Google
This is a digital copy of a book that was preserved for generations on library shelves before it was carefully scanned by Google as part of a project
to make the world's books discoverable online.
It has survived long enough for the copyright to expire and the book to enter the public domain. A public domain book is one that was never subject
to copyright or whose legal copyright term has expired. Whether a book is in the public domain may vary country to country. Public domain books
are our gateways to the past, representing a wealth of history, culture and knowledge that's often difficult to discover.
Marks, notations and other maiginalia present in the original volume will appear in this file - a reminder of this book's long journey from the
publisher to a library and finally to you.
Usage guidelines
Google is proud to partner with libraries to digitize public domain materials and make them widely accessible. Public domain books belong to the
public and we are merely their custodians. Nevertheless, this work is expensive, so in order to keep providing tliis resource, we liave taken steps to
prevent abuse by commercial parties, including placing technical restrictions on automated querying.
We also ask that you:
+ Make non-commercial use of the files We designed Google Book Search for use by individuals, and we request that you use these files for
personal, non-commercial purposes.
+ Refrain fivm automated querying Do not send automated queries of any sort to Google's system: If you are conducting research on machine
translation, optical character recognition or other areas where access to a large amount of text is helpful, please contact us. We encourage the
use of public domain materials for these purposes and may be able to help.
+ Maintain attributionTht GoogXt "watermark" you see on each file is essential for in forming people about this project and helping them find
additional materials through Google Book Search. Please do not remove it.
+ Keep it legal Whatever your use, remember that you are responsible for ensuring that what you are doing is legal. Do not assume that just
because we believe a book is in the public domain for users in the United States, that the work is also in the public domain for users in other
countries. Whether a book is still in copyright varies from country to country, and we can't offer guidance on whether any specific use of
any specific book is allowed. Please do not assume that a book's appearance in Google Book Search means it can be used in any manner
anywhere in the world. Copyright infringement liabili^ can be quite severe.
About Google Book Search
Google's mission is to organize the world's information and to make it universally accessible and useful. Google Book Search helps readers
discover the world's books while helping authors and publishers reach new audiences. You can search through the full text of this book on the web
at |http: //books .google .com/I
':M
r-
\^-
\ tv t \
v. At tV
V/ '
\\
A
I^SV-«A\/^^^ (V^lvvv. IWiUv^v-
Va>.\k>,^^J,
o
THE
SPANISH CONQUEST
OP r.;. -it
UK
CO--
V^ui^'-''** !»
N EW MEXICO,
BT
W. W. H. DAVIS, A. M.
^rSMBEB 07 THK " HI8TOBI0AL BOOUTT OF PSMHSTLYAHIA," AND THX *' NKW
YOBK OS»rXALOQIOAL AMD BIOOKAPmOAI. BOOIXTT;'* AUTHOK OP ** EL
GBDf OO, OB If KW UXXIOO AlfD HXB PKOPLX ;" '* HIBTOST OP THX
OITE nUnDBKD AJTD FOtTBTH PXNlf BTLYAIOA BBODOEHT ;"
"mSTOBY OF TUB HABT FAMILT," AND "tHB
LIFE OF OKNXBAL JOUH X^CET.**
DOYLESTOWN, PA.,
1869.
I
US2.372-./S'
-^.
BOUND AUb a i»13
fiilend, Mcordlog to Act of CoDgMss, la Uw jeir 1M>,
By W. W. H. DAV18,
In tlie Oaik'a Ofice of tbe DlEtrlct Court oribe United Blalei, Is uid fin tli
Butem IHstnct ot Penns;lTanU.
t'iMti^ticxi.
IS RE8FSCTFUU.T DEDICATJED TO
JOHN 0. JAMES, OF PHILADELPHIA.
TO TESTIFY THE
RESPECT ENTERTAINED FOR HIS PERSON
AND CHARACTER,
AND TO MARK
THE AUTHOR'S APPRECIATION OF HIS UNViVRYlN(4
FRIENDSHIP.
PREFACE.
The conquest of that portion of tho North American
continent hitely the province, now the territory, of New
Mexico, and which the United States acquired from
Mexico under the treaty of Guadalupe Hidalgo, is an
unpublished page in Spanish-American history. The
historian has overlooked this field of early adventure
and given his attention to what seemed a more inviting
banquet, thus depriving the world of one of the most
interesting relations of incidents to be met ^vith in the
record of early explorations in the New World. The
earliest mention of Spaniards penetrating into New Mexico
is found in the journal of Alvar Nunez Cabeza de Vaca'
written in the first half of the sixteenth century. He wad
an officer of the unfortunate expedition of Narvaez, and
with three companions was wandering nearly ten years
across the continent, at the end of which time he reached
the Spanish settlements on the gulf of California. Al-
though Vaca and his companions had no part in the
conquest of New Mexico, they were its first explorers,
and the information they gave of it directed the Spaniards
n
VI PREFACE.
thither. For these reasons the work would not be com-
plete without their adventures.
In presenting this work to the public, a sense of duty,
to them and myself, suggests that I state the circum-
stiinces under which it was written. I went to New
ilexico, in 1853, to fill an official station under the general
government. Soon after my arrival I made inquiries, of
those wifli whom I came in contact, about the history ot
tlie country ; but I scarcely met an individual who could
give me any reliable information, nor were books on the
subject to be had. Believing, that the stniggle, which
resulted in the S^mniards wresting the couStry from tlic
l)osse8sion of the partially civilized people they found
there, would present a deeply interesting narrative, I
turned my attention to collecting materials to supply the
want of knowledge on the subject. I did tliis simply for
my personal information, without any thought or inten-
tion of writing a liistory. But the more time I devoted
to the labor, the more interested I became in it ; and as
itionths and years wore away, and new and unpublished
material accumulated on my hands, I concluded to present
the result of my researches to tfie public. Difficulties
presented themselves at nearly every step, and but for the
assistance of kind friends the work had never been com-
pleted. Many of the authorities consulted were in the
original Spanish, and had lain undisturbed, in musty
bundles,' for two centuries. They were written in the
([uaint style of that period and were difficult to decipher*
PREFACE. 'Nil
The events treated in this volume run through a period
of one hundred and seventy-six years — from 1527 to 1703,
and embrace, among others, the following interesting
relations, viz : —
1. The wanderings of Cabeza de Vaca and three com-
panions through portions of New Mexico, as early as
1530-38, from a journal written by himself soon atler his
return to Spain.
2. The explorations of friar Marcos de Niza, in 1539,
in Tsearch of Cibola or the country of the Seven Cities.
3. The expedition of Francisco Vasquez Coronado,
in 1541-43, to subjugate New Mexico to the crowTi of
Spain.
4. The adventures of friat Augustin Ruiz, who entered
the country as a missionary, in 1581.
5. The expedition of Antonio de Espejo, in search of
friar Euiz, in 1582.
6. Accoimt of Juan de Ofiate's colonizing the country
in 1591, and the Aempts the Indians made in the next
ninety years to throw off the Spanish yoke.
7. A full account of the great Indian rebellion of 1680,
a
and the contest to re-establish Spanish power.
Besides these authorities, I consulted fragments of MSS.,
journals of otlier early explorers and adventurers wlio
were mainly attracted thither by their thirst for gold, as
well as all other sources of information I had access to.
The work of Padi'e Frejes on the conquest of the coim-
try, published in Mexico in 1830, and De Larenaudiere's
VIU PREFACE.
History of Mexico afforded me some information I could
obtain nowhere else.
The last seventeen chapters were mainly written from
the Spanish records in the secretary's office at Santa Fe,
and which had never before been translated. These old
manuscripts are complete, and their genuineness is un-
doubted. Their contents include an account of the great
Indian rebellion of 1680, and the subsequent efforts of
the Spaniards to reconquer and hold the country. I had
great difficulty in obtaining the journal of Onate wfio
established the first permanent settlements in New Mexico ;
and I am indebted to Major Simeon Hart, of El Paso,
Texas, for the copy I consulted, which he procured from
the city of Mexico. It had been mutilated and only em-
])raced a portion of his adventures, and as I was unable
to obtain further information on the* subject, the history
of this important period is incomplete. This journal,
entire, was formerly in the secretary's office at Santa Fe,
])ut since the United States obtaine(]^os8es8ion of the
country it was stolen, and no clue has been obtained of it.
Of the journal of Cruzate I was only able to obtain a few
pages, and these in MS.
The copious notes, prepared with great care, will give
the reader information of the most important locaUties
mentioned, while the outline map will enable him to fol-
low the march of troops, and the routes of adventurers,
vdth considerable accuracy. I cannot conclude this
prefatory notice without returning thanks to Samuel
PREFACE. IX
EUliBOD, esquire, late translator iii the executive office at
Santa Fe, for his valuable assistancre in translating the old
Spanish manuscripts.
With this preface The Spanish Conquest of New
Mexico is submitted to the public, with the hope that it
will be foimd of sufficient interest to claim an attentive
perusal.
W. W. H. DAVIS.
Doylestavm^ Pa.^ July laU 1869.
CONTENTS.
CHAPTER I.
Narvacz sails for Florida and lands upon the coast 17
CHAPTER n.
The army marches into the interior and takes Apalache *2*^
CHAPTER ni.
Narvaez causes boats to be built and attempts to escape by sea. ... :il
CHAPTER IV.
The Spaniards re-embark, and Yaca*s boat is cast upon the shore. .'i7
CHAPTER V.
Pitiable condition of Yaca and his men, and what befel them 44
CHAPTER VI.
The island of Malhado, with some account of the inhabitants '><)
CHAPTER VH.
Dorantes and Castillo attempt to escape, and what happened fo
Vaca ,*;«
CHAPTER VIII.
The fate of Narvaez, and the whereabouts of the survivors (>2
CHAPTER IX.
How Vaca and his companions escape from the Indians Vm
CHAPTER X.
The Spaniards continue theu: journey, and the people they met. ... 74
• •
XU CONTENTS.
CHAPTER XI.
Some account of the maimers and customs of various tribes ^ 80
CHAPTER Xn.
The Spaniards again resume their journey and what they saw 87
CHAPTER^Xm.
Vaca and companions arrive among a people of fixed habitations. 94
CHAPTER XIV. '
The Spaniards reach the settlements of New Spain, and thence go
to the city of.Mexico 103
CHAPTER XV.
The earliest information of New Mexico, and the first attempt to
explore it 110
CHAPTER XVI.
Friar Niza sets out for Cibola accompanied by one of Vaca's com-
panions IH
CHAPTER XVn.
Niza continues his Journey, and hears of the death of Stephen 124
CHAPTER XVm.
What happened to Stephen at Cibola; Niza returns to New Spain. 133
CHAPTER XIX.
The friar relates his discoveries to Coronado; a Spanish army
marches for Cibola 141
CHAPTER XX. '
The army enters Culiacan; Coronado marches in advance to
Cibola 149
CHAPTER XXI.
The army reaches Cibola ; expedition of Dias to the coast 158
CHAPTER XXn.
A further account of Cibola ; an expedition marches to the prov-
ince of Tusayan, and the river Tizon 166
%
CONT^ptS. xiii
.CHAPTER XXnL ^
Alvando marches to Ck!ay4j and the army Pes into winter
qoaiteiB at Tigaez 170
CHAPTER XXIV.
Description of Tigaez ; the Indians revolt against the Spaniards
but are conquered • 185
CHAPTER XXV.
The ^qj;e and capture of Tigaez ; Coronado marches to Qcayd.. 193
CHAPTER XXVI.
The army leaves Tigaez and marches out upon the plains 202
CHAPTER XXVn.
Coronado marches to Quivira ; some account of the plahi Indians 211
CHAPTER XXVm.
An account of tlie provinces the Spaniards visited ; the army re-
turns to Tlguex 221
■
CHAPTER XXIX.
Coronado meets with an accident, and the army returns to Mexico. 228
CHAPTER XXX.
Augustln Ruiz and two iiiars enter New Mexico as missionaries,
and are put to death by the Indians. 231
CHAPTER XXXI.
Antonio de Espejo undertakes an expedition to rescue the two
friars 240
CHAPTER XXXn.
Espejo marches up the valley of the Rio del Nort(5 ; some account
of the provinces he passed through 217
CHAPTER XXXm.
The Spaniards visit several new provinces and then return to New-
Biscay V."..
CHAPTER XXXIV.
Tului de Oiltttc enters New Meidco with a party of colonists i' • :
2nv coin^NTS.
Ivi3fi
CHAPTER XXXV,
Ofiate visits QaiyirflT&Qd what took place there ; Friar Salmeroa. 271
CHAPTER XXXVI.
The Indians become discontented under Spanish rule, and ma^e
-sereral attempts at rebellion 27l>
CHAPTER XXXVn.
The Indians rise in rebellion against the Spanish authorities 287
CHAPTER XXXVm.
The Indians besiege Santa F6, and compel the Spaniards to eyacu-
atethetown 291
CHAPTER XXXIX.
What took place after the Spaniards were driven from the countiy. 301
CHAPTER XL.
Governor Otermin marches for the re-conquest of New Mexico .... 307
CHAPTER XLI.
The army reaches the pueblo of Isleta which is taken with slight
resistance 314
CHAPTER XLH.
The Spaniards continue their march up the river, and the condi-
tion in which the pueblos were Ibund 320
CHAPTER XUn.
Mendoza makes a reconnoissance up the river to Cochiti and what
took place there ; the army returns to El Paso 327
CHAPTER XLIV.
Don Diego de Vargas succeeds Otermin, and marches for the re-
conquest of New Mexico ; his expedition to Taos 33f>
CHAPTER XLV.
Vargas marches to subdue the pueblos of Pecos, Cia and Jemez... 347
CHAPTER XLVI.
The army now marches for the provinces of Zufd and Moqui 355
•
*
COCTENTS* ' XV
CHAPTER XLVn.
The Moqni Indians l)eiBg pacified Vargas E^oms to El Paso with
hisanny .W. 363
«
CHAPTER XLVm.
Second expedition of Vargas into New Mexico, and lus march to
Santa P^ ;. 373
CHAPTER XLIX.
TliQ Indians defend Santa Fe, but it is taken by the Spanivds 381
CHAPTER L.
Vargas marches to Cochiti, and afterward meets the Indians on
themesaofSanYldefonso 381)
CHAPTER LI.
The Indians again become hostile, and Vargas marches against
the Taos pneblos ^ 40«3
CHAPTER LH.
An expedition marches against Jemez, with the result ; conclusion. 407
ArPEXDix 4r,>
l7n)EX 427
*
L
THE
CONQUEST
s*
OP
ISTE^W^ MEXICO
CHAPTER I.
^N\UtVAEZ SAILS FOU FLORIDA AND LANDS HPON TIIK COAST.
AJiONCr the adventurous spirits of the sixteenth century,
who sought tlie ac(juisition of fame and wealth in the
New World, was a Spanish cavalier named Pamfilo de
Narvaez, a gentleman of rank and fortiinc in his native*
•land. He was commanded by the king of S]>ain to con-
«[uer the then almost fabulous land of Florida, and was
api)ointed governor over all the country he miglit reduce
to i>ossession. He set sail from the town of San Lucar
de Barrameda, on the 17tli of June, 1527, with a fleet
of five vessels and about six hundred men. Among the
-officers was Alvar Nuiiez Cabeza de Vaca, who held the
18 TUE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXrCO;
responsible posts of treasurer and liigh-slieriiT.i Fairly
at sea the prows of the vessels were turned toward the
Western world, and in due season they arrived at San
Domingo, without accident. Narvaez remained at this
port near fifty days, in order to procure horses and other
articles necessary for the expedition. While there more
than an hundred and forty men deserted the fleet and
I'emained upon the island, being influenced to do so by
the advantageous 06131*8 made them by the settlers. Thence
lie sailed to Santiago, a port on tlie soutliern coast of Cuba,
where ho completed his outfit. He next sailed for Trini-
dad, an hundred leagues from Santiago, to take in some
provisions promised him by a gentleman who lived near
there. He anchored tlie greater part of the fleet at tlie
port of Cape Santa Cruz, midway between these two points,
and sent forw^u'd two vessels for the supplies under the
command of cajitain Pantoja. The latter reached Trini-
dad in safety, but while lying off that harbor a sudden
1 Alvar Nuficz Cal»eza do Vaca was a native cf the city of Jerez de
la Frontcro, and was grandson of Pedro de Vaca, who made the con-
(luest of the Canaries, at his own expense. Upon Vaca'a return from
the unfortunate expedition of Narvacz, the emperor conferred upon
him tlie government of Paraguay, with the title of Adalantado. lie
sailed from the port of San Lucar de Barrameda on the 2d of Novem-
ber, 1540, and arrived at Santa Catalina the 2Dlh of the following
March. lie had a stormy time in Paragnay, and upon his return to
Spain he retired to the city ofSevilla, where he lived upon a ixinsion of
two thousand ducats. lie is described as having the most beautiful
and noble figure of all the conquerors of the New World ; and in the
best days of Spanish chivalry, bis valor upon the battle-field, his reso-
lution in danger, and his constancy and resignation in hardship,
won for him the appellation ^*Illustrioua Warrior." He left
behind him two works— his Shipwrecks, and commentaries upon his
government on the River de la Plata. A gentleman of New Mexico,
Don Toraas Cabcza d;} Vaca, living at Pe^a Blanca, in the county of
Suutti Ana, claims lineal descent from Alvar Numz.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 1 9
and violent storm arose which wrecked botli the vessels,
and drowned sixty meYi and forty horses. Vaca was in
command of one of the vessels ; but having gone ashor(j
with thirty of the crew in quest of the provisions they
escaped the fat« of their companions. Narvaez findintc
a secure anchorage for the fleet at Cape Santa Cruz was
enabled to live through the storm ; and on the 5th of
November he joined Vaca and the survivors of the wrecked
vessels at Trinidad. The season was now far advanced,
and being warned by the inclemency of the weatlier of
the danger of venturing to sea, he determined to spend
the winter upon the island. For this purpose the fleet,
under the command of Vaca, was sent to the port of
Xagua, twelve miles distant, where it was anchored in a
safe harbor.
The fleet remained at Xagua until the 20tli of Fol)-
ruary, 1528, when Narvaez arrived with a small brig lie
had purchased to supply, in part, the place of tlie wrecko<l
vessels. He brought with him a pilot who had l)cen to
Florida and professed to be well acquainted with tin*
coast. He immediately set to work making th^ necessary
preparations for the voyage, which were hastily <M)ni-
pleted ; and on the second day after his arrival lie i^vt
sail on his ill-fated expedition, with a fleet of four sliips
and a brig, cjirrying four hundred men and eighty horst»s.
Steering westward, he coasted along the southern slior<»
of Cuba, encountering several severe storms wliich endan-
gered his safety ; and in a run of twenty days he d<)u])kMl
Cape San Anton, the western point of the island, :md
sailed witliin twelve leamies of llabana. The next dav
lie stood in toward the land, intending to enter the harbor,
when a sudden storm arose from the South which drove
the vessels off the shore in the direction of Horida. 1 To
39 THE CONQUEST OF NTTW^ MEXICOr
made land on the 12tli of April, but sailed along the coaet
until Holy Tliursday, when the fleet came to anchor at
the mouth of a bay, upon the head of which some Indian
habitations were seen.
The controller, iVlonzo Enrriquez, landed upon an
island in tlie bay, and trafficked a little witli the natives,
wlio came io .him without alarm. The next day, being
(Jood Friday, Narvaez went ashore witli as many men as
the boats would carry, and made a visit to the Indian set-
tlement at the head of the bav, which he found deserted.
The huts were generally small, rude structures, but one of
them was large enough to hold three hundred pei'sons.
The only article seen of any value was a small bell of
gold found among some flsli-nets. Narvaez remained here
overnight, and the next morning he unfurled the royal
ensign and took formal ])Osses6ioii of the comitry in tlie
name of the king of Spain. This ceremony completed,
he sissembled his followers around him, and macfc known
to tliem his authority as governor over all the lands that
might be discovered ; when the officers laid before him
their coimnissions which he approved. The remainder
of the troops, with the horses, were now landed without
accident, and the little army stood .in arms upon a savage
and almost unknown coast.j The next dav the Indians
returned to their huts, but as the Spaniards liad no inter-
preter who understood their langui^e, they were unable
to hold anv intercourse with them. Tlie savages made
u few signs to the strangers, as if bidding tliem to go
awav, and then returned into the interior.
i Tlie place where Narvaez landed is established without much, if
any, doubt, as Tampa Bay, on the western coast of Florida, and was
named by the Spaniards the Bay of the Gross. He disembarked on
the northern shore, and marched inland towards the North.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 21
Two days afterward Xarvaez, under an escort of forty
men and accompanied by Vaca and two other otiiceri*,
made art excursion a short distance inland. They marclied
toward the North until evening, wlien they came to a large
hay wliich extended far into the interior, on the shore
of wliich they encamped until the next day, wlien tliey
returned to tlie vessels. The brig was now ordered to
sail along the coast in search of the hai'bor tlie pilot had
d^poken of; but in the event of the captain iiot being able
to find it, he w-as directed to return tO' Ilal^vna and bring
a fiulher supply of provisions from a ship lelt at that
])lace in charge of Alvaro dc la Cevdix.
After the departure of tlie brig Narvaez, with his small
party, returned inland to continue his explorations. They
inarched along the coast for the distance of four league^!,
when they captured four Indians who conducted them to
their town at the head of the bay. Here was found a
little maize in an unripe state, and the Spaniards saw four
dead bodies covered w-ith painted deer-skins, and deposited
in cases similar fo those used in Castile for containinur
merchandize. The bodies were afterward burned. Thev
also discovered some pieces of woolen-cloth, bunches of
feathers, and a few samples of gold. The Indians, upon
being asked, where they Imd obtained these tilings, replied
that they came from a distant province called Apalache,
which also abounded in many other articles of great
value. Thence they continued some ten or twelve leagues
further into the interior, the Indians acting as guides ;
but making no discoveries, except finding a little rij)o
t*orn, they retraced their steps and returned to the shi})s.
The time had now arrived when it became necessarv
for Narvaez to take some steps toward carrying into elfect
the oliject of the expedition. For tliis purpose he asscm-
22 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
liled his principal officers and informed them of his inten-
tion to penetrate into tlio interior with the troops, while
the vessels were to follow the coast nntil they should
arrive at the harbor mentioned by the pilot, where they
were to await his return. This plan did not meet the
entire approbation of his followers. Among those who
opposed it were the notary and Vaca, who thought it
imprudent to penetrate into the heart of the country, cut
off, as they would be, from all support, until the vessels
should be first placed in a known and safe harbor. The
opinion of his lieutenants, however, was disregarded, and
Karviiez followed his own judgment and inclination. lie
made immediate preparations to carry his determination
into execution. The vessels were placed in command of
Caravallo, an alcalde of the expedition, with necessary
instructions to govern him. The troops were then mus-
tered upon the shore, fully armed and equipped for the
march, numbering three hundred infantry and forty cav-
alry. They were tiecompanied by two friars and three
other clergymen. He distributed two pounds of biscuit
and half a pound of bacon to each man, tliis being all the
provisions he had left to give them; and when this sup-
j.ly should be consumed they would be obh'ged to depend
ii!)Ou the uncertaintv of the march for 6ul)sistence.
^H£ CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 23
CHAPTER II.
TliE ASHY MAECHES INTO THE INTERIOR AND TAKES
APALACHE.
The Spaniards marched for the interior on Sunday,
the let of May. They took a northerly course, nearly
yarallcl to the sea^^oast, which they held for fifteen
days when they arrived at a large river which detained
them a day in crossing.i • In all this distance the country
was uninliabited and barren, and the troops subsisted on
A scanty ration of bread and bacon, given them before
starting, and some palmettos, found on the march. Soon
after crossing the river they encountered about two hun-
dred Indians with whom they had some difficulty. They
succeeded in making prisoners of five or six of the savages,
who conducted them to their huts half a league off, where
was found a large quantity of com in a ripe state.
1 This river is undoubtedly the Withlacooche, which is the first large
stream North of Tampa Bay that empties into the gulf of Mexico. The
distance from Tampa is about an hundred miles, and according to
their rate of travel, the Spaniards should have reached it in fidecp
.{iajTs, the time they were occupied i^ making the march.
i4 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO^
Here they encamped for a few days to recniit their*
wasted strength. Their exact position not being known.
Jit the request of the officers, Narvaez sent Vaca with
forty men in search of the sea. He returned in the"
evening and reporte<l that he had mardied upon what
appeared to be the sea-shore until he arrived at the river
they had crossed, when he retraced liis steps without
having discovered the sea. Not beijig satisfied with this
exploration, Narvacx sent out a second ])arty of sixty
infantiy and six cavalry under the command of Vclen-
zuela, wlio was directed to cross the river and follow it
down to tlie mouth, and look for a good harbor. lie
met with little l)etter success tlian Vaca. lie reached
the coast, but tlie water was not more than two feet deej)
in any part of it ; and the only signs of inhabitants were
live or six canoe-loads of Indians seen at a distance.
The next day after A'elenzuela's return the army re-
sumed the march, and continued in a northerly direction,
tlu'ougli a biu-ren and uninliabited country. On the ITtli
of .Tune the Spaniards were visited by an Indian chief,
th'essed in painted deer-skius and carried upon the back
of a warrior. He was accompanied by a large number of
liis people plaj-ing upon reed-flutes. Narvaez held inter-
course with him by signs, and gave liim to understand
that he was going in sean'li of ^Vpalache. Ilie chief said
lie wjis an enemy of that people and would assist him to
make war upon them. A few hawk-bills and other
trinkets were given to the Indians, and the (Jiief, as evi-
dence of his friendly feelings, presented the governor with
the deer-skin he wore. Resuming the march, that niglit
the Spaniards came to another river so broad and deep
tliey were ol)liged to build a liu-ge canoe to fei'ry the men
TIIE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 25
<a(iross, and they were a whole day in getting over./-- One
soldier and his horse were swept away by the cnrrent and
ih'owned ; the body of tlie horse was recovered Ijy the
Indians, and was cooked and eaten that night l)y the
soldiers. They encamj>ed ni)on the bank of the river until
inoming, when the march was iH3snnied, and the same day
.they arrived at the town of the chief. lie extended to
the weary Spaniards the usual hospitalities of his tribe,
and among other things furni8lie<l them with a supply of
com, of whicli they stood in great need. During tlio
m'glit the Indians quietly withdi'ew from the town and
<lisappeared, and the army marched the next mornini;
without one of them making their appearance.
Willie the army was in march a large party of Indians,
fully armed and equipped for battle, came in sight but
fled when the Spaniards approached, and afterwjird fol-
lowed in their rear; A small party of cavalry was placed
in ambush tO' surprise them when they should come u[>,
s This river is supposed to have been the Sawaneo or Suwanec,
which rises in Georgia, flows South and empties into the gulf. From
the length of time cmplo3'ed in marching from the Withlacoocbe to
the Sawance, Mr. Smith supposes that Narvaez crossed the river pretty-
high up. As the journal of Vaca makes no mention of having passed
any stream between these two rivers, it would naturally be inferrc»\
that they crossed the Sawanee below its eastern branch, else some
account would have been given of the latter stream. They must have
changed their course from the North toward the West before they
reached the river. It is the opinion of Mr. Smith, that in the march^
of the Spaniards from the Sawanee to the gulf they were ctjmlucted by
the Indians near the present boundary between Florida and Georgin..
Garcilasso de la Vega, who accompanied the expedition of De Soto iv
few years later, and who appears to have seen Vaca's journal when ho
^v^ote his account of Dc Soto's march, was also of the same opinion.
I believe this route to have been too far to the North, although I en-
tieEtain a different opinion upon this point with a good deal of re^
luctance.
26 Tni: conqiest of new Mexico.
and succeeded in capturing three or four who were used
iis guides. Under their direction the army continued on
until the 24th of June, through a country covered \vith a
heavy growth of timber with the ground much encumbered
with fallen trees, when it came in sight of the long wislied-
for town of Apalachcs Tlie soldiers were much rejoiced
when they saw the goal of their hopes, and exi>ected tliis
would be the termination of their hardships, They had
suffered much from fatigue and hunger, and been obliged
to marcli many a weary mile without finding as much as
a grain of cx)rn to eat.
When the armv arrived in front of the town, Narvaez
ordered Vaca to enter it with fifty infantry and a few
cavalrv, wliieh lie did without loss. He found it onlv
occupied by the women and children. The warriors were
absent, but they shortly returned and opened fire upon
the Spaniards. The action lasted but a few minutes,
when the Indians fied, leaving Vaca and his men in pos-
session of the to\m. None of the soldiers were injured,
and the only loss sustained was one horse killed. Apa-
laclie was situated in the midst of dense forests, sur-
rounded ])V lar^ice bodies of fresh water filled with fallen
trees. The houses were fortv in luimber, small and low,
and l)uilt of thatch ; and in them wci'e found a large
3 The exact situation of this place is not known, and it can only be
locat<;d by conjecture, ^^^arvaez was eight days in marching from the
feawanec to Apalache, and his course must have been W^cst, or nearly
so ; and I believe the town to have been situated between that river
and Uie Ocilla which empties into the Bay of Apalache. The length
of time the Spaniards were occupied in marching from the Sawanec
to Apalache is an argument against their having crossed that river ver}'
high up and passed along near the boundary line between Florida and
Georgia, for they could not have accomplished the distance in eight
days, the time mentioned in V^ica's journal.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICa 27
quantity of com in a dry state, deer-skins, and small
thread mantelets witli which the women covered the per-
son. In the fields the com was fit for plucking. The
country, from the place of landing up to this point. Was
mostly level and sandy, generally covered with a dense
forest of large trees of various kinds, and abounding in
lakes. The forests were filled with rabbits, bears, deer
and other game, and the lakes abounded with water-fowls
and fish.
A few hours after the Spaniards had taken possession
of Apalache, the Indians returned in a peaceful attitude
and requested that their women and children might be
delivered to them. They were given up, but Narvaez
detained a cacique who had been very active in stirring
up the Indians to hostility. The next day the savages
returned and made an attack upon the troops, but when
the latter sallied out they fled to the surrounding lakes
and escaped. The only loss sustained on either side was
one Indian killed. The following day they renewed the
jittack, coming from the opposite side of the lake, but
were repulsed without loss to tlie Spaniards.
The army remained at Apaliiclie, to recniit the men
after their fatiguing march, and also to allow 2s jirvaez an
opportunity of exploring the surrounding country. He
caused three parties to start out in as many directions,
but none of them returned with favorable reports. They
foimd the country thinly peopled, and difficult to be tra-
versed, because of the dense forests and numerous lakes
that everywhere abounded. The governor made inquiries
•of the captive cacique about other towns, and was told
that Apalache was the most populous ; and tliat in other
sections the country was poorer, with fewer inhabitants,
4Uid abounding in vast deserts and solitudes, lie said that
/
28 THE CONQUEST DF NEW MEXICO.
toward the Soutli, in a joiiniey of nine days in the direo-
tion of the sea, there was a town called Ante, whose in-
habitants hfwl an abundance of corn, pumpkins and fish,
and were frrendly with the people of Apalache. TJic
Indians continued hostile and made frequent attacks upon
tlie Spaniards, in one of which they killed one Don Pedro.,
a lor<l of Tescuco. Tliey never stood tlieir ground fur
nnv lenjcth of time, but <:^enerallv fled when attacked in
retnpi, and their covert in the lakes was so secure that
they could not' be dislodged.
'i'he Spaniards rested twent3'-five days at Apalache^
when Narvaez determined to go in search of Ante, of
wliicli tlie Indians had given such a favorable account,
lie evacuated the town at the head of his troops and
resumed the march toward the S^mth. In the meanthne
rlie Indians of all the surrounding country had been
rousted up to resistance, and seemed determined to oppose
his furtlier jirogress. Hie second day after leaving Apa-
la<"he, antl while crossing: a lake, lie wac attacked bv a
large body of savages, who opened a severe fire of arrows
upon his tn)()[>s, from behind trees and among the swamp
;::rass. Thcv succeeded in checking his advance, and dis-
]>uted the passage with much spirit and bravery. They
wounded several men and horses, and were not routed
until the cavalrv liad l)een dismounted and charfj^ed them
Mil foot, when tliev broke and fled into the lake. The
Indians were all well-armed, with bows as thick as the
arm and about three and a half feet long : they were good
marksmen, and shot their arrows with great accuracy the
distance of two hundred vards, and with such force ius to
penetrate tlie coats of mail worn by the soldiers. The
Spaniards now crossed the lake without further opposition
ujid coutinued the march. At the distance of a leagu*
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 29
tiiey arrived at a second passage, similar to, but more
difficult than, the first, but the Indians offered no resist-
ance and it was traversed in safety. The next day they
came to a third passage, ^\'♦lere tliey found the Indians
assembled in large numbers to oppose them. They were
better prepared to meet tliis attack than the former one,
and succeeded in crossing the lake without loss ; and
when they came out upon the plain they charged the
Indians, killing two and wounding two or three others.
They now advanced for some daysNvithout opposition and
until witliin one league of Ante, when the enemy again
appeared and fell upon the rear-guard. In this attack
the Spaniards lost one man, a soldier named Avellaneda.
lie was killed by an arrow which struck the edge of his
cuirass with such force that the shaft passed almOst entirely
through his neck.
The army arrived at Ante the ninth day from Apalaclic.
The town was found deserted and the houses burnt, but
the Indians in their flight had left behind them a good
deal of maize, pumpkins and beans in a ripe state.4 Tlie
Spaniards remained here three days. The third day after
their arrival Yaca was sent in scarcli of the scii, as the
Indians had said it was near tliis place ; they were en-
couraged in this belief, because they had seen a very large
river running toward tlie South. lEe set out with fifty
♦ The situation of this place is equally uncertain with that of Apa-
lache, but was somewhere in the same region of countr>'. Nai-vaez
was nine days in reaching Autc, and his course was South, for which
reason we may infer that it was situated between Apalache and the
culf of Mexico. The party -sent owt* from Autc, in search of the sea,
reached a cove on the coast in one day, and also saw a large rivei
flowing toward the sea. This is the only river Vaca mentions since
crossing the Sawanee, and it is but reasonable to suppose, that had he
seen or crossed any other, he would have mentioned it.
30 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
infantry and seven cavalry, and was accompanied by the
commissioner friar Suarez, captain Castillo, and iVndres
Dorantes. In one day's march they reached a cove or
inlet of the sea, where they JW^nnd an abundance of oys-
ters. The next morning Vaca sent twenty men to explore
the sea-coast, who returned in tlie evening and reported
that they had not been able to reach it, and that it was
very distant. Tlie third day he returned to Aute and
made a report of liis explorations. In his absence the
Indians had made an attack upon the camp, and killed
one hoi'se ; and he found Narvaez and many of the
soldiers sick, being worn down by the hardships of the
march.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 31
CHAPTER III.
NAEVAEZ CAUSES BOATS TO IJE BUILT AND ATTEMPTS TO
ESCAPE BY SEA.
Narvaez remained at Aute seven days when the
march was resumed toward the coast ; and at the end at'
the first day lie reached the little cove where Vaca had
halted in his explorations a few days before. Here the
army encamped, i
1 The point where the Spaniards reached the coast they callud the Bay
of Caballos ; and from the most reliable data I am of the opinion that it
was one of the coves or inlets of Apalache Bay ; in truth it cannot well
be located further West. History seems to have fixed upon this locality
with as much certainty as any other upon the whole route. In 1539 a
squadron from the army of De Soto, under Juan de Afiasco visited this
bay, and the appearance the shore presented was stated by the Ynca
in his account of the expedition. They saw plainly where the furnace
had been built, and charcoal was still found lying round about. The logs
the Spaniards had hollowed out and used for horse-troughs were also
there. They were told bv the Indians that Narvaez had encamped at
that place and built his boats. They pointed out to Afiasco where
various events had transpired, and took him all over the ground ; and
also showed him where the Indians had killed ten of his men, as is
stated in Vaca's journal. They explained to him by signs all that had
occurred there. He and his men searched in holes and under the bark
of trees to discover letters or other mementoes of If arvaez's men, but
foimd nothing. Hcrrera confirms this location. In 1722 Charlevoix
was at San Marcos de Apalache, and in speaking of the bay wrote as
follows : " This bay is precisely that which Garcilasso de la Vega, in
his History of Florida, calls the port of AutJ." Let. xxxiv.
Ji2 TlIE CONQrEST OF 'NEW MEXIG©.
The condition of the Spaniards was now pitiable in the
extreme, and wtus becoming more critical every lioiir.
The march was arduous and djuigerous ; disease was daily
wasting away tlieir number, and tlie sick and disabled
wci'e so numerous there were not horses enough to trans-
l»ort them. Tliey were almost without provisions ; in an
unknown country cut off from all hope of succor, and
surrounded by a savage foe ; they were completely lost
in the wilderness of forests and swamps and knew not-
whither to turn to extricate themselves. In the midst of
these difticulties, of themselves so well calculated to dis-
pirit botli officers and. men, a secret conspiracy was put
on foot by the cavahy, for the purpose of abandoning the
gi)vernor and securing a better fate for themselves. The
misfortunes which beset them had now reached such a
point that some immediate steps seemed necessary for
hclf-preservation. Narvaez was fully aware of the critical
situation, and lie took counsel of the present danger for
his future course. The evening he encamped at the little
cove he called to him each officer and man of any note,
and asked their individual advice as to the course that
hliould be pursued. After calm deliberation u])on the state
of affairs, they coir.cidcd in the project of building boats,
and endeavoring to make their escape by sea. But this
course, which seemed the only feasible one left, by whicli
they could liope to rescue themselves, was surrounded by
many difficulties. They had neither tools, material, nor
workmen ; nor had they provisions to sustain themselves
while at work building boats. Tlie matter was fidly
discussed without coming to any decision that night ; and
when the council broke up each one rei)aired to his couch
in the sand, with a prayer to God that Ue would direct
.them in idl their trials.
TOIE CO^'QL'EST OF NEW MEXICO. 83
Upon further reflection, the next day, it was resolved
sto attempt to build boats in spite of the diflieulties, and
.trust tlieir future fortunes to the waves of the sea. It
M'as their intention to coast along the gulf-shore until they
should reach some of the Spanish settlements in Mexico.
Tliey commenced to build boats tlie 4th of September,
and by the 20th five were completed, each one being
thirty-one feet in length. Their tools were of a very rude
description, and their materials entirely unsuited to the
purpose. One of the men made a pair of bellows of deer-
skins. Nails, saws, axes, etc, were maniifac^tured from
their stirrups, spurs, bridle-bits and other articles of iron
about their equipments. The rigging for the boats was
manufactured from the fibre of the palmetto, and the tails
and manes of their horses; and the shirts of the officers and
men were made into sails. The boats were likewise calked
with the fibre of the palmetto. Every third day a horse
was killed and divided among the workmen and the sick;
and to iucrease tlieir store ©f provisions foraging parties
made frequent excursions to Ante in search of grain, where
-they found a few bushels of corn. The forest around
swarmed with Indians, who harassed the workmen, and
made frequent attacks upon those who went out in search
of provisions. A party of men gathering shell-fish in the
neighboring cove were attacked within sight of the camp
and ten of them killed. A Greek named Teodoro made
rosin from the pine trees witli which he pitched tlie
boats, and stones were used for ballast, though it was with
difficulty a suflicient quantity could be found for that
,})m^^ose. Bottles, to hold water for the voyage, were
made of tanned skins of the horses' legs.
The whole distance the Spaniards had mai'ched from
.the Bay of the Cross, Baya de la Cruz^ where thev fii'st
3
">4 Tilt CONQUEST 0^ XEW ^t^iCO.
landed, to the point where the boats w^re built, was esti-'
mated at about two hundred and eighty leagues ; and the
number who had died of hunger and disease, and been
killed by the Indians, was forty, including officers and men.
The final preparations for departure were made by
the 22d, when they went on board the boats. The
same day they killed the last of their liorses, imd in-
eluding this they had but a very limited supply of pro-
visions for the voyage. They embarked in the following
order : " In the boat of the j'overnor there went forty-
nine men ; in another which he gave to the controller
and commissary othei*s as many. Tlie third he gave to
captain Alonzo de Castillo and Andres Dorantes w^ith
forty-eight men ; and another he gave to two captains,
Tellez and Peualosa with forty-^even men. Th<i last he
gave to the assessor and me (Vaea) with forty-mne men."
nie whole number who embarked, independi^nt of the
frfiiccrs, was two hundred and forty. The boats were
heavily laden, and after the men were on board and the
baggage and provisions taken in, there remained not more
tlian three inches of the gunwale above water. They were
so much crowded, tliat the officers and men liad not even
space to move, l>ut were oWiged to sit in one position.-
In all the boats there was not one person who had any
knowledge of navigation.
The place where the Spaniards embarked is known as
L't /jf,'f/'i f/-! los (■ab'tllosn the Bay of Horses. They went
<^! bortrd the 22d of b^ejxtember, and connnenced their
voyage the same day. They turned their backs upon that
inhospitable coast, and launclied their frail l)oats upon the
bosom of an almost unknown gulf, with emotions of no
ordinary kind. A dark cloud, from which gleamed no
ray of hope, encompassed this l)and (^^ heroes, and the
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO, 35
stoniest heart almost gave way under their misfortunes.
The prows of their little vessels were turned seaward
without a martial sound, or a joyful shout to cheer their
departure. In silence and in fear they cast loose their
boats and' started on their voyage. * 1
For seven days they passed through shallow sounds, V
and at the end of that time they came to an island near
the' main-land. Five canoes loaded with Indians started .
from the main-land to come off to them, but becoming
alarmed they abandoned their canoes, which fell into the
hands of the Spaniards. Some of the boats landed upon
the island, where they were fortunate enough to find a
tew mullets and dried muUet-roes ; and as their stock of
provisions by this time had become much reduced, they
were thankful for this meagre supply. They made use
of the Indian canoes to raise the gunwales of their own
boats, which rendered them more secure. They remained
on the island but a short time when they re-embarked
and pursued their voyage. In a league they discovered
a strait the island made with the main land, througli
which they passed. They named the strait San Miguel,
because it was seon upon that day. They now directed
their course toward the West and pulled along the shore
of the gulf of Mexico. Tims they coasted for tliirty days, v
now and then pulling in close to the main-land and enter-
ing some of the creeks and coves, which they found
shallow and difficult of navigation. The only inhabitants
they saw in all tliis distance were a few miserable Indians
fishing. The Spaniards suffered greatly for water. The
skins that contained it had rotted by this time and were
become perfectly useless ; and their supply being ex-
hausted they landed upon an island and searched for
some in vain. They had now been five days without
S6 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
■water, and their thirst had become bo intolerable that
they drank salt-water, from the effect of which four of
them died. While they were upon this island a violent
i^torm arose, which detained them six days.
The storm had not yet subsided when they again re-
embarked, preferring rather to trust themselves to the
perils of the wind and waves than remain upon the island
and endure such great thirst without a prospect of having
it relieved. The sea ran very high and several times the
l>oats were in great danger of foundering. About sun-set
they doubled a point of land behind which they found
calm-water in a sheltered cove. As tliey nearcd the
s^liorc several canoes filled with unarmed Indians came off
to meet them, and followed them in to the land. When
they had made fast their boats the Indians conducted
them to their village, where they offered them lisli to
eat, the Spaniards giving them in exchange corn and
trinkets. The cacique invited Narvaez to his hut, where
lie tendered him the rude hospitalities of his tribe. Their
friendship appears to have been a pretext to conceal
their hostile designs, for in the night the Indians made
an attack upon the Spaniards who were in the houses
and scattered along the shore, and were with difficulty
beaten off. The governor was wounded in the face, and
hardly a man escaped injury. The cacique was made
prisoner in the conflict, but \yns afterward liberated by his
people. He Icfl behind him, in his escape, his robe of
skins of the civet-marten, which had a fragrance of amber
and musk. The Indians renewed the attack three times
and fought with great determination. At the last assault
fifteen men, under captains Dorantes, Penalosa and Tel-
lez, were placed in ambush and attacked them in roar
when, after shoii; resistance, they fled and did not return.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 37
CHAPTER IV.
THE SPANIARDS RE-EMBARK AND VACA'S BOAT IS CAST UPON
THE SHORE.
i\jFTER the repulse of the Indians the Spaniards passed
tlie. night in quietness, and in the morning the enemy
was not to be seen. The weather had now become cold.
A keen T\dnd was blowing from the North, and being
without shelter they burnt thirty of the Indian cabins for
fuel. The sea was so boisterous all that day that they
were unable to embark and were obliged to remain upon
the island. During the night the sea became more calm,
and on the following morning they again embarked and
continued their voyage. Mter rowing three days in a '•
westerly direction they entered an estuary, where a canoe
tilled with Indians came toward them. When they
approached within speaking distance Narvaez asked them
for water, which they promised to bring him if he would
furnish them something to hold it. The Greek and the
negro' accompanied the Indians for water, against the
advice of the governor and the rest of the men, the sav-
ages leaving two of their number as hostages. Some-
time in the night the Indians returned with the vessels
empty, but without the Greek and negro. They spoke
38 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
a few words to the two hostages who immediately at-
tempted to escape, but were prevented by those who had
them in charge.
The next morning the Spaniards were visited by many
Indians in canoes, among whom were five or six chiefs,
of commanding appearance and great influence ; they
wore the hair flowing upon the shoulders and were
dressed in robes of martens, with lion-skin ties. They
demanded the release of the two hostages, but Narvaez
declined to give them up until the Greek and negro were
returned. This they promised to do, and also agreed to
furnish the Spaniards with water and many other articles
of which they stood in need if some of them would
accompany them to the shore., but the governor refused
to accede to their proposition, i The Indians continued
to collect in great numbers, and fearing they intended to
take possession of the entrance to the estuary to prevent
his escape, Narvaez put to sea, followed by the canoes of
the savages. They kept in his wake, and but a short
distance astern, until about midday, when they com-
menced an attack by throwing clubs and slinging stones;
but while the fight was going on the wind freshened up
when the Indians paddled back to the land and the boats
held on their course toward the West. They rowed
until the middle of the afternoon when Vaca, whose boat
was leading, discovered a cape by which fiowed a great
I The following note of Dorotheo, the Greek, is made by Biedma ;
liecueil, p. 72; ''In 1540, when the soldiers under Soto came^to the
town of Mavila, they heard that Don Dorotheo, with his companions,
had been th«%, and they were shown a dirk that had been his." It is
the opinion of Mr. Smith that Teodoro traveled inland, being invited
by the appearance of a country of plenty and a people less barbarous,
and he may have wandered to the North into the country where the
bison aboanded and passed his life among the hunters of that animal.
THE C0NQU3EST OF NEW MEXICO. 39 .
Tiver. He cast anchor near a small island to wait until
the governor should come up ; but the latter instead
entered a bay near by filled with small islands. Here all
the boats came together aud took in a supply of water.
AVhen they embarked again they tried to make a point
in the river behind the island to obtain wood, but the
current was so strong they were unable to reach it. The
river discharged itself into the gulf with suek iqapetuosity
that the current, assisted by a strong North wind then
prevailing, drove the boats out to sea in spite of all their
labor at the oacs. When half a league from shore they
sounded but could not reach bottom in thirty fathomp^ ,
They labored two days to reach the land, but were unable
to make headway against the strong current that poured
out the moutk of the river. On the third morning
before the sun was up they discovered smoke on shore,
in the distance. They pulled toward the huid all day
and by evening arrived within a short distance of it ; but
fearing to approach nearer in the night, and being then
in three fathoms of water, they resolved to rest on their
oars until morning.
When the mOTnino: dawned Vaca's boat was the only
one near the place where they had rested on their oars
the night before, the others being nowhere in sight. He
sounded and found thirty fathoms of water. He strained
his eyes in vain over the smooth surface of the gulf in
search of the missing boats, but notratte of them could
be discovered, and himself and crew found themselves
alone upon the waters. Under the circumstances they
concluded to continue their course, and again taking to
the oars held on their way to the West. They rowed
until vespers, when Vaca espied two boats ahead, the
rforemQst of which proved to be that of the govenior*
40 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXrCO:
When they met Narvaez and Yaca held a consultations as?
to the proper course to be pursued. The latter was ia
fevor of joining the third boat, wlien the three together
should continue on whithersoever God should be pleased
to direct thera, but the governor wanted to land because
the third boat was too far out at sea to be overtaken.
The latter course was adopted and the boats were turned
toward the shore. They rowed in that direction until
near sun-set, Vaca's boat, meanwhile, having fallen some
distance astern^ for the otlier boat had the strongest men
and best rowers. He asked Narvaez to give him a rope
that he might put his boat in tow, but this he declined,
telling hinl at the same time that it was no longer a time
when one man should command another, but that each=
one should da what he thouo:ht best calculated to save his
own life. Narvaez now held on his way, but as Vaca was
unable to keep up with him he turned his boat from the
land and joined tlue one out at sea, which he found to be
commanded by captains Penalosa and Tellez.
These two boats now steered westward for four days,
when they encountered a furious storm that separated
them. Vaca's boat came near foundering, and when the
fttorm abated he foiwid himself a second time alone upon
the sea. He and his men were now almost in despair,,
but they continued their voyage. Such had been the
inclemency of the weatlier, and the hunger, thirst and
other privations they had been obliged to endure, that at
die close of the next day nearly all the crew were lying-
msensible in the bottom of the boat. There were not
live men able to stand upon their feet, and the master and
Vaca were the only ones capable of handling an oar.
Early, in the evening the master also gave out and \i\ctb
was left the only one of the whole crew able to do any-
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. * 41
thing ; but the former revived a little during the aight
and took charge of the boat, when the latter laid down
and rested awhile. Toward the dawn of day Vaca was
aroused by the roaring of the sea, and believing they were
liear the shore cast the lead and found seven fathoms of
water. They resolved to keep a little ways out at sea
until the sun was up, so as to see how they were situated,
and therefore continued to pull gently along the shore.
They had thus rowed for more than a league when a
great wave struck the boat and knocked it almost out of
the water upon shore. The blow aroused the crew from
their almost insensible state, and they crawled upon their
hands and knees to the shore and sought shelter in some
neighboring ravines. Here they found a little rain-water ;
and building a lire parched some corn and warmed their
benumbed bodies. The boat was cast upon the shore on
the 6tli of November, r
J There is a diversity of opiDion as to the location of the island upoa
which the boat of Vaca was wrecked. It is believed by Mr. Smith
that all the boats were lost somewhere East of the Mississippi river, and
which is generally concurred in by those who have examioid the sul)-
ject. He contends that the boat of the controller, Enrriquez, was.
wrecked at the mouth of Pensacola Bay, and that the crew reached
the land on the Western shore. From the most careful examination
I have been able to give the subject I believe that the boat of Vaca was
cast away West of the 31isaissippi, upon one of the low sandy islands
that line the coast of Louisiana. There arc several reasons for coming
to this conclusion.
In the first place, the time they were occupied in coasting along the
shore would have enabled them to get bf^yond the mouth of the Missis-
sippi. From the time they embarked at the Biy of Caballos until
Vaca's boat was cast upon the island of Malhado, forty-five days
elapsed, exclusive of stoppages. They were seven days passing through
the shoals after they had embarked, and the other thirty-eight were
occupied in rowing toward the West along the co;ist of the gulf. That
they did not follow all the windings and indentations of the coast is
very (evident, for Vaca says they only now and then entered the coves.
42 THE CONQUEST OF 'NEW MEXICO.
f—
After the men had eaten and rested awhile, Vaca or*
dered Lope de Ovieda, who was stouter than the rest, to
ascend a tree near by and take a survey of the country.
Upon his return he reported that they were upon an
island and the country had tlie apj)earance of having been
trodden up by cattle, from which he inferred that it was'
inhabited by Christians. He was now directed to make
After rowing thirty-four days they passed the mouth of a great river,
tbe current of wliich was so strong that it drove the boats out to sea in
spite of all they could do ; and four days afterward the boats were
separated in a storm, and that of Vaca wrecked. The Mississippi is
the only river that empties into the gulf of Mexico with a current as
strong as the one here described. The mouth of the river was encoun-
tered four days before Vaca's boat was wrecked; and Mr. Smith
locates the island of Malhado between the Choctawhatchee river and
Pensacola Bay, but there is 310 river, with a strength of cuirent equal
to the one the Spaniards encountered, emptying into the gulf at a
point lour days east of the islands off Pensacola Bay. There is an-
other rea£on in favor of the conclusion to which I have arrived as to
the place of Vaca^s shipwreck. After he and his companions atarted
inland in their wanderings through the country, they Inet with no river
the size of the Mississippi, and it is not likely a stream which the Indi-
ans called the " Father of Waters " would have passed unnoticed in
the journal. The deepest river Vaca mentions only reached up to the
waist, and that stream was encountered when pretty far out upon the
plains. If they had come to the Mississippi while traveling on land
it would have impeded their march unless they could have obtained
canoes of the Indians to cross it.
The circumstantial evidence already given seems sufficient to fix the
shipwreck of Vaca at a point West of the Jklississippi, in the absence
of other testimony. But in addition to this we have direct evidence
upon the subject. Castafieda, in his narrative of the expedition of Co-
ronado, says the Spaniards passed the mouth of the Mississippi, which
they discovered, on the last day of October, about which time they
encountered the furious storm which separated the boats and drove that
of Narvaez out to sea. According to the same chronicler, six days
after passing the mouth of the river Vaca's boat was cast upon the
shore, which would have allowed tbem sufficient time to make some of
Ihe low sandj islands that skirt the coast of X/Ouisiana.
• ^ ji.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 43
^ further reconnoissance of the island without goino: far
from camp, for fear of a surprise by the Indians. He set
out, but being absent a considerable time Vaca dispatched
two men in search of him, who met him near the camp
on his return, followed by three Indians armed with bows
and arrows. lie had penetrated about half a league into
the wood, when he came to some deserted huts, from
which he took a small dog, an earthen pot and a few
mullets. The Indians followed a little distance in his
rear until they arrived near the camp, when they sBated
themselves upon a bank, where they were joined in half
an hour by fifty more armed warriors. The savages were
peaceably disposed ; but had they been hostile resistance
had been useless, for there were not six Spaniards able
to raise themselves from the ground. The Indians were
persuaded to approach, when a few presents of beads and
hawk-bills were given to each warrior, who in return gave
Vaca an arrow, esteemed by them a pledge of friendship.
The Spaniards explained, as well as they were able, their
unfortunate condition and commended themselves to their
mercy. The appeal seemed to touch a chord of sympathy
in the hearts of the savages, who gave them to under-
stand, when they went away, that they would return in
the morning with something for them to eat, as tliey had
nothing at that time to give them. They came back the
next day as they had promised, bringing with them a
large quantity of fish and certain roots which they gath-
ered from under the water, which tliey of&red to Vaca
^nd his men.
44 • THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER V,
PITIABLE CONDITION OF VACA AND HIS MEN, AND WHAT
BEFEL TIIEM.
The Spaniards remained on tins island several days to
recruit their strength and to make preparations to con-
tinue their voyage. The Indians treated them with
great kindness, supplying them with fish and roots, and
(loin^ many other things to increase their comfort. Hav-
ing now become well-rested and supplied with an abund-
ance of food and water, Yaca determined to re-embark.
Their boat was buried in the sand, but it was digged out
and launched with much difiiculty. To accomplish this
they were obliged to work in the cold water a long time
without clothing. The boat once more afloat they put
in their provisions and went on board. But they had
only fairly embarked when a fierce wave struck it, knocked
the oars from the hands of the rowers and capsized her.
The assessor and one man were drowned, while the others
were cast upon the shore, naked, having lost all their
clothing, provisions and everything else the boat con-
tained.
The condition of. the poor Spaniards was now more
pitiable than ever. They found themselves a second timo
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 45
Tipon an inhospitable and savage coast, entirely at the
mercy of the Indians. The time of yeai' was November ;
the cold was intense, with a shai^p wind that seemed to
go to the very marrow of their bones. They had neither
clothing, tents or anythin^ij else to shelter them from the
inclemency of the weather. Since the montli of May
A'aca himself had eaten nothing but corn ; and the whole
jmrty had become so much emaciated from past suffer-
ings that they had the appearance of skeletons; Tlieir
hearts trailed in the dust at the dreary prospect before
them, and naught else than the indomitable spirit of
Spanish chivalr}'^ gave them resolution to struggle against
their fate. They were thrown upon the shore where
they had previously been encamped and fortunately found
alive a few embers of the fire tliey had left in the morn-
ing. They kindled anew the expiring coals, around which
they gathered and warmed their chilled bodies.
The Indians did not know that the Spaniards had re-
embarked in the morning and been cast ashore a^ain,
and when they returned to the camp toward evening with
the usual supply of food they were so much surprised and
shocked at their desolate appearance that they turned
and fled from fear. Vaca called to them and induced
them to return. They came and sat down with him and
his men, when he related to them as well as he could,
without the aid of an interpreter, the new misfortune
that had overtaken them, and how two of their number
had been drowned. This relation, wi-th their -svretched
appearance, sensibly affected the Indians, who manifested
their grief by uttering loud lamentations for more than half
an liour. Fearing they might perish in their exposed and
destitute condition they besought the savages to take
them to their huts and give them shelter, which thev
J
46 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
consented to do. As their huts were some distance inland
from the scene of the shipwreck, a party of thirty Indiana
was immediately dispatched to make preparations for the
reception of the Spaniards, each one carrying an arm-load
of wood. Toward evening the remainder of them took
the weary Christians in their arms and carried them to
their village. Those who had been sent in advance had
arrived some time before and had already kindled large
tires. They carried their guests from one fire to another,
resting at each one long enough for them to warm
themselves; when they were taken to -a hut which had
been prepared for their reception and in which a lai'ge
fire was blazing. Here they took up their quarters, and
at night they laid themselves down to sleep in greater
comfort than they had known for many months. When
their arrival was known through the village the Indians
held great rejoicings at their rescue, which consisted
principally in yelling and dancing, and which was kept
up all night. Hearing such an uproar among the savages
without knowing the cause, the Spaniards were in great
fear and expected every moment to be oftered up victims
to some heathen rite. They passed the night in safety,
however, and the next morning the Indians assured them
of their friendly feeling by presenting them roots and fish
to eat, and otherwise treating them with great kindness.
The Indians informed the Spaniards there were other
white men in that vicinity, whereupon Vaca, who had no
doubt they were some of his wrecked companions, sent
out two men in search of them. They had not. proceeded
far, however, when they met 9 party of their countrymen
coming toward the village, when they turned back and
accompanied them in. The new-comers were Andres
Dorantes and Civstillo with their boat's crew. Their boat
J. .-^
TilE CONQUEST GF N£W MEXICO^ 47
tad been capsized on the fifth day of the month about a
league and a half from that place, but the crew escaped
to the shore without losing anything. The meeting ot*
these unfortunate wanderers was both sad and pleasant —
sad that they should encountei' each other under such
painful cil-cumstances, and yet not unattended with pleas-
urable emotions, for they were again united in their
misfortunes and could help each other to bear up under
them. The congratulations of «ieeting having passed
they consulted together as to the means of making their
escape. They agreed to refit the boat of Dorantes and
Castillo, and those who were able were to go to sea in
her, while the others were* to remain until they should
have sufficiently recovered their strength to make their
Way along the coast in search of some Christian land.
They took immediate measures to carry out their de-
termination and continue the voyage. The boat was
launched after much exertion, but she was hardly afloat
again when she sunk, and thus an end was put to their
hopes of escape by water. They looked on with mourn-
ful interest as the boat filled and went down before their
eyes; and when the gulf had calmly closed over her
and they saw themselves deprived of the last means of
rescue, they turned from the shore and retraced their
steps to the Indian village with heavy hearts. Since
they were last wrecked ono of their number, a cavalier
named Tavera, had died, and the survivors were in a
verv enfeebled condition..
The fortunes of our wanderers seemed to become darker
and darker with each turn of affairs, but hope still told
"a flattering tale" and bade them be of good cheer.
Escape by sea being now hopeless they determined to use
every exertion to eficct it by land. Finding themselvea
i
9S THE CONQUEST QF NEW MEXICO.
not in a condition to continue their journey westward,
iind the weatiier being exceedingly boisterous and cold,
they yielded to a necessity they could not avoid and con-
cluded to remain and spend the winter where they tlien
were. It was agreed that four men, the most robust of
the part}' and excellent swimmers, should be sent forward
in search of the Spanish settlement at the Panuco, which
was believed to be very near, to give information of those
who remained upon the* island, and, if possible, to obtain
i\ssistanco for them. Those who were sent . upon this
expedition were Alvaro Fernandez, a Portugwese carpen-
ter and sailor, Alendez, Figueron, a native of Toledo, and
Astudillo, a native of Zaire, who took with them an
Indian of the island as gnide. These strong-hearted
pioneers made a few necessary preparations, when bidding
tare well to their companions they started upon their haz-
ardous iournev.
Within a few days the weather increased in cold and
became very tempestuous. The Indians were now unable
to catch fisli or gather roots, and food of all kinds became
tio scarce that starvation began to stare them in the face.
The huts afforded so little protection from the inclemency
of the weather tliat the Spaniards suflered much from the
intense cold and began to sicken and die. Five of the
men upon the coast were reduced to such extremity that
thev were obli^xed to cat the dead bodies of their com-
])anion8 to preserve life. Death made such havoc among
them that in a short time out of eighty, the whole number
who had arrived in the two boats, but fifteen remained
alive, and tliev were reduced to mere skeletons. To
increase their misery, about this time the Indij^ns were
visited by a fatal sickness that carried ofi* half their
auimber ^md the Spaniai'ds were accused of being the
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 49
cause of it. This belief made the savages hostile and they
formed a plan to murder them in revenge. But they were
prevented from carrying the plot into execution by one
of their own number persuading them the Spaniards were
not the cause of the sickness, and as evidence of which he
reminded them ithat nearly all the strangers had died of
the same disease. The Indians also entertained ill-feeling
toward them because they had eaten their dead, a prac-
tice which greatly shocked them, savages though they
were.
4
I
50 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO'*
CHAPTER VI.
THE ISLAND OP MAIJIADO, WITH SOilE ACCOUNT OF Tll£
INHABITANTS.
The island upon which the Spaniards were wrecked,
and which was tlie scene of so many disasters to them,
they gave the name of Malhado, or Misfortune, of whicli
the following account is given by Vaca, with the manners
and customs of the people. lie says :
" To this island we gave the name of Malliado. Tlie
people there are large and well-formed ; they liave no.
other arms than bows and arrows, and in the use of them
they are extremely skillfuL The men have one of their
nipples bored from side to side, and some have both ;
and through the holes they wear a cane the length of two
palms and a half and the thickness of two fingers. They
have the under hp also bored, and wear in it a piece of
cane the thinness of half a finger. The women are ac-
customed to hard labor. The stay the Indians make on
this island is from October to the end of February. Their
subsistence is the root which I have spoken of, got from
under the water in November and December. They
have wears, but take fish only in tliis time, and afterward
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 51
they live on the roots. At the end of February they go
into other parts to seek sustenance, for then the roots
begin to grow and are not good. They love their off-
spring the most of any people in the world, and treat
them with the greatest mildness. When it occurs that a
son dies, the parents and kindred weep for him, and io
does every one ; and the wailing continues a whole year.
They begin it in the morning of every day before sun-
rise, the parents first and after them the whole town.
They do the same at midday and at sunset. After a yeai'
of mourning has passed away they perfonn the rites of
the dead, and they wash and purify themselves from tlie
stain of smoke. They lament all the defunct in this
manner, excepting the aged, for whom they show no
regret, as they say their season lias passed and there is
no enjoyment for them, and tliat living they would occupy
the earth and take the support of the young. It is their
custom to bury the dead, unless it be those among them
who are physicians, and those they bum. While the fire
Idndles they are all dancing and making liigh festivity
until the bones become calcined. After the lapse of a
year the funeral rites are celebrated and all take part in
them. The dust is then presented in water for the rela-
tives to drink.
" Every man has an acknowledged wife. The physi-
cians are allowed more freedom ; they may have two or
three wives, among whom exist the greatest friendship
and harmony. When a daughter is to be married, from
that time to the marriage all that he who takes her to wife
kills in hunting, or catches in fishing, the woman brings
to the house of her father, without daring to take or taste
any part of it, but victuals are taken thence to the groom.
In all this interval neither her father nor mother cntei's
52 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXKX).
liis house, nor can he enter their's, nor the house of the
children ; and if by chance they are in the direction of
meeting they turn aside and pass the distance of a cross-
bow shot from each other, carrying the head low the
while and the eyes cast on the ground ; for they hold it
an impropriety to see or to speak to each other. But the
woman has liberty to converse and communicate with
the parents of her future husband. The custom exists
from this island to the distance of more tlian fifty leagues
inland, i
" There is another custom, which is, when a son or
brother dies, at the house where the death takes place,
for three months they do not go after food, but sooner
famish, and their relatives and neighbors provide what
they eat. As in the time we were here a great number
of the natives died, in most houses there was very great
hunger, because of the observance of tlieir ceremonial ;
and although they who sought after food worked hard,
yet from the severity of the season they obtained but
little ; in consequence, the Indians who kept me left the
island and passed over in canoes to the main into some
bays where there were many oysters.
" For three months in the year they cat nothing else
than these and drink very bad water. There is great
want of wood, and mosquitoes are in great numbers.
The houses are of mats, set up on masses of oyster-shells,
which they sleep upon, and in skins should they accidently
possess them. In this way we lived until the month of
April, when we went to the sea-shore, where we ate
1 A similar custom to the one here described, in regard to the cere-
mony observed daring the time of betrothel, still exists among the
Miembres band of the Apache tribe, and the Nabsjo Indians of New
Mexico.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 53
blackberries all the month, dnrfng which time the Indians
did no't omit to practice their rites and festivities."!
The physicians among the people of Malhado prac-
ticed the healing art in a manner peculiar to them-
selves. Wlien one of them was called to attend upon
a sick person, it was the custom to blow upon the seat
of disease, which was believed to have a magical effect
in the way of curing .the ills whiaii flesh is heir to.
They also scarified over the pain, made cauteries vrith
fire, and sucked the wounded parts. Tliey professed
to cast out all infirmities by merely blowing upon the
patient and the laying on of hands. Cantering with fire
was held in the greatest repute. It was the custom of
these Indians, after having been cured of disease, to give
the physician all their goods and then to seek among their
relatives for more to give him. The Spaniards had not
been a great while upon the island, when the Indians
wished to make physicians of them, and, as Vaca relates
in his journal, without subjecting tliem to the ordeal of
an examination or asking for a diploma. But they de-
sired all knowledge of the healing art and declined to
assume the responsibilities of the profession. Tlie Indi-
ans seemed determined to have their wishes gratified in'
this particular, and used persuasive means so long as there
was any hope of their having the desired effect. But
when this course failed to induce the Christians to alter
their minds, the savages applied a more potent argument,
which consisted in the stoppage of tlieir rations. This
last appeal moved the resolution of the stubborn cavaliers,
who seeing there was no other course left than to comply
with the wishes of the Indians, consented to enter the
profession in competition with their red brethren, and
1 An extract frgn\ Vaca's Journal.
(>4 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
without ceremony began to practice. By way of encour-
agement, one of the Indians told them that he could
remove pain from the stomach by merely passing a heated
stone over it, but inasmuch as they were very extraordi-
nary men they would be able to accomplish a great deal
more.
The mode of practice adopted by the Spaniards was at
once simple and harmless, and if the patient received no
relief from the treatment he was sure to come out of the
doctor's hands without injury. When called upon to
administer to those who stood in need of their services it
was their common custom "to bless the sick, breathe
upon them, and recite a Paternoster and Ave Maria,
praying with all earnestness to God our Lord that he
would give^them health and influence us to do them some
good." This system of practice seems to have acted like
a charm, and it is related that in every instance after the
sign of tlie cross had been made over the patient he im-
mediately recovered. The Christians now received much
better treatment than before and at once grew into favor
and importance. In many instances the Indians even
denied themselves food to supply them and they made
them presents of skins and many other articles. At one
period there was great scarcity of provisions, and Vaca
mentions that he went three days without tasting any kind
of food.
The Spaniards who came to the island with Dorantes
and Castillo, as well as those belonging to the boat of
A'aca, with the exception of liimself, lived some time ^vith
auotlier tribe of Indians of a different tongue and ances-
try, who dwelt upon the opposite shore of the main-land
where oysters abounded, but they retxu'ned to Malliado
about the first of ApriL
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 65
The inhabitants of all this region went naked, with tlie
exception of the women and young damsels, who covered
a portion of tlie person ; the former with the moss that
grew upon the trees and the latter with deer-skins. They
were of two distinct tribes and spoke diflTerent languages ;
one being Capoques and the other Han, and the members
of each tribe lived by themselves. They had no chief
and appeared to be without politicalorganization. They
were generous toward each other. Of their custom when
visiting Vaca speaks as follows : " They have a custom
when they meet, or from time to time when they visit, of
remaining half an hour before they speak, weeping ; aad
this over he. that is visited first rises and gives the other
{ill he has, which is received, and after a little while he
<?arries it away with him and often without saying a
•word."
56 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO^
CHAPTER VII
1>0RANTES AND CASTILLO ATTEMPT TO ESCAPE, AND WHAT
HAPPENED TO VACA.
When Dorantes and Castillo returned to the island of
Malhado upon the opening of spring they assembled all
the Spaniards they found alive, who numbered fourteen.
They had suffered much during the winter from the hard-^
ships they were obliged to endure, and were emaciated
and enfeebled. At this time Vaca was still upon the shore
of the bay where he had wintered with the Indians who
lield him captive, and was much prostrated by disease.
Hearing of his condition his companions in misfortune
gave an Indian the cloak of marten-skins before men-
tioned to pass them over to the main-land to visit him.
All were crossed over the strait in safety but Hieronymo
de Alaniz and Lope de Ovieda, who being too feeble for
the trip were left upon the island. They found Vaca
still too sick to accompany them in an attempt to escape,
and they determined to proceed without him. They
were joined by one of his men, which increased their
number to thirteen. They started along the coast toward
the West, leaving Vaca in the care of the Indians-
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. . 57
The condition of Vaca at this time was more deplorable
than at any fonner perioct and misfortunes seemed to
thicken aroand him from day to day. He fomid himself
prostrated by disease, in the hands of the savages, and
deserted by his companions with whom he had toiled and
snffered so much. latheir desire to escape they had left
him to his fate, and now there seemed for him no hope
of deliverance. As he bade them farewell, and saw their
forms disappear toward the setting smi, liis heart sunk
within him and he almost gave himself up to despair.
After he had recovered from liis sickness he remained
a prisoner among these Indians for a year, and endured
many hardships. They made him an abject slave, and
compelled him to endure every kind of severe labor and
submit to the harshest treatment. Among other duties
that devolved upon him was digging roots from under
the water and among the canes. This occif{)atioii tore
his fingers and the broken canes lacerated liis body. His
life became such a burden that he determined to make his
escape and join a tribe called Charruco, which inhabited
the forests and country of the main-land. He succeeded
in reaching these latter Indians, where his condition was
changed for the better.
Vaca remained with these people nearly six years, from
the summer of 1528 to sometime in the year 1533. In
all this time he went without clothing and conformed in
every respect to the maimers and customs of the Indians.
He followed the occupation of a pedlar, or trader, which
enabled him to obtain plenty of food and command good
treatment. In his trading excursions he was allowed to
travel some forty or fifty leagues along the coast and as
far into the interior as he pleased. He traveled from
tribe to tribe at pleasure, which was a great convenience
58 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
to the Indians, as tliey could not carry on their traflSc in
time of war. He principally carried into the interior sea-
snails and their cones, conchos, and a fruit like a bean,
used for medicine, sea-beads, and other articles ; and in
return brought back skins, ochre with which they colored
their faces, flints for arrow lieads^ cement, canes for ar-
rows, and tassels made of deer-skins, ornamented and
dyed red. He was treated with kindness wherever he
went, and the Indians gave him food in exchange for his
wares. In the course of time he became a pereon of such
great importance in all the surrounding country that his
acquaintance was sought for the reputation he enjoyed.
In imitation of the Indian custom he ceased from his
labors during the winter months, and retired with them
to then* huts and villages and led an inactive life. His
leading object in traveling back and forth through the
country was to become well acquainted with it find the
people, so that in case he should attempt to escape the
knowledge would be of advantage to him.
It will be borne in mind that when Dorantes and Cas-
tillo made their escape from the island of Malhado they
left two Spaniai'ds behind, sick, Ovieda and Alaniz, the
latter of whom died soon after, tlie former getting well
tmd remaining upon the island. The reason Vaca re-
mained so long among the Charrncos, was to enable
Ovieda to make his escape, and for this purpose he made
him a visit every year to persuade him to cross over to
the main-land. At each annual visit Ovieda promised
him that he would certainly accompany him the next
year, but when the time arrived his resolution failed him.
At last, after much persuasion, he induced liim to leave
the island, and as he was not able to swim Vaca crossed
him over in a canoe.
ta^^^MA^^^ri^BlA;^
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 59
Having reached the main in safety, after some slight
l)reparation8 they started on their escape, following tlie
coast toward the West. They traveled in company with
some Indians mitil they had crossed fonr large rivers,
wlien they came to a deep bay a league in width, which
was supposed to be the bay of Espiritu Santo. Having
crossed the bay in satety they resumed tlieir journey and
in a short time met with some Indians of the Quevenes
nation. This people told the Spaniards there were three
Christians some distance bevond, the survivors of a con-
siderable number, the others having either died of hunger
or cold, or been killed ; that the tribe which held them
treated them with cruelty. They represented the coun-
trj" as very poor, with few inhabitants, who sufiercd
much from the cold. Tliey said that those who held the
three Christians would soon come to eat walnuts upon
the margin of that river, within a league of where they
then were, when they would have an opportunity of see-
ing them. In confirmation of the bad treatment the
other Christians received, these savages slapped and beat
A'aca and liis companion ; and put their arrows to their
liearts, saying they were inclined to kill them as they had
killed their friends. Ovieda became alarmed at these
hostile demonstrations and desired to return with the
women w-ho had crossed tlie bay with them. Vaca used
every persuasion hef was master of to induce him to con-
tinue on with him, but it was of no avail ; he returned
witli the women and was never heard of afterward.
Vaca again found himself alone with the Indians, but
he determined to persevere in his effort to escape. Two
days afterward he was informed that those who held liis
countrymen prisoners had come to the place designated
to eat walnuts. He was directed to go to a point of wood
60 THE CONQUEST OF NEW BLEXICO.
which the Indians he was then with must pass on a visit
to the strangers the next day, when they would take him
along with them. He awaited their coming at the place
of rendezvous, and accompanied them to the camp of the
walnut-eating Indians. When they had approached
within a short distance, Andres Dorantes, who had been
told that a white man w^as coming, came out to meet
Vaca. The meeting was a happy one, as each had thought
the other dead, and they mutually returned thanks to
God for having preserved their lives through so many
vicissitudes. In a short time ho had the pleasure of
saluting the other captives, Castillo, and Est«vanico, a
Barbary negro, at whose safety he was also much rejoiced.
The three Spaniards immediately counseled with each
other upon a plan of escape. Vaca told Dorantes that
he had long entertained the intention of escaping to some
Christian land, and s1;ill intended to do so, if possible.
The latter had heretofore advised Castillo and the negro
to the 6am6 course, but they had declined making the
attempt because of their inability to swim the nimierous
bays and rivers which intersected the country. But now
tliey concluded to escape together. They made their
:irrangemcnt8 with great secrecy, to prevent their inten-
tion becoming known to the Indians, who would have
killed tl>em to prevent their escape. In order to allay
all suspicion it was deemed advisable to postpone the
attempt for the space of six months, when the Indiansi,
as was their custom, would migrate to another part of the
country to eat prickly-pears. Here they would meet
other savages who would come there to trade and exchange
bows, with whom they could return if they should succeed
in eluding the vigilance of their masters. Tliis plan of
operations being agreed upon, they awaited witli deep
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICa CI
anxiety the arrival of the time when they lioped to be
able to strike an effectual blow for their deliverance from
bondage.
Vaca and Dorantes were given as slaves to the same
Indian who, as well as aU his family, was blind of one
eye. Their master bflonged to the tribe called Marianes,
while Castillo was living with the Yeguases who dwelt
in their vicinity.
62 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICa
CHAPTER VIII,
THE FATE OF NARV.Az, AND THE WHEREADOLTS OF THE
SUKVrV'ORS.
DoRANTES and companions related to Vaca what had
befallen them since they had left the island of Malhado,
and also what had happened to others of tlie Spaniards.
It will be remembered, that when they parted from
Vaca on tlie shore of the main-land opposite the island,
they took their course along the coast toward the West.
They had not proceeded far when they found tlie boat in
whicli the friar and controller had been wrecked. Thev
passed the months of four great rivers whose currents
were so strong that their boats were swept away and car-
ried out to sea, and four of their number drowned.i In
the distance of sixty leagues they lost two more of their
companions, when they arrived at a large bay. By this
time they were in a starving condition, having eaten
notliing since their departure but crabs and rock-weed.
Ilqre they saw Indians eating mulberries, who fled to the
1 From this it would appear that they were in boats, although the
journal of Vaca is silent as to what boats thej were or how thej ob-
tained them.
.i^,„a^aliiimiiigi^
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 65
opposite side of the cape npon their approach. While
they were contriving some means of crossing the bay an
Indian and a Spaniard approached them, the latter feeing
recognized as one of the party who had been sent forward
from the island of Malhado in search of the Pamico, of
the name of Figueroa. He related that two of his com-
panions had died from cold and hunger, and the third
been killed, while he was a Cciptive among the Quevenes.
Here he met with Hernando de Esquivel, a survivor of
the commissary's boat, who was a prisoner to the Slari-
anes, and from whom Vaca learned the fate of the gov-
ernor and the remainder of the Sjianiards not before
accounted for.
When the boat of Narvaez became separated from the
others, as before related, he continued to coast along the
shore toward the West. He came up with the crew of
the controller's boat, which had been upset at the con-
fluence of the rivers, and carried them across to the main-
land. The latter continued their course by land, while
the governor held on by water. Soon they came to ;i
large bay across which he conveyed the crew of the con-
troller's boat. Here they stopped for the night, tlic
whole party encamping upon the shore, with the exception
of Narvaez and a page who remained in liis boat. It was
anchored with a stone and was thought to be secure : but
in the night a heavy North wind began to blow which
drove them out to sea, and they were never lieard of
afterward. The survivors continued along the shore on
foot, making rafts upon which they crossed the rivers and
bays they encountered in their course. Being now the
month of Novembe;r and cold weather about to set in,
they deemed it advisable to select a suitable place for win-
ter-quarters* They fixed upon a piece of timber on the
J
64 THE CONQimST OP NEW MEXICO.
bank of a river, wood and water being both convenient,
and crabs and shell-fisli near at hand. Here they pitched
B. rude camp and prepared to spend the winter. They
began to sicken and die soon after they encamped, and
by the Ist of March but one of their number was alive.
Their supply of food failed them, and they suffered to the
last extremity from hunger and cold ; and they were so
near starvation that the living were obliged to dry and
eat the desh of the dead to sustain life. To add to their
other troubles a quarrel took place between Soto Mayor
and Pantoja, the lieutenant, which resulted in the death
of the latter. The last survivor was Esquivel, who main-
tained hfe upon the dead body of a companion until he
was taken by a party of Indians, with whom he remained
sometime, when he met with Figueroa as before related.
Of the four hundred men who had sailed from Spain
for the conquest of Florida but few remained aUve and
they were captives in the hands of the Indians. Figueroa
and one other Spaniard soon aferward succeeded in mak-
ing their escape, while Vaca, Dorantes, Castillo, Este-
vanico and two others remained and prevailed upon the
Quevenes to accept them as slaves. In tlie service of
this tribe they were very badly treated, and the Indians,
among other things, amused themselves in pulling out
their beard. They killed three out of the six without
any cause. Dorantes, fearing he would meet the same
fate, made his escape to the Marianes, among whom
Esquivel had been a prisoner. These people informed
5imi how they had put the latter to death, because he tried
to run away on account of a woman dreaming tliat* her
son would kill him, and in confirmation showed him ar-
ticles that had belonged to Esquivel.
These Indians took life according to custom and not
• THE'CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 65
;that tliey were blood-thirsty by nature, and they cast
.away their children because of dreams. They had a
custom of destroying their daughters at birth, and also
l)ermitting the dogs to devour them, fearing their enemies
might raise up children from them and thus become strong
enough to enslave tliem. It is said they even preferred
to destroy them to marrying them among their own peo-
^ple. The only two tribes who practiced this custom were
the Marianes and the Yeguases, The men bought their
wives of their enemies, and the price paid was a bow and
two arrows, or a net a. fathom in length and another in
breadth. The married state continued during the will of
the parties. They also killed their male children and
bought others of strangers.
Castillo and Estevanico made, their escape inland to the
tribe of the Yeguases. These people were of fine sym-
metry and good archers, and had the custom of boring
the nose and one nipple. They lived on roots, spiders,
the eggs of ants, lizards, snakes, and other reptiles and
insects. They kiUed a few deer and caught some fish,
the bones of which they reduced to a powder and ate for
food. Provisions were scarce and they suflered gi'eatly
from hunger. They obliged the old nien and old women,
who were little esteemed among them, to carry all the
burdens; the women did nearly all the hard work and
were only allowed six hours rest in twenty-four. The
roots were baked in ovens, and it was the dntv of the
Avomen to heat them, which occupied part of each night.;
•
8 1 am informed by a geatleman, long a resident of Texas, that the
* Indians upon the Trinity river lire upon roots much in the same man •
ner as those spoken ot by Vaca. They dig them from under the water,
. and prepare them for food hf drying them in the sun, after which they
. are reduced to powder and made into cakes.
5
66 THE CONQUEST OF 5JEW MEXICO.
They began to dig the roote, bring wood and water, and
to do other necessary hibor at sunrise. Tliey also roasted
the roots, which required two days. These Indians were
generally great liars »vnd thieves. They made a kind of
liquor upon which they became intoxicated.
They were fleet runners and could run down a deer,
in which manner they frequently caught them. Their
lodges were made of mats placed upon hoops, and they
often changed tlieir locality when in searcli of food.
They planted nothing. They were a cheerful and merry
people, and even amid the season of greatest hunger they
did not fail to observe their festi\4ties and ceremonies.
Their happiest time was while gathering the prickly-pear^
when tlieir lumger being satisfied for a time, they feasted
and danced day and night. They prepared the pear for
food by squeezing it open and drying it in the sun, and
the skin they beat into a powder.a The country swarmed
with mosquitoes, whose bite was poisonous. These in-
sects were a source of great annoyance to the Spaniards,
and in order to protect tliemselves from them they were
in the liabit of encircling their sleeping placo with a fire
kindled with rotten wood so Jis to make a dense smoke
without much flame. In the winter the Indians rid
themselves of the mosquitoes by firing the plains and
forests, which at the same time drove away lizards, snakes
and other reptiles. They killed deer by surroimding
them witli fire, and they burned the pasturage of the buf-
falo in order to oblige them to seek fresh gnizing in more;
3 The prickly-pear is tbc fruit of a species of the Maguey or the
Af/ave Americana^ and is found more or less abundant in most parts
of New 31exico and Texas, and particularly upon the extensive plains
that traverse these countries. It is not unpleasant to the taste, and the
juice is quite refreshing in time of thirst.
THE CX)yQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 67
convenient localities. They always pitched their camp
close to wood and water; and when they went out to
hunt deer they were obliged to carr}' with them a supply
of these two necessary articles, as they did not abound in
the haunts of this animal. They made hunting excursions
two or three times a vear, and thus, at intervals, were
able to appease their pressing hunger ; but at other times
they suffered a good deal for food. . While out hunting
they were very much annoyed by mosquitoes, which Vaca
says were equal to the "holy plagues of Lazarus."
In speaking of the cattle the Sj)aniards encountered in
their wanderings through the country, Vaca gives tlie
following account : " Cattle come as far as this. I have
seen them three times and eaten of their meat. I tliink
they are about the size of those of Spain. They have
small horns like those of Morocco, and the hair long and
flocky like that of the merino. Some are light brown
(pardillas) and others black. To my judgment the flesh
is finer and sweeter than that of this country. The In-
dians make blankets of those that are not full grown, and
of the larger they make shoes and bucklers. They come
as far as the sea-coast of Florida, and in a direction from
the North, and range over a district of more than four
hundred leagues. In the whole extent of plain over
which they roam, the people who live bordering upon it
descend and kill them for food, and thus a great many
skins are scattered throuficliout the countrv."*
4 The cattle here mentioned were buffaloes, which roamed over all
the great central region of North America ; and tbeir tracks have been
seen as far South and South-east as the Withlacooche river, ^his fact
IB mentioned by Romans. This is the earliest mention of the butfalo
by any writer.
68 THE ^CONQUEST OF l^TEW MEXICa
CHAPTER IX^
»UOW VACA AND HIS COMPANIONS ESCAPE I'llOM THE INDIANS-
The period of six months, during which the Spaniards
had agreed among themselves to remain with the Indians
before attempting to escape, had now elapsed, and the
time approached to put their plans into execution. Their
masters, as was customary, went to a place aboitt
twenty leagues distant to gather pears ; and the Christians
having made the necessary preparations were on the
point of making their escape, when a circumstance
occurred which prevented them for tlie present. The
Indians quarreled among 'themselves about a woman and
fell to beating and kicking each other with great severity ;
and finally their hostility ran so high that each one took
his lodge and wont into some other part of the country,
which separated the Spaniards and thus put an end to
their hopes for a time.
Thi3 course of* events obliged the captives to remain
with the Indians another year. Vaca relates tliat he spent
a very hard life ; was often beaten and otherwise abused
by those who held him ; to escape this cruel treatment
he ran away three times, but upon each occasion he was
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO*. 69
pursued and brought back. The next year the different
bands of Indians with whom the Spaniards lived met at
the usual place of resort, to eat prickly-pears. Again
they had completed their arrangements to escape, when
the savages suddenly separated and returned to their re-
spective homes, thus a second time thwarting their plans.
Vaca now determined to make his escape at all hazards,
and before he separated from his companions he advised
them of his intention. He told tliem he would remain
with the Indians until the moon was full, when, if they
did not join him, he would escape alone. At the time
specified, being the 13th of September, he was joined by
-iVndres Dorantes and Estevanico, who had encountered
nimierous obstacles in meeting him at the tune agreed
upon. CastUlo was not able to join them at that time, as
he could not elude his captors. But in a few days he made
liis escape and came to the place where his companions.
tlien were. They had joined another tribe, meanwhile,
witli whom the Indians, who had previously held him, had
made peace. Vaca learned, from this people, of another-
tribe who lived upon tlie coast, named Camones, who
were said to have killed Pefialosa and Tellez, whose fate
they were ignorant of. To satisfy them such was tha
case, the Indians showed him some of the arras and
clothing that had belonged to tliem.
The survivors of this unfortunate expeditiofi, foiir in
number, now found themselves united, preparatory to at-
tempting their escape — their comrades either having met
a watery grave, been killed by the savages, or died of
disease and starvation. The Indians now changed
their camp and moved to another part of the country..
The Spaniards remained with them one day afterward,
when they eluded their vigilance and took to flight, trust-
70 TUE COKQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
ing to God to guide and direct theni.i It was late in tlie
season and the prickly-pears had nearly disappeared, but
they lioped, with the few that remained and the mast to
be found in the wood, they would be able to subsist while
they traveled over a large district of country. They
hurried on with speed all day fearing lest the Indians
should pursue and recapture them. Toward evening
they saw smoke in the distance, and espied an Indian who
turned and fled. The negro was sent in pursuit, when
he halted until he was overtaken. On being told the
Christians were in search of the people who made the
smoke, he said his village was near by and conducted
tlicm to it. They were received with great kindness and
were lodged in the houses of two physicians. This tribe
was called Avavares, and altliough they spoke a different
language the Spaniards were able to converse with tliem
in the tongue of tlie Marianes. They used to trade with
tlieir former masters, and among other things supplied
.them with bones. Thev had arrived witli their lodo^es
that day, and iis soon as they were informed of the pres-
ence of the Spaniards, and the cures they could effect,
they brought them a great many pears.
4 It is a task of no slight difficulty to trace the route of Vaca and his
companions across the continent from the meagre, and often unreliable,
data we have at hand. The history of the Southern portion of the
United States is the least reliable of any part of the Union ; and for
many years little, if any, addition that throws light upon the earliest
explorations, has been made to it. There is no doubt that Vaca passed
through a portion of New Mexico in his route, though it is impossible
to say how far North he came. Formerly the Southern boundary gf
New Mexico was much further South than at this time, nearly as low
down as the mouth of the Conchos, which empties into the Kio del
Norte. In making up the notes, in reference to Vaca's wanderings,
I am much indebted to the copious notes accompanying Mr. Bucking-
ham Smith's translation of his Journal.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 71
During the night some Indians went to Castillo and
told him they had a pain in the head and requested him
to cure it. He made over them a sign of the cross and
commended them to God, wlien they said they were
well. The Indians furnished them with the best food
the country afforded, and among other things brouglit
them a piece of venison. When it became known
through the village how they could cure the sick, a large
immber flocked to them, each one carrying a piece of
venison as a fee. The Spaniards deemed it advisable to
resume their practice, and all to whom they administered
immediately recovered ; in commemmoration of wliich the
Indians held feastings and rejoicings for three days. T^hey
made inquudes about the country beyond, and the means
of living it afforded ; and upon learning that it was unin-
habited, and that there were few pears at that season of
the year, they resolved to Epend the winter with this
tribe.
In a few days they accompanied the Indians in search
of pears to a place where they expected to meet several
tribes speaking different languages. In a journey of five
. days they arrived at a river, without having seen any
pears on the way, on the bank of which they put up their
lodges, and went in search of a fruit that resembled a pea.
In wandering about the wood Vaca became separated
from his companions and was lost for five days. Ho was
entirely naked, and as the weather was cold he suffered a
great deal. He passed the first night in the warmth of a
burning tree, and the remaining nights he spent in the
low bottoms near the streams. As there were no sticks^
in many parts of the wood, he earned a load always on
hia^back, to kindle a fire when necessary. He dug a hole
in the ground aroimd which lue built four fires in the form
72 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICJO.
of a cross, and then crept into the hole and covered him-
self with grass. One night the grass caught on fire and
he came near being burned to death, and only escaped
with several severe burns. During the time he was lost
he did not taste food of anv kind, and his feet became so •
lacerated and torn that they Ijlcd profusely. He reached
the bank of the river where the Indians and his com-
panions were encamped on the afternoon of the fifth day.
They rejoiced at his return, as they had supposed him
lost. The next day they changed their location and
pitched their lodges at a place where there was a great
quantity of pears, with which they satisfied their pressing
hunger.
The following day some Indians brought five sick per-
sons to the camp and besought Castillo to cure them,
oflering him bows and arrows. At sunset he pronounced
a blessing over the sick, and all the Christians joined in
prayer to God, asking Him to restore them to health ;
and by the next morning tJiey were all as well as though
they had never been sick. This event had a beneficial
influence upon the Indians, and at the same time im-
pressed the Spaniards themselves with a belief that the .
blessings of God were resting upon them, which increased
their hope of escape^ All the sick havmg been restored,
the Indians again moved their lodges to a point where
others were encamped eating prickly-pears. Here were
found assembled various tribes, such as the Cutalches,
Malicones^ Coayes, Lusolas and the Atayos. War was
existing between the two latter nations and they exchanged
arrow shots daily.
Two days after their arrival som^ of the Lusolas Indi-
ans came to the Spaniards and besought Castillo to»go
with them to tiieir lodges to cure their sick and wounded^
THE CONQUEST OP NE^ MEXICO. 73i
one of whom was near his end. But being timid in
the practice of his new profession he dechned to go,,
and Vaea went in his place, accompanied by Estevanico,
"When they arrived at the lodges they found a man to
iill appearance dead ; liis eyes were set and he was
without pulse. His lodge had been pulled down, as
was the custom of his tribe, and his friends were weeping
around him.s Vaca removed the mat which covered
him, breathed upon him and supplicated the Lord to
restore liim to healtli. Tlie man afterward recovered..
His getting well was esteemed a great miracle, and the
Indians gazed upon the Spaniards witli wonder and feai*.
All the sick who were treated in like manner recovered ;
and Vaca was rewarded with a basket of j)ears and the
bow of the man who was so dangerously ill. This re-
covery raised the fame of the Spaniards among all tlie tribes
and they were requested to visit their lodges and bless
their children. When the Cutalchiches were about to
return to their own country they gave the Christians all
the peai's they had gathered, and some flints, five inches
in length, which were used for cutting and -were of high
value among the Indians. When they separated they
begged Vaca and his companions to remember tliem and
pray to God that they might always be well, which they
promised to do.
9 A similar custom to thi^ prevails among the Nabojo Indians of New
Mexico, who either burn or pull down the lodge in which.a.persoci
dies.
74 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER X.
THE SrAXIAIiDS CONTINUE THEIR JOURNEY, iVSD THE PEOPLE
THEY MET.
The Spaniards remained with the Avavares eight
months, during which time the Indians from all parts of
the country brought their sick to them to be healed. By
tliis time Dorantes and Estevanico also began to practice
iiie<l!cine, but they were not such bold practitioners as
^'ar•n. The Indians called them the children of the sun,
and so great was tlieir confidence of their power to hcjil
the sick that thev believed none would die while thev
remained with them. The practice of each one had tlic^
same eftect upon the patient and the savages said that all
^vlIo were treated by them recovered. The inhabitants
i>i' tlie country, tlirough which they had been traveling
since their escape, related to them a remarkable circum-
stance wliicli tliey said had taken place several years
before, and which is given as Vaca relates it :
'* They said that a man wandered through that country
(railed ]5ad-Tliing ; tliat he was small of body and liad
beard, but they never could distinctly see liis features.
"When he came to the house where they were their hair
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 75
stood up and they trembled. Presently there shone at
the door of the house a blazing torcli, and then lie entered
and seized whom he chose of them, and giving him three
great gashes in the side with a very sharp flint, the width
of the hand and two palms in length, he put his hand
through and drew forth the entrailiJ, from one of which
he would cut off a portion more or less the length of a
palm and would throw it on the embers. Then he would
give three gashes to an arm, and the second cut on the
inside of the elbow and would sever the limb. A little
after this he would begin to unite it, and putting his hands
upon the wounds these would instantly become healed.
They said that oftentimes, while they danced, he appeared
among them in the di'ess of a woman, and at others in
that of a man ; that when it pleased him he would take,
up a buhio, or house, and lifting it high after a little wliile
he would c^me down with it with a heavv fall. Thev
also told us that many times they offered him victuals,
but that he never ate ; that they asked him whence he
came and where was his home, and he showed them a
fissure in the eartli and said that his house was there
below. These things that they told us of we much lauglicd
at and ridiculed ; and they, seeing tliat we did not believe
them, brought to us many of those they said he had seized,
and we saw the marks of the gashes he had made in the
places according to the manner they had described. We
told them tliat he was an evil one, and, in the best way
we could, we gave them to understand that, if they would
believe in God, our Lord, and become Christians like us,
they would have no fears of him, nor would he dare to
come and inflict upon them these injuries ; and that tliey
might be certain tliat while wo remained in the land ho
would not dare to appeal* in it. At this they were de-
76 THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO..
lighted and lost much of their dread." These Indians
gave them information of two others of their companions,
the Astiirian and Figaeroa, who were said to be captives
among a tribe further along the coast called the People
of the Figs, los de los hu/os,
Vaca found all the natives whom he encoimtered in the
greatest possible state of ignorance and destitution. They
had no reckoning by the sun or moon, but by the return
of the seasons, as when " the fruit come to ripen and the
fish to die.". They were well treated by. all the tribes.
Their houses were built in the same manner as those of
the Yeguases ; but there was neither maize, acorns nor
nuts in the country. The Spaniards went naked Hke the
Indians during tlie day and and night covered themselves
with skins. Wliile they remained with this tribo they
suffered a good deal for the want of food. In the* spring
when the pears began to ripen Vaca and the negro, with-
out the knowledge or consent of the Indians, visited
another tribe called Maliacones, a day's journey further
on. In three days they sent for Castillo and Dorantes,
w^ho joined tliem. Tiie Indians they were now with
broke up tlieir camp and went into another section of the
country to eat the small fruit of a tree upon which they
were in the habit of subsisting for ten or twelve days while
the pears were coming to maturity. On the way they were
joined by a tribe called the Arbadaos, a weak and miser-
able race, witli wliom the Spaniards remained when the
^laliacones returned to their own country. Here they
were treated with the same unvarying kindness. They
shared with the Spaniards the best they had, which,
however, was scanty enough. Here they sufiered more
for food than at any time since their escape. They had
not more than two handfuls. of pears a da^ and but little
THE CONQUEOT^OF NEW MEXICO. 77
•w^ftter. They traded for two dogs, which they devoured
with great relish. Vaca says that going naked caused
them to shed their skin twice a year like serpents. Tliey
tore their flesh in passing through the wood and bushes,
•and exposure to the sun and air covered tlieir bodies with
-sores. They were obliged to carry heavy loads of wood
upon their backs and the cords wliicli bound it on cut into
•their flesh. The Indians kept them employed a good
deal of their time in scraping and softening skins; and
Vaca relates that then was liis greatest prosperity, for he
preserved the scrapings of the skins which histed liim for
food two or three days. When meat was given them
they ate it raw, because they had been accustomed to it,
and it was easier of digestion. Even if they had wished
to cook it they dared not trust it upon the fire, as the
first Indian who came along would steal it. The savages
devoted *their whole time to hunting food, which was
necessary in order to obtain suflicient quantity to keep
themselves from suflering with hunger.
The Spaniards liaving regained a little of tlieir strength
after eating the two dogs detennined to prosecute tlieir
joumey.i They took leave of the Indians and set out,
traveling the first day through a severe storm of rain.
They stopped at night ui a large wood, and before going
to sleep they built an oven and put ])eas into it to bake,,
^wliich they found well cooked in the morning. Tliese
they ate for breakfast and then resumed their wanderings.
Having passed the wood they came in sight of huts, near
which they saw two women and some boys, who fled upon
their approach. Vaca called to them when they came to
1 When Vaca and hia companions started inland from the sea-coast-
they most probably took a direction nearly NorUi-west until th^v
reacked>the great plains.
78 THE CONQUEST OF XEW 3IEXIC0.
him with timidity, but after their fears had passed away
they conducted them to their village, where they arrived
at evening, llie village contained fifty huts. The in-
liabitants w^ere astonished at tlie sight of white men, and
passed their hands over their faces and bodies and then
over their own.
The next morning the Indians brought their sick to
them to be cured and blessed. They treated the Spani-
ards with great kindness, and even robbed themselves of
food that they might give it to them. They staid several
days with this tribe, and in the meantime other Indians
from beyond ciimc to the village on a visit. When the
latter returned to their own country the Spaniards accoin-
jianied them, much against the wish of their late hosts,
whom they left weeping at tlieir departure. They used
every endeavor to persuade them to stay, but they were
too anxious to continue on. their journey to remain.
From the island of Malhado to the country wdiercin
the Spaniards now found tliemselves tlie inhabitants had
the same general manners and customs. The husband
iHd not cohabit with the wife from the time she l)ecame
pregnant until two years after she had given birth ; and
on account of the scarcity of provisions they suckled their
children until twelve years of age, when they were con-
sidered old enough to support themselves. When they
traveled in the desert, if one fell sick they left him behind
to perish, unless it were a son or brother, w4iom they
would carry upon their backs. It was the custom of men
who were childless to leave their wives at pleasure and
unite themselves with other women ; l)ut when they had
children they never abandoned their wives. Wlien tliey
fouf?ht amonjo: themselves the men never resorted to the
bow and arrow, but they beat each other with their fists ;
THE CONQUEST GF KEW MEXICO. 79
aod when they had ceased fighting both parties retired to
their huts or the wood, where they remained until tlieir
anger had subsided, when they returned and made friends
again. K imman*ied persons quarreled they went to some
neighboring tribe, where they remained some time beibro
returning to their own people. Even their enemies re-
fteived them kindly upon such occasions, and they returned
home loaded with presents.
L
80 THE. CONQUEST OF NEW MEXIC©,
CHAPTEIl XI.
•SOME ACCOUNT OF THE MANNERS AND CUSTOMS OF ^UUIOUB
THIDES.
The various tribes of Indians tlie Spaniards met to this
time were martial in their disposition and well skilled in
the arts of savage warfare. When encamped near an
enemy, or where there was a probabihty of being attacked,
they pitched their lodges upon tlie skirts of the most
taniijled-wood, and dn<x a ditch near bv in which thev
fflept, covered with sticks, loop-holed. Tliey prepared a
place in the wood for the. women and childi'en to sleep
away from the lodges. At night they kindled fires in
tlic lodges, so that if the enemy should come to make an
attack they would assault them, thinking the Indians were
there, when the warriors would rush from the ditches and
take them by surprise. VvHien they could not take shelter
• ill a wood they surrounded themselves with trenchesfrom
behind which they discharged their arrows. While Vaca
was among a tribe chilled Aguenes then* enemies made a
•sudden attack upon them at miduigjit, killing tlu'ee,
■wounding several others and driving them from their
lodges into the fields. About daylight, and after thej'
TIIE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. SHL
•Imd returned to their lodges, the enemy made a second
uttack. They were again taken by surprise; liad five
killed and several wounded, and were a second time
<h-iven from their lodges, witli tlie loss of all tlieir pro^v-
•crty. In a little while the wives of the Quevenes came
l^s ambassadors and made a treaty of peace, when the twe
tribes became friendly again. When Indians who were
not of the same lamily had personal enmities they assas-
^sinatcd at night by lying in wait, and committed gross
barbarities u[)on each other.
They were always watchful and on the alert in time of
danger, and when in fear of an en^my they slept with a
bow and a dozen arrows by their side, keeping the bow
fctrung. During the niglit they ran out of tlieir lodges
unci crept about bent down to the ground so that they
could not be seen, and thus watched upc/h all sides. L:*
they discovered any object they took to the bushes with
their bows and arrows where they remained until daylight,
constantly running about and searching where the sup-
posed enemy was to be found. They now unbent their
bows until they went out to hunt. Their bow-strings
were made of the sinews of the deer. When they fought
they laid close to the ground and kept constantly moving
• about while discharging their arrows, and thus received
])ut little hann from the enemy. When they exhausted
their arrows in battle each one returned his own way,
never following in each other's footsteps.
Vaca mentions the following nations they passed
through, viz: ''I also desire to enumerate the nations
jind tongues that exist from the island of Malhado to the
furthest limit. lu the island of Malhado there are two
languages; the people of the one are called Coaques,
tthose of the other Han. On the terra firraa over against
6
62 tHE CONQUEST OP KEW MEXICa
the island is another people called Chorruco, who take*
their name from the forests where they live. Advancing,
by the shore of the sea others inhabit who are called
Doguenes, and in the rear of them others of the name of
Mendica. Further along the coast are the Quevenes, and
after them, in the interior, the ilarianes ; and continuing
by tlie coast are others called the Guaycones ; and behind
them, inland, the Yeguases. Back of them are the Atoy os ;
and in their rear others the Acubadaos, and beyond them
rtie many on the same path. By tl>e coast also live those
called Quitoles and behind, in the interior, are the Ava-
vares, to whom adjoin the ilaliacones, the Cutalchiches,
and others called Susoles and the CJomos; and by the
coast further on are the Camoles ; and on the same coast,
in advance, are those whom we call Los de lo8 Higos^ the
people of the tig3."i
Tliese various tribes inhabited huts and lived in vil-
lages built in diifercnt ways. Each tribe spoke a sepa-
rate language, although some of them understood the
languages of their neighbors. They stupificd themselves
with smoke, which they considered so great a luxury that
they would sacrifice anything to enjoy it. They made a
tea from the leaves of a tree that resembled the oak.
They first toasted the leaves in a pot, and after they were
I Mr. Smith, in his translation, makes the followhig note of the vari-
ous tribes Vacia traveled among, viz :
" The Cayoques or Capoques may have been the Cadoques. Charle-
voix wntes of the Coaquias as a tribe of the Illinois. He found them
in the winter of 1721 re-unlted to the Tamarouas, a kindred tribe, com-
posing the inhabitants of a populous town on the Eastern bank of the
Missouri. Lettre xxviii, p. p. 392-8. Other names are suggestive in
their sounds, of other nations ; the Aguenes of the Ageronos or Inies,
the Charruco of the Challakee, the Guaycones of the Tawakones re-
siding on the river AVachta.''
THE CONQUEST OT NEW MEXICO. 83
well parched the pot was filled with water and twice
boiled when the liquid was poured into a jar to cool.
They drank it as soon as it was covered with a thick
froth, and as hot as they could bear it. The color of the
liquid was yellow, and while boiling the pot was carefully
covered; but if it happened to be open when a woman
passed by they threw the tea away. They drank this
tea for three days and a half, and each one drank daily
an arroba and a half, equal to about four and a half gal-
lons, wine measure. It was their custom to cry aloud,
from the time it wa» taken from the pot until it was used :
*'Who wishes to drink?" Vacasays: " When the women
hear these cries they instantly stop without daring to
move ; and although they be heavily loaded they dare do
nothing further. Should one of them move they dis-
honor her and boat her with sticks, and, greatly vexed,
they throw away the liquor they have prepared ; while
they who have drunk void it, which they do readily and
without pain. They give a reason for the usage, that
when they are about to drink, if the women move from
where they hear the cry something malign enters the
body in that liquid and causes them shortly to die."
It was the custom among these tribes fur men to live
with others who were emasculate and impotent, who were
dressed like women and performed their labors ; and they
also used the bow and arrow, and carried heavy burdens.
There were manv seen in this condition amonir them.
They were more muscular and taller than other men and
bore burdens of great weight.
We last took leave of Vaca and his companions as they
were about bidding farewell to the Arbadaos, who wept
at their departure. They left with the strange Indians
who had come to visit them and accompanied them to
84 THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO.
their country. They were well received and kindly
treated ; and, according to custom, the cliildren were
brought to them to be blessed. Among the food given
them to eat was a flour made of tlie fruit of o tree called
Mezquiquez, which was of a sweet and pleasant taste, and
wholesome. It was prepared in the following manner :
They dug a hole in the ground into which they placed
the fruit and pounded it until well mashed ; when they
put the mixture into ajar and poured water upon it until
it was covered. They next put earth in the jar and
stirred it with the mixture until of th(i proper sweetness.
To cat it they sat around the jar and each one put in
his hands and took out as much as he wanted. The pits
and skins of the fruit were pounded a second and third
time until all the juice was extracted. It was their cus-
tom to make great banquets upon this preparation, when
they gorged themselves with it. They made a feast for
the Spaniards, accompanied by great dances and cere-
monies, which lastad several days. Among other markti
of respect with which they were treated a guard of six
men was stationed by each one while he slept at night,
and no person w^as permitted to approach them until the
sun was up.2
After they had lived with these people for some time,
they were visited by the women of the tribe which inhal -
ited a countr}^ further on, with whom Vaca proposed to
2 This, most probably, was the fruit of the Mesquit tree, which is
found growing in New Mexico, but is not seen until we approach the
Rio del Norte, going West, The Indians make it into a kind ot bread,
aud also distil from it a liquor which they are very fond of. The tree
1)ears a pod in the shape of a bean, which is sweet to the taste. Mr.
Smith is of the opinion that the fruit referred to is that of the sweet
locust, but at this time the Spaniards must have been in the Mesquit
country, and further AVest than the locust-tree grows.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 85
return, though much against the will of the Indians. The
women pointed out to the Spaniards the direction they
should take to reach their village, when, after biddin<^
farewell to their late hosts, they started off in search of
it. There being no paths they soon became lost, and
^vandered about four leagues out of their way, when they
were overtaken by the women who now became their
guides. They traveled until sun-set, when they arrived
at the village, which consisted of one hundred habitations.
On tticir way they crossed a largo and rapid river, the
water coming up breast high. When near the village
the inhabitants came out to welcome them, yelling as
loud as the}'' could and striking the palms of their hands
against their thighs. Many of tbem carried gourds bored
witli holes and pebble stones in them, which were held
in very great veneration, and were only brought out on
important occasions. They attributed to them wonderful
virtues, and made use of them to effect cures. They told
the Spaniards they grew in Heaven and were washed
down to their country by the river.
The appearance of the strangers caused great excite-
ment in the village, and the Indians were so anxious to
touch them that they almost crushed them in the effort.
They took them up in their arms and carried them into
their houses, where a crowd of people constantly pressed
npon them. The savages were so much rejoiced at their
arrival, that they passed the entire night in dancing and
rejoicing. They wished to perform some personal
ceremony over their guests, but Vaca declined this
honor. The next day the whole population presented
themselves and requested to be touched and blessed by
them, in the same manner they had done others through
whose country they passed.
86 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICa
Vaca remained at this village two days when he took
Iiis departure, accompanied by all the inhabitants who
escorted him to the village of the next adjoining tribe.
The latter were equally well pleased to see the Spaniards,
and gave them the same friendly welcome, furnishing
them witii the best provisions they had, including a part
of a deer killed that d»y. The sick and the aflSicted were
brought to them to be healed, and were sent away
rejoicing. Among other customs was that of those who
came to be cured giving their bows and arrows, shoes and
beads to the Indians who accompanied Vaca and his
companions. Their general direction of travel, at this
time, was a little North of West.
•THE CONQUEST OF l^EW l^XICQ. 87
CHAPTER XII
THE SPANURDS AGAIN BESUME THEIB JOURNEY AND ^lAT
THEY SAW.
The Spaniards resume their wandcriDgs. Setting out
from the village mentioned at the close of the last chapter,
they continued their journey across river and plain
through numerous tribes of nameless Indians, with a
/Crowd ever at their heels. Among others they came to
a people who dwelt in a great number of fixed dwellings.
They were of fairer complexion than any they had yet
seen, but were mostly clouded of one eye and many were
•entirely blind.i Here they observed a new and singular
custom which prevailed among many tribes they after-
ward visited. When they arrived At a village the Indians
who accompanied them immediately began to pillage and
ransack the houses, and to appropriate to themselves
-everything they could lay their hands on. Vaca became
1 The story has its parallel. The following passage is from a traveler
who was at a town of the Shoccories, in the year 1701 : ** Most of these
;Indian8 have hut one eye; hut what mischance or quarrel has
bereaved them of the other, I could not learn." New voyage to Caro-
lina, &c ., b/ John Lawson, Gent., Surveyor General of North Carolina,
I/ondon» . 1709. 3.uc>dngham Smith's note on Yaca's jQornA).
88 TUE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXIBO.
alarmed at this proceeding, fearing that it would bring:
himself and companions into difficulty ; but he was assured
by the inhabitants that they were so much pleased at
seeing him they considered their goods well-disposed of,
and that further on there were rich people from whom
they would be able to repay themselves. This custom
appears to have been a system of reciprocal plundering,
each tribe, in turn, depredating upon its neighbor. The
whole population came to the Spaniards to be blessed.
The appearance of the country now changed. The broad
plains, covered with a rich carpet of grass interspersed
with flowers, gave way to a more uneven surface, and
serrated peaks of mountains could be seen in the distance.
When first discovered they appaared to be about fifteen
leagues oft^ and upon information obtained from the
Indians the Spaniards believed them to run from the
North sea. They took the direction of the mountains,
guided by the Indians, who conducted them through the
country of their friends, as they were not willing their
enemies should enjoy the sight of such wonderful beings.
They soon arrived among another pcoi)le, whom their
guides began to plunder ; but, as the custom was well
understood, the inhabitants had taken the precaution to
conceal some things so as not to be stripped entirely bare.
The Spaniards received a mendly welcome, and their
presence was celebrated by great rejoicing. The Indians
presented them with the articles they had concealed,
consisting of beads, ochre, and a few small bags of silver ;
but these Vaca and his companions did not retain them-
selves, but, as was their universal custom, gave them to
the Indians who accompanied them. Upon receiving
these presents they commenced their dances. •
The Spaniards rested, one day with this people, and.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 89
then toot their departure. The Indians wished to conduct
them to their friends wlio lived at the summit of the
ridge ; but as it was out ot* their course, they continued
along the plain near the foot of the mountains. Many
of the Indians accompanied them in ' spite of their
opposition, and two were dispatched in advance in search
of people in the direction thoy were traveling. The
women carried a supply of water, and would not allow
any one to drink of it without permission of the Spaniards
Their course now lay along the bank of a river. After
traveling two leagues the Indians who had been sent
forward were met returning; who reported they could not
find any inhabitants, and advised them to travel by tlie
mountains. Vaca again refused to take this route, when
the Indians left him and returned down the river, while
he and hi s companions continued up the stream. The
Spaniards were now alone. But they had not proceeded
far when tliey met two women on tlieix way to join the
Indians who htid just left them; by whom thoy we^e
informed that further up the river they would find houses^
pears, and flour of maize.
They continued up the river all day, and at sunset
amved at a town containing twenty houses where the
inhabitants came out to meet them, weeping. They
supposed the strangers were accompanied by Indians
from below, in which case tliey knew they would bo
plundered ; but when they saw the Spaniards were alone,
their weeping was turned into joy. They slept in the
village that night. About daylight the next morning
the village was surprised by a party of hostile Indians,
and as the inhabitants had not time to conceal anvthin^c
they were robbed of all they possessed. The thieves, by
TPay of consoling their victims, told them that the Spaniards
90 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
were children of the sun, and had the power of life and
death in their hands ; intimating that their presence was
remuneration enough for the loss of their goods. They
Advised them to conduct the Christians where the people
were numerous ; that they should offend them in nothing,
but give them all their goods, and should rob other Indians
wherever encountered.
The thieves having given this advice took their
departure. The Spaniards resumed their journey the
next day, the Indians conducting them through a well-
peopled country for three days, to another village. Their
guides announced their approach to the various tribes
they encountered, relating to them many wonderful stories
they had heard from others about the strangers, and
some of their own invention. When they arrived near
the village the inhabitants came out to meet them, and
tendered all the rites of savage hospitality. Their guides
rifled the houses they encountered on the way.
, Thence they traveled fifty leagues inland along the
base of the mountains, and in that distance arrived at a
village of fifty houses. The inhabitants made them
numerous presents, giving a copper bell to Dorantes with
a human face engraved upon it The Indians said it had
come from the North. Here they rested over night, and
departed the next morning. That day they crossed a
mountain range about seven leagues broad covered with
scoria and iron, and in the evening they arrived at another
village situated upon the bank of a beautiful river. The
inhabitants, carrying their children upon their backs,
^ame out to meet them. They gave them many presents,
including little bags of pearls, pounded antimony with
which they rubbed the face, beads, and blankets of cow
liides, and buffalo robes. Vaca thus speaks of the fruit
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 91
•
of the country: "There are in that country small pine
trees, and the cones of them are like small eggs ; but the
seeds are better than those of Castile, as its husk is vfery
thin, and while green it is beat and made into balls, and
thus eaten. If dry, it is pounded in its husk, and con-
sumed in the form of flour. "• The principal article of food,
in addition to the seeds of the pine tree, was pears.
After those who had come out to receive the Spaniards
had touched them, they ran back to their houses and
returned with many things for them to eat. They brought
to VacS a man who had been wounded some time before
with an arrow, the head remaining in the wound, and
requested him to cure it. He succeeded in drawing out
the arrow-head, and sewed up the wound, when, in a
short time, the i^n recovered. At this the Indians were
greatly pleased and rejoiced publicly. This operation,
and the recovery of the wounded man, gave the Spaniards
great influence. They sliowed the Indians the bell that
had been given them, and were informed that there were
many plates of the same material, buried, and also fixed
habitations, where it had been obtained.
Leaving this village they continued on their way, and
Vaca says, they "traveled through so many soHs of
people of such divers languages, that the memory fails to
recall them. They were invariably followed by a crowd
of Indians, and the custom of plundering each other was
universal. They were armed with clubs, which they threw
with astonishing precision and killed more hares with
them than they could consume. Hares were very abundant
s This fruit is the piiioQ that grows on a species of pine>tree, and
which abounds in most parts of New Mexico. It is a small but pala-
table nut, and forms quite an article of trade. I am not aware that the
pifion-tree grows in Texas.
92 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
When one was started the Indians would surround and
attack him with their ehibs, driving him from one to
another until he was overcome and captured. 3 Those
armed with bows did not travel with the main bodj, but
dispersed along the'ridges in seareli of deer. When they
came in to camp at night they brought a plentiful supply
of venison, with birds, quail and other game. Everything
thej^ killed they brought and laid before the Spaniards.
The women carried mats to construct the lodges, each
Spaniard having a separate one allotted to him with the
necessary attendants. The deer and hares were roasted
in ovens built for that purpose ; and after partaking of a
little of the food thus prepared, they distributed it to the
principal Indians, who were requested to divide it among
their followers ; but none would touch * until it had first
been blessed by the Cliristians. Sometimes they were
accompanied by as many as three or four hundred Indians,
and as they had to breathe upon, and bless their food and
drink before they would touch it, their presence became
a prrcat annoyance. On their route they crossed a great
river which came from the North, and traversed a plain
thirty leagues broad. Here they were met by other
Indians who came a groat distance to welcome them, and
through whose country they must pass.
Here the custom of mutual plunder ceased. When the
Spaniards entered the houses the inhabitants placed them,
an4 everything they contained, at their disposal; but
3 This custom still prevails amoDg the Pueblo Indians of New
Mexico, and they practice the sport several limes a year. They sally
out from their villages, mounted on mules and horses, armed with
clubs, and ride to a neighboring prairie where the hunt comes off. The
rabbits are started from their covert, when the horsemen run them
down and kill them with their clubs. In this manner they capture a
great many of these animals. It is a favorite sport.
V
TUE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICa 93
they returned the presents given them to the chief, to
be distributed among the people. Vaca's guides told the
new-comers they should not hide any of their goods from
the white men, for the sun revealed all things to them,
and that for so doing they would cause them to die.
These people stood in great fear of the Spaniards, and for
several days after their arrival they dared not speak nor
raise thoir eyes to. Heaven. The Indians who had ac-
companied them to this point now returned, and this
new tribe became their guides. The latter conducted
them through a desert and mountainous country for fifty
leagues, when they came to a very large river, which they
forded, the water coming up to their breasts.* The
traveling over the barren and rugged country was now
so difficult that many of the Indians began to sicken from
mere fatigue and privation. Thence they entered upon
extensive plains at the foot of mountains, where they met
otlier Itidians who came from a great distance beyond.
They gave the Spaniards more presents than they could
carry, and when requested to receive part of them back
again, they replied that such was not their custom, and tlie
articles were left upon the ground.
4 Mr. Smith fixes this river as the Arkansas, near its junction with
the Canadian Fork, bat docs not give the data from which he arrives
at this conclusion. My opinion is, that at this time Vaca was not so
f^r North as the Arkansas, but was probably on the hoad-waters of
some of the rivers of Eastern Texas. That he was as fjir North as the
Canadian, during his wanderings, I think more than probable.
Castaneda, in his journal, mentions that Coronado, when out upon the
bofiUlo plains, which must have been at a point not far from the lati>
tude of Santa Fe, came among a people who told him that three white
men, like himself, had passed through their country, and had blessed
their skins. These were probably Vaca and his companions, as we
have no record of any other white men passing through that section of
New Mexico before the arrival of Coronado and his army^
I
94 THE CONQUEST OF NEW KEXICX).
CHAPTER XIII.
VACA AND COMPANIONS ARRIVE AMONG A PEOPLE OP JlXElT
UABITATIONS.
Vaca now desired tlio Indians to conduct him toward
the setting-sun, and wanted them to send messengers
ahead to announce his coming to the inhabitants of the
country. They endeavored to excuse themselves on the
ground tliat the country was remote, and its people their
enemies ; but not daring to disoblige him they sent for-
ward two women. The Spaniards and Indians followed
them but halted at a point agreed upon to await their
return. They waited there five days, but the messengers
not returning in that time, tlie Indians said they coiiM
not have found any people. The Spaniards now requested
to be conducted toward the North, but this the Indians
declined for a like reason, and because, as tliey alleged,
tliere was neither food to eat nor water to drink in that
direction. Vaca now showed his displeasure, which gave
great alarm to the Indians. They besought him not to
be angry any longer, and promised to guide him whither-
soever he desired to go, even though it were certain they
would die on the wav.
About this time a circumstance happened which gave
the Indians increased dread of the Spaniards, and made
tHE CONQUEST CP KEW MEXICO-- , 95
(bem more Bubmissive to tbeir wilL Wbile tbe latter
feigned displeasure at their cond^t a sickness broke out
among them, of which eight died in one day. This caused
great consternation amoi^ the inhabitants throughout all
the country, as they believed the Spaniards caused their
death by merely willing it ; and their dread became so
great that they were almost ready to die with fear. The
famihes of the dead manifested great sympathy for them
during their illness ; but after tlieir decease they showed
neither feeling nor pity for their remains, nor would they
bury the bodies until commanded to do so by the Spani-
ards. Vaca and his companions now became alarmed in
turn, fearing the Indians would die of disease, or run away
from fright, and they would be left without guides in that
strange and savage country. While among these people
one person was never seen to speak to another, nor aiv
infant to smile ; and " the only one that cried they took
off to a distance and with the sharp teeth of a rat they
scratched it from the shoulder down neai-ly to the ends
of the legs." The Indians said it was done as a punish-
ment because the child had cried in the presence of the
Christians.! These people were in a better condition,
more comely in person, and more obedient than any they
had yet seen.
The Spaniards had now been with this tribe eighteen
days, at the end of whidi the two women who had been
I On the authority of Romans, as stated by Mr. Smith, tbe Muscogeef^
used to practice a custom very similar. He says: "They make their
boys frequently undergo scratching from head to foot through the skiu
with broken glass or garfish teeth, so as to make them all in a gore of
blood, and wash them in cold water; this is with them the Arcanu7n
against all disease ; but when they design it as punishment to the boys
they dry scratch them (i. e.) they apply no water for the operation,
tfhich renders it very painful."
i
5)6 . THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
dispatched toward tlie setting sun in searcli of other
people returned. They reported that they liad Been but
lew Indians, a^ it was the season for cattle and thev had
nearly all gone in pursuit of them. The Spaniards now
determined to resume their journey, and the next morning
tliey started. The sick who were convalescent remained
behind, but those wlio were able went forward. Tliev
traveled three days through an uninhabited country when
they encamped. Castillo and Estevanico started the next
moniing, v/ith the two women as guides, in search of
inhabitants. One of the women conducted them to the
town where her father lived, situate upon a river that ran
Ijetween ridges, the habitations being the first they had
seen with the appearance and structure of houses.s ^riioy
explained to the inhabitants, as well they could, the reason
of tlieir visit. Thev were treated with kindness. At the
end of three days Castllk) took five or six of tlie principal
inliabitants and returned to Vaca, reporting that they Jiad
found a people living in fixed and civilized dwellings, and
subsisting on beans, pun^pkins and maize. Vaca and the
Indians innnediately set out for the village, and after
travelin£c a leaffuo and a half they met Estevanico with
the whole population coming to receive them. They
gave the Spaniards many presents, including beans,
pumpkins, calabashes and " blankets of cov; hide3."3 Tlie
Indians who had accompanied them to this point, being
2 The Spaninrds, at this time, must have been among the villages of*
the Pueblo Indians of New Mexico. At one point the Canadian River
ruijs for some miles ihrouj^h a deep cafion, which answers pretty well
to Vaca's account of a "river which runs between two ridges," and in
whicli are found ruins of old Indian pueblos, or villages. If tliis sup-
position be true, they must have ascended the Red River some distance
and then struck across to the Canadian.
3 BulTdlo robes.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXieO. "07
^•enemies of this new people, were dismissed and sent back
to their own country after receiving many presents from
A^'aca and Lis companions.. The journey was now resumed
under the guidance of their new 4tllies, and after traveling
about six leagues they reached the village at dark. Their
arrival was the occasion of great rejoicing.
Vaca remained with this people two nights and one
day, when they conducted him to a neighboring tribe
who also dwelt in fixed habitations and hved upon the
same kind of food. Here the manners and customs were
different. The inhabitants did not go out to receive them
as many other tribes had done, but awaited them in their
houses, seated upon the floor with their heads down,
fiices turned toward the wall and tlie hair pulled over the
eyes. They piled their property in a heap on tlie middle
of the floor. They gave the Spaniards many presents.
They were an intelligent and active race, with fine per-
sons and possessed of great strength. Vaca gave them
the name of the "Cow Nation," because of the great
number of cattle* that were killed in their country, and
particularly along the river, for fifty leagues.s The coun-
4 Whenever cattle are mentioned in these pages it refers to buffaloes ,
which then roamed over all New Nexico.
5 1 am of opinion that the river here referred to was the Pecos
'toward which Vaca traveled from the Canadian or Red River,
probably in a South-west direction. In 1583, when Espejo made
an expedition into New Mexico he ascended the Del Norte and returned
South down a river further to the East which he called the River of
• Oxen, because of the great number of buffaloes found upon its banks.
Vaca called the country he was now in the ** Cow Nation," from the
great number of the same animals that were killed there and particu-
larly along the river. The Pecos is the only river East of the Del
.l^orte that flows toward the South ; and there can be no doubt that
this is the stream that Espejo descended, and that it is identical will'
.-the one to which Vaca refers.
.7
08 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
•
try was very populous. The inhabitants went in a state
of nature, except the women and old men who were
incapable of fighting, who dressed in deer-skins. The
season was unusually dry. Rain had not fallen for two
years, and all the seed corn they had planted had been
eaten by the moles. They were afraid to plant again
until it rained lest tliey should lose the httle seed they
had left. They begged the Spaniards to '^ tell the sky to
rain," and also to pray for it ; which latter request was
complied wifh.
Seeing maize among this people the Spaniards asked
them where they got it ; they replied that it came from
where the sun goes down, where it grew in great abund-
ance. The Indians declined accompanying them in that
direction, but told them that the path to that country lay
along the river which flowed by their village toward the
North ;« that tlie country was barren, and in a journey of
seventeen days they would find nothing to eat but a fruit
called chacan which was ground between stones, but
which could not be eaten on account of its dryness and
pungency ; that the people along the river and among
6 Mr. Smith gives it as his opinion that this river came from the
West instead of the North as stated in Yaca's journal. In this con-
clusion, however, he is undoubtedly in error, as there is no river run-
ning irom the West anywhere in the region of country where the
Spaniards then were. If they were not on the Pecos they may have
been on the Del Norte, which comes from West of North ; in which
case they must have traveled up that river, and afterward changed their
course and traveled toward the South-west. Espejo mentions that
traces of the Spaniards were found along the River Conchos when he
passed down that stream nearly fifty years afterward. It is possible
they had already passed the Del Norte, and were now traveling up the
Conchos ; but that stream is jiot of sufficient length to permit its banks
to be traveled for thirty four days toward its source, as appears to have
been the case with the stream the Spaniards were on.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 99
•
whom they would travel were their enemies, but spoke
their language, and although they had nothing to give
them to eat they would receive them with kindness and
make them presents of cotton, hides and other articles.
They remained among these Indians two days, feasting
upon beans and pumpkins, but uncertain what course to
take. These vegetables were cooked in a manner differ-
ent from any thing they had seen in the country. The
use of pots for boiling food was unknown. For this pur-
pose they filled the half of a calabash with water and put
hot stones into it until it boiled, when they put in the
food to be cooked. "While the food was Jboiling they
were constantly taking out the stones as they became cool
and putting in hot ones that the temperature of the water
might be kept up.
At the end of 'two days the Spaniards determined to
continue their journey in quest of the country where the
maixe grew. They took their course toward the Westz
and followed up the river for seventeen days. They met
many Indians on the way who gave them blankets of
cow hides, and did not offer to molest them. Thev saw
some of the fruit called chacan, which they tasted but
found it bitter and unpalatable. They subsisted on deer-
suet which they had saved for such an emergency, as the
country produced nothing for them to live upon. At the
end of seventeen days they crossed the river and con-
tinued along the other bank for seventeen days longer in
the same direction, when they arrived among a new
people living upon plains between very high mountains.*
7 This is an error as to direction, no doubt.
8 The Llanos Estacados, or Staked Plains, which Mr. Smith mentions
in his translation of Vaca, lay in New Mexico and Texas mostly East
of the Pecos River, and from their position cannot be the plains
100 THE CONQUEST OF XEW ^MEXICO.
These Indians lived one-third of the year on the powder
'of a certain straw ; and as it was the season when nothing
else could be obtained, the Spaniards were compelled to
•eat of it while passing through the country.
After leaving this people they again arrived in a
country of permanent habitations where they found an
abundance of maize. The houses were built of earth and
mats. The inhabitants gave them maize both in grain
and flour, and also made them presents of beans,
calabashes and blankets of cotton. Here the Indians
who had come with them were dismissed, Vaca first di-
Tiding among them the presents received from this last
•tribe, as was the usual custom. The Spaniards returned
thanks to God for having brought them safely into a
country where there was such an abundance of food.
Again resuming their journey they traveled for an hun-
dred leagues through a country that abounded in fixed
habitations w^ith plenty of maize and beans. The in-
liabitants, in all this distance, treated them friendly, and
gave them of everything they possessed, among wliich
were deer, blankets of cotton, beads, corals that came
from tlic South Sea, and many fine turquoises brought
from the North. They gave Vaca five emeralds made
into arrow-heads which were held in great esteem and
used in their dances and celebrations ; which the Indians
said they obtained from lofty mountains to the North,
where there w^ere populous towns and very large houses,
in exchange for bunches of plumes and feathers of parrots.*
spoken of as lying between mountains. At this time the Spaniards
were much further South and West, and if they passed up the Conchos
■during their wanderings they had already traversed that stream and
were now a long distance West of the Del Norte.
9 In the country inhabited by the Nabajo Indians, Ijdng between the
•rivers San Juan and the Colorado Chiquito, are ound great qaantitie€
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXlCOk 101
TBrough all this country there was evidence of a higher
degree of civilization. The women were better treated
and better dressed than among the tribes they had pre-
viously visited. Their dress consisted of a skirt of cotton
that came down to the knees with half sleeves, and skirts
of dressed deer-skin reaching to the ground, open in
front, and confined with leather straps. They washed
their garments vdth a certain soapy root that cleansed
them well.io They also wore shoes.u The Spaniards
had great influence over all these people, who came to
them both sick and well, and begged they would touch
and bless them. When a woman gave birth to a child
she inunediately carried it to the Christians to receive
their blessing. They believed the Spaniards came from
Heaven, and in order to keep alive their superstitious awe
the latter conversed but little with them. The negro,
however, was iu constant intercourse with them in order
to find out all that liis companions wished to know. If
the Indians were at war they made peace on the arrival
of the Spaniards, in order to be able to meet them a&
ot beautiful garnets, and a green stone resembling the emerald. The
country also abounds in ruins of large and once populous towns. In
aU probability the emeralds mentioned by Yaea came from this region.
The Spaniards were now undoubtedly among the Pueblo Indians of
New Mexico, or a people who strongly resembled them.
10 This is the root of a species of a palm tree, and is a spongy, fibrous
mass, containing mucilaginous and alkaline matter. It grows in most
parts of New Mexico, where it is known by the name of Amole, and
is used instead of soap for washing woolen goods. Two kinds are
found, AmoH Pelota and Amole Largo. The former has a large and
round leaf, and is best for washing, while the latter has a long and
narrow leaf like that of the palm tree. I do not know that it is found
out of New Mexico.
11 This is the first mention of the inhabitants of all that region wear-
ing covering on then: feet. The '* shoes** were no doubt the moccasins
still worn.
102 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICa
friends and present their offerings. They left all the
.tribes at peace as they passed through the conntrj'. They
taught them that there was in Heaven a Great Being
whom they called God, who made the sk}^ and the earth,
and all other things ; that Ho was their master and they
worsliippcd and ol)eyed him, and received from liim aU
good things. The Indians comprehended this very
imperfectly, but at the rising and going down of the sun
they would open their hands toward the Heavens with
loud shoutings, and afterward draw them down over their
bodies. The Spaniards spoke six different languages,
but tlie people they were now with could understand
neither of them, and they could only hold intercourse
with each other by signs.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW BIEXICO. • 103
CHAPTER XIV.
YlIK SPANIARDS REACH THE SETTLEMENTS OF NEW SPAIN,
AND THENCE CO TO THE CITY OF MEXICO.
The Spaniards remained in the village where the
inhabitants gave them emeralds, three days ; which tliey
failed the " Town of Heart8,"i because the Indians crave
I The *'Town of Hearts'* must have been near the gulf of California,
and in the limits of the present Mexican State of Cinnloa. Castailcda
mentions that the first province the army came to, in the march to
Cibola, after leaving Culiacan, was the one which Cabeza de Vaca had
called Tierra de los Corazones, because when lie passed through it
the inhabitants offered him many hearts of animals to eat. At this
time the Spaniards were marching nearly parallel with, and but a short
distance Irom, the Gulf of California ; and from this position of Vaca
and his companions, they may have passed entirely across the territory
of New Mejuco, and then continued their journey down near the ^If
coast. They may possibly have struck the head-waters of the Gila,
lifter crossing the Del Norte, and, passing down that stream toward the
West, to a point near where it empties into the Rio Colorado, changed
their course to the Southeast, and traveled parallel to the Gulf until
they reached Culiacan. But if this were the case, they could not have
passed up the Conchos, as already indicated. Tliey may, however,
have traveled nearly due West from the Conchos towanl the coast, and
then turned South-cast from the ** Town of Hearts," and continued their
course parallel to the coast. This opinion is sustained by lieutenant
Whipple, U. S. Toi)Ographical Engineers, who places the Town of
Hearts in the valley of the river San Miguel, and not far from the coast
of the Gulf of California. If this location be correct, it is conclusive
evidence that Vaca and companions did not pass up the river Conchos,
but instead passed down the Gila, to a point near its mouth, mnd theii
strack across to ihoTiycr San Miguel, and se on to Culiacan.
104 tTHE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
Dorantes over five hundred split hearts of deer. These
formed an important article of food with the inhabitants,
and great abundance was always kept on hand for con-
sumption. Vaca says this country was the entrance to
many provinces in the South Sea, " and whoever go to
seek it and do not enter will be lost ; for tliere is no
maize on the coast ; the inhabitants eat the powder of
corn, {Uedo,) and of straw, and fish cauglit in the sea from
rafts, as they have no canoes. The women cover their
nudity with grass and straw. They are a melancholy
and emaciated jxjople."
In a day's journey beyond the "Town of Hearts," they
aiTived at another to\vn where they were detained fifteen
days by heavy rains, which raised the river so high that
they could not cross it for that length of time. Hero
Castillo saw upon the neck of an Indian the buckle of a
sword-belt, and the nail of ahorse shoe. The inhabitants
being asked how they had obtained these things, answered^
that they had got them from men who wore beards like
themselves, who came from Heaven, and liad arrived at
tliat river witli horses, lances and swords, where they
killed two of their people ; that they had gone to sea and
returned homo toward where the sun sets. Tliis was the
first information the Spaniards received of their country-
men, and tliey were greatly rejoiced at the prospect of
again meeting them. As they advanced they heard more
rumors of white men having been in tlie countrj^, and now
traveled with renewed hope. To conciliate the Indians,
Vaca told them he was going in search of the white people,
in order to persuade them neither to hurt nor make
slaves of them, which gave them great joy.
Thence our wanderers passed througli many territories,
aboimding in fertile land and beautiful streams, but found.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXlCa 105
all tlie houses and towns deserted, tlie inhabitants having
fled to the mountains through fear of tlie Spanitirds of
Mexico, who made incursions that far. Behig unable to
plant their crops, they lived upon roots and the bark of
trees, and were almost in a starving condition. Here
tliey suffered much from hunger, as the Indians had
nothing to give them but blankets. They related to them
liow the Spaniards had entered their country, destroyed
their towns, and carried away many of the men, and all
the women and boys, while those who had been able to
escape were wandering through the mountains.
Vaca and companions were now alarmed lest the
Indians should revenge upon them the injuries they had
received from their countrymen, and feared wlicn they
should reach that part of the country where hostilities had
already taken place, they would oppose their progress..
They traveled under many apprehensions, but when they
arrived among the Indians at war with the Spaniards,
they were received with kindness, and looked upon with
awe and reverence. They were conducted to a town at
tlie edge of a mountain range of difficult passage, wliere
they found many people assembled. The Indians gave
them " two thousand back loads of corn," which Vaca
distributed among those who had accompanied him. The
next day two messengers were dispatched through tlie
country to notify the inhabitants to meet them at a town
three day's journey beyond, and the following day they
set out for that place. As they advanced they saw
repeated indications of their countrymen. At mid-day
they met the messengers returning, who reported that
they had seen but few Indians as tliey had left their
villages and were wandering in the mountains, but that
106 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
they bad seen the Spaniards the night before, who were
carrying away the people in chains.
This information so alarmed the Indians who accom-
panied Vaca, that many of them fled immediately, and
the whole would have left them had he not assured tliem
of tlieir safety. Some of them bad come with him an
hundred leagues, and as he could not then discharge them
in a condition to reach their own country, he kept them
with him. They continued their journey. On the third
day they were guided to the place where the Spaniards
liad been seea ; when it was found that horsemen bad
been there, but liad left. They were now on tlie river
Petutan, at a point estimated to be ninety-two leagues
from the village where they were detained by the rain.
It was eighty leagues from the river where they first
heard of Christians, and to which point Diego de Guyman
had been. In the mountain regions of all this extent,
they saw traces of gold, antimony, iron, copper, and other
metals, and found the climate very warm.
These repeated indications of their countrymen filled
the wanderers witli joy, and they returned thanks to God
for liaving delivered them from so many dangers and
privations. \'aca entreated some of liis companions to
go in search of the Spaniards ; but they being unwilling,
he set out himself, accompanied by the negro and eleven
Indians. He followed their trail, and the next day over-
took four horsemen. They were so much astonished at
his strange appearance, and seeing him in company with
Indians, tliat they would have but little to do or say to
liim. He requested to be conducted to their commanding
oflicer, when they took him and the Indians to captain
Diego de Alcaraz. He explained to Alcaraz whence he
came and liis condition, and that Castillo and Dorantes,
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 107
with a multitude of Indians, were only ten leagues off.
The captain immediately dispatched three cavalry men
M'ith fifty Indians, and the negro as guide, to bring them
up. Alcaraz explained to Vaca that he was lost and did
not know whither to turn to extricate himself ; that he
had not been able to capture an Indian for several days,
and that their provisions had given out. Vaca requested
his countrymen to give him a certificate of tlio day,
month and year of his arrival among them, and stating
the manner in which he came. This was done as he
desired.
After the lapse of five days the companions of Vaca
arrived at the camp of Alcaraz, accompanied by some
six hundred Indians. The soldiers being in great want
of provisions, the Indians, at th6 request of Vaca, brought
them a plentiful supply of corn and other articles of food.
The com was in jars closed up with clay, wliich they had
l)uried to conceal from the Spaniards. Alcaraz was
anxious to make slaves of these Indians according to the
custom of the times, but Vaca opposed it. He felt liim-
self in honor bound to protect the simple natives who had
treated him with so much kindness, and therefore would
not allow them to be reduced to bondage. This led to
high words between him and Alcaraz.
The Indians who accompanied Vaca refused to return
to their own country until they had delivered him safely
into the hands of other Indians, as was their custom,
fearing they would die unless they did so. Alcaraz,
jealous of the devoted attachment of the Indians to Vaca
and his companions, endeavored to weaken their venera-
tion for them by telling them they were white men like
themselves ; thai they had been long lost and were persons
of a low condition. But this had no influence with the
108 THE CONQUEST CB NEW MEXICCK
untutored natives ; who declared that the soldiers lied ^^
that the poor wanderers " had come from whence the sun.
rises, and they, whence it goes down ; that we healed the
sick, and they killed the sound ; that we had come naked
and barefooted, and they in clothing and on horses with
lances ; that we were not covetous of anything, but that
all that was given to us we directly turned to give, re-
maining with nothing ; and the others that they had no
piu'pose but to rob whomsoever they found, and give
nothing to any one." Vaca was unable to convince them
that he was like the other Christians, and with difficulty
persuaded them to return to their own country and plant
their crops and rebuild their towns. The country is
described as the best and most prolific of all the Indias,
producing three crops in a year. It abounded in fertile
valleys and beautiful rivers, with an abundance of fruits,
provisions of various kinds, and the precious metals ; and
the inhal)itants were comely in person and well disposed.
Alcaraz sent Vaca and his companions forward in
charge of an alcalde named Zeburos, attended by two
men. He conducted tluem through vast forests and
solitudes, and they suflered so many hardships that some
of the Indians died. They were lost in the wood for two
days, and after traveling twenty-five leagues and being
greatly fatigued, the alcalde conducted them to a town
of friendly Indians. Here the alcalde stopped, but the
Spaniards continued on to the town of Culiazan,i three
leagues further, where they found Melchor Diaz, principal
alcalde and captain of the province.3
Diaz hearing of their arrival came to see them* He
t The same as Culiacan.
3 A small town in the Mexican State of Cinaloa on the river Culiacan*
which empties into the Galf o£ California.
THE COKQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 109
received them with great kindness in the name of Nnno
de Guzman, the governor of the province, and placed all
that he had at their disposal. After tarrying here a few
days in order to pacify the neighboring Indians by means
of the great influence they exercised over them, they de-
parted for the village San ^Miguel, thirty leagues from the
river Petutan. They remained at tliis place until the
15th of May, when they set out under an escort for the
city of Compostella, an hundred leagues distant, traveling
tlirough a country swarming with hostile Indians. Upon
their arrival they were received and entertained by
governor GuJ^man in the most gracious and hospitable
raanniBr. He clothed them from his own wardrobe, but
they could not wear the clothes given them, nor sleep
elsewhere than on the ground for some days. They
rcmaisted at Compostella ten or twelve days wlien they
departed for the city of Mexico. They were well enter-
tained as they passed through the country, and in some
parts the people flocked to the road from a considerable
distance to see them, and return thanks that they had
been delivered from all their dangers and trials. Thev
arrived in Mexico on Sunday, the day before the vespers
of St. James, and were welcomed by the Viceroy and the
marquis del Valle.
Vaca and his companions spent the winter in Mexico,
and in the spring himself and Dorantes went to Vera
Cruz to take shipping for Spain. They sailed hence the
10th of April, and after a voyage of many vicissitudes
and danger^ they arrived safely at the jport of Lisbon, on
4he 9th day of August, 153Z,
110 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER XV.
THE EARLIEST INFORMATION OF NEW MEXICO, AND THE
FIRST ATTEMPT TO EXPLORE IT,
•
The earliest information the Spaniards of Southern
Mexico received of what is now the territory of New
Mexico, then known as the country of the Seven Citied
or Cibola,! was about the year 1530. At this time, Nuno
de Guzman was President of New Spain, and resided in
the city of Mexico. He had in his employ an Indian who
was said to be a native of tlie valley of Oxitipar, whi(;h
the Spaniards called Tejos ; who represented himself as
the son of a merchant in the habit of traveling through
the interior of the country for the purpose of selling fine
bird feathers to be manufactured into plumes, for which
he obtained, in exchange, large quantities of gold and
silver which everywhere abounded. He said that he had
1 The origin of this word is not linown, but I believe it to be Indian,
and was, no doubt, the name the ilatives of the country gave to the
bison or buffiilo. The ** Cibola" country was known to the Spaniards
of Southern Mexico, ten years before Coronada undertook his expedi-
tion. In New Mexico, by common consent, the word is accepted as
the Spanish for buffalo, but in the Spanish lexicons it is translated
a quadruped called the ** Mexican bull." New Mexico was known
to the early Spaniards as the *^ buffalo country."
THE CONQUEST OF HEW MEXICO. Ill
made two trips with liis father and saw the cities he spoke
about ; that they were seven in number, and so extensive
and beautiful they could be compared to the city of
Mexico, and that entire streets were occupied by those
who worked in tlie precious metals. He represented that
this country could only be reached after crossing a desert
of forty days journey, which was covered with a species
of short grass about five inches high, and that it must be
penetrated in a Northern direction between the two seas.
Guzman and others, to whom tliese relations were
made, placed implicit confidence in the narrative of the
Indian, wliich inflamed the minds of the adventurous and
gold-loving Spaniards, who determined to penetrate that
unknown region, make it subject to the crown of Spain,
and enrich themselves from the spoils of the conquest.
For this purpose an expedition was immediately placed
on foot to be commanded by the. President in person,
composed of four hundred Spaniards, principally men of
wealtli and gay cavaliers, and twenty thousand Indian
allies. They believed Cibola could be reached in a dis-
tance of about two hundred leagues.
The army took up its march from ilexico witli high
hopes of success, directing its course toward what was
then called the North Sea. It crossed the province of
Tobasco, a dependency of Michoacan, and in gobd order
reached that of Culiacan where the government of Nuno
de Guzman terminated. Here he encountered many
difficulties, and obstructions to his march met him on
every hand. The country was wild and unexplored, and
the mountains so precipitous and rugged that he could
not find a road across them. The want of a route by
which to advance obliged him to remain a considerable
time in Culiacan, which produced great dissatisfaction in
112 TEE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
•
the army, and many became anxious to return. The rich
])er8on8, who made up a large portion of his force, not
accustomed to the hardships they encomitered were
imanimously in favor of quitting an expedition which
promised only suifering and danger. These causes were
a deatli-blow to a further advance.
In the meantime, affairs in the city of Mexico had as-
sumed such a shape that Guzman had no desire to return
thither. During his absence the renowned Hernan
Cortez had returned from Spain clothed with new honors
and authority, and Guzman feared to place liimself in liis
power. In the absence of Cortez he had been his enfemy ;
he had oppressed his friends and squandered his estate,
and justly feared that he would retaliate if he should have
an opportunity. This condition of things induced Guz-
man not to Return to Mexico, but to remain and colonize
the province of Culiacan and there establish his power.
Relinquishing all idea of advancing further into the
interior, he returned with those Spaniards who still
remained with him and established himself at Xalisco
and Tonala, which two provinces subsequently formed
the kingdom of New Galecia. During this period the
Tejos Indian died, and, for the present, all thought of
exploring the country of Seven Cities was abandoned.
Nufio*de Guzman remained in authority about eight
years after the termination of this expedition, when he
was deposed and thrown into prison and the government
• of the province was usurped by and passed into the hand^
of ti resident judge, called the licentiate de la Torre.
After the death of the latter, the Viceroy of New Spain,
Don Antonio de Slendoza, appointed Francisco Vasquez
Coronado to succeed him in the government of New
< Galecia. .He was a gentleman of Salamanca, in Spain,
THE CONQUESiyOP NEW MEXICO. sll3
Ibut had been established sometime at Mexico, where he
»^ married a daughter of the Treasurer, Alonzo d'Estrada,
• a reputed son of Ferdinand the Catholic. On his ap-
pointment, Coronado took a journey through New Spain
in order to become acquainted with the country and to
see the people whom he was to govern.
About this time the Viceroy received further informa-
tion concerning the country of the ' Seven Cities. This
Was commimioated by Cabeza de Vaca and his companions
who reached Culiacan after their adventurous wanderings
across the continent. They stated to Mendoza that they
?]iad made inquiries of tlie country through wliich tlioy
passed, and had been told by the inliabitants of great
cities where the houses were four stories high ; that the
country was populous, and the people cultivated and lived
upon maize, pumpkins and other vegetables ; that it
abounded in cattle, which roamed about in great herds ;
• deer and other animals, and that they had seen many
towns of fixed habitations whose inhabitants dressed in
cotton and tanned deer-skin.
The Spaniards listened with ^eep interest to these
recitals, which renewed their desire to penetrate the
country f>i the Seven Cities in search of the remarkable
things said to exist there. The Viceroy communicated
this information to Coronado, who immediately abandoned
the visit he was making through New Spain, and repaired
to Culiacan. He took with him to his province three
monks, and the Barbaiy negro who had accompanied
Vaca in his wanderings. Being anxious to obtain more
correct knowledge of the country in which ho had become
60 deeply interested, he induced two of tlie monks ami
the negro to undertake an exploration in that direction.
.They made immediate preparations for the journey.
8
114 THE CO^^QUEST OF X«W MEXICO.
CHAPTER XVI.
FKIAR XIZA SETS OUT FOR CIBOLA, A(XOMrAXIED BY ONE OF
VACA'S COMPANIONS. I
TuE expedition which • Men doza put on foot to make
explorations into the province of Cibola, or the country of
the Seven Cities, was under tlic direction of a Franciscan
friar named Marcos de Niza, or Nizza.* He was well
1 Before he set out the friar receiTed instructions from Mendoza,
which pointed out the object of the expedition and particularly in-
structed him in what he 8lA)uld say to the Indians. lie was to obsenre
the country, climate, soil and productions, rivers, animals, the number
of the inhabitants and precious metals, and, if possible, oblain samples
of everything he saw. According to the letter of instructions, the
expedition was undertaken for '* the honor and glory of the Holy
Trinity, and for the propagation of our holy Catholic faith." The friar
received these instructions the 28lh of November, 1538. Temaux
Comparts, Appendice, p. 249.
3 Th6 route taken by Niza and Stephen can be traced with much
greater accuracy than that of Vaca and his companions. They trav-
eled nearly parallel with the gulf of California until they arrived near
the head of it, when they changed direction to the North-east, crossed
the river Qila, and traversed the extensive stretch of barren country
that lies to the North of that stream. This region is almost a desert
waste, with a light sandy soil, covered for the most part with a growth
of stunted pine trees, and with little water.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO* 115
fitted for the journey by his former experience, haying
served under Alvarado in Peru, and was inured to hard-
ship and danger. He was accompanied by friar Ono-
rato, and Stephen, the Barbary negro before mentioned,
and a number of Indians, of the towns of Petatlan and
Cuchillo, whom the Viceroy had pujpchased and set free
in Culiacan. Having completed the necessary arrange-
ments they departed from the town of Saint Michael, in
the province of Culiacan, on Friday, the 7th of March,
1539. They traveled nearly in a North-west direction,
some little distance from the coast of the gulf of Califor-
nia, and in a few days arrived safely at the town of
Petatlan. The inhabitants of the country through which
they passed treated them with great kindness and hospi-
tality. They made entertainments for them on the road
side, furnished them with provisions and gave them
presents of robes, flowers and many other ai'ticles. In
It is the opinion of some who have examined the subject that the
route of Nixa was further inland than I have located it, among whom
are lieutenant Whipple, of the U. S. Topographical Engineers, and
Mr. Bartiett. It is supposed that the desert of *'four days' Journey,'*
first crossed by Niza, lies between the Hio Yaqui and Hio Sonora.
Thence he passed through the valley of Sonora and continued in a
course nearly North. The town of Vacupa, of *' reasonable bigness,"
is supposed to have been identical with Magdalena on the river San
Miguel. He is thought to have passed near the present site of Tueson,
a small Mexican town in the territory of Arizona, and continuing
North struck the Gila, through the valley of which he traveled five days*
journey ; he then crossed over to the Hio Azul which he ascended,
and so continued on to the great desert which he passed, until he came
Within sight of Cibola. Upon reflection I believe that Niza traveled
some distance up the valley of the Qila, but that he did not ascend it
to a point so high up as the Azul, as that would have obliged him to
cross the Mogollon mountains of which no mention is made. He must
have followed up the Rio Francisco or Salt river further to the West
and thus escaped the mountains.
116 THE CONQUEST 'OF NEW MEXICO.
the parts of the country where there were no houses the
Indians made bowers of the boughs and branches of trees
plaited together for thera to rest and sleep under. At
Petatlan Onorato was taken sick which detained Niza
three days, but his illness increased to such a degree
that he was compelled to leave him behind.
Resuming his march he traveled a distance of twenty-
five or thirty leagues from Petatlan, receiving the same
uniform kindness from the inhabitants. There was great
scarcity of provisions throughout all the country, and the
Indians informed him that rain had not fallen for three
years. They had almost ceased cultivating the land,
having fled to the mountains and concealed themselves
from fear of the Spaniards, who were in the habit of
piaking incursions from the town of Saint Michael and
carrying them off into captivity. Through all this region
nothing was seen worthy of note. There came to him
some Indians from an island visited by Cortez and told
him that it was not the main-land, as was generally sup-
posed, but was really an island. They crossed over on
rafts to the main-land, the distance beins: about half a
league. He was also visited hy other Indians who came
from a larger island further oft*. They said there were
thirty other islands, inhabited, which produced but few
provisions, except two of them which yielded corn. They
wore about their necks many large shells of the mother
of pearl ; and upon Niza showing them some which he
carried they told him there was a great number of such
on the islands, but he saw none upon his march.
Niza now arrived at a desert which he crossed* in a
journey of four days, accompanied by the Indians of the
islands and some others who inhabited the mountains he
had passed. Having crossed the desert he came to
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 117
another people who were much astonished at the sight of
white men, as they had no knowledge of the Spaniards ;
nor did they hold traffic or intercourse of any kind with
the people who lived upon the opposite side of the desert.
They treated Niza and his companions with great kind-
ness, and furnished them with such provision as the
country afforded. They sought to touch the garments
of the friar, whom they called Uayota^ which, meant, iu
their language, a man comefroQn heaveiu In accordance
with his instructions he taught these people a knowledge
of God and the Emperor as he was best able to do. As
he traversed the country he made diligent inquiry of the
natives as to where he should find a region containinf]^
large cities, and inhabited by people superior to those he
had already seen, but he could hear of none. Some of
the Indians told him that four or five days' journey
further into the interior there was a great plain at the
foot of a mountain, which contained a number of large
towns, and that the people were clad in cotton. Niza
exhibited to these Indians several varieties of metals, iu
order to learn if any such were to be found in tliat counr
try. They took up the gold and told him there were
many vessels of that metal among the people who inhal>-
ited. the plain, " and that they carried certain round green
stones hanging at their nostrils and at their ears, and
that they have certain thin plates of that gold wherewith
they scrape off their sweat, and that the walls of their
temple are covered therewith, and that they use it in all
their household vessels." He postponed an exploration
of the plain until his return, as it was a considerable dis-
tance in the interior, anci he was instructed not to leave
the sea-coast.
He DOW traveled for three days through a country
118 THE CX)NQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
inhabited by these same Indians, at the end of which
time he arrived at a town of "reasonable bigness," called
Vacupa, where he was well received by the inhabitants
and furnished with an abundance of provisions. It was
situated about forty leagues from the sea, and the sur-
rounding country was fruitful and capable of being
watered. He arrived there two days before Passion-
Week, and remained until after Easter for the purpose
of informing himself of the country and the people.
He sent three parties to the sea-coast with directions
to bring in some of the inhabitants of the coast and
from the adjacent islands, from whom he hoped to ob-
tain information of those rcigions. He also dispatched
Stephen, with instructions to proceed directly to tlie
Northward the distance of fifty or three-score leagues^ to
search for anything of interest in that direction. It was
agreed between liim and Niza, before starting, that if he
should discover anything of but little importance he was
to send back a white cross of one handful in length ; but
if he should learn of a country greater and better to the
North-east he was to send back a great cross. The friar
further instructed Stephen, that in case he should gain
information of a rich and well-peopled country he was
not to proceed any further on his journey, but return in
person or send back an Indian with the intelligence.
The negro set out on the afternoon of Passion-Monday.
In four days a messenger came to Niza with intelligence
from Stephen, bearing a cross as large and high as a man.
He sent word that he had arrived among a people who
gave him information of a mighty province, and that there
were Indians in his company who had been there. He
requested the friar to leave Vacupa immediately and fol-
low him. An Indian who was acquainted with this
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 119
province accompanied the messenger and gave Niza an
account of the new country. He said it was a journey
of thirty days from the town where the negro then was
to the first city of said province, which was called Cibola ;a
that the province contained seven great cities in all, un-
der the dominion of one lord ; that the houses were built
3 In ezamining the early liistory of New Mexico I have been able^
locate the ancient city, or grillage, of Cibola with accuracy, and
which heretofore has been a matter of speculation. The situation is
identical with the present pueblo of Zufli, of which the reader will find
abundant evidence in this volume, although the town of Cibola may
not have stood upon the exact spot where modern ZaUi is situated, as
there are indications that the pueblo has been located at two or three
different points.
The present pueblo of ZuM is situated on the North side of the creek
of the same name a few miles above its Junction with the Little Colo-
rado, and contains about one thousand inhabitants. The houses arc
clustered together upon an eminence which rises eeme twenty feet above
the surrounding plain ; they are one and two stones high and some of
the rooms are large. About the centre of the pueblo are an old
church and monastery, both now in a ridned condition. The streets
are both narrow and crooked.
Some twelve or fifteen miles above this pueblo on the same creek are
ihe ruins of another yillage called Old Zufli, which has been abandoned
for a number of years ; though the fields around the ruins are still cul-
tivated by the Zuili Indians, and som*e of the houses are occupied during
the summer months, and the fall of the year unlil the crops are gathered,
^(any of these houses are entirely under ground, without ventilation
except through a small aperture in the top^ while others are built with
one story above ground, of rude stones laid in mud and covered with
earth. About three miles above these ruins there is a fine bold spring
of good water gushing out at the head of a hollow, with the ruins of
another old pueblo on both sides. The spring is walled up with stone
in the form of a horse-shoe, with the wail on three sides elcyated above
the ground, while to the westward the water escapes in a fine, clear
brook. These latter ruins are entirely of stone without any appearance
of mortar, and appear to have been abandoned for ages.
The ruins near the spring appear to be the point where the Zufii
Indians established themselves a very long time ago, and their extent
voald lEdicate that at that .time the population was not more tluui
120 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXIOOi
of pine and stones, and were large and commodious ; tbair
the least of them were one story in height, and some
were two and three ; and the dwelling of the lord of the
province was four stories high. All the houses were
joined one to another, in good order, and in the gates of
the principal ones there were set many turquoises,
oi^-ibird as maoy as at present. When the population became more
numerous the land susceptible of cultivation around the village was
^und to be insufflcient for the inhabitants, and they removed down
the creek to the site of Old Zu&i. Again the population became too*
numerous to subsist at the latter place, and the land also becoming
exhausted fVom cultivation, another removal was made to the site of
the present pueblo, which is considerably larger than the former appear
to have been.
Some fifteen or eighteen miles East of the ruins at the spring is a
large perpendicular sandstone rock, called Inscription Rock. It Juts-
out from the hill several hundred yards in the form of a triangle, with
the accute angle pointing eastward, and is nearly two hundred feet in
height. This rock has a great number of names, inscriptions and
hycroglyphics t:ut upon its face, some of them bearing date about three
hundred years ago. At the base of the southern face near its junction
with the hill is a pool of not very good water, surrounded by a cluster
of small trees. The present pueblo of Zuiii is near an hundred and
fifty miles West of the Rio del Norte, and about the same distance be-
yond the settlements in the valley of that riyer. This pueblo, like all
others in the territory, is an indepehdout community, and among the
officers annually elected is one whose duty it is to take care of the sun
and moon. Among the records of the early explorations in New
Mexico which fell into my hands in the Secretary's office, Santa Fe',
was a portion of the manuscript journal of captain general Don Do-
mingo Jeronso Petriz de Cruzate, who marched into the country in
T688 to subdue the Indians. He mentions, among other things, that
in the time of Philip II., of Spain, Ziuii was known as the ** Buffalo-
Province." Now, as Philip was upon the throne within twenty years
after the expedition of Coronado, and many of the men living who
were engaged in it, and as many other Spaniards visited the Cibola
country, which was afterward named Zuiii, before his death, J believe^
}vam justified in pronpuncing the evidence conclusive on the point.
This point being settled the tracing of the route of Ck>Eonado is com-
paratively easy. . .
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 12 1
iigeniouBly wrought; that the people of Cibola were
well-dressed, and that beyond this were many other
provinces all greater than that of the Seven Cities.
The friar was greatly pleased at the receipt of this
intelligence. He placed full confidence in all the Indian
told him for the reason that he found him " a man of good,
understanding." Believing that Stephen would await
his arrival at the place where he then was, he deferred
his departure to join him until the return of those he had.
sent to the sea-coast. They reached Vacupa on Easter
day, bringing with them some of the inhabitants. They
also brought back some sluelds made of cow-hides, very
well dressed, and large enough to cover the entire person,
from head to foot, with a hol^ in the top to look through.
They were made so strong it was said a cross-bow could,
not pierce them. They informed Niza that both the
islands and the coast were scarce of provisions ; but that
gold abounded in great quantities, and the inhabitants
wore shells of pearls upon their foreheads. The people
of the islands traded with those of the main-land, crossing-
over on rafts.
The same day three Indians, called Pintados,* arrived,
at Vacupa on a visit to Niza. They lived far up in the
interior toward the East, some upon the borders of the
country of the Seven Cities, and were so named because
their faces, breasts and arms were painted. They con-
firmed the information received from the messengers of
Stephen, in all essential particulars. In the meantime,
the negro sent other messengers and a new cross as large
as the first, to the friar, with information that the land.
4 There is a race of Indians to this day in Mexico, caUed ** Pintos,'*
for the same reason, who are considered the bravest men of the coan«>
iwf, and arc probably the descendants of. these same Pintados..
122 THE CONQUEST PF NEW MEXICO. '
which he sought was the greatest and best country in all
those parts. From thein he also learned many things
that were new concerning the seven cities. He sent the
Indians of the sea-coast back to their country, retaining
those of the islands who promised to accompany him a
•seven or eight days journey toward Cibola.
This information hastened the departure of Niza from
A^acupa. lie made immediate arrangements to resume
his march, and on Easter Tuesday he set out accompanied
by the Indians of the islands and the Pintados. He
traveled in the direction that Stephen had taken, and in
three days he arrived among a people who told him that
a man might reach the cities of Cibola from that place in
ii journey of thirty days. From them he-gained a more
exact knowledge of the country and the inhabitants.
They informed him that besides these seven cities there
were other kingdoms which were called Marata, Acus
«md Totonteal. Upon these Indians being asked why
they had traveled so far from their homes, they answered
that they were going in search of turquoises, hides of
cattle and other things which abounded in the Cibola
country ; that they were in the habit of going into the
first cities of the province and serving the inhabitants by
tilhng the soil and in other occupations, for which they
received in exchange, hides and turquoises ; that the in-
habitants of Cibola, this being the name of the first of the
seven, wore fine turquoises hanging from their ears and
nostrils, and the gates of the principal houses were
oramented with them in beautiful workmanship; that they
dressed in a gown of cotton which reached to the feet,
with a button at the neck and a long string hanging
down from the same ; the sleeves were as broad beneath
as above, and the waist was encircled with a girdle made
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
123
of turquoises. Some wore over their coats dresses of
tanned skins which were esteemed the best n^aterial in
the country, and others wore a still different material.
The women dressed in gowns of the same description.
These Indians entertained Niza with great hospitality,
and were, anxious to know when he would return to
Vacupa, so that they could furnish him with food and
lodgings. They brought the sick to him to be healed,
and sought to touch his garments, under the belief that
they contained. some hidden virtue. They gave him a
number of cow-hides which had come from Cibola, which
were so well tanned, and dressed, and trimmed with such
taste, that they appeared to have been prepared by a
civilized people.
124 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO*
CHAPTE.E XVII
NIZA CONTINUES HIS JOURNEY, AND HEARS OF THE DEATH.
OF STEPHEN.
NiZA again resames his journey, taking with him only
the Pintados. The same day he came to another village
where the inhabitants likewise received him with kind-
ness, and sought to touch his garments. They gave him
substantially the same account of the country of the Seven
Cities as he had already received. Here he found a large
cross, which the negro had set up as a sigi> that the news
of a good country was more encouraging, and had left
word that he intended to hasten forward as rapidly as
possible, but would wait for the friar at the edge of the
first desert he should come to. Several of the inhabitants
had accompanied Stephen on his journey, but had not
yet returned. Before Niza left this place he set up two
crosses and took possession of the country as far as that
point, in accordance with his instructions.
Niza- now traveled five days through a country well-
peopled and abounding in villages. He was everywhere
well received and hospitably entertained by the Indians
and had given to him presents of turquoises and ox-hides.i.
i.No doubt these '* ox. hides " were tanned buffalo skins.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 125
•
Here lie received additional information aboitt Cibola.
He was told that in two days he would come to a desert
v.'hcre there was no food to be had, and that in order to
supply his wants some of their people had been sent for-
v.'ard to carry provisions and prepare lod«;ings for hiui.
This induced him to hasten on, for he hoped to find
Stephen at the further side of this desert, as he had
promised to wait for him at that point.
Before he arrived at the desert he came to a very con-
siderable village, pleasantly situated, and sui)plied with
an abundance of water conveyed thither by artificial
means. Many of the inhabitants, both men and w^meu,
were dressed in cotton garments, while others were cov-
ered with ox-hides, which were generally esteemed in the
country the best article of apparel. They wore turquoises
suspended .from their nostrils and ears as ornaments,
which they called Cacona^ and the wearing of them was
called CascoJiados. Among those who came to pay their
respects to Niza was the Lord of the village and his two
brothers, who. were well-dressed in cotton, with a collar
of turquoises about the neck, and others suspended from
their ears and nose. To manifest their good will toward
the friar they offered, him many turquoises, dressed ox-
liides, beautiful drinking vessels, besides conies,* quails,
maize, pine-nuts, and other articles none of which would
he accept. They were much pleased with the garment
he wore, which they touched with their iiands and exam-
ined. They informed him there was an abundance of
such cloth in the province of Totonteal and that the peo-
ple of that country dressed in clothes made of it. lie
laughed at this and told them the material was the same
as the cotton garments they themselves wore ; to which
t Rabbits.
126 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
the Indians replied : "We would have thee think that
we understand that that apparel which thou wearest and
that which we wear are of divers sorts. Understand thou
that in Cibola all the houses are full of that apparel which
we wear, tod in Totonteal there are certain little beasts
from whom they take that thing whereof such apparel as
thou wearest is made." The friar was deeply interested
in this relation and was anxious to know more about the
matter. He inquired more particularly of the Indians
about the little beasts, and was told thev were about the
size of the two spaniels that Stephen carried with him
and were to be found in great abundance in Totonteahs
In one day from the last mentioned village Niza arrived
at the desert and continued on across it. About noon
he came to the bank of a river where aij abundance of
victuals was prepared for him and a bower built for his
accommodation. He found the same provision made for
him where he encamped at night, and also during the
four days he was crossing the desert. At the end of this
time, he entered a valley well-inhabited. Soon afterward
he came to a village where he met many people, both
men and women, bearing him victuals, all of whom wore
•
turquoises suspended from their nostrils and ears, and
some had collars of the same around the neck. These
necklaces were single, while those worn by the Lord and
people of the village on the other side of the desert were
three or four times double. The inhabitants were dressed
in skins, the women wearing good waist-coats and other
garments, with turquoises in the nostrils and ears.
These Indians professed to have much knowledge of
3 These '* little beasts" were probably a species of mountain sheep
which famished the wool from which the Indians wore their gar^*
rncnts.
THE CONQUEST CP KEW MEXICO. 12T
Cibola. Tliey gave Niza a particular account of the
manner in which the people built their houses, their
lodgings and their market places. They told liim they
had often been to Cibola where they procured all the
necessary articles for the household, and they confirmed
all he had previously heard. He doubted that tlie houses
were built in the manner related, when the Indians to
satisfy him that such was the case, " took earth and poured
water thereupon and showed him how they laid stones
upon it, and how the building grew up as they continued
laying stones thereon until it mounted aloft."* He asked
if the men of that country had wings by which they were
enabled to ascend into these lofts, when they showed liira
a well-made ladder and told him that by such means
they ascended to them. They then took a staff which
they held up over theu* heads and said the lofts were of
that height, one above another. Here he received addi-
tional information about the woolen cloth of Totonteal,
and further particulars of the country ; that it was a great
province with the houses built in the same manner as
those of Cibola, but were better constructed and in
greater numbers. The province he was now in had no
governor.
Continuing his journey he traveled through this valley
five days, which he found populous and fertile. It was
well watered and under a high state of cultivation ; and
provisions were so abundant that Niza believed three
thousand horsemen CQuld have been sustained there.
Some of the villages were a half, and others a quarter of
a league long. In all of them through which he passed
he heard many reports of the seven cities, and the in-
habitants gave such particular accounts as might be
4 From Ike Spanish Ms.
128 THE CONQUEST OF SEW MEXICO.
expected from a people who were in close intercoarse
ivith those of whom they spoke. Here he saw a man who
■was born in Cibola, but liad escaped from tlie governor
or lieutenant of tlie town, and fled to this valley. Ho
eaid the Lord of the province lived in one of the towns
called Apacus, but appointed lieutenants in all the others
under liis control. Tliis Indian was of a light complexion
and resembled a European ; was well advanced in years
and exhibited more intelligence than the people of the
'salley, or any he had previously seen. He yraa anxious
to return to Cibola, and promised Niza to go there with
iiim if he would intercede with the authorities to induce
them not to punish him for running 'away.
From this Indian Niza learned many additional par-
ticulai-s of the country and the towns. He represented
Cibola as a great city inhabited by a niimeroua population
with many streets and market places ; that in some pnit^
of it there were great houses of five stories liigh in which
the chief men of the place assembled at certain seasons of
■the year ; tlutt the houses were of hme and stone, and the
{jates and smaller jtilhtrs of tlie principal lionscs wore
made of turquoises, and all tlie drinking and ornamental
vessels were of gold. Tlie .other cities of the proviuco
-were built in the same niamier as Cil>ola, some of them
'{icing larger, and that Apacus, the residence of the lonl
of the province, was the greatest of tliem all. He stated
'that toward the South-east from Cibola there was a king-
dom called JIarata, wliich contained many great cities,
the houses of which were built with numerous hifts ; and
that on account of the frequent wars between these two
kingdoms the towns of" the latter were, for the most })art,
■buvroiinded by walls. iVt this time tlierc was peace
.Iwtwecn JIarata and the seven cities. «
jyHE CONQUEST ^F NEW tMEXIC©. 129
He represented the kingdom of Totonteal as an exten-
-oive province situated toward the West with a numerous
^population and great riches ; the inhabitants dressed in
woolen cloth such as that worn by the friar, and others of
a finer texture made of the fleece of the animal before
described to him. They were said to be a quiet and
peaceable people. He also spoke of the province of
Acus, said to be extensive and not a great distance from
Cibola. He confirmed all that Niza had previously heard
•concerning the people of Cibola and their mode of dress,
with additional information of their customs; among
which was that they slept upon beds with canopies over
them, and had quilts which they spread upon the beds-
Many of tlie inhabitants of the valley related to him the
same things in substance, but with less particularity.
These relations of the Indians gave Niza renewed hope,
and he resumed his journey with pleasing anticipations.
He traveled three days longer through the valley, being
followed by a considerable number of the natives. Ho
encountered many of the inhabitants who, as usual, pro-
vided him with provisions and other necessaries. He
saw more than a thousand ox-hides well dressed and
tanned, and also a great numb«r of turquoises, many of
which had been manufactured into chains. He was told
tliey had been brought from the city of Cibola, where
there was great abundance, and thaf they also abounded
in the kingdoms of Marata, Acus and Totonteal.5 There
was exhibited to him a hide half as big again as the hide
of an ox, which they represented as the " skin of a beast
that had but one horn upon his forehead, and tliat tliis
horn bendeth toward his head, and that out of the samo
.goeth a point right forward wherein he hath so great
5 This is written Totonteac in some-parts of the old record.
9
130 THE COITQUEST OP SEW MEXICO.
strength that it will break anything how Btrong soever it
may be, if he run against it, and that there are great
store of these beasts in that country. Tlie color of the
hide is of the color of a great goat skin, and the hair is a
finger thick."
Here Niza received other nw-ssengera from Stephen
^ith later information of his whereabouta. He sent word
to the friar that he had arrived at the extremity of the
desert, and the further he advanced the more he wa*
enconn^ed with tlie news he received concerning the
country. Tlie Indians had not deceived him in anything,
bvit as he advanced he found the condition of things the
same as represented. He had set np crosses in all the
country he passed through, and used such ceremonies in
taking possession of the same as he deemed necessary
nnder his instructiona.
TIic Indians requested Niza to remain in their country
three or four days to make the neceseary preparations to
cross the desert. They told him that from tliat place to
tho desert was a journey of four days, and i'rom the first
entrance into it to the cities of Cibnla was fifteen days
more ; that if he would tarry there they would provide
him victuals and other necessaries for the trip, and would
likewise furnish him witli men to carry his baggage. He
accepted their offer and remained with them a tew days.
These Indians were not entirely disinterested. Thoy
hoped by accompanying Niza to Cibola to be able to re-
turn loaded with riches. He spent the time he remained
among this people in obtaining information of the country
he was going to, with the manners and customs of the
people, and other knowledge that might be useful to him^
For tiiis purpose he called before him a number of the
Indians and examined them separately, wlio agreed in tlie
«»»unt thej gave of the population of Cibola, die or^r
of the streets, the number of the houses, and the gtrength
*of the gates* At the end of three days a great multitude
assembled to occompany him, of whom he selected thirty
of the principal men for companions, who were well
dressed and wore strings of turquoises, and a number of
others to carry the provisions and baggage.e
Thus provided and accompanied Niza resumed his
journey, and on the 9th of May he entered the great
desert The first day he traveled a very broad and well-
beatep path* The Indians went in advance to prepare
accommodations for him, and at noon he arrived at a place
where there was water and where he found dinner pro*
vided. At night he encamped at another watering-place
where they had prepared a house for his accommodation
with the necessary provisions for his supper. Here he
rested until morning. This point appeared to be the
usual stopping-place for those going to, and returning
from, Cibola, as there were several old cottages standing
about and many signs of fire having been kindled. The
Indians pointed out the hut they had erected for Stephen
when he passed along, and in which he had lodged. He
thus traversed the desert, living upon the flesh of wild
animals and partridges provided for him by the Indians,
who also supplied all his other wants. He had advanced
twelve days toward Cibola, when an Indian who had
4iccompanied Stephen, and a son of one of the principal
men then with Niza, came to him in great fright and with
s, countenance full of sadness announced the death of the
negro. He related the particidars of the manner in which
6 For some days, up to this time, Niza was, undoubtedly, traveling
along ttie valley of the river Qila, and when he left it he changed his
course more to the Nortk-easU
182 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXIOa
it took place, an account of which will be given in the
next chapter.
bW.1^.- ...
THE C0NQUE8T OF HEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER XVIII
WHAT HAPPENED TO STEPHEN AT CIBOI^ ; NIZA RETURNS
TO NEW SPAM.
The last information that Niza received of Stephen,
before he heard of his death, was tranamittcd from the
valley whero he made preparationa to cross the great
desert. He made the passage of the desert in sirfety,
accompanied by three hundred Indians, who carried his
baggage and provisions and attended to all his wants.
From this point lie again resumed the march for Cibola
imd advanced through the country without molestation,
the inhabitants everywhere receiving him with kindness,
giving him turquoises; and presenting him with beautiful
females for slaves. He carried in liis hand a great mace
made of a gourd with a string of bells upon it, and two
feathers, one white and the other red, the whole being a
symbol of peace. It was his custom when he arrived
near a town, or in the neighborhood of a new people, to
fiend the mace forward by the hands of a messenger to
nnnounce his coming. When within three days' journey
of Cibola he sent the mace to the town bj some Indians,
with instmctions to say that he came upon a friendly
134 rSE CONQUEST OF VEVT IfBXICO.
mission and requested a safe conduct. Upon their arrival
they were taken before the chief-magistrate, whom the
Lord of the province had placed there as his lieutenant^
to whom they delivered the mace. He took it into his
hands to examine, but when he saw the bells he dashed
it upon the ground in a great rage and ordered the mes-
sengers to leave iqamediately. He said he knew well
what kind of people they tvere and that they would not
be allowed, upon any account, to enter the town, but if
they should he would put them all to death. The mes-
sengei's were much alarmed, and returned and announced
the result of their mission to Stephen ; who replied that
it made but little difference whether they would give him
permission, or not, to enter Cibola, as he intended to
proceed on his journey until he should arrive thither.
He resumed his march and in due time presented him-
self before Cibola. He foimd a number of the inhabitants
awaiting his arrival, as they suspected his coming was for
an hostile purpose. He was not permitted to enter the
town, but was made prisoner and confined in a large
house outside, where he was closely guarded. He wa&
plundered of aU he possessed, including many articles he
had brought to barter with the inhabitants, and numerous
turquoises the Indians had given him on the way. They
kept him confined that night without meat or drink. The
next day the old men and the caciques assembled in coun-
cil and had him brought before them, when they questioned
liim as to his motives in coming into their country: He
told tliem that he preceded two white meni who had been
sent thither by their master, a mighty prince, to explore-
the country, and that they were deeply learned in heav-
1 One of the Mats, rX will be remembered, was left behind, sick^ at
FetaUan.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 135
enly things in which they would instruct the people of
Cibola. The Indians did not believe this statement, but
thought him a spy from some powerful nation that wished
to ctoquer them ; and above all it seemed impossible that
he could come from a country of white men as he was so
black himself. Besides the suspicious circumstances at-
tending his arrival, and the natural prejudice of the
Indians against strangers, Stephen's own conduct placed
him in a still more unfavorable light. He was haughty,
unreasonable in his demands, and treated the people
without the least consideration. He commanded them
to surrender to him their riches and their women, which
they refused. His conduct satisfied the Indians that he
was a dangerous man and ought not to be allowed to
regain his liberty. They questioned him for four days,
and after deliberating upon the case, with all the care its
importance demanded, they resolved to put him to death.
If the journal of friar Niza is to be rehed upon, the
negro was not executed in accordance with the sentence
1^>ut was killed while attempting to escape. Early the
next morning after liis sentence, about sun-rise, some of
the chiel-men took liim from his place of confinement and
-conducted him toward the town. On their way they
encountered a large crowd of people coming out, and
when he saw them he became alarmed and started to run.
The Indians immediately opened a fire of arrows upon
him and those who had accompanied him to Cibola, kil-
ling and wounding many as they ran ; and as Stephen
was not seen again it is supposed fliat he was among
the number slain. Of all those who had come with liina
hut three escaped, the young Indian who brought the
information to Niza, and two others. The former was
tOn his way to the river that ran near the town, to get a
136 THE CONQUEST OF NEW HEXIOO.
3rink of water, when the attack was made. BecomiDg
alarmed for his life he hid himself upon the river bank
and afterward made his escape into the desert. The two
other Indians were wounded during the firing an* fell
eovered with blood, buried under the slain. Here they
remained all day, as they did not dare to get up for fear
of being seen and killed. From where they lay they had
a good view of tiie town, and saw many men and women
keeping watch upon the walls,- and heard noises inside as
though the people were astir. At night they made their
escape and succeeded in regaining the desert, where they
joined some friendly Indians, among whom was the ono
who had hid upon the river bank.*
The news of tlie deatli of Stephen and the hostility of
tlie inhabitants of Cibola gave Niza great alarm. They
placed liim on his guard, and he resolved not to sacrifice
his life, wilfully, as the negro appeared to have done. To
create a favorable influence upon the Indians he told
them that God would punish the inhabitants of Cibola^
and that when the viceroy should hear what had hap-
pened he would send an lU'my of Christians to chastise
them. But this they did not believe and said that no
man was able to stand against the power of that city.
The poor friar was in great uncertainty as to the course he
ought to pursue under the circumstances, and his situation
caused him serious reflection. To increase his difliculties
an Indiam named Marcus, whom he had brought with
2 There is difference of opinion among the old chroniclers as to tho
number of those who made their escape from Cibola at the time
Stephen was killed. Castafieda says: *' Those who came with hiuY
were allowed to go away In safety except some young boys whom they
retained for slaves." He enumerates the whole numb^ who made
their escape and joined the monk at about sixty, while Niza says that
but three escaped of all those who accompanied the negro thkher.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICa 137
him from Mexico, told him that he had overheard those
who accompanied him across tlie desert consulting about
putting him to death, because they attributed the death
of their friends and relatives at Cibola to liim and Stephen.
In order to appease them he divided among them the
few articles he had retained, which, in some measure, had
the desired effect, but they still exhibited great grief at
the loss they had sustained. He wanted some of them
to go to Cibola in order to ascertain more reliable infor-
mation of the fate of Stephen and whether other Indians
had escaped, but this they declined to do.
Upon the refusal of the Indians to return to Cibola
Niza told them that he intended to see the town at all
hazards and in spite of the dangers that beset him.
When they saw that he was determined to return two of
the chiefs, his interpreters and some others, signified their
willingness to go with him. They 'resumed the journey
immediately and arrived in sight of the town without
accident. His journal relates that he found it situated
upon a plain at the foot of a round hill, and in order to
obtain a better view of it he ascended a neighboring
mountain. It presented the appearance of a large place
and was better situated than any other town he had seen*
The houses were built of stone, several stories high, with
flat roofs, and arranged in good order. The inhabitants
were of light complexion, and dressed in cotton goods
and skins. They slept in beds. Their offensive weapons
were the bow and arrow. They possessed many emeralds
and other precious stones, but valued turquoises above
all others. With these they adorned the porches of their
houses and their dresses, and used them for many other
purposes of ornament. They had vessels of gold and
silver, which were said to be in greater use and more
138 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
abundant than in Peru. There was said to be no other
kinds of metal in the country, and they were principally
obtained from the province of Pintado, in exchange for
turquoises, where rich mines were said to exist.!
Niza was not able to obtain any certain and- correct
information concerning other kingdoms. He was tempted
several times to visit some of them ; but when he reflected
that if his life should be lost in the attempt the knowledge
which he had gained of the country and the people would
die with him he was deterred from the undertaking.
When he told the two ciiiefs who accompanied him what
a commodious city Cibola seemed to be, they answered
that it wa9 the least of the sevjen cities, that Totonteal
was the best and greatest of them all, with a great num-
ber of houses and a large population. Having obtained
all the information possible concerning the province of
the Seven Cities, with a description of the country and
the manners and customs of the inhabitants, he took
formal possession thereof in the name of the " most hon-
orable Lord Antonio de Mondoza, viceroy and captain-
general of New Spain," for His Majesty the Emperor.
With the aid of the Indians he raised a heap of stones
upon the mountain and erected thereon a small wooden
cross, the symbol of taking possession. He named the
province of Cibolo IHl Nuevo Reyno de San Francisco^
The New Kingdom of Saint Francis. By this same act
he also took formal possession of the pro\ances of Toton-
teal, Acus and Marata.
Having completed this ceremony, and made the neces-
sary preparations for the march homeward, he set out
from Cibola on his return to New .Galicia ; and, in the
3 The accounts given by subsequent explorers prove that Niza's
statements about Cibola were greatly exaggerated.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 139
•
words of the friar himself, he " retarned with more fear
than victuals." At the end of two days he reached the
place where the Indians had remained behind, with whom
he traveled until he had crossed the great desert. Here
he found the inhabitants in great grief for the loss of
their relatives and friends who had been killed at Cibola
with Stephen, and they were not able to entertain him as
they had done before. He therefore hastened from the
valley, and traveling at the rate of eight •r ten leagues
each day he did riot take rest until he had crossed the
second desert.
Considering himself now out of danger he turned aside
from the direct route homeward to visit the great plain
extending to the East from the foot of the mountains,
which is mentioned in a previous chapter. He entered
upon the edge of it, whence he saw, at a distance, several
towns of considerable size, situated in a beautiful green
valley, with a fruitful soil, and from which many rivers
ran. He was told that gold abounded in this valley,
which the people worked into vessels, and thin plates
" wherewith they strike and take off their sweat." They
would not permit the inhabitants of the other side of the
plain to trade with them. Learning that this plain was
not inhabited for many days' journey he was afraid to
enter upon it and extended his discoveries no further in
that direction. He deemed it advisable to leave future
explorations in that region until the country should be
occupied by the Spaniards, when they could be prose-
cuted with more safety, and to return immediately to
New Spain and give an account of the things he had
already seen. Here he likewise set up two crosses, and
took possession of the valley and the plain, as he had
done before at Cibola and the neighboring provinces.
k.
140 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
He now resumed bis jourDey and made all poB^ble
haste until he arrived at the town of San Michael whence
he had started. He expected to find the governor of
New Galecia at this place, but learning that he was at
Compostella, he proceeded thither, where he arrived in.
safety, and related to him an account of his discoveries
and adventures. The whole distance from Cibola td
Culiacan was estimated at three hundred leagues.
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 141
CHAPTER XIX.
THE FEIAE RELATES HIS DISCOVERIES TO CORONADO ; A
SPANISH ARMY MARCHES FOR CIBOLA.
During the absence of Niza, Coronado was principally
employed in managing the affairs of his government and
anxiously awaiting his return. In the meantime he
made an expedition to the North into the province of
Topeza, of which the most flattering accounts had been
^ given him. He collected a few Spaniards and Indian
allies and penetrated some distance into the interior, but
he found everything very different from what it had been
represented. The mountains were high and rugged, and
could only be crossed with great difliculty; and the
whole appearance of the country was uninviting in the
extreme. He immediately returned to Culiacan where
he found Niza who had just arrived from Cibola.
The friar gave Coronado the most exaggerated account
of all that he had seen and been ' told by the Indians,
which excited his mind to such degree that he determined
to take Niza to Mexico in order that he might relate the
same to the viceroy. They pretended to make the matter
a great secret and thereby magnify its importance. Upon
arriving in Mexico they obtained an audience of *hc
i
142 THE (X)NQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
viceroy, who lent a willing ear to the narrative. The
friar said that he had found the country of the Seven
Cities which Guzman had searched for in vain; had dis-
covered islands in the South Sea filled with untold wealth ;
and that he was engaged in raising an* army to conquer
them. The influence of both the viceroy and the church
was enlisted in the cause, and soon all the pulpits
resounded with most wonderful accounts of these un-
known regions.
Such an interest was exdited upon the subject that in
a few days an army of four hundred Spaniards and eight
hundred Indians was raised for the conquest of Cibola.
The viceroy appointed Don Francisco Vasquez Coronado,
captain-general of the expedition, both because he was
the reputed author of the discovery, and a great favorite.
He is represented as a ''good gentleman, and a wise,
prudent and able man ;" but the chronicler of the expe-
dition intimates that he thought more of the riches and
the lovely wife ho left behind in New Spain, than of the
honor he enjoyed in leading such a numerous company of
gallant gentlemen. A majority of the Spaniards who
took part in the enterprise are reputed to have been w/en
of good families, and Ctistaiieda, i who accompanied them,
says in his journal, '' I doubt whether there has ever been
1 But little is known of Castafteda the historian of tho expedition.
As bis name is not found in the list of officers, it is supposed that he
was a common soldier. lie was evidently a man of education and ac-
customed to writing ; and his narrative is superior to most of those
composed at that period. Upon the return of the Spaniards to New
Sp^ from Cibola, he established himself at Ouliacan where he wrote
his work. lie left it behind him in manuscript covering one hmidred
and forty-seven pages, written on paper in characters of the time^,
and covered with parchment. It was preserved in the collection of
D*Ugulaa, Paris, and was translated and publisbed in French for the
first time by H. Temaux Gampans, in ISdS.
THE COKQUEST OP ICEW MEXICO. 143
collected in the Indias so brilliant a troop^ particulai*ly
for the small number of four hundred men."
The viceroy having caused Coronado to be proclaimed
and recognized as captain-general, -proceeded to appoint
the captains and other chief officers. Castafieda says:
" He chose for standard-bearer of the army Don Pedro de
Tobar, a young cavalier, son of Don Hernando de Tobar,
chief Mayor-Domo of the late queen Joanna, our legiti-
mate sovereign whose soul be in God's keepiug. Ho
gave the place of Colonel to Lope de Saraaniego,
governor of the arsenal of Mexico, and a chevalier well
wortliy this station. The captains were Don Tristan de
Arellano, Don Pedro de Quevara, son of Don Juan d(5
Qaevara, and nephew of the count of Oiiate, Don Garcia
Lopez de Cardenas, Don Eodrigo llaldonado, brother-in-
law of the duke of Infantado, Diego Lopez, member of the
council of Sevilla, and Diego Gutierrez, captain of
cavalry." IJesides these enumerated there were many
other distinguished cavaliers who held no command or
rank, but were placed under the immediate orders of the
captain-general.
The expedition being fully organized, the viceroy
designated Corapostella,* the capital of New Galecia, and
one hundred and ten leagues from Mexico, as the point
where the army was to assemble. It marched to the
place of rendezvous in separate columns, owing to the
difficulty of subsisting the whole command in a body :
and the detachment to which Castaiieda was attached ar-
rived there in good order on Shrove Tuesday, 1540. At
the same time two vessels under the command of Don
Pedro Alarcon, were ordered to sail from Natividad and
t CompoBtella is an unimportant Mexican town situated in tlie State
of Jalisco, a few miles Soatli^ast of San Bias, on tlie Pacific coast.
/
I
./
i44 THE 'CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
follow the coast as far as Xalisco, in order to transport
Biich ba^jgage as the soldiers could not carry with them.
He was directed to continue along the coast in commu-
nication with the army on its march to Cibola, but the
route of Ooronado diverged so much toward the interior
that the land and sea forces could not hold intercourse
with each other.
After all the detachments were in march, the viceroy
left Mexico for Compostella accompanied by a numerous
company of gentlemen. He was received and welcomed
everywhere w;th many demonstrations of delight. He
spent New Year's day at Pascuaro, the capital of Mic-
hoacan, where festivities were held in honor of his
arrival. He found all the troops assembled at Compostella
when he arrived there. After reviewinc: the army, he
addressed the soldiers upon the importance of the
expedition they were about to undertake, and the great
results that would probably flow from the discovery and
settlement of the country of the Seven Cities. He
impressed upon them the duty they owed their officens
and caused each one to take an oath upon a missal con-
taining the four gospels, to obey their general in every
particular, and never abandon liim. He also obliged the
officers to be acknowledged anew by the whole army.
The force, including Indians, servants and camp fol-
lowers, numbered some fifteen hundred men with a
thousand horses. There were collected, to drive along
with the army, five thousand sheep and one hundred and
fifty cows of Spanish breed, for the purpose of supplying
the new settlements that might be made. The arrange7
ments being now complete the array commenced its
march the next day after the arrival of the viceroy, being
•early in tlie month of January, 1541. The troqps as
I'HE COKQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 145
tliey marched out the city with colors flyin«r and trumpets
sounding, and with the bright beams of the morning sun
flashing upon the burnished armor of the proud cavaliers,
presented a martial and brilliant appearance. The officers
and men were burning with enthusiasm, and returned in
loud shouts the acclamations of the populace who thronged
the streets and homse-tops. The viceroy accompanied
the army two Says on the march, when he turned back
and retraced his steps toward Mexico.
While the aniiy is on the march let us leave it for a
moment and glance at the province of Culiacan, and tlie
manners and customs of the inhabitants. The town of
this name was the last inhabited place in the kingdom of
New Galecia and the first founded by Nufio de Guzman,
distant two hundred and ten leagues from the city of
Mexico. Tlie natives of the province spoke three prin-
<5ipal languages, besides numerous dialects of which no
mention is made. The first tribe enumerated was called
the Tahus, which was the most civilized and had made
some progress in a knowledge of the Catholic religion.
They were not cannibals, but wxre far sunk in supersti-
tion and savage fierceness. They worshipped the devil,
to whom they made offerings of their wordly goods ; and
they held in great veneration a large serpent which they
raised and preserved with care. They did not sacrifice
human victims. It was customary for women to devote
themselves to a life of -celebacy, in honor of whom great
and indecent festivals were held. All the caciques of the
district came together, and, in a state of nudity, danced
with the candidates for single-blessedness, after which the
ceremonies were concluded with beastly orgies* Upon
«uch occasions the women took upon themselves certain
obligations from which they were not released, althougli
10
146 THE co:>QUi:ST or new Mexico,
lliey miglit subsequently marry. Before marriage tlie
bride wns obliged to surrender her person to the cacique,
who was regarded as a kiud of high priest ; and if she
was not a virgin her parents were compelled to restore to
the husband all he had given her, and he also had the
choice of keeping her as his wife or forcing her to become
ii public woman. This was also the occasion of great
festivities and orgies. The second language of the prov*-
ince was that spoken by the Pacasas, a tribe less civiUzed
and intelligent than the Tahus, who ate human flesh and
worshipped stones. Poligamy prevailed among them, and
41 man married several sisters. They owned the country
between the plain and the mountains. The third and
last language was that spoken by the Acaxas, who diflfered
but little from tlie Pacasas. Theiy, also, were cannibals,
and hunted men to eat in the same manner as wild
animals. Thqy adorned tlieir houses with the skuUs and
bones of their victims, and tliose who could show the
greatest number of such trophies were most feared and
respected. They had frequent wars among themselves
when they devoured each other in great numbers. They
built their villages in places difficult of access and sepa-
rated by impassable ravines. Gold mines abounded in
the country, but none of them were very productive.
We took leave of the army two days out of Com*
postella, whence it advanced into the interior by easy
and regular marches. The troops were much en*,
cumbered with baggage, which had to be transported
on horses; and as the soldiers did not understand
packing the animals, they soon became so much dis*
couraged that many threw their baggage away rather
than be troubled with it. The most refined gentlemen
Mrere compelled to be their own muleteers., and necessity
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 147
tibliged the noble and the low-born to perform the same
menial service. After a fatiguing march the army
reached the village of Chiametla where the provi-
sions began to fail, and it was obliged to halt tliere for
some days in order to procure a fresli supply. While at
that place the colonel, Lope de Samaniego, was killed by
the Indians. His loss was deeply felt by the whole army.
^lle went out one day with a few men to a neigliboring
village, when the Indians suddenly fell upon them, killing
him by an arrow shot tlu-ough the head, and wounding
five or six .of liis men. His body was recovered and
buried with the honors of war. As punishment to the
Indians all the inhabitants of that village were put to
' death. Here some dissatisfaction arose among the troops,
and many desired to leave and return to Mexico.
While the army lay at Chiametla, two officers, Melchor
Bias and Juan de Saldibar, whom Coronado had dis-
patched with a dozen men to make an exploration toward
Cibola at the time he left Culiacan^to go to Mexico with
the friar, returned from their expedition. They had gone
as far as the great desert, when, becoming discouraged,
they turned back. When it became known in camp that
this party had made no important discoveries the ardor
of the troops abated. The friar, who seemed determined
that the expedition should advance at every hazard, took
it upon himself to contradict the rumors spread abroad,
and denied that Bias and Saldibar had failed in their
exploration ; but represented that th^ had discovered a
good country, and that all who were able to reach it would
be sure to return richer in worldly goods. This assured
the soldiers in some degree, though they were not fully
satisfied that what the holy father told them was true.
Having collected sufficient provisions, the army resumed
148 THE CONQUEST OF K£W HEXICOSr
its march toward Culiacan, and arrived within two leaguef^
of that place on Easter eve. The inhabitants came out
to welcome it, but requested Coronado to postpone his
entrance into the town until the day after the festivalr
and he accordingly encamped outside^
TUE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO* 149
CHAPTER XX.
-JCUE ARMY ENTERS CULIACAN ; CORONADO MARCHES IN
ADVANCE TO aBOLA.
TuE army entered Culiacan the next day after Easter.
The troops were met a short distance outside the town
by the inhabitants, who were drawn up in order of battle
in a large field and armed with cannon and small arms.
After some welcoming ceremonies had been held, the
opposing forces engaged in a sham fight for the amuse*
inent of the populace, the citizens falling back upon the
to\vn which the army assaulted and entered in triumpli.
This mimic warfare passed off with great eclat, and the
only accident recorded is that caused by the premature
discharge of a gun by which one man lost his arm. The
inhabitants whom Castaneda says were " all honorable
men," extended a generous hospitality to the army ;
receiving both officers and men into their houses, although
good quarters had been provided for them outside the town.
The chronicler of the expedition says that this kind treat-
ment was not disadvantageous to the inhabitants as the
-officers were obliged to leave with them the greater part
<Qf their baggage for want of transportation. He even
1j50 the conquest op msw Mexico.
intimates that the prospect of this spoil had something to
do with their hospitality.
The array rested at Culiacan a month ; provisions were-
plenty and the inhabitants supplied them liberally^
While here a little incident occurred which I record ii^
the words of the chronicler himself: " Sometime before
tiie departure of the general there happened a quite
amusing event which I wilLhere relate.^ A young soldier
named Truxillo pretended to have had a vision while
bathing in the river. He was brought before the general
in much alarm, and related that the demon had appeared
to him and said : * If thou wilt kill thy general I will
marry thee to Dona Beatrice his wife, and will give thee
great treasures.' He added a great many tales, and friar
ilarcos made thereupon a fine sermon, pretending that
the demon, alarmed at the fruit the expedition promised,
used all his efforts to prevent it. Not only was the whole
army persuaded of this, but the monks- who were in
company wrote it to their convents in Mexico, and for
u long time all the pulpits re-echoed this adventure, add-
ing to it a quantity of fables. The general ordered-
Truxillo to quit the army and remain at Culiacan, and it
was precisely for this that he had invented this deoeptioii
us was afterwards made known."
The general, impatient to penetrate the unknown country
of the Seven Cities, determined to go in advance with a
few chosen men, leaving the army to follow more at
leisure. Under the orders of the viceroy he appointed
Heniandarias Saaveard, his lieutenant, to replace him in
the government of the province during his absence ; and
Don Tristan de Arellano was named to succeed liim in
the command of tlie array. He set out fifteen days after
his arrival in Culiacan, taking with him fifty cavaliers.
a
.dhMMriHBilfiMu
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 151
few foot soldiers, his most iDtimate friends, and all the
monks, as none of the latter were willing to remain be*
hind. The army was to follow fifteen days afterward.
The little party took their departure in high spirits-
After marching three days a priest, named Antonio
Victorio, broke his thigh and was sent back to Culiacan,
wliich caused a little delay. Putting themselves en route
again, they traveled through the country without inter-
ruption. The Indians were all friendly ; many of them
having seen friar Marcos on his previous journey
professed great friendship for the Spaniards. Thoy
passed through the whole of the inhabited country and
arrived in good order at Chichilticale,i where the desert
1 We arc able to trace the march of Coronado and bis army tbrough
New Mexico without much if any doubt as to the course he took.
Leaving the town of Culiacan, in the Mexican State of Cinaloa, he
marched to the North-west nearly parallel to the coast of the gulf of
California. At what point he crossed the Gila river I am unable to
determine with any degree of accuracy, but suppose it to have been at
or near the place where the Casas Qrandes are located. The ruins
called Chichilticale I believe to have been upon the Gila, although no
mention is made of any river at or near that point ; but as few of the
many rivers the army crossed are mentioned in the Journal of Casta-
iieda, the failure to notice the Gila is no evidence against my location
of Chichilticale upon that stream.
The earliest records we have of New Mexico contain a notice of the
ruins of large houses on the Gila called Casas Grandes, the origin of
which has caused considerable speculation among antiquarians. Albert
Gallatin, in a paper addressed to the American Ethnological Society,
gives the following account of these ruins.
'* The ruins of ancient buildings, known by the name of Casas
Grandes, ascribed to the Azteques, and called the second and third
stations, are evidently of the same character as the ancient buildings of
Cibola ; most probably the remains of some of them. We have no
description of the most Southern of these Casas Grandes. The father
Pedro Pont has given the description of the great house situated near
the river Gila, considered as the second station of the Azteques, and
which he visited in the year 1775. The ruins of the houses which
J
152 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO*
begins. Coronado had now completed an important
i^tage in the expedition, and he was much dispirited and
out of heart at the result Thus far he had seen nothing:
that was encouraging. The country for the most part
foimed the town extended more than a league towaid the East, and
the ground was covered with broken vases and painted pottery.
** The house itself is a parallelogram, facing precisely the four cardinaV
points, East, West, North and South; extending seventy feet long:
from North to South, and fifiy wide from East to West. It consists of
five halls, three intervals, thirty-eight feet by twelve ; and they are
eleven feet high. The edifice had been three stories and probably
four, countmg one underground. There was no trace of stairs which
probably were wooden and burnt when the Apaches set the building
on fire. The whole building is made of eaith ; the interior walls being
four feet thick and well constructed, and the external six feet thick,
and shelving outside. The timber work consisted partly of mesquit^
principally of pine, though the nearest pine forest was twenty-five
leagues distant. Facing the eastern gate, whieh is separated from the
house, there is another hall twenty-six feet by eighteen, inside.
Toward the South-west there is a leauiant of construction one-stoiy
high. Around the whole there 'are indications of an external waU
which included the house and other buildings. The wall was, inside,,
four hundred and twenty-eight feet from North to South, and two hun-
dred and twenty-six from East to West. From some remains of mud
walls (torcbis), and some scattered blocks, it appears that there had
been a canal to bring water from the river to the town«"^
General Emory, of the United States army,, in his reconnoisance along
the Gila on his march to California, makes the following note of the
ruins upon tbatr stream r
** The ruins of the Gila were first seen in longitude about one hun-
dred and nine degrees, twenty minutes. Thence to the Pijmos village
distant about one hundred and sixty miles in a stvaight line, the rum»
were seen in great abundance, and wherever the mountains did not
shut out the valley. They are sufiicient to indieatc a very great former
population. In one place between one hundved and eleven and one
hundred and twelve degrees there is a long wide valley, twenty miles
in length, much of which is covered with the ruins of buildings and
broken pottery.
'* These ruins are uniformly of the same kind. Not one stone novr
remains on the top of another or above the ground. They are dis-
coverable hy the brokea potteiy in the vicinity^ and by stones laid Ia
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICOw 163
was monntainous and barren, and only inhabited by un-
civilized and wretched Indians. Chichiltieale, instead of
being a fine, large town as represented, dwindled down
to a single mud house in ruins ; and the only consolation
regalar order on a level with the grouDd, and showing the traces of the
foundation of houses. Most of these outlines are rectangular, and vary
from fifty to two hundred and four hundred feet fVont. The stones are
unhewn and mostly amygdaloid, rounded by attrition.
'* The implement for grinding com, and the broken pottery, are the
only vestiges of mechanical arts among the ruins with the exception
of a few ornaments, principally large well turned beads, the size of a
hen's egg. The same com grinder and pottery are now in use among
the Pijmos. The first consists of two large stones slightly concave and
convex, fitting each other, and intended to crush the corn by the pres-
sure of the hand."
In addition to the above, I make the following extracts from Casta-
fieda upon the subject of the ruins seen by Coronado :
'* The name of Chichiltieale was formerly given to this place because
the monks found in the vicinity a house which had long been inhabited
by a tribe that came from Cibola. The house was large and seemed
to have served as a fortress. It appears that it was anciently destroyed
by the inhabitants who compose the most barbarous nation yet found
in these regions."
*' He was above all distressed at finding that this Chichiltieale of
which so much had been said dwindled down to a house in ruins and
roofless, but which, however, seemed to have been fortified. It was
evident this house, built of red>earth, was the work of civilized people
who had come from a distance."
I find it stated in the journal of Don Antonio de Otermin, of 1G81,
that the Casas Grandes were eighty leagues distant from El Paso,
which would be from two hundred to two hundred and forty miles.
At this time there were a few settlers at that point, two of whom raised
corn. In my location of the ruins of Chichiltieale, I am sustained by
lieutenant Whipple, who says, ** Chichiltieale, meaning Red House,
is the often described ruin of the present day, in the valley of the
Rio Gila, near the Pima villages," which is the location of Casas
Grandes.
The army pursued substantially the same route that Niza and the
negro had traversed, and in a little more than fifteen days after cross-
ing the desert reached Cibola.
154 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXlGOi
connected with it was the probability that it had beea
built by a civilized people who came from a distance.
Before him spread a boundless desert which would require
many days to cross at the expense of great suffering and
fatigue, and beyond lay the unknown region ho sought
to explore and conquer. The situation of things was
gloomy, and it was impossible for him to repress a feeling
of sadness. His thoughts turned upon Dona Beatrice
and the pleasant home he had left behind in the valley
of Mexico, and he sighed to return to them. The as-
surances he received from his companions that he was
certain to find wonderful things further on failed to restore
his spirits, for he had so often found their statements
false that he could no lotiger believe tfaem.
Gloomy as the prospect was Coronado determined to
advance, and he accordingly left Chichilticale and entered
upon the desert traveling a North-east course. For the
space of fifteen days they continued across the barren and
sandy country scorched by the sun, athirst for the want
of water, and wearied by their bodily fatigues. At the
end of this time they came to a narrow river on the banks
of which they encamped, some eight leagues from Cibola*
They named the stream Rio Vermejo» on account of the
reddish hue of the water in which they caught mullets
that resembled those of Spain. Here they saw the first
Indians of the country, who took to flight as soon as they
were discovered. The next evening, when about two
leagues from the town, some Indians were seen watching
their movements from a height that could not be reached.
When Coronado and party came into view they raised
piercing cries that spread alarm among the Spaniards ;
and Castaneda records that some of them were so mucli
t Rio Colorado Chiqullo.
THE C(WQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 156
fiightened that they " saddled their horses wrong end
foremost." The soldiers scoured, the country in pursuit
ef the Indians but all succeeded in making their escape.
The next day they entered the inhabited country and
came in sight of Cibola, but they were so much disap-
pointed in its appearance that they broke out in
maledictions against friar Marcos.
Instead of thfe large city as the friar had represented,
they found it to be a village of not more than two hun-
dred warriors, situated upon a rock, and the only means
of reaching it was by a parrow and tortuous icoad difficult
of ascents The houses were three and four stories high,
and several were built around one court-yard. The
province was composed of seven towns some of them
much better built and larger than Cibola. Instead of
finding the inhabitants peaceable and ready to welcome
them, as was expected, the warriors were drawn up in
battle a short distance from the town waiting their aj)-
proach. Coronado ordered the interpreter to summon
them to surrender, but they took no further notice of it
than to reply with menacing gestures. He now deter-
mined to attack tliem. Placing himself at the head of
his escort, they charged under the favorite war cry of
" Santiago." The Indians fled the field without resistance
and retired to the town. This was next attacked, but
was not taken without resistance. The only approach
to is was up the narrow and steep pathway that led fron>
3 It will be seen that the locatioa of this towQ is not the same as the
one Niza saw, which he states was situated upon a plain at the foot of
a hill ; while the one Coronado visited was upon a rock. It is doubt-
fai whether they visited the same place, although both towns, na
donbt, were in the province of Cibola. The location of the village
seen by Coronado, and the approaches to it, answer so well to ZuHl
that there can be no mistake about their identity.
I
156 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
the valley to the top of the rock, and which the Indians
had prepared to defend. As the Spaniards advanced up
the ascent to the assault, they were received with a
shower of arrows and large stones hurled down upon
them. Coronado was felled to the earth, and he would
have been killed had not two of the cavaliers thrown
themselves before his body and received the blows in-
tended for liim. The Indians fought with bravery, but
were not able to withstand the attack, and in one- hour
Cibola was carried and the enemy beaten. The town
was found well stored with provisionii, and as the Span-
iards stood in great need of them they were taken
possession of for the use of the army. In a short time
the whole province made terms and peace was restored.
Here, for the present, I will leave the general and return
to the army which was left at Culiacan.
In fifteen days after the departure of Coronado the
army set out under the command of Don Tristan de
Arellano. All, both officers and men, marched on foot
with lance on the shoulder and provisions strapped on
the back ; the horses being loaded with baggage and extra
provisions. The advance was slow and difficult. The
iii*8t province they entered was the one which Cabeza de
Vaca had called Tierra de los Corazones, Here Arellano
founded a city which he called San Hieronimo de los
Corazones, which was afterward abandoned and the set-
tlement transferred to another point. From this place
he sent a party under Don Rodrigo Maldonado down the
river to the gulf (California), to search for the vessels
which had been ordered to follow the coast and hold
communication with the army. They returned in a few
days without having heard anything of the vessels, and
bringing with them an Indian so tall that he was the
■^ mt *-\ •■'■ ^
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 157
wonder of all who beheld him. The tallest Spaniard
coald no more than reach \ip to his breast, and it was
said that there were many people on the coast still taller
than he. The army now crossed the river to await further
orders from the general. Here it remained encamped
xmtil about the middle of October, when two cavaliers,
Melchor Dias and Juan Gallego, arrived with instructions
for it to hasten forward to Cibola. Dias was ordered to
remain in command at the new settlement for the pur-
pose of colonizing it and endeavoring to open a commu-
nication with the fleet, while Gallego was directed to
return to Mexico and give an account of the discoveries
to the viceroy. He took with him friar ilarcos who
dared not trust himself any longer in Cibola because
everything he had said about the country turned out to
be false, and the soldiers were much incensed against
him. They found neither powerful kingdoms, beautiful
and populous cities, nor the gold, silver and rich stuffs
that had been promised them. The army made the
necessary preparations for the march to Cibola. Eighty
chosen men were left with Dias to garrison the town,
besides all who were not considered hardy enough to
stand the fatigues of the march. It appears that Arellano
accompanied the army no further than this point, but
remained in command of those who were not able to
endure the hardships of the campaign. The journal of
Castaneda is silent as to the reason of his remaining^ be-
hind, by whose orders, and who took command of the
army in his place.
158 TlIE GONQl^EST OF NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER XXI
•aUE AKMY KE ACHES CIBOLA ; EXPEDITION OF DI AS TO THE
COAST.
The army left San Ilierouimo de los Corazoues soon
after the middle of October. It advanced toward CiboLi
without opposition from the Indians, for Coronado
had left all the provinces through which he passed at
peace. In the province of Nacapan tlie inhabitants gave
the soldiers a preserved fruit of the cactus, called tunas,
or India iigs, which produced a dangerous sickness among
them. They were seized with a burning fever and severe
head-ache immediately after editing them, which lasted
for twenty-four hours, and entirely disabled them for
that time. They struck the desert at Chichilticale, the
same point where Coronado had entered it. Here Cas-
taiieda and some of the soldiers saw a flock of sheep, of
which the following account is given in his journal. He
says : " I also saw and followed them ; they were very
Large — had very long horns and hair. When they wish
to run they throw back the head, so that their horns lie
along the back. They run so rapidly that we could not
•cxitch them, and were obliged to let them go/' Three
days from this place, while marching upon the bank of a
river that ran through a deej) ravine, they found a large
THE CONQUEST OP KEW MEXICO. 159
liom which is said to have been " a fathom and a half in
length ; tlie base was as large as one's thigh ; it resembled
in shape a^goat's horn, and was a curious thing." It had
also been seen by Coronado. The desert was crossed in
lifteen days, without anytliing occurring worthy of note.
Within one day's march of Cibola they encountered a
furious hurricane, followed by a severe snow storm. The
cold was so severe that many of the Indians who accom-
panied them perished. Late in the night they obtained
partial shelter under some r<)cks, which, to some extent,
]>rotected them from the storm. The Indians suffered
much more than the Spaniards, not having been accus-
tomed to such cold weather ; and besides those frozen to
death many were so much benumbed that they could not
walk the next dav, and had to be carried on horseback.
The army reached Cibola the next day, where the general
wjis very anxiously awaiting its arrival, and where he had
comfortable quarters already prepared for it.
While the troops are resting from their fatigues in the
comfortable quarters at Crbola, let us turn back to see
what is taking place at Los Corazones where, it will be
remembered, a small garrison liad been left under Dias,
Soon after the army marched disorders and mutinies
broke out among the soldiers, and tlie place was a scene
of constant confusion. Dias with twenty-five men went
in search of the sea-coast, leaving Diego de Alcarraz in
command of the garrison. Provided with suitable guides
he started, and after marching one hundred and fifty
leaOTCSi in a South-west direction he arrived amonc: a
nation of prodigious stature.* They lived in cabins made
1 This distance must be greatly oyerestimated.
4 Probably the same nation whence Maldonado brought the taM
Indian mentioned in the last chapter.
160 the[|conquest op new Mexico,
of straw with the roof only above ground, and with two
doors in opposite sides, one of egress and the other of
regress. The cabins were large and more than an hun-
dred persons slept in one of them. The inhabitants were
savages and went naked. They carried burdens upon
the head of the weight of three or four quintals ; and one
of them carried a piece of wood with ease that six Spani-
ards could not lift, and placed it upon the fire. They
raised maize which they made into loaves and baked it
under the ashes. When they traveled in cold weather
they carried a fire brand in their hands with which they
warmed themselves. Here Dias struck a large river called
Tizon, and which took its name from the custom of the
inhabitants carrying fire brands. It was half a league
wide at this point. The captain heard of the vessels he
was in search of and started down the river to look for
them. On his way he came to a tree with tlie inscription
upon it, " Alarcan has come as far as this ; there are let-
ters at the foot of this tree." The letters were found,
as indicated, in the ground, which informed them that
Alarcan had waited sometime for them at that point and
then returned to New Spain. They also contained the
information that California was not an island, as had been
supposed, but a peninsula ; and that the water the vesssels
were then in was a gulf, and not the South sea. 3
Dias now determined to march up the river and cross
over and then to seek the coast by continuing toward the
South-west. They followed the river bank five or six
3 Dias and his party most have marched to the North-west instead of
South-west, and the large river he discovered was undoubtedly the
Colorado of the West, which empties into the Gulf of California at Its
head. There is no river to the South-west of Los Corazones which
answers the description of the one he disco?ered, and his starting point
was far below the head of the gulf.
"THE CONQUEST 01* NEW MEX1CX>. 161
i
•'days when they came to a* point at which they concluded
they would be able to cross on rafts, w^here they en-
< camped. They called in a number of the inhabitants of
the surrounding country to assist in cutting down trees
and constructing rafts. In the meantime the Indians
laid a plot to massacre them, but it was discovered before
there was time to put it into execution. They intended
to attack the Spaniards while crossing the river or after
a part of them had crossed, and were thus divided ; and
the hope of accomplishing their designs induced them to
assiet in making the rafts. Asoldielr while outwalking
one day, saw a large party of armed Indians passing
through a wood toward the river, apparently watching
for the Sp^ards to cross over. His suspicions being
aroused he communicated what he had seen to Dias. An
-Indian was immediately secretly confined and put to the
torture, when he exposed the whole plot Their plan
was that the Indians, on the rafts crossing with the
Spaniards, w^ere to throw them overboard, while those
on shore were to be attacked at the same time and over-
powered. The savage who had divulged the conspiracy
was quietly disowned by sinking him in the river without
letting his companions know that they were suspected.
The next morning tlie Indians, having a suspicion that
their intentions were known to the Spaniards, commenced
the attack without waiting for them to begin to cross
the river. Tliey discharged a multitude of arrows, but
being charged by the horsemen armed with lances, and a
warm fire opened upon them by the archers, they were
^on put to fiight and retreated into the wood. The
passage of the river was then begun, the Indian allies
^manning the raft, and in a short time the whole party,
^men and horses, were safely landed on. the opposite side-
11
162' THE CONQUEST OP KEW BlEXfCO.
They immediately resumed their march down tlr^
stream toward the giilf, and &ocfn arrived in a district
of country that had been subject to volcanic action. Cas-
taneda describes it as " a place covered with ashes so hot
tliat it was impossible to march over it, for they might
as well have drowned themselves in the sea. The eartli
trembled like a drum, which caused the supposition of
subterraneous lakes, and the ashes boiled in some places
in a manner truly infernal." This route being considered
dangerous they changed their direction a little and con-
tinued on. A few days after, captain Dias received an
accidental wound which caused his death and terminated
the expedition. A greyhound, belonging to a soldier,
having attacked some sheep they were driving along for
provisions, the captain threw his lance at the dog to drive
him away. It struck the ground point upward, and as
he was not able to check his horse, which was going at a
gallop, he rode directly upon the poiftt which pierced liis
tliigh and inflicted a mortal wound/ He lived twenty
days. After his death the party retraced their steps, and
arrived at their place of starting without further casualty,
notwithstanding the Indians harassed them a good deal.
During the absence of the expedition aiiairs do not appear
to have gotten on very smoothly at the garrison.
Alcarniz proved an inefficient officer, and the soldien?
again became mutinous ; two of them were condemned
to be hanged, but they made their escape before they
could be executed. He sent messengers to Cibola witli
information of the condition of things, and Coronado
detailed Don Pedro de Tobar to return and endeavor to
quell the disturbance. He received instructions to remove
the most mutinous from the post;
Tobar arrived at a critical moment. The Indians
THK CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 163
abound the garrison were becoming quite hostile, and a
soldier had just died from a wound inflicted by a poisoned
arrow. He sent Alcarraz to a neighboring district called
the "Valley of the Eogues," to make the caciques
prisoners to hold as hostages for the good behavior of
their people. They were captured ^rithout difliculty, but
were soon set at liberty again for a ransom of articles
which the soldiers stood in great need of. The Indians
immediately took up arms and attacked the Spaniards.
They used poisoned arrows, and succeeded in kilUng a
good many and wounding several others. The poison
was so powerful that all who were penetrated by the ar-
rows died in a short time, and no remedy could save
them. One of the men went mad, and his flesh instantly
putrified. Tlie hostility of the Indians induced Tobar to
remove the garrison forty leagues in the direction of
Cibola, where he established a new post in the valley of
Suya, Here I will leave him for the present to give
some account of the people between Culiacan and Cibola.
Twenty leagues from Culiacan was the province of
Petatlan, so named from the material with which the
inhabitants built their houses, ^><?^a^c^, (rush-mats) ; and
the same material was used in all the provinces to tlie
beginning of the desert of Cibola. The villages were
built in a valley between the mountains and the sea, ou
the bank of a river, and were very populous. But little
is known of these people. The next province was that of
Sonora, one hundred and eighty leagues from Petatlan,^
of which some account has already been given. Several
small villages were found between these two provinces,
the names of some of which are given as follows, viz. :
Sinaloa, Boyomo, Tcocomo and Yaquimi. Sonora took
its name from a river and a valley, and the inhabitants
'164 ' THE COiJQl/EST OP HfBW MEXKJO.
■were more numerous and superior in intelligence to sufy
•Indians liitlierto seen. The women wore a petticoat of
dressed deer-skin, and another garment that came down
■to the middle. In each village was a small earthen emi-
nence which the cacique mounted every morning and for
more than an hour proclaimed aloud to the people the
work each one had to do during the day .4 Their places
of religions worship were small houses, but nothing is said
of their forms and ceremonies. When they expected war
they struck up a row of arrows around their places of
worship.
From Sonora to the valley of Suya, where the village
of San Hieronimo was rebuilt, was forty leagues. Here
were several Indian towns, with the same manners, cus-
toms and religion, with few exceptions, as the other
provinces to the beginning of the desert at Chicliilticale.
The men drank a liquor made from the fruit of the cactus,
•called the wine of Pitihaya, and they were addicted to
intoxication. The women painted the chin and around
the eyes in the same manner as the women of Barbary.
They made preserves of tlie tunas, the juice of which was
sweet enough to preserve themj Melons were raised in
abundance and of an enormous size ; they were preserved
for use by being cut into thin slices and dried in the sun,
when they had the taste of dried figs. They made bread
of the berries of the mesquit-tree — it was baked in loaves
like cheeses and would keep sweet the whole year. Tame
eagles were found in the houses of the caciques, and were
greatly prized ; and hens, resembling those of Spain, were
seen in the valley of Suya, but not elsewhere. Wild
sheep and goats of large size and with great horns were
4 A similar costinn still prevails among the- Pueblo Indians of Ne^~
-Mexico.
TH£ COVQUEST OF NEW MEXICO* 165
iseeu in floclsB of an hundred in some parts of the country,
but the Spaniards were never able to. ca^toire any o£
166 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER XXII.
A FURTHER ACCOUNT OF CIBOLA ; AN EXPEDITION MARCHES
TO THE PROVINCE OF TUSAYAN AND THE RIVER TIZON.
At the close of the last chapter we left the army united
at Cibola. But before I relate what took place there,
and the operations put on foot from that point to explore
and conquer the surrounding country, it will be in place
to give some account of the great desert crossed to reach
Cibola, with the manners and customs of the people of
that province.
The name of Chichilticale was given by the monks to
the last house on the edge of the desert, and which had
formerly been inhabited by a tribe of people who came
from Cibola. The word Chichalti in the language of the
country signified house, and it was supposed that this
might be the name of the people; though it was the
opinion of Casteneda that the building had been erected
by a more civilized race. It was large, and had the
appearance of having been a fortress, and was supposed to
have been destroyed by the inliabitants of the surround-
ing country, who were represented as the most barbarous
people of all that region. The country was a desert ;
TttS CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 167
the soil was red and covered with small pine trees, the
branches of wliich extended down^the trunk to within
five feet of the ground. There was also seen a kind
of oak which bore an acorn very sweet to the taste.i
Throughout this region were a few miserable inhabitants
who subsisted by the chase, and dwelt in rude cabins.
A few roses and pennyroyal were found, and cresses
grew in some of the springs. Barbels and picories were
seen in the streams. The only animal mentioned is a
"tawny lion" that dwelt in the uninhabited part. The
distance across tliis desert region was eighty leagues, and
the course of the Spaniards lay toward the North.
The province of Cibola contained seven villages, situ-
ated in a warm valley between high mountains ; one of
them took the napie .of the province, and another, called
Mnzaque, is said to have been the most populous. The
houses were, ordinarily, four and .five stories high, and
some few in Muzaque were six and seven. The inhabit-
ants were more civilized and intelligent than any the
Spaniards had hitherto seen. They dressed in skins and
stuffs made of cotton. The entire middle of the body
was covered with a garment that resembled a napkin,
which was embroidered with tufls at the ends, and was
fastened ai*ound the loins. They also manufactured ia
kind of pelisses of feathers. The women were dressed
differently from the men. Tiiey wore ^ mantle over the
1 The same kind of oak is still found in California. Surgeon Williaoi
S. King, of the United States army, writes to the Medical and Sur-
gical Reporter that in California the Indians live almost entirely,
at certain seasons, on acorns, making from them a flour which is very
sweet and palatable. They m^ke this by pounding the acorns to flnc
flour, and boiling and stirring it for several hours in hot water. This
makes a jelly-like substance which is very good to eat, or may be
Uaked into bread.
1
J
188 THE GONQUEST OF NEW MEXICa
shoulder fastened around the neck and paesinc^ under*
the right am; some of their garments were made of
skins beautifully dressed. The hair was done up behind
the ear, ^^ in the shape of a wheel which resembles the
handle of a cup.'' Maize was raised as an article of food,
and some cotton was cultivated. . The stalks of the maize
were very shorty and the ears started near the ground ;.
each ear contained seven or eight hundred grains, which*
was a.matter of astonishment to the Spaniards, and waa
said to excel anything seen in the Indias. The animals
found tin the country were bears in great numbers^ lions,
wild-cats, hyenas and beavers; there were a few tur-
quoises^ but neither gold nor silver. The nuts of the
pine tree were coDected and used for food.
The manners and customs of the people of Cibola
differed from any hitherto mentioned. A man married
only once, and if he should lose liis wafe he was obliged
to live single the rest of his days. The women were well
treated, but two of them were not allowed to enter into-
a place at the same time, such conduct being considered
a sacrilege. Their government was primitive and rather
patriarchal. They had no recognized political organiza-
tion, neither oaciques, nor a emincil of elders. Their
religion was thought to be a branch of the Aztec worship..
They had priests who^ were selected from among the
aged peraons, one of whose duties was to regulate the
manner of living. They preached every morning at sun-
rise from the highest point in the village, the people
sitting around on the ground and paying the most
profound attention. They were a peaceful and laborious
people, and were neither given to eating human flesh,
drunkenness or theft. Vapor-baths were found in many
of- their houses, and they understood the use of them*.
M J ^».>J I ~l
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 169)
The cross was known among them and revered as an
emblem of peace. They burned the dead, and with
them the instruments of their trade. There was another
province a few leagues to the West of Cibola which
also contained seven villages, with similar manners and
customs. These fourteen villages were said to contain
fourteen thousand men.s
Before the main body of the army reached Cibola,
Coronado had succeeded in making peace with the inhab-
itants, who maaifested a friendly disposition. Wishing
s ** After passing the desert seven towns are found, about a day's
Journey from each other ; all united together are called Cibola. Tlie
houses, coarsely constructed, are of stones and mud. Behold the man-
ner in which they are built ; they have one long wall, and on the two
ftonts of this wall^there are chambers of twenty feet square and sepa-
rated by partition walls, as they communicate by signs. They are
ceiled with beamih In order to get into these houses you ascend upon
a tecrace by means of ladders which they give you in the street ; the
houses are three op four stories high ; they say there are very few that
are not two. These stories are more than nine feet high, except the
first which is not much more than six. Ten or twelve houses make
use of the same ladder ; the lower stories are set apart for labor ; they
live in the upper one. They have on the ground floor loop-holes used
slantingly as in the fortresses of Spain. These Indians say that when
they go to make war against those of Cibola, the latter shut themselves
in their houses whence they defend themselves. When the latter set
out on an expedition they carry shields and a garment of colored
leather. They fight with arrows and little tomahawks of stone, and
€>iher arms of wood which they have not been able to explain to me.
They are cannibals; they reduce their prisoners to slavery. They
have a great many hens of the country tamed, a great quantity of beans,
maize and melons. They rear up in their houses hairy animals large
as the dogs of Spain. They shear them — they make of it wigs similar
to the one I have already sent to your lordship. They also manufac-
ture cloaks of it. The men are small—the women are fair and have
very, graceful actions. Their dress consists of a shirt that reaches
nearly to the feet. They divide the hair on two sides and arrange it so
that the ears are exposed. Tl^y place in it many turquoises, also
sound the neck and waist. Tttie men wear mantles, and over. them.i
170 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
to obtain further information of the neighboring nations,
he dispatched ninners into various parts to in\T[te the
people to come in, to hold a talk and trade with him.
The Indians sent word to all their neighbors and allies,
and informed them that the Christians had arrived, who
desired to be their friends, and wished to be advised of a
good coimtry where they might settle themselves. But
few came in, and .tlie general was not able to obtain
much knowledge . of the surrounding country. The
people of Cibola informed him that twenty-live leagues
leather similar to that worn by Cabeza de Vaca and Dorantes, and
which your lordship has already seen. They havd a species of bon •
nets. In the summer they wear leather shoes painted or colored, and
in tho winter high boots of the same material.
"They cultivate the land as in New Spain — they carry upon the
head as in Mexico. The men lay the groundwork of cloth and spin
cotton. They use salt which they obtain from a lake two days' jour-
ney from Cibola. These Indians accompany their dances and songs
with flutes, on which are marked the placos where it is necessaiy to
put the fingers. They are very fond of music — they sing in tune with
those who play on instruments. The singiers beat time as among us.
I have scon the Indian that Estevan, the negro who had been a pri-
soner in the country, had brought back, play on the flute as he had
learned it among tho natives. Others sing as I have related, but they
are not very skillful. It is said that five or six men assemble together
to play the flute, and that these instruments are of unequal size. The
sun is favorable for maize, beans and other grains. They are not
acquainted with sea fish. They have no cows but they have a knowl-
edge of them. Further on in the province ot Cibola there are found a
great many wild goats— they are the color of bright gray hair. In the
country where I am they abound in great numbers ; I have asked tho
Indians if those of which they speak are similar, and they answered
me that they are not. They say that of the seven villages three are
very large and four arc smaller. It appears, from what I have been
able to comprehend by their signs, each of these villages had three
gates of square cross bows." — Extract from a letter Melchor Diaa
wrote to Mendoza^ which^he latter communicated to Charles V.
in his second letter to the Emperor, Temaiix Campans, Ap^
^iendicCf p, 293.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 171
from there was a province called Tusayans wliieb con-
tained seven cities like their own ; that the houses were
several stories in height and the inhabitants very brave.
The information he obtained was very limited, as there
was no intercourse between the two provinces ; but it was
sufficient to awaken his interest, and he determined to
send an expedition thither.
He selected for this purpose the gallant cavalier Don
Pedro de Tobar, and placed under his orders seventeen
horsemen and three or four foot soldiers. They were
accompanied by a monk named Juan de Padilla, who
had been a soldier in his youth, but now belonged to tlie
Franciscans. The rumor had been spread tlirough the
surrounding provinces that Cibola was conquered by a
very ferocious nation, who rode great animals and de-
voured men ; and as these people had no knowledge of
3 The province of Tusayan is identical wiUi the present MoquI vil-
lages, situated on the great tableau between the river San Juan and
the Colorado Chiquito. The villages are seven in number, and five of
them, in 1692, bore the names of Aguatubi, Qualpi, Jongopavi, 3Ion-
eonavi, and Of ayvi. At the present time four of these same pueblos
are called Moqui, Una-Vida, Cuelpe and Towas. The bute or mesa,
upon the top of which the pueblos are built, rises up with nearly
perpendicular sides, and around the base lay their arable land where
they cultivate grains, fruit and vegetables, and pasture their flocks
and herds. The Indians attend their crops, and watch their bhcep
and goats during the day ii;i the valley below, and when night
approaches they retire up to their villages. They are a mild and
peaceful race of people, and have the reputation of being strictly
honest. They dress in cotton and other garments of their own manu-
facture. The females are said to be good-looking, and are cleanly in
their habits ; they are well treated by the men, and only attend to
work within doors while the latter perform the labor in the fields.
The women have a peculiar style of dressing the hair, and the rank
and condition of each one may be known by the manner in which she
wears it. The married women wear it done up in a club at the back
of the head, while the virgins part it in the middle behind, and bdn^
172 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
horses this news caused great astonishment and alarm.
For this reason Tobar supposed the inhabitants of Tusayan
would be on the look out and would not allow him to
enter their country, peaceably ; but he marched with such
secrecy that he arrived in their province without being
discovered, nor having seen a house or person on the
way. They came within sight of one of the villages about
dark, and crossing, some cultivated fields approached so-
near the houses that they heard the people talking^ Here
they encamped all night undiscovered;. The next mom*
ing they were seen by the Indians, who immediately
sounded the alarm in the village. The warriors turned
out armed with bows and arrows, clubs aaid bucklers, and
advanced in good order against them. The Spaniards
sounded a parley, and sent their mterpreter to hold a talk
with the Indians. He was received in a friendly manner,
but was told that the Spaniards could not enter the vilr
it round to either side Bomething in the form of a rosette, and nicely
smoothed and oiled.
Their houses are bsilt of stone and mortar, or mud, and some of
them are two and three stories in height. Some are large and others
small,, and the upper stories of all of them are entered from the outside
by means of ladders. They obtain water, for their crops and other
purposes, by digging boles in the sand in the valley ; but this supply
often gives out in a time of great drought, and to avoid a famine they
always keep on hand a considerable supply of provisions. Now and
then their more warlike neighbors, the Kabajos, come sweeping down
upon them and drive off their flocks ; when they offer but little resist-
ance, but gathering up their movables retreat to their strongholds
upon the mesa. Their manufactures in woollen, cotton, leather,
basket-work and potteiy exhibit considerable skill. Among the popu-
lation there are a few Albinos with perfectly white hair and light
eyes. The Moqui villages are situated some seventy-flve miles West
of Fort Defiance, and about the same distance North-west of Zufii ;
and from their location there can be no doubt of their being the
province of ancient Tusayan. There has not been a Catholic priesV
settled among the Moquis since 1680.
THE CONQUEST OP KEW MEXICO. 173
lage. The Indians traced a line upon the sand, which
they forbid any of the strangers to cross ; but one of the
soldiers, more bold than the rest, rode liis horse over the
line, when an Indian made at him with a club and struck
his horse's bridle.
The friar was impatient of delay and advised Tobar to
attack the Indians sword in hand ; and in order to excite
the soldiers to do so said to them : " In truth I know not
why we have come hither." The order was then given,
when they cliarged the Indians at full speed, who broke
and fled toward the village, but a great number were
killed before they could reacli it. The Spaniards diS not
then attempt to enter the village in pursuit of the Indians,
but selecting a convenient place near by pitclied their
camp. In a sliort time the inhabitants came out to them
loaded with presents, and gave their submission in the
name of the whole province and masked for an alliance
with them. The presents consisted of tanned-leather,
flour, fir-nuts, maize, po<iltry, and some turquoises, which
they desired the captain to accept as a mark of their good
vnM. During the day a large number of Indians visited
the camp to barter and see the strangers ; and toward
evening the Spaniards entered the village and took pos-
session of it. The inhabitants lived in the same manner
as those of Cibola, and were governed by a council of
wise-men, and had also governors and captains. Some
of the chiefs informed Tobar that to the West there ran
a great river and by ascending it they would find a nation
of very great stature. Having now fulfilled their mission
the Spaniards returned to Cibola and reported to the
general the result of the expedition.
The news of the great river induced Coronado to send
1 74 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO".
a party to discover and explore it. He selected Don
Garcia de Cardenas to command this expedition, and
placed twelve men under him. Leaving Cibola tliey
marched to the province of Tusayan, where they obtained
a supply of provisions and guides for the journey. Their
route now lay across a desert of twenty days' journey,
wliicli they passed in safety and arrived on the bank of
the river. Tliey suifered much from cold, although it
was summer time. The country was covered with a
growtli of low, stunted pine trees, and being open to the
North, the wind came sweeping down from that quarter
with piercing coldness. The banks of the river were so
high and rugged tliat it was impossible to reach tlie
water. From the top of the bank the stream did not
appear more than a fathom in breath, while the Indians
represented it as half a league wide. Cardenas and Iiis
party marched several days along the ridge of mountains
searching for an opening by which they might descend to
tlie stream; but there appeared one continuous barrier
of almost perpendicular rock on eitlier side, and far
below they could see the river, winding its solitary
course like a thread of silver. At one j)oint the bank
seemed less precipitous, and they made an attempt to
descend. Three of the party, captain Melgosa, Juan
Geleres, and a private soldier made the effort, and
descended until those who stood upon the bank had lost
sight of tliem. They were absent until four o'clock in
the afternoon when they returned, not having been able
to accomplish one-third of the distance. They rej)orted
the descent as very difficult and dangerous, and that the
rocks whicli, from the top, appeared no taller than a
man, were found to be, when they reached them, higher
int COKQUEST 6P KEW MEXICO. 175
than tlie tower of the cathedral of Seville, and that the
river appeared very large to them from tlie last point.4
They followed the river bank three or four days
l)eyond this point, when they abandoned it because of
the etitire absence of ws^ter ; being obliged to go every
night a league or two into tlie interior to find it. It was
the custom of the Indians, when they traveled tliroygli
this dry region, to take with them a number of women
loaded with gourds filled with water, some of which they
buried on the wav until their return. Tliis was the river
Ti^on w^liich Melchor Dias had discovered near the
mouth; and the Indians of large stature here mentioned
are supposed to have been the same which Dias had
seen and described. During the marcli the Spaniards
came to a beautiful cascade formed by water falling over
a rock, around which a number of crystals were formed.
The Indians represented these crystals to be salt, and
some of which were collected and carried to Cibola;
but nothing is said in the original record as to what they
really were.
4 The great chasm here spoken of in the river Tl3M)n was none other
flian the cafton through which the Rio Colorado, sometimes called the
Great Colorado of the West, flow?. It is many miles in length, and is
of snch great depth, and so difficult of descent, that it is not known
whether any person has ever been able to reach the water. The
Indians of the western part of New Mexico speak of this caflon as an
object of amaasement to them, and probably they are the only persons
who have ever reached the river-bank at this point and gazed down
the Irightful chasm. Within a few years, and since the foregoing was
Virrilten, the Rio Colorado has been navigated by steam, and boats
have ascended a considerable distance above its mouth. The passage
through the great cafion is described as wild in the extreme, where
the rocky banks rise up, in some place a thousand or fifteen hundre<.i
feet from the watef .
176 THE CONQUEST OF KEW-MEXICO.
CHAPTER X.XIII.
"ALVAKADO ^lARCHES TO CICUYE, AND THE AEMY GOES INTO
WINTER QUARTERS AT TIGUEX.
Meanwhile Coronado and his aa-my remained in good
• quarters at Cibola. The Indians from several of the
neighboring provinces came in to see him, make presents,
and form an alliance. Among others, there came a depu-
tation from the province of Cicuye situated seventy
leaguesi toward the East ; who said they had heard of
the arrival of strangers at Cibola, and came to offer their
services, and beg, if they should come into their country,
to be treated as allies. They were accompanied by their
cacique, a handsome and well-made man, whom the Spani-
ards called Bigotes, because he wore long mustaches.
They brought a present of tanned-skins and bucklers for
the general ; who gave them, in return, some necklaces
of beads, and bells, with which they were greatly pleased,
as they had never before seen such things. They gave
Coronado much information concerning the country they
inhabited, particularly ctf their cows, a picture of which
* was painted upon the body of one of ^the Indians. They
1 Thoughoutthc jottfual of Gastaficda all 4he -distances are-overesti- «
» mated.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW 1MEXIC0. IT/
• represented tliem as covered with a frizzled liair which
resembled wool.» He was deeply interested in their
relation and resolved to send. an expedition into their
country for the purpose of exploring it.
He gave the command of this expedition to captain
Hernando Alvarado, who, witli twenty men, was directed
to accompany the. Indians upon tlieir return, and at the
end of eighty days to present himself in Cibola and give
an account of what he had seen and heard. The Spani-
ards started with the Indians immediately. In a march
of five days they arrived at a town called Acuco,3 a very
. strong place built upon a rock, the inhabitants of wliioli
were great brigands and were much dreaded by all the
province. The rock upon which the town stood was very
high, and on three sides the ascent was perpendicular.
The only means of reaching Ih© top was by ascending a
Btair-case cut in the solid rock ; the first flight of steps
numbered two hundred which could be ascended without
much difliculty, when a second flight of one hundred more
2 The animal here referred to was the buffalo.
3 The village called Acuco, by Castafieda, is the pueblo of Acoma of
the present day ; and the situation of the two places agrees so well that
I do not think the location I have given Acuco can be called in question.
Acoma is situated some fifty miles from Zu&i, nearly East, and fifteen
miles South>wcst of the pueblo of Laguna. It is built on the top of a
small rocky mesa, about ten acres in extent and two hundred feet high,
rising up in the plain with nearly perpendicular sides ; it is detached
from the surrounding mesas, and is ascended by means of a road cut
in the rock and earth. It is a place of great strength, and the mesa
can only be ascended up the artificial road. The houses are clustered
together on the top without regularity, of one and two stories in height,
and some have portals, or porches, on the second story. They are
built of adobes. The present population is not more than three hun-
dred and fifty or four hundred souls. Water is obtained from the plain
'Or valley below and is carried up to the pudblo by the women in jars
« Df earthenware. .The inhabitants cultivate some of the land that liec
.12
1?8 THE CONQUEST OP ^EW MEXICO.
commenced. These were narrower and more diflScnIt of
ascent than the first ; and when surmounted there re-
mained about twelve feet more to the top, which could
only be ascended by putting the hands and feet in holes
(nit in the rock* On tlie top was a large pile of stones
for the pm'pose of hurhng down upon an enemy who
should attempt to ascend. There was space enough on
tliis summit to store a great quantity of provisions, and
to build cisterns to hold water. The Indians came down
in a warlike attitude into the plain to meet the Spaniards,
and refused to receive any proposition from them. They
drew a mark in the sand, as the Indians had done at
Tusayan, and forbade them to cross it. Alvarado, de-
spairing of bringing them to terms in any peaceable
manner, resolved to attack them. He made his disposition
to that effect immediately, when, seeing he was about to
advance, they bogged for quarter. Castafieda relates that
their manner of making peace was *'to approach the
horses, to take their perspiration and rub their whole body
'with it, and then to make a cross^ witli the fi-ngers." They
around the mesa, but their principal fields are iu the valley of the
Gallo, a few miles above Laguna. Acoma is in the direction the
Spaniards took from ZuBi on their way to Cicuyd ; and at their rate of
marching it would have taken them about fire days to make the dis-
tance. There is no other pueblo, or the ruinti of one, in all that section
of the country whose location answers so well to the situation of Acuco
as Acoma. Casta&eda mentions that at Acuco was found a cross near
a fountain two palms high and a finger in thickness. The wood was
squared, and around it were many dried fiowers and little staves orna-
mented with feathers. In my location ot Acuco as identical with
Acoma of the present day I am sustained by lieutenant-colonel Eaton,
late of the United States Army, who says upon this subject: '*In a
conversation with a very intelligent Zufii Indian I learned that the
pueblo of Acoma is called in the Zufii tongue Hah-koc-kee-ah (Acuco) ;
and this name was give!! to me without any previous question which
could serve to give him an idea of this old Spanish name."
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 179
also crossed their hands which act they held inviolable.
According to custom they made the Spaniards presents
of fowis, bread, dressed deer-skins, grains of the fir-cone,
flonr and maize.
jYlvarado continued on and in three days he arrived at
a province called Tigucx.4 Here the inliabitants received
him with pacific demonstrations on account of Bigotes
being along, who was a powerful cliief and much feared
in all that country. He was so much pleased with the
appearance of this province that he dispatched a messenger
back to Coronado with a recommendation that he should
*come there to spend the winter. Thence the Spaniards
continued their march and in five days arrived at Cicuye,
a large and strongly fortified village. Here, also, they
were received in the most friendly manner. When the
inhabitants saw them approach they marched out to
receive them, and escorted them into the town to the
music of their drums and flutes. The Indians made
Alvarado .presents of stufls and turquoises, the latter
abounding in the province. The Spaniards remained
here some davs to recover from the fatiOTCS of tlie march.
At this village they met an Indian from a distant province
toward the East, whom they named the " Turk," because
of his resemblance of the people of that nation. He gave
a most glowing account of the famous cities to be found
in th^ country whence he came, and of the abundance qf
gold and silver to be found there. Alvarado became so
much interested in his narrative that he felt but little
interest in completing his expedition into the country
where the buffalo abounded ; therefore taking this Indian
for a guide he continued his march until he obtained a
4 In the Journal of Jaramillo, a captain in tlie expedition, this word
is written TihueXy bat I prefer to follow the spelling of Castafieda.
ISO THE CONQUEST' OF NEW MEXICa
sight of buffaloes, when he hastened back to report to
Coronado the result of his explorations.
The messenger that Alvarado dispatched from X^g^^x
reached Coronado in safety, and he ^vas so much pleased
with the account he gave of that place that he determined
to winter the army there. He immediately sent Gai'cia
Lopez de Cardenas thither to prepare quarters for the
troops. When he arrived he turned all the inhabitants
of the village out of their houses to make room for the
soldiers. They were not allowed to carry anything away
with them but their clothing, and tliey were obliged to
seek shelter in the neighboring provinces. At this cruel *
treatment the Indians were much incensed, and they
turned from their homes filled with hostility toward .the
strangers. Coronado having heard of the existence of
another province with eight villages determined to visit
it on his way to Tiguex. For this purpose he set out in
advance with thirty of the most hardy men, leaving
instructions for the army to follow in twenty days. In a
march of eight days he an'ived at a to^vn cidled Tutahaco^s
3 Tutaliaco, and Uie other seven villages here referred to, must have
been situated upon the Gallo, and in a direction North-east from Cibola.
In marching from the latter province, in a general North-east course,
-which the Spaniards were then pursuing, the first stream they would
approach was what is now called the river Gallo. Tlie only pueblo
cm it, at the present day, is that of Laguna, and the ruins of the others,
if situated upon its banks, have disappeared, at least I have never
heard of any being in existence. It is now a small stream ; but there
is evidence of many of the streams having partially dried up, and at
that day this, probably, contained a much larger body of water. The
time the Spaniards were occupied in marching from Cibola to Tuta-
haco would seem to argue against my location of the villages of this
province, as the Gallo should have been reached in half that time from
the former place ; but as the country to be traversed is mountainous,
the march may have been prolonged on this account. I am not able
to give these pueblos any other location consistent with the well knoWii
and determined points upon the route of Coronado.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 181
where the inhabitants gave him a friendly welcome. He
found the houses built in the same manner, and the
people wearing the same style of clothing, as in Cibola.
Thence he ascended the river and visited all the other;
villages of the province,6 when he resumed the march for
Tiguex. He reached that place witliout accident, where
he met Alvarado, who had stopped there on his return
from the buffalo country to await liis arrival. Coronado
found but little water on his march and was much impeded
by the want of it. At one stretch of two and a half days
there was none to be had for man or beast, which caused
great suffering among the horses and Indians of burden.
Here Coronado met the Turk, who had returned with
6 The only village extant of those in the province of Tutahaco, men-
tioned by Castancda, is that of Lagana, if I am correct in fixing their
location on the river Gallo. I visited it some years ago on my way to
Fort Defiance. It is ^situated upon a rocky knoll on the west bank of
the Gallo, and has a population of nearly a thousand souls. The
houses are of mud and stones, generally small and badly ventilated,
and built without order. The people enter them by means of out^de
ladders and pull the ladders up afler them on to the terrace abovCi
The rows of houses are separated by narrow lanes, and in. the centre of
the village is a small plaza or square. At this village is kept what the
Indians are pleased to call their God Montezuma, which I was per-
mitted to see, as I was. not a Mexican. An old woman brought
something into the room wrapped up in a dirty cloth, which was set
on the floor before me and uncovered. It was not in the image of
anything upon the earth, in the heavens above or in the waters under-
neath. The famous God was made of tanned skin, stretched on a
circular frame about nine inches high and the same in diameter. One-
half was painted red and the other green, and the top was covered
over. On the green side were cut apertures to represent eyes ; it was
without a nose, while circular pieces ot leather represented the mouth
and ears.* There was a small tuft of leather dressed with feathers on
the top. The Indians present looked on it with the greatest venera-
tion and knelt around it. They went through a form of prayer, and
sprinkled a white powder upon it. One of them told me this seuselesa
thing was God, and the brother of God.
I
182 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
•
Alvarado. The general was deeply interested in the
account he gave of liis native province, of which he spoke
in the most exaggerated terms. He said there was a
great river which ran through it, two leagues wide, in
which were fish as large as a horse;? that the canoes were
capable of carrying twenty rowers on a side, and were
also propelled by sails ; they were fitted up with gi-eat
magnificence ; a large golden eagle was fixed in the prow,
and the master recHned in the stern imder a beautiful
canopy. He represented the sovereign as great and pow-
erful, who took his siestas under tlie spreading branches
of a great tree, and was charmed to sleep by the music of
little golden bells suspended therefrom, wliich sounded
when the wind blew. He said gold and silver abounded
in the country and were used for all purposes ; that the
most common vases were made of massive wrought silver,
and the plates and porringers of gold. ' This marvellous
story was readily beUeved by the too credulous Spaniards,
and Coronado determined to make an expedition in searcli
of the untold wealth said to exist there. Among other
things, the Turk said hfe had brought several golden
bracelets with him as evidence of the wealth of the coun-
try, wliich he left at Cicuye ; and as he was anxious to
reclaim them the general sent Alvarado back with him
to that village to assist in their recovery. When they
arrived there the inliabitants denied all knowledge of
them, and said that the Turk was such a liar he could not
be believed. The captain made prisoners of the chief,
Bigotes, and the cacique, whom he chained in his tent in
order to make them tell where the bracelets Imd been
7 The river referred to was probably the Rio del Norte, and fish oJ
au enormoas size are still caught in it.
8 Mid-day nap.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 183
cencealed ; but they persisted in denying all knowledge
of them, and reproached the Spaniards as men Who were
void of faith and friendship. They were carried captive
to Tiguex, where the. general kept them confined for
several months, but without being able to extort any
knowledge of the golden bracelets.
Twenty days after the departure of Coronado from
Cibola the army commen(5ed the march from that place
for Tiguex, under the command of Don Tristan de iVrel-
lano, who had Jately arrived from Sonora. Uhe first
night it quartered at a village, the largest and handsomest
that had been seen in the province. The houses were
seven stories high, built in the form of terraces with bal-
conies supported by wooden pillars, and the walls were
pierced with loop-holes for the purpose of defence. The
roofs were on a level and common to all the inhabitants
of the village ; and they were entered by an exterior
stair-case,9 there being no doors on the outside. There
were no streets to this village. While here a violent
«iow storm came on, and the soldiers took shelter under
the projecting balconies of the houses.
The next morning the march was resumed. The season
was the beginning of December ; the cold was quite severe,
and the snow, which fell almost every day and night,
covered the ground to the depth of tliree feet. The
country abounded in forests of fir and pine trees, and at
night the soldiers built large fires to melt the snow and
keep themselves warm. Some nights there was such a
heavy fall of snow that the camp would be buried up
before morning. The troops suflfered from cold and
fatigue. They passed the village of Acuco, before men-
9 The word ** stair-case," no doubt, means ladder, the present method
'Of entering the dwellings of the Pueblo Indians of Kew Mexico.
184
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO;
tioned, where the inhabitants gave them a friendlp
reception and furnished them provisions. The Spaniards-
looked at the rock, with the village perched upon its top,
with great interest. The accent was inaccessible to thena
without assisting each other, while the Indians, who were
accustomed to it, would go up and down with great
facility, the women carrying burdens and scarcely using
their hands. Thence they marched to Tiguex, whero
they arrived without accident and went into the comforts
able quarters already provided for theiji. They found
the province in a state of revolt, with active hostilities,
going on between the Indians and Spaniards^
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 183
CHAPTER XXIV.
I
DESCRIPTION OF TIGUEX; THE INDIANS REVOLT AGAINST.
THE SPANIARDS, BUT ARE CONQUERED.
The account which Castafieda gives of the province ot
♦ Tiguex is so complete and interesting that I copy it en-
tire from his journal. He says : " The province of Tiguexi
1 The villages of the province of Tiguex must have been upon the
banks of the Rio Puerco, and at this day the ruins of several are found^
upon this stream. After crossing the Gallo, this is the next river ap-
proached traveling toward the North-east, and is the largest until you
arrive at the Dei Norte. A chain of high mountains bounds it on the
West, and according to the wording of the original text the pueblo of
Jemes was about seven leagues to the North-east. The locality of the
latter village is perfectly well known, and the Puerqp is the only stream
within seven leagues ot it to the South-west ; and it is impossible tor
loci^ Tiguex. in any other part of the country, and at the same time
do justice to the march of the Spaniards. Castafieda describes tho
river as large, which may have been the case with the Puerco at that
time, but at the present day it is an inconsiderable stream, and at some
seasons of the year is quite dry. During the rainy season its banks
are filled witl^ water, and like all mountain streams has a rapid cur-
rent. The valley of the Puerco contains some good farming land.
and varies in width. It empties into the Rio del Norte. There is
some evidence that Tiguex, I mean the village of that name, was
situated upon the Jemes river. After the army had returned from the
plains to Tiguex, an officer ascended the river the latter village wasr
situated upon, some distance, and visited the two provinces of Jemes
and Ynqueyunquo. Now, Jemes is upon the river of the same name ;
and if the river was ascended to this village, the evidence that Tiguex
was situated upon the same stream, would appear quite conclusive..
18*6 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
-contains twelve villages situated upon thq bank of a great
river ; it is a valley about two leagues broad, and bounded
on the West by very high mountains covered with snow.
Four villages are built at the foot of these mountains,
and three others on the heights.
" They are governed by a council of old men. • The
houses arc built in common ; the women temper the
mortar and raise the walls ; the men bring timber and
construct the frames. They have no lime but they make
a mixture of ashes, earth and charcoal, which answers
very well for a substitute ; for although they raise their
houses four stories high, the walls are not more than
three feet thick. They make great heaps of thyme and
rushes which they set on fire ; when this mass is reduced
to coal and ashes they throw upoii it a great deal of earth
and water and mix all together. They then knead it in
round masses which are dried and which they employ as
stones ; the whoLe is then coated with the same mixture.
This work thus resembles somewhat a piece of masonry.
"The young unmarried people serve the public in
geni3raL Thej^ seek fii-ewood and collect in the courts,
whence the women take it for use in the houses. They
occupy the vapor-baths which are under ground in the
courts of the village. There are square and also round
ones. The roof is sustained by pillars made of trunks of
the pine. I have seen them which had twelve pillars,
each one twelve feet round ; but usually they have only
four pillars. They are paved with large polished stones
like the baths of Europe. In tlie centre is a lighted fur-
nace on which a handful of thyme is occasionally thrown,
and which sufiBces to keep up the heat, so that one is
there as in a bath ; the roof is on a level with the
ground There a^e some as large as a tennis court
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
187
*' When a young man marries it is by the order of the
old men who govern. He must spin and weave a mantle ;
they then bring the young girl to him, he covers her
shoulders with it, and she becomes his wife.
" The houses belong to the women and the vapor-baths
to the men. The women are forbidden to enter or sleep
in them, except to carry food to their husbands or sons.
The men spin and weave ; the women take care of the
children and cook provisions. The soil is so fertile that
it does not need to be worked when they sow ; the snow
falls and covers the seed, and the maize springs under-
neath. The harvest of one year answers for seven.
There is found in the country a quantity of cranes, ducks,
crows and partridges, which live on the houses. When
they begin to sow the fields are still covered with maize
which they had not been able to gather.
** In this province were a great number of tte hens of
the country and gallos de pcqyacla^ (double-chinned cocks) ;
they might be kept sixty days without being plucked or
dressed, and wdthout giving out a bad smell. 2 So it was
with human corpses, particularly in winter. Their villages
are very neat. Tlio houses are very well distributed and
very neat. One room is designed for the kitchen, and
another to grind the grain ; this last is apart and contains
a furnace and three stones made fast in masonry. These
women sit down before the stones ; the first crushes tlie
grain, the second brays it, and the third reduces it entirely
to powder. Before entering they take oS their shoes, tie
their hair, cover their heads and shake their clothes.
2 New Mexico is noted for the dryness of its atmosphere. Dew and
moisture are aknost unknown, and neither animal nor vegetable matter
decay. Dead bodies give out no unpleasant smell, for the ordinary
{nroceas of decomposition does not take place, but they dry up instead*
188 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
While they are at work a man seated at the door plfeys
on the bagpipe, so that they work, keeping time ; they
sing in three voices. They make a great deal of flour at
once ; to make bread they mix it with warm water, and
make a dough wliich resembles the cakes called oublis.
They collect a great quantity of herbs, and when they are
quite dry they use them all the year in cooking their
food. No other fruits than .pine nuts are seen in the
country.
" They have preachers ; the crime against nature is
not known among them ; they are not cruel, do not make
human sacrifices and are not antliropophagi. When we
entered Tiguex it was forty days since Francisco Hernando
had been killed by the inhabitants ; he was nevertheless
found among the dead without any. other injury than the
wound of which he died. He was white as snow and had
Ao unpleasant smell.
" I liave learned something of their manners from one
of our Indians who had been a prisoner among them.
Having asked him why the young girls went wholly
naked, notwithstanding the great cold, he told me they
were not allowed to cover themselves until they were
married. The men wear a sort of shirt of dressed leather
and a pelisse over it. In all this province was found
pottery glazed, and vases of really ciu'ious form and
workmanship."
Tiguex was surrounded by other populous pro\'inces.
HemeSjS with seven villages, was seven leagues to the
3 The pueblo of Hemes or Jemez can be located with the same cer-
tainty as Cibola and Acuco, and forms a third well defined point in the
march of the Spaniards. It is situated on a small river of the same
name West of the Del Norte, and about fifty miles West of Santa Fe',
and at the foot of a chain of high mountains. The population is but
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 189
North-east, and a little more Nortliwardly was that of
Quirix with the same number of villages. Those of Tu-
tahuco4 and Acha were the first four, and the latter forty
leagues distant ; the former to the South which contained
eight villages, and the latter to the North-east. In all
the provinces the peoi)le had the same mamiers and
customs, with the exception of some local peculiarities.
It has been already stated that at the time the army
arrived in Tiguex, the Indians were in a hostile state and
open warfare existed between them and the Spaniards.
The ill-will of the natives was aroused by the bad treatment
Bigotes and the cacique 6f Cicuye had received, and sub-
sequent acts incensed them still more. The soldiers were
in great want of clothing, and Coronado made a demand
upon the Indians for the necessary supply. He required
■of them three hundred pieces of stuffs immediately, but
they asked for time to talk the -matter over in council as
a few hundred, and the style of building with the form of governmcDt,
and the manners and customs of the people, is almost identical with
the other pueblos yet remaining in the country. In the valley of the
littl#riyer, upon which this village is built, are found, at this time, nu-
merous ruins probably the remains of the other pueblos of which the
province consisted when Coronado marched through the country. The
houses are built upon two or three principal streets parallel with each
other, and some of them are two stories high with the upper story reced-
ing from the lower so as to leave space for a sort of uncovered balcony.
Around the village are a few acres covered with apricot and peach
trees. The houses are entered from the ground by means of ladders.
The river here is some fifty feet broad with a rapid current, and flows
to the Southward. Some distance North-west of Jemez, in the valley
of the river Chaco, are extensive ruins of large buildings formerly con-
structed of stone, and which exhibit a style of architecture superior to
any others found in the country. They are probably the remains of
some of the populous provinces which Ca&taileda mentions, but were
not visited.
4 Probably Tutahaco is the pueblo referred to, the name being mis-
epelled.
190 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
was their custom, in order to distribute the amount to be
furnished among the different villages. He consented to
this, and runners were dispatched to the twelve villages
situated upon both banks of the river, but before the
people could assemble and make their arrangements, he
ordered them to furnish the quantity demanded. Soldiers
were sent around to collect tlie stuff of the Indians, who
were obliged to take the clothes off their back to make
up the required amount. If these Christian collectors
were displeased ^vith what was given them, and met a.
l>erson with better garments on, they obliged him to '
change without any regard to his rank or condition.
This bad conduct created a deadly hostility on the part
of the Indians, but they had other cause of grievance of
still greater weight.
An officer rode to a village about a league distant from
the one where he was quartered, when, giving his horse
in charge of an Indian, he entered his house and attempted
to violate his wife. When the Spaniard had ridden
away and the Indian re-entered his house, the wife told
him of the outrage that had been committed upon ner.
The injured husband and the chiefs of the village imme-
diately waited upon the general to complain of the bad
conduct of the officer and to demand redress. This
Coronado promised to grant. He caused the whole army
to be paraded, and directed the husband to point out the
guilty party in order that he might be punished, but he
was not able to recognize him. The Indian then said he
could recognize the horse, when the general ordered all
the horses brought out that he might select the one ridden
by the officer. He pointed out the animal he had held,
but as the owner was not recognized, he denied the accu-
sation, and here the matter ended. The Indians returned
■ -" - ' •-*'■■ — — *-■
THE CONQUEST OP KEW MEXICO. 191
to their village with their grievance unredressed and
greatly dissatisfied.
That night the Indians held a grave council in the
estufa, when, after a discussion of their many wrongs,
they resolved to make war upon the strangers, and, if
possible, to drive them from the province. The next
morning they appeared in arms and commenced hostilities.
They first attacked some of the Indian allies who were
out of camp, killed one man and captured some of the
animals. One of the fugitives brought information of the
attack to the general, who sent out a party in pursuit.
They recovered some of the horses, but a large number.
were lost, together with seven mules that belonged to
Coronado. The next day an officer with a party of men
was sent to a neighboring village for the purpose of talk-
ing with the inhabitantB and endeavoring to make peace
with them f but they saluted them with words of scorn
and derision, and refused to hold any intercourse with
them. The Indians were strongly barricaded and opened
a fire of arrows which killed several horses. Upon the
general being informed of the issue of this mission, he
sent Don Garcia Lopez de Cardenas, with a considerable
force, to besiege one of the villages and bring the inhabi-
tants to terms. lie marched against the village where
the oflicer had oflered the insult to the woman, and made
the attack before his approach was known. The Sj)an-
iards rushed to the assault imd gained the house-tops
without losing a man, although several were wounded by
arrows discharged from the looj)-hole8 of the houses.
Here Cardenas maintained liimself fighting for two dayr;
and one night, the inhabitants meanwhile keeping up a
brisk fire upon his men with arrows, which the Spaniards
returned with cross-bow and arquebus. While they held
492 THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO.
the roofs, some Indiwi allies, protected by the horsemen,
dug passages under ground leading into the houses.
These were filled with some inflammable substance and
set on fire, which smoked the Indians out and compelled
them to sue for quarter. They now made signs of a
desire to come to terms. They were answered by Pablo
Lopez lilelyosa and Diego Lopez, of the council of Seville,
by crossing their hands in token of peace, when the
Indians threw down their arms and surrendered. The
prisoners were conducted to the tent of Cardenas. As he
did not know that they had given themselves up, he
ordered immediate preparations made to burn them alive
both as a warning to their neighbors, and in obedience
to liis orders that none should be spared. He supposed
they had come to ask for their lives, which he could not
grant under liis instructions.. Those who knew they hail
surrendered themselves prisoners of war said nothing, but
jillowed the preparations for their execution to proceed.
But the poor Indians were- not disposed to be massacred
without resistance. When they saw that the Spaniards
intended to violate their faith and put them to deatR, they
began to prepare for resistance. There were nearly one
hundi-ed Indians in the tent. They immediately seized
pieces of wood and everything else they could lay their
hands on that would assist them to defend themselves.
The soldiers now rushed upon them sword in hand, killing
i?ome and driving others outside the tent where the horse-
men charged them and cut them down without mercy.
But few escai:)ed. These concealed themselves in the
village until night when they fled to other parts of the
»^'Ountry.
.THE CONQUEST ^P NEW MEXICO. 1 9S
CHAPTER XXY.
^lEGE AND CAPTURE OF TIGUEX ; OORONADO MARCHES TO
GICUYB.
About the time the village mentioned at the close of
'the last chapter was taken, it commenced to snow and
continued for two months. It fell in such quantities that
it was impossible to undertake any new enterprise, and
the army remained in c^mp and quarters. The Spaniards
-were now anxious to make pea(!e with the Indians, and,
Jis soon as the state of the weather would permit, mes-
sengers were sent into different parts of the province to
invite them to come in and have a talk. This they
refused to do, saying they could not trust people who
paid no regard to treaties and violated their word to those
who had surrendered themselves. About this time Car-
denas returned from the village he had lately captured to
Tiguex, to have a talk with an influential Indian called
'Juan Aleman from his resemblance to a Spaniard of that
name in Mexico. The Indians being suspicious of the
•object of his coming w^ere found on their guard. Car-
denas approached the village and proposed terms of peace,
but they refused to negotiate unless he would dismount
-and remove his horsemen. This, being done Juan Ak-
13
194 THE COl^QUfiST OP NEW MEXICO^
man and the cacique came out to confer with him, htii
before they would proceed to businesB they demanded
that he should lay aside his arms, as they were unarmed,
Cardenas consented to this, notwithstanding his compan-^
ions endeavored to per8uad(y hkn to the contrary, and not
to trust himself in the hands of the enemy without the
mean& of defending himself.
The parties approached each other to treat. When
they met, Aleman, as if for the purpose of embracing him,,
by way of salutation, took Cardenas in his arms ; where
lie held him fast while two of his companions struck liin*
several blows on the head with their tomahawks, which
they had concealed under their garments, and felled him
senseless to the ground. The soldiers, perceiving the
treachery of the Indians, rushed to the rescue of their
captain, whom they succeeded in extricating from hi&
danger ; but the enemy opened upon them a severe fire
of arrows, which wounded several of the men, and obliged
them to retreat. Cardenas was only stunned and in a
Hhort time he was able to* moutit again. The Indians
retired into the village-
The Spaniards now proceeded to another village about
a league and a half distant, where they found a large
number of Indians assembled. They were no more
friendly disposed than those of Tiguex, and received tlxem
with a shower of arrows and shouts of derision. Seeing
they were hostile Cardenas made no effort to hold a parley
with them, but returned to Tiguex, before which he had
left a portion of his men. The inhabitants again sallied
out in great numbers and made every demonstration to
attack him. He feigned a retreat and began to retire ;
whereupon they pursued him into the plain, where he
turjied upon them vnth his horsemen and killed several
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 195
of tlieir bravest warriors. They were put to flight and
eought refuge upon the heights around the village.
In the meantime Coron*do, with the main body of the
army, was lying in camp in the valley recruiting his
forces. After the last combat before Tiguex Cardenas
returned to head-quarters and reported to the general the
result of his scout. The latter resolved to lay siege to
this village and inflict proper punishment upon the
inhabitants for their treachery and hostility, and he made
immediate preparations to open the campaign. He caused
n number of scaling-ladders to be made to enable them
to climb the walls, and perfected other necessary arrange*
raents for such an undertaking. The army now marched
for Tiguex, before which it arrived in good order, and
commenced the assault of the town without delay. The
Indians had watched the approach of the Spaniards from
the house tops and hills, and were prepared to give them
a warm reception. As they attempted to scale the walls
they discharged upon them a shower of arrows, and rolled
down from the tops of the houses great stones which
unhorsed many of the assailants. More than twenty were
pierced with arrows, several of whom died. The attack *
lasted some time, when the Spaniards were repulsed and
withdrew.
Coronado, satisfied the village could not be taken by
assault, changed his plan of operations, and set down
before it to besiege it. Such was the strength of the
place, and the great bravery with which the inhabitants
defended it, that fifty days were occupied in its reduction.
Among other things he cut off th6 water which supplied
the village, which caused great suffering among the gar-
rison. To remedy this the inhabitants sunk a deep well,
which fell in while digging and buried thirty men under
tS6 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
the earth. The village was assaulted many times during
the siege, and more than two hundred of the enemy
were killed before they obtained possession of it. The
Spaniards likewise lost €everal men, killed, among whohi
was Francisco de Pebares, who fell in a desperate assault.
The Indians took prisoner Francisco de Obando, whom
they carried into the village and put to death. He was
a distinguished man, and his death was a great loss to the
army.
In the course of the «iege the Indians sounded a parley
and asked a cessation of hostilities for one day, in order
to send away the women and children, which was granted
them. The Spaniards seized this opportunity to propose
terms of peace, which the enemy declined on the ground
that as they did not keep their word they were not to be
trusted. About one hundred women and children left the
village, the others prefemng to remain and share the
fate of their fathers, husbands and brothers. When the
children were let down from the walls to be sent away
Cardenas, like a gallant knight, advanced and received
tliem in his arms, and delivered them over to their friends.
While thus engaged he put dowTi his helmet, which he
fergot to replace, and remained standing near the walls.
He was observed by an Indian, who made a sign to him
to put on his helmet again and go away or he would fire
upon him. But as he did not move the warrior bent hie
bow and discharged an arrow, wdiich passed between liis
Ivorse's legs without doing any injury. He threatened to
aim another with more accuracy if he did not immediately
leave the place. This w&s sufficient warning to Cardenas,
who replaced his helmet and rejoined his horsemen.
When he had reached a place of safety the Indians uttered
-loud shouts and discharged a shower of arrows, whicli of
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 197
course fell harmless to the ground. The assault was now
relinquished for the day, as Coronado was of opinion thaii
the besieged would consent to make peace ; but as they
refused to listen to all terms proposed to them hostilities
were resumed the next morning.
The siege continued fifteen days after this period,
when the inhabitants abandoned the village in. the night
to retiiro to some otlier part of the country. They
succeeded in leaving the place unperceived, but were
discovered by a sentinel as they were passing the camp of
Don Rodrigo Maldonado ; when an alarm was immedi-
ately sounded. The Indians, aware that their retreat
was known, made an attack upon the Spaniards, and
succeeded in killing one soldier and a horse and wounded
several other soldiers ; but they were put to rout with,
great slaughter. A large number were killed upon the
^ot, wliile the survivors were driven into the river where
most of them were d^o^vned or perished from the cold.
A few succeeded in swimming the stream and getting
upon the opposite bank, but tliey were so much chilled
hy the water that tliey fell exhauJsted upon the ground
unable to proceed. The soldiers crossed the river and
captured the benumbed fugitives, whom they reduced to
slavery. Of the whole number who abandoned Tiguex
but few escaped ; those who survived the combat being
mostly drowned in the river or captured upon the opposite
side. Thus the sieoje terminated and the villaoje fell into
the hands of the Spaniards ; although a few Indians
retired into the outskirts, where they held out for several:
days. Wliile Coronado with the main body of the army
was engaged in the siege of Tiguex, a party of men, under
Don Diego de Quevara and Don Juan de Saldibar, was
sent to capture a neighboring village. Here the Indiana
198 . THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO*
also attempted to escape by night, but they were discovered
by the Spaniards who laid in ambush, who sallied out and
attacked them. A great number were killed and the rest
put to flight. The village was given up to pillage, and
about one hundred women and cliildren were made pris-
oners. These operations were brought to a close at the
end of the year 1541.
Although Tiguex and the neighboring villages had
fallen into the hands of Coronado, it could hardly be said
that the province was subdued. The inhabitants had aU
left their homes and no persuasion could induce them to
return while the Spaniards remained. They were over-
powered but not conquered. Having nothing more to
accomplish in Tiguex the general determined to continue
his march as soon as the weather would permit the troops
to move. Ho was so niuch pleased vnth. the account the
Turk gave of Quivira, and of the great riches said ta
abound tliere, that he came to the determination to march
thither and explore it. For this purpose he left Tiguex
in advance of the armv, with a small escort, and went to
Cicuye to await its arrival. The inhabitants received
him in a friendly manner, and were greatly rejoiced
because he brought their cacique with him and restored
him to liberty.
The \'illage of Cicuye i was situated upon the top of a
great rock^ in a narrow valley, among mountains covered
1 The situation of Cicuye cannot be fixed with certainty^ but there is
great probability that it stood upon the bank of the Jemez, or Guada-
lupe, river, probably the latter, and not far from where that stream
empties into the Del Norte. When the Spaniards came to the latter
river they named it the river of Cicuye, because it flowed near thai
village ; which confirms me in the opinion that it was situated some-
where in the valley of the Guadalupe, and but a few miles trom its
mouth. The province contained several villages, and I believe thai
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 199
<^tli pines. A small stream flowed through the valley,
Avhich abounded in trout and ottei's, and bears and hawk^
were also found in great numbers. The houses were
.built around a great square in the centre, underneath
which were vapor-baths ; they were all built with terraces,
<and of the same height, four or five stories, and on the
roofs the inhabitants could jpass around the whole village
"without being interrupted by , a. single street. To the fii*8t
two stories there was a corridor in the form of a balcony,
which also made the circuit of the village, under which*
the people sat and sheltered themselves. The houses
Jiad no doors below, but they were entered by means of
movable ladders, by whicli the inhabitants ascended to
the balconies. On the upper stories the doors opened
out upon the balconies, which fronted both toward the
^country and the public square. Those which faced
the two which dow bear the names of Santa Ana, and Silla, or Cia,
were of the number. The Spaniards called one of them Silos, which
subsequent explorers may have changed into Silla. It is possible that
Cicuyc stood upon the banks of the^Del Norte, and there is some evi-
dence to justify this conclusion. When the army returned from the
plains it struck the river Oiouye (Del Norte) about thirty leagues South
of the point where it crossed that stream in marching to the plains ;
thence it ascended the river until the village of Cicuyc' was reached.
This evidence appears^pretty conclusive that the pueblo of Cicuyc' was
situated upon the river of the same name, otherwise the Del Norte.
This hypothesis, however, is hardly reconcilable with the original text
that a small stream flowed by Cicuy^. Castafieda states that the village
of Cicuy€ was situated upon the top of a great rock, in a narrow valley
surrounded by mountains, and that a small stream flowed by it. This
location agrees pretty well with the situation of Cia or Silla as found
by Vargas when he visited it in 1C92. He then described it as situated
upon the mesa of Cerro Colorado, and it could only be reached by
ascending the slope of the mesa by a steep and stony road. A small
.river ran near it. The village had been destroyed a few years before
■by Cruzate, and a new one was aftesv^ard built at the foot of the ;xies^,
«7hecB.itremains to ibis day.
200 TBTE CONQUEST OP NEW WSXICO.
inward to the court were higher than the outer oneiv
which made the place stronger in time of war. The
YiUage could muster about five hundred warriors, who
were feared by all their neighbors ; they boasted that
they had vanquished all who dared attack them, and had
never been subdued. It was supplied with water from a
spring at a little distance. These people were of the
same race as those encountered before, and had similar
manners and customs. Before marriage the females went
entirely naked, of which it was said they had no cause to
be ashamed, as they were born so.
In this province tliere were several villages. The first
was Ximera, between Cicuye and the province of Quirix ;
ivnd near by was a large one in ruins, being abandoned
except by a few people who lived in one quarter. It had
the appearance of having been destroyed by violent means.
The Spaniards called it Silos, because they found a quan-
tity of corn-pits (silos) near it. Beyond this there was
another large village entirely in ruins and without inhab-
itants. In the court yard they found a number of stone
balls, which appeared to have been thrown by a macliine,
and were supposed to have been used to batter down the
place. They were the size of a large cannon ball. The
inhabitants of tlie province told the Spaniards that foui^
or five years before they were invaded by a numerous
and powerful nation called Teyas, who destroyed theuf
villages. They were represented as having machines for
besieging. They were so named because they were a
valliant people, and were supposed to have come from
the North, though it was not known. The Teyans after-
ward made an alliance with the Cicuyans and sometimes
came to winter under the walls of their villages ; but they
were never allowed to pass the night inside, because of
THE: CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 201
the dread the inhabitants entertained of them. These
two nations traded with each other. The Teyans were
said to mount guard.in their own country with trumpets,
and that the sentinels called eacli other . in the same
manner as in Spain. There were seven other villages
between the route the Spaniards pursued and the Sierra .
Nevada* mountains, one of which belonged to Cicuye, and
one other had been destroyed by the Teyans.
i These were not the Sierra Nevada mountains of Califomia, bat a
range in New Mexico a short distance West of the Del Nort<^, and
were given this name by the Spaniards because they W£re coverecli
with snow when first seen by them. .
202 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER XXVI.
THE AR^IY LEAVES TIGUEX AND iLAECHES OUT UPON THE
PLAINS.
CoRONADO, having re-established the cacique in his
dignity and authority in Cicuye and made some examina-
tion of the country, returned to his camp, leaving the
inliabitants very friendly toward him. Soon afterward
a deputation from the large and populous village of Chia,i
four leagues distant on the river, came in to make terms ;
and the general sent an officer and a few soldiers back
with them to their village to hold a council. They made
submission. To give assurance of the confidence the
Spaniards reposed in them, four old bronzed cannoni;
were left with them for safe-keeping. A party of six
soldiers was next sent to the province of Quirix, which
likewise contained seven villages. The inhabitants of
the first \'illage fled at their approach, but upon being
pursued and assured of good treatment they returned-
Here the Spaniards remained for some time waiting for
Ihe river to break up so that they could cross over. It
1 This may have been the present Cilia or Cia, as it is located in the
,same region of countiy.
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 203
had been frozen for four months, and the ice was thick
enough to bear the weight of a horse ; but they did not
attempt to cross until it had thawed.
In the meanwhile the army had been making prepara-
tions to leave Tiguex and march to Quivira. By this
time the Spaniards had begun to suspect that all the
Turk had told them about the abundance of gold and
silver in Quivira was not true, and they watched him
closely. Cervantes, who had charge of him, swore that
he had seen him conversing with the devnl in a vase of
water, during the siege, and he related the following
particulars of the matter : " That while he was keeping
this man under lock and key, so that he could commu-
nicate with no one, the Turk asked him who was the
Christian that had been killed by the people of Tiguex ;
that he hftd answered that no one had been killed, but
that the Indian had told him : ' You lie ; they have killed
five Christians and a captain.' Cervantes was obliged to
assent, for it was truth, and asked the Turk who had
told him ; but the latter replied, ' I have no need of any
person to know it.' Since that time Cervantes had
watched him, and had seen him speak with the devil."
About tliis time some Indians arrived from Cibola on a
visit to the general, and were received very kindly. He
charged them to extend every assistance to the Spaniards
who might pass through their country. He gave them
letters to carry back for Don Pedro de Tobar, who was
expected shortly to arrive there from Sonora with rein-
forcements for the army. These letters contained in-
structions as to the route Coronado would take, with
information that he would cause crosses to be erected
as he advanced into the interior, by wliich Tobar would
find other letters.
204 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
The army left Tiguex on the 5th of May, (1542,) for
Giciiye where it arrived in safety in a march of twenty-five
leagues, s According to a promise Coronado had made
the Indians some time before, he restored Bigotes to
liberty and permitted him to rejoin his people. They
received him with many demonstrations of delight, and
were so well pleased with this generous conduct that
they furnished an abundance of provisions to the whole
army. They appeared entirely pacific, and promised
ever after to live on good terms with the Spaniards.
The cacique and Bogotes gave to Ooronado a young
Indian named Xabe, a nati^ of Quivira, to serve as
guide to that country. He confirmed the information
given by the Turk, that gold and silver were to be found
there, but said they were not so abundant as he had
represented.
After a brief rest at Cicuye the Spaniards resumed
the march. In a few leagues they came to a chain of
mountains which tliey entered, and toiling, up their rugged
sides crossed them and debouched upon a more level coun-
try beyond. In a march of four days they arrived at the
bank of a great rivers which tliey called the river of Ci-
2 This distance is overestimated.
3 This was the Kio Grande del Norte, and the chain of mountains
passed four days before reaching the river was that now known as the
Jemcz mountains. The general direction of the march since leaving
Cibola, was North-east, thou^ now and then they deviated, either on
account of natural obstacles or to visit neighboring pueblos. The
point where the Spaniards crossed the Del Norte was a little North of.
Santa Fe', and between the pueblos of Cochiti and San Yldefonso ; and
holding on their course must have come out upon the plains somewhere
North and East of where Fort Union now stands. The Indians they
encountered there were, probably, some of the wandering tribes that
are slill found on the plains, either the Kiowahs, Cheyennes, Arrapa-
hoes or the Comanches, all of whom dwell in lodges and subsist by the
chase, as did the Querechos described by Castafieda.
THE COXQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 20'5
ctiye because it flowed near that village. Here they were
obliged to halt for several days in order to construct a
bridge! when they crossed over and continued their march.
They now entered a mountainous country over which
they held their coiu'se with no greater obstacles than na-
ture presented, for the space of ten days, when they
encountered sbme Indians who dwelt in tents like Arabs.
They were called Querechos. Their tents or lodges were
made of tanned buffalo skin, and they lived upon tlic
flesh of this animal. They ^^•cre not alarmed at the sight
of strangers coming into their country, but came out of
their lodges to meet them and see who thev were. Thev
asked tlie advance guard to direct them to the chief, when
they were conducted to Coronado, whom they approached
and conversed with by signs. They appeared to be an
intelligent people and made themselves so well understood
by signs tlmt the Spaniards had no difliculty in conversing
with them without the assistance of an interpreter. In-
quuy was made of them whether gold and silver abounded
in the Quivira country they wei*e in search of; when
they confirmed all the Turk had said, but not until after
they had first seen and talked \^^th that Indian. They
told Coronado that by going to^\T^rd the rising sun they
would come to a very great rivers which might be
followed for ninety days down its banks without leaving
an inhabited country ; it was more than a league l)road
and was covered with a great number of canoes. The
first village upon it they called Ilaxa. The next day the
•
4 Dnring my residence in New Mexico, I was told that some remains
of what were supposed to have been a bridge across the Del Norle,
were still to be seen about where I have located the crossing.
5 Probably the Arkansas, as that is much the largest river to be mat
with on tho plains in crossing them in the latitude of Santa Fe.
206 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
Indians broke up their camp and moved away, transport-
ing all their baggage upon the backs of dogs, of which
they had a large number with them.
The army continued the march toward the South-east,
and in two days came up with the Querechos who had
pitched tlieir camp. The Spaniards were now fairly out
upon the great plains that lie between the eastern slope
of the Rocky mountains and the Mississippi river, and
extend from the British Possessions in the North, to the
gulf of Mexico in the South. They were surrounded by
a nearly level country covered with tall grass, on which
immense herds of buffaloes were pasturing in every di-
rection.« The Indians again assured them that they
« Castaileda, in speaking of Uie plains and what they saw there,
among other things writes as follows : " Who would beUe7e that a
thousand horses, one hundred and fifty cows of Spanish breed, and
more than five thousand sheep, and fifteen hundred persons, including
Indian servants, would not leave the slightest trace of their passage in
the desert, and that it was necessary to raise, from point to point,
heaps of stones and buffalo bones, in order that the rear guard might
follow us, for the grass, short as it was, rose up after being trodden
down, as straight and fresh as ever.
•* Another very astonishing thing is that on the eastern margin of
one of the salt hikes toward the South, was found a spot almost half
a musket shot long, entirely covered with buffalo bones to the height
of twelve feet, and eighteen feet broad, which is surprising in a desert
country where no one could have brought these bones together. It is
pretended that when the lake is troubled by the North winds, it throws
upon the opposite shore the bones of aU animals which have perished
in coming to drink.
"The first time we encountered the buffalo, all the horses took to
flight on geeing them, for they are horrible to the sight."
The following is Castafieda's description of the buffalo, which will
answer very well at the present day. There can be no doubt, what-
ever, of the identity of the animal here described with the American
bison or buffalo. He says :
" They have a broad and short face, eyes two palms from each
other, and projecting in such a manner sideways that they can see a
THE CONQUEST OP NEW BffiXICX)* 207
would arrive at many villages by traveling toward the
East, which encouraged them to continue in that direction*
Here one man was lost, having gone out hunting and
not being able to find his way back to camp ; and an officer,
named Garcia, accidentally broke his arm. The Turk
told Coronado they were now near the village of Haxa,
and he dispatched Diego Lopez with a small party of
men in search of it, with orders to march as rapidly as
possible, and to lose no time in returning to tlie main
body.
The next day the army again came in sight of bufialoes
•
pursaer. Their beard is like that of goats, and so long that it drags
the ground when they lower the head. They have, on the anterior
portion of the body a frizzled hair like sheep's wool ; it is very fine
npon the croup and sleek like a lion's mane. Their horns are very
short and thick, and can scarcely be seen through the hair. They al-
ways change their hair in May, and at this season they really resemble
lions. To make it drop more quickly, for they change it as adders do
their skins, they roll among the brush- wood which they find in the
ravines.
** Their tail is very short and terminates in a great tuft. When they
run they carry it in the air like scorpions. When quite young they
are tawny and resemble our calves, but as age increases they change
color and form.
" Another thing which struck us was that all the old buffaloes that
we killed had the left ear cloven, while it was entire in the young ;
we could never discover the reason of this.
" Their wool is so fine that handsome clothes would certainly be
made of it, but it cannot be died, for it is a tawny red. We were much
surprised at sometimes meeting innumerable herds of bulls without a
single cow, and other herds of cows without bulls. It would some-
times be forty leagues from one herd to another, and that in a country
so level that from a distance the sky was seen between their legs, so
that when many were together, they would have been called pines
whose foliage united^ and if but one was seen his legs had the effect of
four pines. When near, then it was impossible by an effort, to per-
ceive the ground beyond, for all this country is so flat, that turn which
way we will, the sky and the grass are alone to be seen.''
208 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO,
which covered the plains in almost incredible numbers.
They took to flight on the appearance of the Spaniards,
and overturned each other in their anxiety to escape. In
tlieir course lay a large and deep ravine, but as they could
not stop with the countless thousands in the rear pushing
t^em on,, they tumbled headlong into it, and so many fell
unable to lise again, that the bodies of the fallen formed
a bridge for the others to cross over on. The cavalry
were in hot pursuit of the flying herd, and before they
were aware of it, they were in the ravine among the
struggling animals. They extricated themselves with
difiiculty, and some of the horses became so mucli en-
tangled that they could not be recovered, and were neither
seen nor heard of again. Lopez had now been gone some
time and the general began to be uneasy at his long
absence. He was expecting him back every moment,
but heard no tidings of him. He therefore sent parties
out to scour tlic surrounding country and to examine both
banks of the little river which ran near wliere the army
then was. As the tall grass which covered the whole
country rose up again almost immediately after being
trampled down, it was an easy matter for one to lose
his way. The lost party were discovered by some Indians
out gathering fruit near where the soldiers were search-
ing for them, and wore conducted back to camp. Lopez
reported that they had traveled more than twenty leagues,
and had seen nothing but buflFaloes and sky.
Coronado was at a loss to know what to believe con-
cerning the Quivira, amid the conflicting rumors that
reached him. He had with him a painted Indian named
Sopete, said to be a native of that province, who gave a
'very different account of the coimtry from the Turk,
'swhom the wliole army now began to suspect of misrepre-
THE COIJQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 200
^ renting tilings. For a time Sopete was believed; but
when the Querechos confirmed the story of the Tm*k, the
account of the former fell into disrepute, and he was be-
. lieved no longer. In order to . learn the truth of the
matter, if possible, he determined to send an expedition
to explore the country in the direction where he supposed
■ Quivira to lie. .For this purpose he detailed Don Kodrigo
Maldonado \dth his company, who immediately left camp
on that service. In his march he came to a great ravine
in whi6h was a village of Indians that Cabeza de Vaca
and his companions had visited when they paSsed through
the country.r They made Maldonado a present of a
quantity of skins, a very large tent or lodge, and many
other tilings. Here he encamped and sent some of his
soldiers back to the army with a request to Coronado that
he should come to that point. The army marched thither
and in a few days all the troops were united in the ravine.
The general determined to divide the skins given to Mal-
donado among the whole army, and in order to prevent
any of them being taken before the distribution should
l)e made, he placed a guard over them. But the guard
permitted some persons to take a few, when the soldiers
fearing that a fair division would not *be made, carried
the whole of them oflf without permission. The Indians
took part in the general scramble but they did not get
any of them. The women and children cried bitterly
when they saw the skins in the possession of the Span-
iards,[as they had not believed they would carry them off,
but supposed they would bless them as Cabeza de Vaca
. had done. In the village they saw an Indian woman as
7 No definite location can be given to this point except that it was
^ oat upon the plains, probably about South-east of the latitude of Santa
- Fe.
.14
210 THE CONQUEST OF NEW HEXIOO.
white as themselves, with her chin painted after ther
fashion of the Moors.
While the army remained at this place there arose a
furious storm of wind and hail. The hail stones are said
to have been as large as " porringers," and some of them
larger, and covered the ground to the depth of a foot, or
a foot and a half. They fell with such force as to ruin,
many of the tents, indent the hehnets of the soldiers, and
wound several men ; besides breaking all the dishes in
camp, wliich was deemed the greatest calamity, as none
others could be procured in the country to replace them.
'The violence of the storm caused a stampede among the
animals, and all broke loose except two or three horses
which were held by negroes, who wore helmets upon
their heads to protect them from the hail stones. The
wind raised some of tlie horses off their feet and threw
them with great violence against the sides of the ravine,
and others were forced into places from which they were
rescued with difficulty. There was neither maize nor
bread in this country, and the people lived on raw or
badly-cooked meat and fruit8.8
8 Nothing is said of the manners and customs of the inhabitants of
this region, nor of their particular location except being near a large
and deep ravine. But Maldonado, in his exploration, had undoubtedly
advanced toward the East from the former position of the army.
THS CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. , 211
CHAPTER XXVII
COROXADO MARCHES TO QUIVIRA ; SOME ACCOUNT OF THE
PLAIN INDIANS.
The Spaniards found this region of the plains very
populous. A reconnoitering party sent out by Coronado
came to a people inhabiting huts resembling "heaths,"i
and of different construction from those in the ravine ;
and they found beans, plums which resembled those of
Spain, and grape *vines. This^place was called Cona.
The army again resumed its march, and for three days
it passed through an inhabited country. It was accom-
panied by some Teyas Indians as guides, who took with
them their women and children, and, as was their custom,
had a large number of dogs to carry their baggage. They
were intelligent and appeared to be well acquainted with
the country. Their account of it differed very much
from that given by the Turk, whom the Spaniards now
believed had deceived them, and they began to have
confidence in the painted Indian. The Teyans said the
country of Quivira was toward the North, « but that there
was no good road leading thither. The army encoun-
1 ** D'autres cabanes semblables I. des brujeres (alixares)."
s South.
'2^2 l^E COKQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
tered other large ravines, one of which was a league
broad, and at the bottom was a fertile little plain watered
by a small stream- Here were found growing, trees,
grape vines, rose bushes, plums similar to those of Castile,
and poultry like that of New Spain. The inhabitants of
the country treated their wives well, who were chaste
and modest in their behavior. They were well clothed
in dressed-leather, and wore leggings. The women wore
a mantle of the same material over the petticoat, falling
from the shoulders, with trimmed and ornamented
sleeves ; and also another little garment said to resemble
an expiatory vestment, which reached down to the middle
of the body over the petticoat, and was ornamented with
tassels.
The army having marched a long distance out upon
the plains, and the provisions beginning to fail without
any prospect of obtaining a new supply, a council of the
officers was held to determine the best course to be pur-
sued. They were satisfied that the Turk had deceived
them in conducting them to this point, and that his
advice could no longer be taken with safety. The
council decided that Coronado, with a small escort, should
continue his search for Quivira, while the army should
return to Tiguex under the command of Tristan de
Arellano. When this determination was made known to
the soldiers they expressed great dissatisfaction, saying
they were ready to die with their general, and implored
him not to abandon them, but permit them accompany
him. This he refused to do, but promised to let them
know in eight days whether they could rejoin him.
Coronado made preparations to depart for Quivira.
He selected an escort of thirty horsemen and six foot-
soldiers from among those who were the best mounted and
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 213
equipped) and had a reputation for courage. He nomi-
nated Diego Lopez his second in command. The Teyans
furnished him with guides, and he also took with him
Sopete, the painted Indian, and the Turk, the latter
being loaded with chains as a punishment for his treach-
ery. Being fully prepared, he left camp in search of
that almost fabulous country and city, which had engaged
so many of the thoughts of the Spaniards.
For a time we will leave the army, and follow the
fortunes of its general. The Turk had conducted the
Spaniards so much out of their way, that Coronado was
foHy-eight days in reaching Quivira.3 His whole march
3 In the county of Valencia, about hundred and fifty miles, nearly
due South of Santa Fe, is to be found a ruin which bears the name of
Quivira, and is believed to be the remains of the town that Coronado
was in search of. Gleneral Carleton, U. S. A., who visited this locality
a few years ago, giyes the following account of it He says : *' The
ruins consist of the remains of a large church or cathedral, with a
monastery attached ; a small church or chapel, and the ruins of the
town extending nine hundred feet in a direction East and West, and
three hundred North and South. All these buildings have been con-
structed of the dark-blue limestone which is found in the vicinity. The
walls of the cathedral are now about thirty feet in height. It wa&
esthnated, from the great quantity of stones that have fallen down,
forming a sort of talus, both with the walls and the outside of them,
that originally this building was all of fifty feet in height. There is a
small room to the right as you enter the cathedral, and another room
which is very large, and which communicates with the main body of
the building, by a door at the left of the transcept. There was also a
communication between this large room and the monastery, or system
of cloisters, which are attached to the cathedral. This building is one
hundred and eighteen feet long outside, and thirty^two in width. It is
apparently in a better state of preservation than the cathedral, but yet
none of the former wood- work remains in it." Among the ruins are
found great quantities of broken earthenware, such as the Pueblo
Indians formerly made, some of which shows traces of having been,
once handsomely painted and glazed. An old road runs toward the
East, on the bed of which are growing large cedar-trees. The cou^try
214 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICOw
lay across extensive plains, and was only accomplished
after many hardships and great fatigue. The location
of Quivira was to the West of the great ravine whence
he set out, and upon a plain within sight of mountains.
The country was well peopled, and abounded in fruits,
such as plums, grapes, nuts and mulberries, and also
produced rye, grass, oats, pennyroyal and flax. The
latter grew wild ; and the inhabitants did not cultivate
it, because tliey were not acquainted with its use.
The houses were round, without walls, with roofs of
1 ■
in the vicinity shows no traces of former cultivation, and at the present
day the nearest water is fifteen miles off. The ruins now fouA at
Quivira are the remains of buildings erected by the Spaniards after
they had taken possession of the country and Cliristianized the Indians ;
while the houses of the natives have so completely passed away as not
to leave a trace behind them. After the most careful examina-
tion of the subject there is no other location which I am able to give
the Quivira of Castailcda. These ruins are in the same region of
country where he locates Quivira. In the course of more than three
hundred years the country has undergone such change as to reduce it
from a fertile and populous region, as the Spaniards then described it,
to an uninhabited and barren waste, as found at the present day.
In the same section of country are other ruins. Forty miles North-
west of Quivira are those of Quarra, on a small stream that soon sinks
into the earth and disappears. Here are the remains of a church,
portions of which are in tolerable preservation. Near by are two
groves ot apple tiees which are said to have been planted when these
villages were inhabited. As these trees are not indigenous to the
country they were probably planted by Spanish priests when the town
was a missionary station. Twelve miles South of Quarra are the ruins
of Abo. The ruin of the church shows that the building was large,
built in the Cbrm of a cross, the long arm being one hundred and thirty-
two feet in length, and the short arm forty-one feet. The material of
construction was red sandstone. Some of the timbers show marks of
the axe, and no doubt the building was the work of Spaniards. Near by
are heaps of stones that mark the site of ruined houses. The remains
of an outer wall can be traced nine hundred and fifty feet from North to
South and four hundred and fifty from East to West. The wall, no
doubt, enclosed the Indian town, and with their compact way of build--
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 215
straw, under which the people slept and kept their
property. The village resembled those of New Spain,
and the manners and customs of the people were the
same as those of theTeyans, The people had neither
gold nor silver, nor were they acquainted with these
metals. The cacique wore a plate of copper upon his
breast, which he prized very highly.
In the vicinity of Quivira were several other populous
provinces, some of which were said to have been visited
by a Portuguese, a monk, a negro, and some Indians of
iDg the population must have been considerable. The country around
is barren and roUiug, covered with pine trees and without evidence of
ever having been under cultivation. While this work was in press, the
following paragraph, in the Semi- Weekly JReview^ published at Al-
buquerque, New Mexico, of April IGth, 1869, relating to some recent
discoveries at the Gran Quivira, fell under my notice, viz :
*' We understand that a tunnel and several shafts have recently been
discovered within a distance of twenty miles of the niins of Gran
Quivira. The mouth of the tunnel had been closed with stone masonry,
and the wall concealed with earth, and the shafts concealed in like
manner. The tunnels and shaAs are supposed to be a portion of the
Gran Quivira mines which were concealed when the Indians drove
the Spaniards out of the country some three hundred years ago, and
all traces of which ^re so obliterated that searchers gave them up as
having had existence only in the imagination of travelers and gossips ;
and the town of Gran Quivira was considered by some savana to have
been merely a Jesuit mission, and by others an ancient Aztec city,
rather than the habitation of miners for the precious metals and the
traders who supplied them and their families. The discovery was
purely accidental ; and Time, which gives a lucid solution of questions
which perplex the brains of philosophers and statesmen for ages,
revealed these tunnels and shafts to persons who were not searching
for them, long after intelligent men, guided by tradition and old manu-
scripts, had abandoned them as romantic. TimffiB process was simple ;
the seasons caused the masonry and earth which concealed it to * settle'
m a manner to expose the entrances of tunnel and shafts, and thereby
settled the question of their existence. We have been shown speci-
mens of quartz taken from the tunnel at sixty leet distance from the
entrance. How rich it wiH prove is a question for asaayers."
M
216 THE COKQUEBT OF NEW MEXICO.
the province of Capetlan. The monk was killed because*
he wished to go among the enemies of the Tejans, and
the Portuguese made his escape to New Spain on horse-
back. The Mexican Indians l^uried the monk, by
permission of those who had killed him, and then*
rejoined the Portuguese. In speaking of this country
Casteiiada says : "In this country takes its rise the great
river of Espiritu Santa which Don Hernando de Soto
discovered in Florida ; it traverses afterward 'a province
called Arache. The sources were not seen ; they were
very far distant, and on the slope of the Cordillera
toward the plains. It crosses them entirely, as well as
the Cordillera of the North Sea. Its mouth is three
hundred leagues from the spot where Hernando de Soto
and his companions embarked. The course of the river
is so long, and it receives so many affluents, that it has a
prodigious breadth where it empties into the sea; one is
long in fresh water after having lost sight of land. '\
After Coronado had reached Quivira and was satisfied
how greatly the Turk had deceived him both about the
4 Juan Jaramilla, a captain in the army of Coronado, in his relation
of the march gives the following account of the country of Quivira :.
'* This country has a superb appearance, and such that I have not
seen any better in all Spain, nor in Italy, or in France, nor in any
country where I have been in the service of his majesty. It is not a
country of mountains ; there are only some hills, plains, and streams
of very beautiful water ; it satisfied me completely. I presume that
it ought to be very fertile and favorable to the culture of all species of
fruits. As for flocks, experience proves that it is very suitable, judgr
ing from the multitude of animals that are found there, and which is as
considerable as can hi imagined. We found Spanish prunes, and a
specie which is not entirely red, but resembles the red prunes. It is
certain that the tree and the fruit are of the same specie as those of
Spain. The taste of these prunes is excellent. We found in the
country some cows, flax which grows without culture in little shoots-
separate from each other ; and as the savage flocks do not eat it on^
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 217.
eountry and the manner of reaching it, he interrogated
him as to his motives for practicing so much deception.
He replied that the people of Gicuye had requested him
to lead them astray upon the plains so thai their horses
would perish, when the men, returning exhausted, could-
be easily overcome and killed by them in revenge for all
the injuries they had suffered from the Spaniards ; that
he had agreed to do this because he supposed the Chris-
tians could not live by hunting, but could only subsist
on corn, and their destruction would be easy ; and that
he had never known where there was either gold or
silver. For this treachery, as well as to prevent him
giving dangerous information to the people of the coun-
try, he was put to death. This delighted Sopete, the
Tevas Indian, because the Turk had constantlv traduced
him, and prevailed upon the Spaniards not to believe
him.
We left the army encamped in the valley, where it
remained for fifteen days, and until an order was received
from the general for it to return to Tiguex, at which place
Bees the stalks and the blue flowers; altboagh small it is excellent.
There is found in some of the streams sumac not unlike that of Spam,
and a grape of very good taste, although it may not be cultivated.
The houses of these Indians are of straw, a very great nuiftber being
of a circular shape ; the straw descends almost to the earth like walls ;
they do not resemble ours ; on the outside and top there is a specie of
chapel or turret having an entrance where the Indians sit or sleep. In
the village where the cross was erected the Indian Ysopete was left,
and they took in place of him five or six others to conduct us to houses
covered with flat roofs, and we traveled by the same road that we had
already passed over, as far as the river to which we gave the name of
Sabit Peter and Saint Paul. From this place we left the road that we
had foUowed. The guides now took to the right and conducted us in
the midst of marshes and cows^ in a good country, although there is
not seen on any side other signs of a road than those left by the cows^.
even as I have said it,"— Temcwx Campana, Appendice, p, STS*.
M
218 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
he promised to join them. In the meantime the troops
had killed a great number of buftaloes in order to procure
provisions for the return march. In the chase of these
animals many of the soldiers became lost upon the plains,
and as the camp was in the valley and shut out from
their sight, they oftentimes had great difficulty in finding
their way back. An Indian in pursuit of buffaloes
pierced one of them through and through with an arrow,
which, as the Spaniards had never witnessed such an
exploit before, greatly astonished them. It was the
practice, every evenin;:^, to call the roll of those who
were missing, fire cannons, sound trumpets, and kindle
fires as signals to point out the direction of the camp.
The Indians met some upon the plains and brought
them in, and a few of the most skillful were able to find
their way back without assistance. The country was so
level, that the only way of determining their position
was to keep in mind the point where the sun had risen
in the morning when they left <jamp, and to remain near
the game they killed until they could see in what direc-
tion it would set ; when they could calculate the direction
to camp.
The Spaniards had marched out upon the plains some
hundred and fifty leagues, according to their estimate.*
This whole distance the country was nearly a dead level,
without mountain or hill to diversify the even surface.
They saw several small ponds, some fresh and others salt,
bordered by tall grass. A few trees were found growing
along the banks of the streams which ran through the
ravines, into which they descended by the paths the
5 This estimate of the distance is too great. One hundred and fifty
leagues would have brought them to the Arkansas river, but Castafieda
.8a3;:s nothing about coming to a river of such magnitude.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 219
buffaloes made in going to water. The inhabitants were
wandering Indians who h'ved in lodges, of whom they
found two tribes, the Qaerechos and Teyan8;8 they were
braver and more accustomed to war than those who lived
in the villages, and were a taller and stronger race of
men. They subsisted entirely by the chase of the buf-
falo, the skins of which they preserved and dressed and
bartered to their neighbors. They passed the summer
upon the plains, and in the winter retired to the villages,
where they lived in peace and harmony with the inhabi-
tants until the spring opened. Some went to Cicuye, and
others to Quivira, or neighboring towns. The baggage
was fastened on the backs of their dogs by means of a
girth and small pack-saddle; and when the pack became
disarranged the dogs made a sign by barking, for their
masters to adjust it. No other domestic animal was seen
among them. These Indians were mild and gentle in
their manners ; and besides eating raw meat they drank
blood, but did not eat human flesh.
They prepared buffalo meat by cutting it into thin
slices and drying it in the sun, after which they pounded
it into a powder.r They cooked it by putting it into a
pot with water, and boiling, when it expanded so much
that a single handlul made a meal. The meat was
always prepared with the fat, which was carefully pre-
served when the animal was killed. The blood of the
buffalo and other animals was esteemed a great delicacy,
which they preserved and drank as d usual beverage.
They filled a large intestine with it, which they carried
6 It might be infeijed that those who lived in the ravines had habi-
tations of a more permanent kind, and were a distinct, or at least a
different, people from those who dwelt in tents or lodges.
.7 Buffalo meat is cured in the same manner bj the New Mexicans.
220; THE CONGEST OF NEW MEXICO.
around the neck, and when dry quenched their thirst
from it. When they opened a buffalo they collected the
masticated grass found in the stomach, which they
squeezed and drank as it ran out. This, also, they
relished exceedingly, and considered it the whole sub-
stance of the belly. They used a pebble fastened to the
end of a stick for a knife, with which they could cut up
a buffalo with the same facility as though the instrument
had been made of the best steel. They opened the
animal on the back, and divided it at the joints with
a rapidity that astonished the Spaniards. They sharp-
ened these pebbles on their teeth. There were a great
many white wolves upon the plains, which pursued the
buffalo, but they were found of no other color. Spotted
stags abounded in great numbers, and when dead and
while still warm, the hair was easily taken off by the
hand. Hares were numerous, and so tame that they
allowed the horsemen to kill them with the lance. They
were not afraid, of buffaloes, but would flee before a man,
on. foot.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 221
OHAPTEH XXVIII.
vtN ACCOUNT OF THE rno\TxcES THE spaniauds visited;
THE ARMY RETURNS TO TIGUEX.
4
Up to the point where the army was left upon the plains,
•*the SpaniaiiU had passed through the following pro-
vinces, which are given in the words of Castafieda, viz. :
" Cibola is the first province; it contains seven villages.
Tusayan, seven ; the rock of Acuco, one ; Tiguex, twelve ;
Tutahaco, eight, (these villages are found in descending
the river) ; Quirix, seven ; in tbo snowy mountains, seven ;
Ximena, three; Cicuye, one; Hemes, seven; Aguasla-
-lientes, three; Ynqueyxmque of the mountains, six;
Valladolid or Braba, one ; Chia, one, which makes in all
seventy. Tiguex is the central point, and Valladolid the
last toward the North-east, i The four villages on the
•river below Tiguex are toward the South-east because
the river makes an elbow to the East; it is reckoned
about one hundred and thirty leagues from the highest
.point to the lowest, reached by the expedition. This
interval is wholly inhabited ; here are situated the seventy
villages of which I have spoken ; judging from appear-
1 This direction is coreect if taken from Cibola, but not otherwise.
222 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXIca
auce they may contain about twenty thousand men. The
rest of the country is entirely desert ; not the smallest
hut is seen. This circumstance, the customs and forms
of government of the nations, wholly different from all
those hitherto discovered, prove that they have come
from that part of the great Indias, the coasts of which
touch those of this country to the Westward. They
liave been able to arrive by following the' course of the
river, after having crossed the mountains, and establish
themselves in places tliat seemed advantageous. As they
have multiplied they have built other villages until the
river failed them, by sinking in the earth. When it
reappears it takes the direction of Florida. There exist,
they say, other villages on the bank of this river, but
they were not visit<;d ; under the advice of the Turk we
preferred crossing the mountains where it takiB its source.
1 believe great riches would l)e found in the country
whence these Indians have come. From the route they
followed they nnist have come from tlie extremity of the
East Indias, and from a very unknown portion wliich,
from the configuration of the coasts, would be situated
veiy far in the interior between China and Norway. It
must indeed be an immense distance from one sea to the
other agreeably to the form of the coasts, as discovered
by captain Yillalobos who went in that direction in
search of China. It is the same if we follow the coast
of Horida ; it continually approaches Norway until we
reach the country of God, (Newfoundland).
" To return to our subject. I will say then that in
the length of one hundred and thirty leagues, following
the course of the river, and in a breadth of thirty, no
more inhabitants are seen than I have above mentioned.
Many governments of New Spain contain a much more
THE CONQUEST 6P NEW MEXICO* 22i5
considerable population. In many villages are found
pieces of silver-ore, which serve the natives in varnishing
and painting earthenware."
At the close of tlie last chapter we left the army
encamped upon the plains. As soon as the messenger
from Coronado arrived, the troops made immediate pre-
parations to begin the return march. Leaving the valley
they marched to the country of the Teyas Indians, who
famished them with guides to cpnduct them to Tiguex
by a nearer route than the one they had come. They
returned through a new part of the country, and further
South, \vith which the guides appeared to be perfectly
acquainted. Castafieda gives the following as the manner
. in which they guided the array on its march : " In the
morning they observed where the sun rose, and took
their course by shooting an arrow before them ; before
reaching this arrow tliey discharged another, and in this
manner they marched the entire route up to the place
they found water and encamped." They passed a num-
ber of salt marshes or lakes, whgre they found a large
quantity of salt, botli in cakes and in a crystalline form.2
Some of the cakes were several feet in length, four or
five inches thick, and floated upon the top of the water.
It was bitter to the taste. On the plains they encoun-
tered a great number of small animals that resembled the
squirrel, and lived in holes tliey dug in the ground.s
Tliey struck the river Cicuye more than thirty leagues
below the point where they had crossed it in marching
to the plains, whence they followed up the bank,
which abounded with fruit similar to the Muscat grape.
s There are salt lakes in Valencia and Bernalillo counties, New
Mexico.
8 Prairie dogs which are still found all over the plains.
224 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
The plant was about six feet high, with e leaf thd[t
resembled parsley. The Indians told them that this
river discharged itself into the Tignex about twenty days'
journey distant, and thence ran Eastward, but the Span-
iards supposed it emptied into the river Espiritu Santa
(Mississippi). • They ascended the river to CScuye. The
inhabitants took up arms and refused to furnish them
with provisions, and those who were disposed to be
friendly were coujipelle^ to quit their homes and leave
the village. The army thence continued its march to
Tiguex, where it arrived in good order. During the
march upon the plains an Indian w(mian, whom captain
Juan de Saldebar got for a servant at Tiguex, where
he was a slave, made her escape. She recognized some
part of the country they passed through, when, plunging
into a ravine, she succeeded in eluding her pursuers and
getting off. She fled toward the East and is said to have
fallen in with a portion of De Soto's army coming
West from Florida, whom she told tliat she had left a
party of Spaniards nine days before, exploring the coun-
tiy. Ciistafieda says that this was related to him by
some of De Soto's men after they had arrived in New
Spain, and from which it appears that the two expedi-
tions approached very near to each other from opposite
• directions.
Tlie army, under the command of Don Tristan de
Arellano, reached Tiguex about the middle of July,
1542. The general had not yet returned ; and as it was
» expected the troops would winter here, Arellano took the
necessary steps to lay in a supply of provisions. For
this purpose he sent officers in various du'ections to
collect them, some of whom penetrated into portions of
'»the country not before explored. Captain Fraccifico de
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. • 226
Barrio ascended the river some distance and visited the
'two provinces of Hemes and Ynqneyunque, The inhab-
•itants of the former received him friendly, and furnished
supplies, while those of the latter abandoned their villages
• on the bank of the river and fled to the mountains, where
they had others strongly fortified, and wliich could not
be approadied with horses. Considerable provisions
were found in the deserted villages, which the Spaniards
seized ; and they also saw a good deal of handsome
glazed pottery, well made and highly ornamented. Many
jars were filled with a brilliant metal resembling silver,
supposed to have been the material the Indians used in
glazing their pottery. From its strong resemblance to
silver the Spaniards believed this metal was to bo found
in that country. Twenty leagues higher up tlie river
they came to a large village called Braba, which they
named Valladolid. It was built upon both sides of the
river, which was crossed by bridges made of pine logs
squared, and very well fastened together. Here were
found vapor-baths more extensive than any they had yet
seen in the country; being supported by wooden pillars
twelve feet high, and about as many in circumference.
The country was elevated and cold and the river deep
and rapid. Thence captain Barrio returned to camp.
Another officer followed down the river until he arrived
at a point where it sunk into the ground and became
lost, eighty leagues •below Tiguex. He discovered four
hirge villages, which submitted. The inliabitants told
him that if he would follow tlie river some distance*,
furtlier down he would arrive at the place where it came
out of the ground larger than when it sunk ; but as he
'had no orders to proceed beyond eighty leagues he re-
* turned to camp.
15
226 • THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
As the general had not yet returned from QnivffJt
some alarm was felt at his absence, and Arellano deter-
mined to go in search of him. With an escort of forty
horsemen he marched to Cicnye, whose inhabitants made
an attack upon him. The fight continued four days,
during which time Arellano fired several cannon balls int<»
the village, and severely chastised them. He killed two*
of their chiefs. While here he heard that Coronado was-
on liis return, and therefore waited his arrival to afford
him protection if it should be required. The soldiers
welcomed the general back, but they were much disap-
pointed when inlprmed that he had brought neither gold
nor silver. Some thought he had not penetrated far
enough into the country, and probably was returning for
more troops. The Indian, Xaba, had encouraged the
soldiers in the l)elief that he would bring back some of
the precious metals, and therefore when told that none
had been found he was much mortified, because he had
boasted that his prediction would come true. Coronado
was forty days returning from Quivira, and arrived at
Cicuye in the month of August, when the rainy season
had already set in. lie contimied his march to Tiguex,
where he determined to spend the winter, and in the
spring, with the whole army, advance further into the
interior. The inhabitants of the country through which
he had traveled, on his return from Quivira, had spoken
of a populous region called Acochis, which resembled
Spain, and was watered by great rivers. It was expected
that gold could be found in abundance, and as he hoped
to obtain wealth enough there to repay him for all his
hardships, he was anxious to penetrate into and explore
the countrv.
Shortly after Coronado reached Tiguex, Don Pedro
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 227
a
^le Tobar arrived with reinforcements from San Hiero-
nimo. Castaneda records in his journal that these fresh
troops " came vnth. their noses in the air, hoping to find
the general already in the rich country of which the
Turk had spoken," and were greatly disappointed to meet
him at Tiguex. Tobar brought letters for the troops,
among which was one for Don Gafcia Lopez de Cardenas,
one of the most valiant of the captains, which announced
the death of liis brother in Spain, by which he inherited
the family estate. He left camp to return home on leave
of absence, accompanied by others who, having become
tired of military life, returned to Mexico to establisli
themselves there. The remainder of the army made
arrangements to pass the winter in Tiguex.
Coronado occupied liimself, during the winter, in
pacifying the country, and putting the army in a con-
dition to take the field in the spring. He exerted all his
influence to persuade the inhabitants to return to their
liomes and live in peace and quietness. The army was
in a sad state, and needed much recruiting before it would
be fit for active service. The soldiers were almost
without clothing, and covered with vermin, besides mucli
broken down by hard marches. Coronado collected all
the stuffs he could find in the province and had them
made into imiforms. Much dissatisfaction arose as to tlie
manner of distributing the clothing, because the officers
reserved the best part for themselves and friends. Tlie
general took the part of the troops, which produced a
misunderstanding between him and the officers, l)ut
nothing of a serious nature grew out of it. With the
exception of these little difficulties the winter passed
tranquilly away, and the opening spring found the army
in a much more efficient condition than when it had gone
into wintjer quarters.
32B THE CONQUEST OF KfcIV MfiXICOv
CHAPTER XXIX.
■*^- \
WRONADO MEETS WITH AN ACCIDENT, AND THE ARMf
RETUEN8 TO MEXICO.
At the opening of spring Coronado issued orders for
the army to make immediate preparations to march to
Quivira. The troops were ahnost ready to take the field,
when he met with an accident which frustrated all liis
plans. On a fcast day at this season of the year, as was
his custom, he went out on horseback to ride at the ring,
accompanied by Don Pedro Maldonado. While in full
career his saddle girth broke and he fell to the ground ;
when the horse of Maldonado, in springing over him>
kicked Inm on the head and knocked him senseless. He
was picked up and carried to liis quarters, where he was
confined to liis bed for a long time, with his life in great
danger. During his illness all operations were suspended
and the army remained at Tiguex. Wlien partially
restored to health, he received information of the revolt
of the Indians in the province of Suya, which affected
him very seriously and caused a relapse. Castaneda inti-
mates that Ids second illness was more a feint than real,
-assumed in order to excuse his subsequent strange conducts
In the meantime it was wliispered around that «
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 229
mathematician of Salamanca had predicted that Coronado
would become great and powerful in a distant land, but
would afterward encounter a fall that would cause his
death. This prediction now haunted his mind, and he
believed, or pretended to believe, that the fulfillment of it
was about to come to pass. Under these circumstances
he appeared ill at ease, and fearing lie was about to die,
expressed a desire to return home and end his days in
the bosom of his family, ilany of the principal officers
were also anxious to "return, and at his solicitation they
induced the soldiers to present a petition to him, asking
to bo conducted back to New Spain. Ho now called a
council of officers to take the matter into consideration ;
which decided that inasmuch as they had not found any
rich country, and the land they had taken possession of
was not fertile enough to bo distributed among the sol-
diers, it would be advisable to retm*n home. An order
was immediately issued for the army to make preparations
to march for Mexico. As soon as this decision was made
a number of the soldiers regretted what they had done,
and supplicated the general to revoke the order. This
lie declined to do, and, to avoid their intercessions, he
shut himself up in his quarters and refused. to be seen,
pretending to be much sicker than he really was. They
were anxious to obtain possession of the petition they had
l^resented to him, in order to destroy it, so that he would
have no sanction from them for the course he was about
to take ; and to prevent them entering the house for this
purpose, at night, he was obliged to place sentinels before
his door and upon the balcony. They succeeded, never-
theless, in possessing themselves of his trunk, but did not
find tlic wished-for paper in it ; which he kept under his
pillow. The officers who repented their decision to
230 TUE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
return lioiiie now made Coronado two propositions ;
cither to leave them sixty men with wliich to maintain
themselves in the country, or to take sixty men himself
and return to New Spain, leaving the command of the
army to another officer. These propositions not being
approved by a majority of the troops, he refused to accept
either. The officers yielded the point, as they were
obliged to submit to the general, but they lost all zeal
for the service and aflfection for their chief. The orders
for the return march were announced anew, and tlio
officers and men busied themselves in making the
necessary preparations.
While the army is getting ready to march from Tiguex,
let us notice the events that had been taking place in the
province of Suya. Wlien Don Garcia Lopez de Cardenas
arrived there, on liis way to Spain, he found the Indians
in a state of revolt, and immediately returned to the army
to inform Coronado of the condition of things. The
garrison left there consisted of the most turbulent and
seditious soldiers in the army, who would neither submit
to tlieir own officers, or to those of the civil government.
They were in a state of daily mutiny, and at last took up
their arms and marched for Culiacan, leaving behind their
captahi, Diego de Alcarraz, and a few sick men. Some
of the deserters were killed on the way, while the rest
reached their place of destination, where they were placed
in confinement by Don Hernando Arias de Saavedra.
Upon the departure of the garrison the Indians became
more troublesome than before, and threatened an attack.
The town was built upon the bank of a small stream and
of easy access to the inhabitants of all the surrounding
country. One night fires were seen blazing upon the
liilk arumid, when the Spaniards, expecting the enemy.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 231
doubled the guard ; but everything remaining quiet ther
relaxed their vigilance toward morning. In the meantime
the Indians had entered the place under cover of the
darkness, but their presence was not known until they
eommenced the attack. The garrison was taken com-
pletely by surprise? and made but a feeble resistance.
They attempted to leave the town, but were met and
di'iven back with the loss of their commanding officer.
A few of the horsemen cut their way through the enemy
and made their escape. The Indians effected their pur-
pose of sacking the place and retreated loaded with booty ;
besides killing upward of twenty soldiers and several
servants, whom they shot with poisoned arrows. The
survivors marched for Culiacan the next morning, where
they arrived in safety, after suffering many hardships on
the road.
The army marched from Tiguex, for New Spain, the
beginning of April, 1543. Coronado left behind two of
the missionaries, who determined to remain and make an
effort to convert the Indians, named Juan de Padilla, a
Fraciscan, and Louis, a lav brother.i The former intended
to station himself at Quivira and the latter at Cicuyc, and
before the troops left an escort was furnished them as far
as the latter place. Padilla was put to death soon after
I The following is an additional account of what befel the friars lell
behind in New Mexico, after Coronado and his army had marched,
translated from the old Spanish Ms., at Santa Fe :
** When Coronado returned to Mexico he left behind, among the
Indians of Cibola, the father fray Francisco Juan de Padilla, the father
fray Juan de la Cruz, and a Portuguese named Andres del Campo.
Soon after the Spaniards depjyted Padilla and the Portuguese set off in
search of the country of the Grand Quivira, where the former under-
stood there were innumerable souls to be saved. After traveling
several days they reached a large settlement in the Quivira country.
The IndiaoB came out to receive them in battle array, when the friai:,
232 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
liis arrival at Quivira. The last that was seen or heard*
of brother Louis was when on his way with some Indiana
to visit a neighboring province. He said the Indians
treated liim kindly, with the exception of the old men
who disliked him and would most probably cause him ta^
be put to death* The general sent hfcn a few sheep for
his support.
The array returned by the same route by which it had.
entered the country, and but few incidents occurred oil
tlie homeward march worthy of note. Before reaching '
Cibola a fatal sickness broke out among the troops, of
which more than thirty died. Here they encamped a
few days to recruit and make preparations to cross the
(lesert. A few of the Mexican Indians remained at Cibola,,
refusing to return to their own country. Resuming the
inarch again, the Spaniards crossed the desert and arrived
in safety at Chichilticale. The Indians followed them
for two or three days, to pick up whatever might ho
abandoned, but made no hostile demonstrations. Two
(lays after their arrival at this place Juan Gallegos came
in ^vith reinforcements and was much disappointed to
meet the army returniug, instead of being in the rich
country described by tlie Turk. The arrival of this addi-
tional force induced the officers to renew their former
proposition to Coronado ; but neither he nor the soldiers
knowing tbcir intentions, told the Portuguese and his attendants to
take to flight, while he would await their coming, in order that they
might vent their fury on him as they ran. The former took to flight,
and placing themselves on a height within view, saw what happened
to the friar. Padilla awaited their coming upon his knees, and when
they arrived where he was they immediately put him to death. The
same happened to Juan de la Cruz, who was left behind at Cibola^
which people killed him. The Portuguese and his attendants made
their escape and ultimately arrived safely in Mexico, .where ha told.
^Yhat had occurred."
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 233
would listen to it. Their faces were turned homeward,
and they were opposed to retracing their steps.. Thence
again resuming the march they reached Culiacan. On
this part of the route they met with some opposition from,
tlie Indians, who killed several soldiers and some horses.
One day an Indian shot a Spaniard with an arrow freslily
dipped in poison, and the wound should have been mortal ;
but quince juice was applied to the parts and the man's
life was saved. The wound was on the wrist, and the
poison was so virulent that the flesh adjacent entirely
decayed and left the nerves and bones bare, and the
putrefaction extended up to the shoulder.
Upon the arrival of the army at Culiacan all discipline
came to an end, and Coronado, although in the province
of which he was the governor, found himself without civil,
or military authority, lie was enabled, however, by
nleans of promises, to collect together most of the strag-
glers, with whom he continued the march to Compostella,
where they arrived during the festival of Saint John.
Between this place and the city of Mexico the march was
an arduous one and the troops suffered severely. It was
the rainy season, the streams were nmch swollen and
some of them could only be crossed with dijfficulty and
danger. Just before reaching Compostella a soldier fell
into a river when he was devoured by aligators* before
any assistance could be rendered him. Desertions were
constant and numerous, and when Coronado reached
Mexico he had not more than an himdred men with him.
The viceroy was much displeased with the maimer in
which he had conducted the expedition and received him
coldly. He was soon afterward deprived of his province
and fell into disgrace.
^ % Probably sharks.
234 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER XXX.
AL'GUSTIN RUIZ AND TWO FRIARS KNTER NEW 'MEXICO AS
MISSIONARIES AND ARE PUT TO DIIATH BY THE INDIANS.
The expedition of Coronado resulted so disastrously
to the Spanish arms, that jdl desire for further ex-
ploration into New Mexico was repressed for a number
of years. The gallant cavaliers who composed his ad-
Tenturous little army had been so sanguine of a rich
harvest of wealth and honors in the almost fabulous
country of the Seven Cities, that the failure of the
expedition filled them with sad disappointment. Their
bright anticipations were dashed to tlie ground, and they
tui'ncd their attention to other regions which promised a
more certain realization of their hopes.
For the space of forty years no further attempt was
made to penetrate into, and explore, the country, and
the inhabitants were left undisturbed in their quiet
mountain valleys. At the end of this time, and in tlie
year 1581, a Franciscan friar named Augustin Ruiz was
living in the valley of Saint Bartholomew, about two
hundred leagues from the city of Mexico, lie was
informed by the Conchos and Passagttate Indians, with
whom he had some intercourse, that to tlie North there
TUE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO, 235
were scvcrcol large provinces wliicli the Spaniards had
not yet discovered. Fired with rehgious zeal, and moved
by a strong desire to convert tliese heathen nations to
Christianity, Ruiz determined to penetrate this unknown
region as a soldier of the cross. For this purpose ho
made immediate application to the Conde de Corunna,
the viceroy of New Spain, for perniipsion to enter the
country in order to learn the language and preach to tho
Indians. At the, same time he made a similar application
to the superiors of his own order. License was granted
by both authorities, and the friar made preparations for
his journey.
He selected for his companions two of his brotlier
Franciscans, one named Francisco Lopez, who was ap-
pointed commissary of the expedition, and the other friar
Juan de Santa Maria. They were accompanied by twelve
soldiers, under the command of a captain, who went along
as an escort and defence against the Indians, and also for
tlie purpose of searching for mines of the precious metals,
with which the country was said to abound. Euiz, hav-
ing completed the necessary arrangements, set out on his
pious mission.
They traveled toward the North, and, after a march of
some two hundred leagues in that direction, arrived in
the province of the Teguas Indians, who inhabited the
banks of the Del Norte. They found the country tliickly
populated by various nations, and the inhabitants every-
where received them in a friendly manner. They
continued up the river until they reached the pueblo, or
village, of Puara.i Here the soldiers became alarmed for
I This pueblo was situated about eight miles above the town of Air
buquerque, iu Bernalillo eouuty, on the Del Norte, but it has long slnCQ
gone to rums.
236 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
their safety, because of the great number of Indians they
saw; being too few themselves to offer resistance in
case of an attack, and so distant from the Spanish
settlements that they could not receive any assistance
from that quarter. For these reasons they declined to
proceed furtlicr, but resolved to return immediately to
Saint Bartholomew. The friars used every persuasion
to induce them to continue on, Init it was of no avail,
ajid they turned their faces homeward. The soldiers
tried hard to persuade the friars to return home "with
them, but the latter declined to turn back. They
determined to continue their journey, feeling assm^ed that
the time had arrived when they would be able to put
into execution their pious intention of christianizing the
savages. They were not alarmed ^.t the desertion of the
soldiers, for they put their faith and hope in " things not
of this world," but remained with cheerfulness among
these heathen nations to instruQt them in the knowledge
of the living God.
The friars were still at tlie* pueblo of Puara when
the soldiers abandoned them. They were attended by
three Indian boys and a [Mexican who refused to leave
them and return with the escort. They remained here
a few days longer, when they resumed their journey
toward the North, and in a few leagues' travel arrived at
the pueblo of the Galistco,8 a village of the Tanos nation.
Thus far they had found the Indians peaceable, who had
treated them in the most friendly manner possible, and
provided for all their wants. They were so much pleased
with the provinces they had passed through, and with
the apparent mild and amiable disposition of the inhab-
s These pueblos were situated on the Qalisteo crock about twenty-
two miles South of Santa Fe, and arc in ruins.
«>;
Om
THE CONQUEST OP NEW BIEX3C0. So/
itants, that it was resolved to send one of their numlKjr
"back to New Spain to give information of what they had
seen, and invito other friars to come hither. Juan do
Santa Maria volunteered to undertake this journey, and
having made a few hasty preparations he set out on his
return.
Friar Maria was accompanied some distance by Ruiz
and Lopez, when they returned to Puara, whore they
establislied themselves for the purpose of learning the
language of the country. They located at this point
because the Indians had treated them witli great kind-
ness. After bidding farewell to liis two companions,
Maria continued on toward the South. lie crossed the
Sandia mountains, intending to pass by tlie Salinas (salt
lakes), and thence to take a direct coui'sc for El Paso
del Norte, one liundrcd leagues to the South, tlius making
■ a shorter and quicker route tlian the one by which they
had entered the country-. The third day, when near the
pueblo afterward called San Pablo, in tlie Teguas nation^
he stopped to rest under a tree, where the Indians killed
him and burnt his remains.
The two friars lived some time in peace and quiet at
Puara, and i)ursued their labors without interruption.
One afternoon Lopez retired about a league from the
village to engage in liis devotions*, and while occupied in
praver he was killed bv an Indian, who inflicted tw(?
mortal wounds upon his temples. The Indians afterward
pointed out to Ruiz where the body of his companion
had been buried, w^liich he caused to be'disinterred and
rcburied in the pueblo according to the forms of the
Catholic religion. The death of Lopez was a severe
atHiction to Ruiis, who mounied his loss in bitterness of
spirit. lie felt now, in truth, that he was alone in tlic
238 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO*
midst of savage nations, with no one upon whom he
could rely but Him whose cause he espoused. He was
in no \vise discouraged at tliis gloomy condition of things,
but resolved to prosecute his mission as long as life should
last.
The war captain of Puara was much grieved at the
death of Lopez, and in order to save Ruiz from the
same fate he removed him to the pueblo of Santiago, a
leage and a half up the river. But his death had been
resolved upon and it was impossible to save him. A few
days afterward he met the same fate as his brethren, and
almost before the breath of life was out of his body it
was thrown into the river, then in flood, as food for the
fishes. Thus the Teguas Indians completed the work of
blood, and put to death three pious men who came into
the Avilderness to devote their time and their lives ,to
their temporal and spiritual welfare.
From the sacrifice of these three friai's the old chron-
iclers contend that there sprung a plentiful harvest of
souls. Tliey record, that from that time dow-n to the
year 1G20 there were baptised thirty-four thousand six
hundred and fifty Indians, and many others were in a
state of conversion; and that in the same period the
friars had erected, without cost to the government or
king, forty-three churches in New Mexico. The body of
Lopez remained buried at Puara for thirty-three years,
when the place of interment was pointed out to Estevan
de Perea, commissary of the province. The remains
were disinterred in the month of February, 1614, an(J
deposited in the chiu*ch of the pueblo of Sandias with
3 This pueblo is Bituated on the East bank of the Del Nort^, a few-
miles above the town of Albuquerque, and contaius detween two and
three hundred inhabitants.
fth^-
THE CONQUEST 6F KEW MEXICO. 239
«
great ceremony, a number of priests marching on foot,
dressed in full robes. It is related in the writings of one
of the priests who was present, that when the procession
began to move- the saint in the church commenced to
perform miracles.
The soldiers wdio deserted the friars at Puara reached
Saint Bartholomew in safety, where they related all
that had taken place since they first set out on their
journey, and also made a report of the same to tho
viceroy at the city of Mexico. The San Franciscan
order was much alarmed at the situation of their brethren
who remained beliind among the Indians, and they used
every exertion to persuade a party of soldiers to march
to their relief.
At this time thofc was a cavalier at the mines of Santa
Barbara of the name of Antonio do Espejo, a native of
Cordova, and a man of wealth, courage and industr}^
lie offered his services to the Franciscans for the purpose
of rescuing their brethren, and declared lie was willing to
risk his life and part of his fortune in the enterprise, if
he should be authorized to undertake it by some person
of competent authority. The offer was accepted, and
governor Juan de Ontrueros, the king's alcalde and chief
justice of the town of Las quarta Ciencgas in the juris-
diction of Nueva Biscaya, twenty leagues from Santa
Barbara, granted him license to lead an expedition. He
Wiis authorized to take with him as many soldiers as
might be willing to follow liis fortunes, or would be
required to carry out tho object of the expedition.
240 TCHE CONQUEST OF NEW :^£XIGO.
CHAPTER XXXI.
ANTONIO DE ESPEJO UNDEIIT/VKES AN EXPEDITION TO RES-
CUE THE TWO FRIARS*
EsPEJO made immediate preparatfcns to march into
New Mexico. lie set about the work Avitli such activity
und energy that in the course of a few days he had the
requisite number of men embodied and a sufficient quan-
tity of provisions collected. He provided, as a matter of
precaution, one hundred and fifteen extra mules and
horses, besides a large supply of arms and munitions of
war ; and he was accompanied by a number of Indians
to assist the soldiers in whatever way their services might
be recpiired. Everything being in readiness they took i^p
the line of march from the valley of Saint Bartholomew
on the 10th of December, 1582, and directed their course
toward the North.
In a march of ten days they arrived in a province
inhabited by a people called Conchos, who liv^ed in vil-
laires of rude houses covered with straw. i When the
inhabitants heard of their approach they came forth to
I These Indians lived in Mei^ico along the Ck)ncho8 river, which
'cmptiesinto the Rio Qrandc dell^ortc hi latltade about(M) degrees.
' THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 241
Mneet and give them a fnendly welcome. They went
- almost naked, and lived mider the government of caciqueB
similar to the Indians of jyiexico. They were armed with
bows and arrows. They raised a great quantity of maize
or Indian corn, gourds, and melons of good quaKty ; and
the streams abounded with fish of various kinds and of
fine flavor. Their principal articles of food were conies,
liares and bears ; the latter were iilled in great numbers
and were eaten by the inhabitants of the wliole province.
Idols were not seen among these people, nor was an}'-
form of religious worship observed or heard of. The
Spaniards erected crosses to which the natives made no
objection ; and the friars explained to them, by the aid
of interpreters, the meaning of tlie cross and liow it was
an emblem of their religion. The Indians informed them
of other towns of the same nation twenty leagues distant,
whither they conducted them. The caciques sent word
from one town to another, in advance, of the coming of
the strangers, and upon their amval they found the
inhabitants waiting to receive them.
Having passed through the coutitry of the Conchos
Indians the Spaniards arrived among the Passaguatcs,
their neighbors, who lived in a similar manner. They
were well received, but. tamed among them a very short
time. These Indians, according to. the custom of the
country, and in obedience to the command of the caciques,
conducted them four days on their march. In this region
they found many mines of silver, which those skilled in
metals pronounced very rich, but they were not prepared
to take possession and work them. Thence they con-
tinued tlieir march, and in one day arrived in another
, province called Tobosos, whose inhabitants, upon their
.approach, fled into the woods and mountains. Upoj)
.16
242 tHE CONQUEST OP KEW ^iEXIC^O.
inquiry as to the cause of this strange conduct, Espeja
learned that some years before a party of Spanish
soldiers had come into that country and carried many of
the people away captive; who, hearing that the Christians
were again approaching, feared a similar fate awaited
them a second time.
Espejo sent messengers after the fugitives to assure
them they need not be alarmed, as no injury would be
done them, and requested them to return to their houses.
Many returned and were received and treated in the
most friendly manner by the Spaniards, who distributed
presents among them. The captain explained to them,
through an interpreter, the object of his coming into their
coimtry, and that his mission was a peaceable one, which
removed all their fears. The friars taught them the
mystery of the cross, and obtained their permission to
erect some in the cpuntry. These Indians conducted tlife
Spaniards until they arrived in a country inliabited by a
neighboring nation twelve leagues distant. The Tobosjos
went naked, and were armed with bows and arrows.
The province into which the Tobosos conducted the
Spaniards was called by the Indians Lumanosf (Humanos),
and by the Christians Patarabueyas. Tlicy inhabited an
extensive and populous district .of country, which con-
tained several large towns. The houses were built of
lime and stone, with flat roofs, and the streets were laid
out with order and regularity. The inhabitants M'cre a
people of large stature, and their faces, legs and arms
were ^^ raced and *•'' poic7iced.^\ Their mode of govern-
ment was superior to that of any Indians hitherto met
2 This province was situated upon the Del Norle river, and most
fjrobably SouUi of EI Paso.
•s A species of tattooing.
THE CONQtJEST 05* KEW MEXICO. 24S
^ith; and they were provided with an abundance ot*
provisions, including several kinds of wild beasts, fishes,
and fowls. The province was well watered by numerous
rivers, one of which came from the North and emptied
into the gulf of Mexico, and is represented as being as
large as the Guadalquiver.4 There were several salt
lakes which produced excellent salt. They were a war-
like people, and exhibited hostility to the Sfpaniards as
soon as they entered the country. The first night they
were encamped among them they made an attack upon
their animals, killing five and severely wounding two
more ; and but for the guard defending them with great
bravery, they would have killed the whole of them.
After this they abandoned their town and fied to the
mountain near by.
Early the next morning Espejo, accompanied by five
soldiers well armed, and an interpreter named Peter, a
native of this nation, went up to them in the mountain
to prevail upon them to return to their village. He
assured them of his peaceful intentions, and that he had
come there neither to do them any injury nor to rob
them of their goods. They believed what he said,
and descended and re-occupied their houses. He made
the caciques presents of bracelets of glass, beads, hats,
and other articles. This course entirely pacified the
Indians, and gained their confidence; and when the
Spaniards again resumed their journey a number of them
accompanied Espejo several days on the way. They
continued their march along the bank of the Del Norte
for the space of twelve days, during which time they
passed through many towns inhabited by the Humanos.
Notice of their approach was sent in advance, and as
■ -* ■-...■,.. ■
4 The Rio del Nortitf .
-244 tHE C6KQUE6T OF KEW MEXICO.
they drew nigh the various towns the caciqnes, nnarmcci)
came out to meet and welcome them. They were
entertained with hospitah'ty, supplied with an abundance
of victuals, and given presents of hides and chamois-skins
very well di^essed, many equal to those of Flanders.
These Indians were very well clothed.
The Humanos seemed to have some fitint idea of the
^Christian n^Jigion. They made rude figures to represent
God, at the same time looking up toward heaven. In
their language they called the Supreme Being Apalito,
and acknowledged him for their Lord, "from whose boun-
tiful hand and mercy they confess that they have received
their life and being, and these worldly goods." Many of
them brought their wives and children to the friars that
they might cross, and bless them. * Upon being asked
whence they had obtained a knowledge of God, they
answered that it was taught them by three Christians and
a negro who had passed through that part of the country,
and remained some days among them. From the infor-
ination the Indians gave of these strangers, the Spaniards
' were satisfied they were Cabeza de Vaea and his ship-
wrecked companions, whose adventures across the con-
tinent have already been given in another part of this
volume.
The Spaniards resumed the march, leaving the Indians
of the province in peace, and in token of their friendly
feeling some of them accompanied Espejo to perform
labor for the soldiers. They continued up the river for
some days, when they came to another large and populous
province. The inhabitants had received notice of their
approach fi'om their neighbors down the river, and a«
was their custom, came forth to conduct them to their
•nllages. They brought with them many articles m«de
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 245
of feathers of beaatifal workmanship, of various colors,
and mantles of cotton streaked with blue and white like
those of China, to trade with the Spaniards. The whole
population was dressed in chamois-skins well tanned and
prepared. The knowledge obtained of this province was
very limited, by reason of the want of an interpreter.
Espejo was not even able to learn its name, but they
held a little intercourse with the inhabitants by means of
^igns. Exhibiting to them some of the precious metals,
they inquired whether any such was to be found in their
country ; when they replied, that in a region five days'
journey to the Westward there was an abundance of the
same metals, and promised to conduct the Spaniards,
thitlier. The Indians afterward conducted them to that
section of country, but the journal of Espejo says nothing
about the discovery of gold or silver.
Continuing their march up the river, the Spaniards
came to another province more populous than the last ;.
where the inhabitants received them as friends, and made
them many presents. Among the articles of food given
them was a fish taken from one of the lakes in the prov-
ince, which abounded with them. They remained with
these people three days, during which time a continued,
scene of rejoicing w-as kept up, the Indians performing
many of their dances, and other ceremonies, expressive of
great joy. They were likewise unable to learn the name
of this province, but understood it was very extensive and
contained a numerous population. Here they found a
Conchos Indian who explained to them, by signs, that
at the distance of fifteen days' journey toward the West
there was a very broad lake, and near it several great
towns ; that the houses were three and four stories high,,
and the people were w^ell dressed and provided with tax
S46 THE CONQUEST OF Iv'EW MEXICOw
abundance of provisions. He offered to conduct them
tliither^ but Espejo declined turning from liis march until
he had accomplished the object for which he had set out —
the relief of the friars. The temperature of this province
was mild and pleasant, and the soil very fertile. It
abounded in wild beasts and fowls, yielded the precious
metals in abundance, and produced many other desirable
articles.
The Spaniards continued their march toward the North, ,
along the bank of the great river, for the space of fifteen
days, traveling through a country covered with pine forests,
bearing fruit like those of Castile. 5 In all this distance
they saw no inhabitants. At the end of this time, and
after having marched, as they supposed, some eighty
leagues, they arri^'cd at a small village of poor cottages
covered mth straw, and containing but few inhabitants*
Among this people they found a large cumber of well-
dressed deer-skins, with a great quantity of excellent
white salt. Here they tarried two days, and were well
entertained; and when they resumed the march the
Indians accompanied them the distance of twelve leagues,
and until they arrived at other large towns, and within
what the Spaniards called New Mexico.e Here, all along
the banks of the river, there grew forests of poplan and
walnut trees, and ^'ines like those of Castile ; the timber
in some places being as much as four leagues broad.
5 The pifion nut.
6 Part of the province of Ilamanos was undoubtecUj within th&
liresent limits ot New Mexico.
7 The cotton- wood, which is etill found in the valley of the Del
Jj^ortc.
TttE CONQUflST OF KflW HJSXICO. 2.4^7
CHAPTER XXXII-
ESPEJO 3LA.RCHES UP THE VALLEY- OF THE RIO DEL NOKTE;
SOME ACOL^'T OF THE PKOVIXCES HE PASSED THROUGH.
»
Ha\ing traveled two days through the poplar and
v/alnut groves, Espejo came to ten towns situated upon
both banks of the Eio del Norte, and others some dis-
tance from the river, i They were all populous, and the
Spaniards estimated the Indians they saw at ten thousand.
The houses were four stories high, well built, and with
good lodgings overhead, and in most of them provisions
were stored away for the winter season. The inhabit-
ants dressed in deer-skins and cotton, and the garments
of both the men and women were made after the mann^*
of those of Mexico. They wore boots and shoes with
soles of " neats-leather, " & circumstance which appears
to have given much surprise to the Spaniards, as they
had seen nothing -of the kind before in any part of the
country. The women kept their hair well dressed and
combed, and went with their heads uncovered.
1 The towns of this province were situated South of Albuquerque.
And k is probable thatlsleta and'^Les Lentes were of the nomben
248 THE CONQUESr OF KEW MEXICO.
The towns were governed .by caciques in the saafto^
manner as those of Mexico ; whose commands were exe-
cuted by an officer called a sergeant, who went through'
the town crying in a loud voice the will of the cacique,
and ordering the same to be put in execution. The
inhabitants gave the Spaniards a friendly reception and
farnislied them with an abundance of provisions, among
which were hens of the country. Many idols, which the
Indians worshipped, were found in this province ; and in
e%'ery house an oratory was erected for the devil, where
he was said to preside, and to which food was carried for
him to eat. In various places the Indians had erected
chapels dedicated to the devil, in which he was said to
recreate and rest himself when he traveled through the
country, from one town to another. These chapels were
all handsomely trimmed and painted. They represented^
by pictures, the sun, moon and stars as principal objects
of their worship.
On their arable lands, of wliich there waa a great
extent in the province, the Indians erected on one side a
small shed standing upon four studs, under which the
laborers ate their food, and reclined during the heat of
the day. They were a laborious people, and continually
occupied themselves in some useful employment. The
fields nearest the banks of the Del Norte were well cul-
tivated. Their arms were strong bows, and arrows
headed with sharp-pointed stones tliat would pierce
through a coat of mail, and 7naca?ias, or clubs, half a
yard in length and armed with sharp flints, which they
wielded with great dexterity, and with which they could
cut a man's body in two at a single blow. They used a
shield made of untanned bull-hide. The country, except
tlie valley of the river, was mountainous and covered-
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 249
with pine trees. When the Indians first saw the horses
of the Spaniards they were no less astonished than the
]\Iexicans, and ahnost worshipped them as superior beings.
They entertained them in their best houses, and entreated .
them to eat of their choicest provisions. Some of the
tribes were more advanced, than others, and dwelt in.
better habitations and wore more comfortable clothing.
A chief of one of the provinces gave Espejo four thousand
boUs of cotton.
The Spaniards remained four days among these people,
when they resumed the marcli* Continuing up the bank
of the Del Norte, in a few leagues they entered the
Teguas nation, which contained fourteen towns. Here
they learned that the two friars with the Indian boy and
the Mexican, whom they were in search of, had been
slain in a town of this province called Puara. When
the inliabitants of this town and their neighbors heard
of the approach of the Spaniards, they became greatly
alarmed, and fearing they came to revenge the death of
tlie friars, deserted their houses and fled into the moun-
tains for safety. Espejo used every eflfort to induce them
to descend and re-occupy their houses, but witliout
success, as they feared to place themselves in his power.
lie found a great quantity of provisions and a large
number of the hens of the country in Puara, besides many
sorts of metals, some of which appeared valuable. Tliey
could not determine the number of inhabitants in tlie
province. Here were found the bodies of the two friars,
to which they gave Christian burial.*
Having now accomplished the object of the expedition,
the Spaniards held a consultation as to the course they
1 This must be an error, as the body of Lopez was buried by Ruiz,,
while that of the latter was thrown into the river.
fioO THE <X)NQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
shonid pursne ; whether to return immediately to New
Biscay, or continue their explorations. Various opinions
were held among the oflScers and men. Espejo had
understood that some distance from thence, in the eastern
(western) part of the province, there were great and rich
towns, and as they were so far advanced on their way, he
tliought it advisable to continue the march until they
should reach them, and thus be enabled, as eye-wit-
nesses, to give a correct accoimt of the country upon
their return. In this opinion he was supported by friar
Beruardine Beltram and many of the soldiers, wliick
determined him to prosecute their explorations further.
It was decided that the command should remain at
that place, while Espejo explored some of the surround*-
ing provinces, which determination he proceeded to put
into immediate execution. He set out with two men, and
after traveling toward the West for two days he arrived
in a province which contained eleven towns ; they were
all very populous, and were estimated to contain forty
tliousand inhabitants. It bordered on that of Cibola, and
was very fertile, producing an abmidancc of all tlie
necessaries of life. The country was covered with a great
number of cattle, with the hides of which, and with cotton,
they made their clothing, imitating in style the dress of
their next neighbors. They saw signs of rich mines of
the precious metals, and also found considerable quantities
in the houses. The inhabitants worsliipped idols. They
gave the Spaniards a friendly welcome, and furnished
them with provisions. Espejo and his companions having
obtained some knowledge of the countiy and the people,
returned to camp and related an account of their explo-
rations to their compauions.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 251
Espejo, hearing of another province some five leagues
farther up the river, called Los Queros (Queres), imme-
diately marched thither from Puara, When they arrived
within a league of the first town a large number of Indians
came forth to meet them, who saluted them with great
friendship, and wanted them to enter their villages. They
escorted them to their houses, where they were well
entertained. This province contained five towns, and the
population was estimated at fourteen thousand souls, all
of whom worshipped idols, in tlie manner of their neigh-
bors. They foimd in one of the towns "certain shadows"
and canopies similar to those said to have been brought
from China, in those days, and on wliich were painted
the sun, moon and stars, besides other curious things.
Here they took the altitude of the north star, and found
themselves in latitude 38 degrees North.s
Leaving the province of Los Queros, they continued
their march in the same Northerly course, and in the
distance of fourteen leagues they arrived in the province
of Cunames. Here they found five towns, the largest of
which wafi called Cia.* This was an extensive to\vn, and
contained eight market places, and the houses were
better built than any others they had seen in the country,
being plastered and painted many colors. The jprovince
was populous, and they estimated the people they saw at
twenty thousand. The Indians received them in a friendly
3 An error, for they were then South of Santa Fe, which is in 35
degrees 41 minutes North.
4 This pueblo, sometimes called Zia or Silla, is situated in the county
of Santa Ana, near the Jemez river, a few miles from where it empties
into the Dei Nortel. At this time it contains not more than three or
four hundred inhabitants, and in aU essential particulars differs in no
manner from the other pueblos of the present day. It is built in this
valley of the river.
252 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
manner, and besides furnishing them with p^rovisions^
made them presents of many curious mantles. They
were more advanced in oivilization, and had a better*
form of government, than any province Espejo had pre-
viously visited. They exhibited to the Spaniards some
of the precious metals, and pointed out the mounti^n, not
far off, where they were obtained.
While in this province the Spaniards heard of another
in a North-west direction, whither they determined
to go. Resuming their march they traveled about
five leagues, when they came to a new province, the
inhabitants of which were called Amies.. It contained
seven large towns, with an estimated population of thirty
thousand. One of them, situated behind a mountam, is
represented as being much larger and more beautifol
than the others ; but the Spaniards did not visit it, fear-
ing to separate the command lest some accident might
befall them. These people resembled the inhabitants of
the province of Cunames, being as well provided with
tlie necessaries of life, and having as good government.
Continuing the march toward the West, in a distance
of about fifteen leagues, they arrived at a large town
called Acoma. It was situated upon the top of a rock
near fifty paces high, and contained a population of about
five thousand souls. The ascent to it was up a pair of
stairs cut in the solid rock, and water was kept in a
cistern hewn in the summit of the same rock. Upon the
approach of the Spaniards the principal men of the place
went forth to meet and welcome them, bringing witli
them, as presents, many mantles of chamois-skins, very
well dressed, and an abundance of provisions. Their
corn-fields were situated two leagues from the town, and
were watered by a small river that flowed near by, along
THE CONQUEST Of NEW MEXICO. 268
■the banks of wliicli were grow^pg great beds of roses
similar to those of Castile. In the vicinity of Acoma
were several mountains, said to abound in metals, but as
they were inhabited by a numerous and warlike people,
the Spaniards did not visit them. They remained in tliis
town three days, and during tlie time, the inhabitants
performed a solemn dance before them. They came
forth dressed in good apparel, and joined many interest-
ing sports with their exercises, which afforded great
amusement to the Christians.
Leaving Acoma on the fourth day after their arrival,
they continued their march toward tUe West, and at the
■ distance of twenty-four leagues they came to tlie province
of Zuui, which the Spaniards called Cibola. It was very
populous. This is the same province tliat Francisco
Vasquez de Coronado visited forty years before, and
where he erected many crosses and other tokens of
Christianity, wliich yet remained standing. Tliey found
the Christian Indiaus who had remained behind when
Coronado returned to New Spain, still living, named
Andrew de Culiacan, Gaspar de Mexico, and Antonio de
Guadalajara. They had been so long among these people,
that they had almost forgotten their mother tongue, but
spoke the language of Cibola with great fluency; and it
was with some difficulty the Spaniards were able to
converse with them. They informed Espejo that several
days' journey from thence was a great lake, upoii
the banks of which stood many large and populous
towns; that the country abounded in precious metals,
and as evidence r)f it he was told that the inhabitants
wore golden ear-rings and bracelets; that Coronado knew
of this province and attempted to reach it, but after
marching in that direction for twelve days, he was obliged
254 THE COIJQUEST OP j!(^vr MExica
ta turn back for want o1^ water, and never made a second
attempt.6
6 This lake was most probably Agua Negra, or Black Water, sitaate
in the Nabajo country, and less than a day's march from Fort Defiance,
as I am not aware of any other lake in that part of the country. I(
lies to the North-west of Zuid instead of West, a mistake of direction
Very easy for Espejo to make in an unli^o^fn region.
THE CONQUEST? OF KEW MIXIOO. 255
CHAPTEB XXXIII-
THE SPxVNIARDS VISIT SEVERAL NEW PROVINCES AND TIIE!^
RETURN TO NEW BISCAY.
When Espejo lieard of the country on the borders of
the great lake which promised such a rich harvest of the
precious metals, he .was very desirous of going thither,
and proposed the same to his officers and men. Some of
them were willing to accompany him but the majority,
among whom was the friar, were opposed to a further
advance into the interior, and advocated an immediate
return to New Biscay. But he was not to be thwarted
in his plans. He found nine soldiers who were willing
to follow his fortunes, with whom he determined to
prosecute his adventures ; while the remainder of the
Spaniards decided to return home. Having made the
necessary preparations and obtained some information of
the country he started from Cibola toward the unexplored
West.
Let us take leave of the soldiers for the present, and
follow the march of Espejo and his companions. In tire
diifftance of twenty-eight leagues they entered a large mvd
populous province, which was estimated to contain fifty
2B6 THEt OOKQISSST OP NEW MEXICO.
•thousand inhabitants. i The Indians were alarmed when
they heard of the approach of the Spaniards, and immedi-
ately dispatched -a messenger to warn tliem not to come
nearer their towns under penalty of death. Espejo
assured him that, his coming was for a peaceful purpose
and that no harm would be done to his people. To
prove his friendly intention he gave liim several presents
to carry back to be distributed among the Indians.
He made such a favorable report of the strangers
* and the presents had so much influence in quieting
their fears, that the Indians gave permission to
Espejo to enter their towns. Upon being informed of
this decision the Spaniards resumed their march. Wlien
they arrived within a league of the first town they met
about two thousand Indians, who had come out to bid
them welcome, bearing them loads of provisions as evi-
dence of their good-will. In return the captain presented
them a few articles of small value which greatly pleased
tliem, and which they esteemed more precious than pure
gold. As they drew nearer the town the caciques, with
a multitude of other Indians, came out to meet them.
They manifested great plea&i-re at the visit of the Clmst-
ians, in teetiinony of which tliey cast corn-meal on tlie
ground under their horses' feet.
Thus surrounded, and esc-orted by a numerous tlu'ong
of Indians, and amid the liveliest expressions of gladness,
the Spaniards entered tlic town where they were well
lodged and entertained. Espejo, not to be excelled in
generosity, again distributed among them presents of
hats, glass beads and other articles. The cacique sent
word to the whole province of the arrival of the strangei*s,
vwhom he represented as a corteous people, for which
. 7 This was, undoubtedly, Uiq province of MQqid.
THE DONQITEST OrP^"NEW^rEXI00. 257
( reason he had not offered them harm. Upon the receipt
of this infonnation the Indians from all parts of the
country came in to pay their respects and welcome them
to the province. They came loaded with presents which
they bestowed upon the Spaniards, and also invited them
to visit them in their towns and to make merry. Notwith-
standing this apparent display of friendship on the part
of the natives, Espejo feared that treachery ^was lurking
at the bottom of it ; and to be better prepared in case of
necessity, he wanted some place of defence to rally upon.
As it would not do to let the Indians suspect his object
he was obliged to accomplish his wishes by a little
strategy. He represented to the cacique that his horses
were very fierce animals and would kill his people in case
they should become enraged, and that it was necessary-
he should have some enclosure to confine them in to
prevent any accident. The cacique, believing this to be
true, assembled a large number of Indians, who in a short
time constructed a rude fort of lime and stone, being sucli
an enclosure as the Spaniards would stand in need of in
case the Indians should become hostile. . This town bore
the name of Zaguato.
Having remained several days in this town, receiving
the hospitalities of the Indians, Espejo made preparations
to continue his march Westward. Here he received
additional intbmiation of the great lake he was in search
of, which agreed with what he had already heard. He
left behind at this place two Spaniards and the Tubian
Indians who had accompanied him, with orders for them
to retmn to Zufii withhis carriages, while he continued liis
journey with but four companions^ When the Indiarts
: learned that he was about to leave them, they brought him
. numerous presents in token of tlieir friendship, amontrt
17
258 THE- CX)NQUEST OF NEW MEXIGO.
which were "forty thousand" mantles of cotton, both white
nnd colored, a large number of hard towels with tassels at
tlie corners, and some metals which appeared to contain
inuch silver.
Before resuming the march Espejo obtained the services
of reliable guides, well acquainted with the country. He
took a course due West, and after traveling forty-five
leagues in that direction he reached the mines near tlie
lake. They were situated in a mountain which could be
ascended \vithout difficulty. The vein was very broad,
and he took therefrom, with liis own hands, several
specimens of rich metals which contained great quantities
of silver. Near the mines were situated several towns
upon the mountains, inhabited by a race of Indians called
Tubians. • The inhabitants came forth to meet him, upoM
liis approach, carrying crosses upon their heads and other
tokens of peace. In this province there were two con-
siderable rivcra, upon the banks of which were found
growing many vines bearing excellent grapes, and large
groves of walnut trees. There were also hares like those
of Castile. The Indians explained to Espejo, by means
of drawings, that behind the moimtains tliere was a great
rivera that ran toward the North-sea. It was about eight
leagues broad, and on both sides were situated many
towns of such size that those in which they dwelt were
l)ut small hamlets in comparison.
Having obtained this informalion Espejo immediately
took up the march for Zuni, where he arrived without
accident or opposition from the Indians. He found the
remainder of the Spaniards still at this place, and also
those whom he had sent back from Zaguato. In his
2 This river must have been the Great Colorado of the West, bat its
«size is overestimated.-
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.' 259
absence the inhabitants had treated them with great
kindness and furnished them with an abundance of every-
thing necessary to supply their wants. They were pleased
at his return, and a large number went forth to meet him
and welcome him back to the village.
The Spaniards now made preparations to leave Zuni,
the friar and the greater part of the soldiers to return to
New Biscay, and the captain to continue his explorations
higher up the river Del Norte. The Indians furnished
them with provisions for the march and expressed great
regret at their departure. They invited them to return
to their province and bring others with them, promising
to supply as many as miglit come with corn,*for which
purpose they planted a greater quantity that year than
usual.
The soldiers and the friar having marched on their
return to New Biscay, Espejo and companions set out on
their contemplated expedition to the North-east. After
marching some sixty leagues toward the Queres nation,
and thence twelve leagues more to the East, they entered
the province of the Tubians,3 otherwise called Hubates.
The Indians welcomed them as friends and supplied them
with provisions. Here they were informed of rich mines
of the precious metals, some of which they visited. The
province was estimated to contain twenty-five thousand
inhabitants, who were clothed in colored mantles of cotton
and chamois-skins, well-dressed. Their houses were four
and five stories high. The country was mountainous,
covered with pine-trees and filled with mines. Informa-
tion was received of another province about a day's
journey distant, inhabited by a people called Tanos, and
which contained a population of some forty thousand.
z Two protinces appear to have been called by the same name.
M
•260 Ike conquest of new "Mexico.
'"Espejo marched thither, but when he arrived in thfe
province the Indians would neither furnish him with
♦provisions nor permit him to enter their towns.
This was the limit of his explorations. Being nov7 a
.great distance from New Spain, Ins party few in number
and in the middt of numerous and powerful nations of
Indians, he resolved to return to Mexico. The necessary
preparations were quickly made, and in the beginning of
July, 1684, they took up the line of march homeward.
One of the Indians 'who accompanied them acted as guide
and conducted them by a route to the Eastward of the
Del Norte. They passed down a river called Bio de las
Vacas^* oz the river of Oxen, and was so named because
• of the great number of buflWoes that fed upon its banks.
They traveled down this river the distance of one hundred
and twenty leagues, all the way passing through great
herds of buflEaloes. Thence they struck across to the river
Conchos by which they had entered the country, whence
they continued on to the valley of Saint Bilrtholomew,
their starting point. The friar and the soldiers had
arrived there before them and gone to the town of Guar-
diana, whither Espejo and his companions followed. Here
he remained some time and wrote an accoimt of his
expedition for the Conde de Corrunna, who forwarded
the same to the king of Spain and the lords of the council
of the Indians.
Sometime after the return of Espejo one* Humana
entered the country to make explorations, and penetrated
some distance into the interior, but I have not been able
to obtain any information of his operations. He was
hunting gold in the southempart of the territory, and on
liis return passed near the town of Quivira. On the march
4 The river Pecos, and the same " Cow River " that Vaca describes.
TOE CONQUEST OF NEW ICEXICO. 261
&e had a difficulty with one of his officers, a Portagnese
named Leiva, whom he caused to, be executed. This act
60 alarmed one of his companions, a Mexican Indian
named Jpsefe, that he made his escape to the pueblo of
Picons, where he was afterward found by Oiiate. Soon
after this Humana and nearly all his companions were
put to d0ath by the Lidians. They had halted to rest
abouthihree days' travel from Quivira, when the Indians,
set fire to the grass, and th^ smoke and flames either suffo-
cated, or burnt them to. death, or rendered them helpless,
and thus they became easy victims to the savages. Of
the whole number only two escaped, one a Spaniard,
named Alonzo Sanches, and the other a mulatto girl who
was badly burnt. Sanches remained with the Indians
and was much respected and feared by them, and because
of his great* bravery was made a captain. No reliable
information was received of him afterward, though the
Indians said he was aUve a few years before 1629. The
mulatto girl was living when Onate entered the country..
1
262 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER XXXIV.
JUAN DE OitATE ENTERS NEW MEXICO WITH A PARTY OF
COLONISTS.
EsPEJO and his companions, upon their return to New
Spain, gave a most flattering account of the country they
had passed through, of the populous towns, fertile valleys,
abundance of provisions to be obtained, and the rich
mines of the precious metals to be found in the mountains.
This information rekindled the avarice of the Spaniards
of Mexico, and the viceroy determined to take permanent
possession of, and colonize, tlie country, i
1 1 have translated the following mterestmg account which Eepejo
gave of New Mexico from De Larenaudi^re's History of Mexico, viz :
"The people were somewhat advanced toward civilization, with
many manners and customs similar to those of the Aztecs. Many of
the men and women wore long gowns of cotton, tastefully painted,
and some had coats of cloth colored with blue and white, similar to
the manner of the Chinese. They were adorned with feathers of
difierent colors. One of the chiefs gave him four thousand bolls of
cotton. One of the tribes, called Jumanes, painted the face, arms and
legs in ridiculous figures. Their arms were great bows, with arrows
terminated with sharp-pointed stones, veiy hard, and wooden swords
armed on both sides with sharp-cutting stones, similar to the swords of
the Aztecs. The latter they use with great dexterity, and could cut a
man's body in two at a single blow. Their shields were covered with
untanned bull-hide. Some of the nations li?ed in houses of stone four
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 268
The person who first moved in the matter of .the colo-
nization of New Mexico was Don Juan de Oiiate, a native
of Zacatecas, and a gentleman of influence and import-
ance in his daj. He conceived the idea of planting
Spanish colonies in the country, and in order to obtain
permission to do so, presented a petition to the viceroy,
Don Louis de Velasco, to tliat eflect, about the close of
the sixteenth century.j He pledged himself to introduce
stories high, and walls very thick to keep out the cold of winter.
Others slept under tents during the heiit of summer, or lived in them
all the year. There were ftund villages where luxury and comforts
were noted. The houses were whitewashed and the walls covered
with pictures. The inhabitants used rich mantles with similar pictures,
and subsisted on good flesh and corn-bread. Other tribes were some-
what more savage : they covered themselves with skins of animals,
the product of thp chase, and the flesh of the mountain bull was their
principal food. Those nearest to the banks of the Del Norte, whose
fields appeared well cultivated, obeyed chiefs whose orders were an-
nounced by public criers. In the pueblos ot all the Indians were seen
a multitude of idols, and in each house there was a chapel dedicated
to the genius of mischief. They represented, by means of pictures, the
sun, moon and stars as principal objects of their worship. When they
saw the Spanish horses for the first time they were no less astonished
than the Mexicans, and were on the point of worshipping them as
superior beings. They subsisted them in* their most beautiful houses,
and entreated them to accept the best they had. There were found in
that great region abundant harvests of com, flax similar to that of
Europe, vines loaded with grapes, and beautiful forests filled with
buffaloes, deer, stags, and every species of game."
i The date of this petition is given as the 21st of September, 150r>,
which is most likely an error, as the records state that he left Mexico,
for New Mexico, on his expedition of colonization, in the year 1591.
There is a good deal of discrepance among the authorities as to the
time Ofiate arrived in New Mexico. Padre Frejes, in his history of
the conquest of New Mexico, published in Mexico, in 1830, states that
OQatc arrived there in 1505 ; ^Mariana says that he set out from
Mexico in 1598 ; while De Larenaudibre, in his History of Mexico,
published at Barcelona in 1844, states that he took possession of the
country the last year of the sixteenth century— 1589.
264 THE CX)NQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
two hundred soldiers, horses, cattle, merchandise, and'
agricultural implements. As a remuneration for his-
services he demanded large grants of land; that his.
The following is a copy of the original decree of the king of Spain,
in favorof Oiiatet
** Don Felipe, by tbe Grace of God, King of Castile^ of Airagon, of
tiie Sicilies, of Jerusalem, of Portugal, of Granada,, of Toleda, of Va-
lencia, of Galecia, Mayoria, Sevilla, of Yerdina, Cordova, Cor^ega,.
Murriaa, Jaen, Algarbes, of Algesira, Gibraltar, Canary Islands, East
and West Indies, Islands, and Tierra Firma of the Ocean, Archduque
of Austria, Duque of Borgora and Milan, Count of Traspur, Fland^,.
and Tirol, of Barcelona, Lord of Viscaya and Mollsa, &c.» &c, :
'' Whereas the ViceRoy, Don Louis of ¥plasco, by "virtue of a decree
of the King my Lord— may he live in Glory— entered into an agreement
and capitulatk)n with Don Juan de Ofiate, relative to the discovery,
pacification and settlement of the provinces of New Mexico, which is
in New Spain, and among otiier things he granted to him what is con-
tained in one of the chapters of instructions of new discoveries and
settlements of the Indias, which is as follows : ^ To* those who bind
themselves to form said settlements, and shall have done the same, and
shall have complied with the agreement, in honor to their own persona-
and their descendants and of them as first settlers^ laudable memory
may remain, wo make them and their legitimate descendants Hijoa^
dalgoa of the lands owned by ihem, in order that in the settlement
established by them, and in any other part of the Indies they may be
Hijoadalgoa and persons of noble lineage and Lord paramount, and
as such they shall be known, held and considered,, and enjoy all the
honors and pre-eminences, and may do"all things that noblemen and
gentlemen of the Kingdom of Castile can do, according to the privi-
leges, laws, and customs of Spain, should or ought to do and enjoy/
And in behalf of the said Don Juan de Ofiate, I have been requested to
grant him the grace to conunand him to approve, notwithstanding the
moderation which the Duque of Monterey used relative thereto, and
published by him, my Council of the Indies, I have thought proper
that the said prerogatives should be miderstood to continue during the
time occupied in said conquest, for five yea^rs, and if the said conquer-
ors should terminate the conquest thereof before the expiration of the
five years, they, their sons and descendants shall enjoy the said prero-
gatives as herein set forth. And I do hereby conmiand that aU who
may have gone and shall go on the said conquest^ pacification, and^
settlement, acoordiag^o, and in conformity, with, ,the pjx>visionsoLth&
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 265
&iaxl J fihonld be ennobled ; the loan of ar'considerable sum .
of money to defray the expenses ; a tat salary, and to be
furnished with arms and ammunition. He also asked
permission to reduce the natives to a state or obedience,
said chapter, and shall continue in the conquest for five years ; and
those who shall prosecute the same who should die before the expi-
ration of the five years, there shaU be reserved and secored unto their
sons and descendants aU the pre-eminences and pierogatiyes, exemp-
tions and Ubertiesas aforesaiddn conformity to, and as is granted and
conferred upon them in the said chapter, entirely and completely,,
failing in nothing, and charge the Infantes, Prelates, Duqnes, Marquises,
Counts, Nobles, Subjects and Briors of royal orders, Prefects, Alcaldes
of the Gastiles, houses surrounded with a moat, and country houses
(cases Aierte y lianas), and those of n^ Councils,. Presidents, Judges,
Alcaldes, High Constables of my household and court, and chanceiy to
my Vice Roys and Gtovemors, and to aU of my authorities and judges,,
as well those of my Kingdom and Seignories as those of the Indies and
Tierra Sirma of the Ocean, and other persons of whatever condition <
or quality to observe and comply, and to have obeyed and executed
this my franchise and grace, confirmed to the aforesaid, without
restricting or increasing, nor consent to any infiraction of the contents
of thfb my- determination, which I desire and it is my will that it shall
have the force of law as though it had been decreed and promulgated,
in Court, and it be published in all proper parts and places.
'* Given at San Lorenzo, on the Sth day of July, 1602.
(Signed) " I tub King.
"Laguna, Armenteros, Doc. Eugenic de Salazar, Benabente d&
Venavides— Louis de Saleedo. By order of the King, my Lord. Juan
de Ybarra. Recorded, Qabriel de Ochoa, Chancellor, Sebastian de la
Vega.
" AOT OF AimZIKOE.
'* In the city of Mexico, June 20, 1604, the President and Judge of
the Royal Ajodience of I9ew Spain being present at the session, also the
Mariscal de Campo, "Vicente the Saldivan, presented the Royal decree
govemingfto the opposite party, and asked that it be complied with ;
and being seen by the said Audience they obeyed the same with all
reverence and respects, and replied that it should be observed and
complied with, and executed in all its parts as His Majesty com-
manded ; and thus it was recorded as their act, and they approved the
same by placing their rubric thereto in my presence.
(^iglied); ''Cbisioval.Obo8io.*'
206 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICX).
which meant, in its practical eflfect, their redaction to a
state of slavery, and stipulated that the government
should supply the colony with " six priests, a full comple-
ment of books, ornaments, and church accoutrements."
The viceroy granted the petition of Oiiate, with the
exception of some of his most extravagant demands ; and
the agreement entered into between them stipulated for
" the discovery, pacification and settlement of the pro-
vinces of New Mexico, which is in New Spain." Among
other things there were granted to them the following
privileges contained in one of the " chapters of instruc-
tions of new discoveries and settlement of the Indias ;'*
which gave "To those who bind themselves to form said
new settlements, and shall have done the same, and shall
have complied with their agreement, in honor of their
own persons and their descendants, and of them as first
settlers, laudable memory may remain, we make them
and their legitimate descendants hijosdalgos of the lands
owned by them, in order that in the settlement established
l)y them, and in any other part of the Indias, they may
l)e hijosdalgos and persons of noble lineage, and lord
paramount, and as such they shall be known, held and
considered, and enjoy all the lionors and pre-eminences,
and may do all things that noblemen and gentlemen of
the kingdoms of Castile can do, according to the privi-
leges, laws and customs of Spain, should or ought to do
and enjoy." The time limited for the conquest and
pacification of the country was five years ; and if Oiiate
should die during that period, and before the conquest
should be completed, his sons were empowered to carry
on and complete the same, with like privileges and pre-
rogatives as their ancestor. This agreement between
vOiiate and the viceroy was confirmed and approved by
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 267
Don Felipe the Third, king of Spain, at San Lorenzo on
the 8th of July, 1602, but Onate had entered upon the
labor of conquest and colonization some years before.
As. soon as the viceroy had granted the petition of
Onate, and given him the necessary authority to organ-
ize the expedition, he made immediate preparations to
carry it into execution. He exhibited great activity in
raising troops, inducing settlers to embark in the enter-
prise, and procuring a supply of provisions. He had
numerous obstacles to encounter in fitting out the expe-
dition, which those who were opposed to it increased in
every possible manner. From this cause there was a
delay of three months in marching, and in the meantime
the men became much dissatisfied. More than two hun-
dred returned home, many of whom were married and
intended accompanying the expedition with their families.
This delay also caused great loss to Onate, who defrayed
nearly the whole expense. But in spite of every obstacle
and opposition he completed his arrangements and took
up the line of march from the city of Mexico sometime
in the year 1591. His foJce consisted o^upward of seven
hundred soldiers, including the flower of the Cliichimeca
troops, and he was accompanied by one hundred and
thirty married men, with their wives and children, who
went into the country as permanent settlers. Among
this number were several persons of note. Although the
records are silent upon the subject, we may suppose that
he took with him a sufficient number of domestic animals
to commence new settlements. He was also accompanied
by ten Franciscan friars, said to have been men of spirit
and leai*ning, who were named, Alonzo Martinez, commis-
sary of the troops, Francisco de San Miguel, Francisco de
Zamora, Juan de Bosas, Alonzo de Lugo, Andres Corchado,
i
"HE LUXQLiaT OP NEW MEXICO.
-. -.L^.=% ^;ia Cristoval Salazar, ministers; and Juan*
'^ / :ttiii'k eiicura and Pedro de Vergara, secular
. . ■ -uce, L^tiace directed his march toward the
*-. . -. j-.-.^.: ■ ::e iucerior of the country, until he struck.
..-» ".v-er, which he reached without any
^^ .r-.-^iirr. He followed up the bank of this
-..^. ^c**^;^ ".umerous Indian towns belonging to*
-.-VT .. ^•. ..A.ttH anril he arrived at the valley inhab-
■ ;^*.iakfr riatiotK situated on the borders of said
, ...... .ijituvie 37 deirrees N-orth.4 Continuing
.,c 1 ew Ita^uos further, he established his
. s. iw.sk^ius Ivvation between the rivers Del.
c V* ::iiiuH. He entered New Mexico with a
i^ s.idT^d men, including the one hundred
.A u\»u:xhc their wives and families with
. .. ^.-> !:iviui; either deserted on the march, or
.. . iws.> Hilcd to reach their destination. The
A 'M records for fixing upon this point
....s',i::CLir of the new settlement is because
.V .to [ate iK)int, imd on the West is CaU-
>^'»*. »%o imiJred leagues, as has been seen,
■ic Eiist three hundred leagues by an
^.i^\Liiu: the distance traveled by Orantes,
.^ :v'i- Horuando de Soto, for they were
.,\ .'s; '^aok and forth, and the distance
...^isv^.-tvi II a direct line, and on the North to
,-* wliioh is called San Lorenzo, where
Oi- S*t»aiu is easy, for it will be seen
,», .i> • »vcr !ub> its confluence in the Labrador
...%
..>>««
-%.
%fc ■, «.'.^-. * •
.-J .M v^'Aouivtg^ as the Teguafs nation inhabited a
• S.*^ui ot* $tuita F^ and in latitude about 35 de^eSt,
.^«
K* ^v»
ims COKQtfEST OF ITfiW ^ffixico. 269
comitry, the frontier of Terranova, at which place they
come every year to fish for cod/'s
The Indians received the Spaniards as friends, and
manifested their good-will by supplying them with pro-
visions and clothing, assisting them in the erection of
their houses, and immediately declaring themselves vassals
of the king of Spain. They found the climate cool and
healthful, somewhat isimilar to the elevated regions of
Spain, the land fertile, and watered by beautiful and
clear streams. The forests and mountains abounded
with game of many kinds, and the rivers and streams
were swarming witli fish. The surrounding pro\nnce8
were inhabited by a peaceable and amiable people, many
of whom lived to be an hundred years old.
Upon their first arrival the Spaniards encountered the
difliculties that always beset settlers of a new country,
and they were necessarily obliged to endure many liard-
ships. The soldiers soon became dissatisfied with the
life they were obliged to lead, and deserted their officers
and returned home. Upon their arrival in Mexico they
gave the most discouraging accouilt of the condition of
things, representing the country as barren and unfit for
the residence of man. They disparaged it in every
possible way, which had the effect of bringing the new
settlement into bad repute.
The colonists immediately commenced to build lionses
and organize a settlement, in which labors the Indians
gave them assistance. As soon as they had prepared a
shelter for themselves and families, they turned their
attention to the cultivation of the soil, as the best and
surest means of living. They located land, opened farms,
5 This extract is given for the purpose of showing the crude idea the
1Bpani&rds of that day had of the geography of the cominent.
270 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
planted corn, and all kinds of vegetables, and sowed
wheat and other grains; and soon the valleys were
blooming under the hand of industry, and the colonists
had the satisfaction of witnessing the steady growth of
an abundance of all the necessaries of life. Until the
harvest yielded its bountifursupply, the wood, the moun-
tains, and streams furnished a sufficiency of flesh and fisli
to satisfy their immediate wants. The country was well
adapted to grazing purposes, and, as soon as practicable,
they turned their attention to tliis branch of husbandry,
and in a few years numerous flocks of sheep and herds of
cattle were seen pastming upon the neighboring moun-
tains and plains. Plenty smiled on every hand, and
peace between the Christians and natives seemed ce-
mented by permanent good-will betweea the parties.
The accounts given of the Indians, as they were found
by Ofiate and his followers, agree substantially with those
received from his predecessors. They were settled in vil-
lages of large houses which contained many rooms, and
were several stories higli ; they dressed in mantles of cotton,
whicli was cultivated by them to a considerable extent,
and in buflalo-robes and wolf-skins. The mantles were
painted. They also wore mantles of feathers made from
the plumage of the wdld turkey, with which the country
abouuded. The dress of the men and women was similar ;
and all wore moccasins. They cultivated corn, beans,
pumpkins, and herbs, of which they laid in a supply for
the year before cold weather commenced ; and they also
ate bears, deer, rabbits, wild turkeys, partridges, and
quails, which they obtained- by the chase. They caught
trout, perch, and catfish in the streams, of which the
latter in particular abounded in the Rio del Norte. The
Indians were all sober, and drank no other beverage than
water.
THE CONQUEST CF NEW MEXICO* 271
CHAPTER XXXV.
oSate visits quivira, and what took place there;.
friar salmeron.
As a leading object of the Spaniards in entering New
Mexico was to seai'ch for the precious metals, they soon
turned their attention in that direction and neglected,, in
a measure, the pursuits of agriculture. In their searcli
for mines they were very successful, and found deposits
of gold and silver, of greater or less riclmess, in various
localities ; as in the mountains near Socorro, Puara,
Tunque, in the Puerto, in the Siencga, in San ilarcos,
GaUsteo, Pozos and Picoris, and also in the Jemez moun-
tains. Granite was found near Chama. Besides the
precious metals, there were discovered copper, lead,
magnets, copperas, alum, sulphur and charchihaites. The
latter were sought after principally by the Indians and
used by them as ornaments, and by whom they were
valued above aU other earthly things. The Spanish
colonists of that day are described by some as men of
great idleness, and enemies to all kinds of labor ; and one
old chronicler remarks, that although their desire for
gold was such that they would enter into the infernal
272 THirCOKQUEST OP mSW^ MEXICO.
regions to obtain it, and the country abounded in valu-
able mines, they, had not the energy necefisary to woric
them; and another goes bo fai* as to say that, ^^if they
have a good crop of tobacco to smoke they are well
coBtented, and want no other riches/'
This is probably an overdrawn picture. It is .quite
iikely that the want of C9.pital, and the absence of proper
machinery were greater drawbacks to the working of the
mines than lack of energy in the colonists, for the Span-
ish settler, in all parte of the world, has ever been noted
for his untiring industry in his search for the precious
metals. Among those who took > up their abode in New
Mexico, during the fipet nine year^ After Oiiate had entered
tlie country, were three Flemish men, but citizens of
Mexico, named Jusml Fresco, (Cool Johp), Juan Descalso),
(Barefooted John), and Rodrigo Lorenzo. They turned
their attrition to 'mining; discovered many new mines;
extracted a good deal of silver from the ore, and made
many experiments in the precious metals. Encouraged
by what- they had seen and done irf the business of mining,
they returned to Mexico and obtained competent miners
and refiners, togeOlier with the necessary machinery to
work the mines, v^Lich they carried back with them to
New Mexico. When they reached the settlements, and
the Spaniards heard their intention, the latter assembled
the night of th(^r arrival, set fire to the machinery and
burnt it. This is said to have been done because the
governor, Don Pedro de Peralto, gave the enterprise his
countenance; from which it would appear that the settlers
would not allow tliose who were so disposed work tlie
mines.
When Onate had erected his own house, and the colo-
nists were in a condition for him to be absent, he made
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 2TS
"iSk visit to the different Indian provinces. After he had
been to those neighboring to the new settlements, he
extended his explorations into the interior, and visited
•the more distant. Having heard a good deal said of the
great city of Quivira, he determined to make a trip
thither, to obtain correct information of the people and
the country. For this purpose he left the village of New
Mexico some time in thef year 1599, accompanied by
eighty soldiers as an escort and father Francisco de
Velasco, then commissary of the province, and a secular
friar named Pedro de Vergara, both of whom had come
into the country with him. He took for guide the Mex-
ican Indian, Josefe, who made his escape from Humana,
as before mentioned.
Thus prepared for the expedition he took up the line
of march, traveling in an East South-east direction over
the buffalo plains, covered with great herds of that animal.
They passed through a beautiful, healthful and fertile
country, with a salubrious climate, and well watered.
The plains abounded with fine pasture, and the soil pro-
duced by cultivation good grapes, plums, and other fruits.
They traveled, according to their computation, the dis-
tance of two hundred leagues, when they arrived at what
they denominated the " promised land," from its great
beauty and fertility. They saw, upon the plains, wan-
dering Indians, without permanent habitations, who dwelt
in huts of straw, and lived upon the flesh of the buffalo,
and who never planted, or laid up food. They dres;sed
In skins, which they also carried into the settled provinces
to sell, and brought back in return corn-meal, i
The Spaniards also encountered a tribe of Indians
called Escansaques, who were then on their way to make
1 These people were probably the .Querechos4escribed by Castaileda.
-18
i
274 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
battle with their enemies, the Quiviras. They had been*
in the habit of entering the settlements and setting fire to
the houses, and father Velasco persuaded Oiiate to punish
them in such a manner that they would not be likely to
do any damage in future. A battle took place between
them and the Indians, in which a thousand of the latter
were killed and a number of the Spaniards wounded.
Here was found some evidence of the killing of Humana
and his companions, in a few articles of iron, old boots,
and bones of horses seen at this point.
When the Quiviraj Indians heard of the approach of
the Spaniards, they sent a messenger to receive them ;
but when he saw them in company with their enemies,
the Escansaques, he became alarmed, and dared not cross
the river which separated them* Onate sent a party of
soldiers to cut off his retreat and make him prisoner,
which they succeeded in doing, and brought him in to
camp and put him in irons. The Quiviras, hearing what
had happened to their messenger, resolved to rescue him,
which they accomplished by a little stratagem and cun-
ning. They pretended to have become reconciled with
the Spaniards and visited their camp, but while the
latter were taking care of their arms, they succeeded in-
carrying off both the Indian and his irons. The sur-
rounding country appearing to be thickly settled, from
the number of smokes rising in all directions, Onate sent
out a reconnoitering party. They returned the next day,
and reported that there was no end to the settlements ;
that the Indians said the country was very extensive, and
was still more populous to the North. The Indians
likewise told them that it was the custom of their people
to liang their clothes upon the trees when they were
^ The same Qnivira that Coronado visited.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 275
preparing for war, where they, themselves, had seen
them hanging. They heard much said of the great wealth
of the country, and how the spear heads and drinking
cups were made of gold, but they saw no evidence of it.
Upon the return of the reconnoitering party the Span-
iards advanced toward the settlements, taking the direction
the Indians had fled after they released the prisoner. On
their approach the Indians abandoned their houses through
fear; but when they were informed how many of their
enemies, the Escansaques, had been killed, they were
assured and returned. They were now satisfied that the
Spaniards were a brave people and would make valuable
friends, and their exploit was published throughout the
country. The Indians now desired their friendship, and
for this purpose they sent, as embassador to them, an
Indian of Quivira, a man of great shrewdness and reserve,
who established peace between the parties. Oiiate was
well satisfied, from what he could learn, that the country
abounded in gold, and which the Indians refined by a
process they called Tejas.3
When Onate returned to Mexico he took with him two
Indian boys he had made prisoners in the fight with the
Escansaques, and whom he named Miguel, because the
action took place on that day. In the city of Mexico
one of them built a furnace for refining gold, with an
accuracy that astonished all of that occupation. He
said this was the only metal found in the country
whence he came, and that he was acquainted with no
other kind. The silversmiths tried to deceive him with
plated and spurious articles, but they could not, as in
3 The author has not been able to procure the balance of Ofiate's
journal, which will account for the abrapt termination of his adventures
in New Mexico.
27C THE CONQUEST OF NEW l^EXICO.
every instance he readily distinguished the true from the
false. He was afterward taken to Spain and presented
to Philip m. and the Court. The silversmiths of the
capital also tried to deceive him with a mixture of metals,
but in every case he detected the spurious article and
pointed out the pure -gold. His intelligence created quite
a sensation at CJourt. He made a map of his native pro-
vince and the neighboidng countries, with an accuracy
that caused great surprise, and which was placed in the
hands of the duke of Infantado, where it was afterward
seen by father Francisco Velasco. Miguel gave such a
flattering account of the wealth and greatness of the-
country, and of the abundance of gold to be found there,
that the king determmed to cause that region to be well
explored, and gave immediate orders for one thousand
}nen to be equipped for that purpose. The gentleman,
who carried this Indian to Spain, wishing to do great
service to Ids country offered to equip one half the
soldiers at his own expense. The king granted him
permission to do so; and he wrote to the viceroy of
Mexico, that in case he sliould comply with his promise
the other five hundred were to be equipped at his, the*
lung's, exi)ense. But nothing was done in the matter,
and the expedition entirely failed.
Ofiate appears to have remained several years in New
Mexico after his expedition to Quivira, and was engaged
in subduing the natives, and making settlements. Several
villages and missions were established, principally in the
valley of the Del Norte, and the colony flourished and
gained strength from year to year. In 1611 lie made an
exploration toward the East and discovered what were
then known as the Cannibal lakes, and also a river which
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 277
was called the "river of Cadaudachos, which means Pali-
sade."*
While the settlers were occupied in subduing the
Indians, cultivating the soil, and digging the precious,
metals, the Mars were employed in preaching to the
natives and converting them to Christianity. The number
of these pious missionaries was increased, from time to
time, and with a zeal worthy the cause in which they
were engaged, they traversed all parts of the country
proclaiming the gospel to the heathen. The first mission
was established at a place called El Teguayo, and down
to the. year 1608 eight thousand Indians had been bap-
tised and converted to Catholicism. Among the rehgious
men who came into the country mthin a few years after
the arrival of Onate, was one Geronimo de Zarate Sal-
maron, a monk of the Franciscan order, who passed eight
years of his life endeavoring to civilize and christianize
the natives. He took up his residence in the pueblo of
Jemez, which language he acquired, and preached to the
inhabitants in their native tongue. He resided there
several years, and baptised, and administered the sa:cra-
ment to, six thousand five hundred and sixty-six Indians
of this nation, besides baptising a large number of the
pueblos of Cia and Santa Ana, of the Queres nation. He
built several churches and convents, and did many other
praiseworthy acts to improve the condition of the heathen
inhabitants. He made a visit to the pueblo of Acoma,
then hostile to the Spaniards, which he succeeded in
pacifying and inducing to make peace. He traveled over
a large portion of the country, which he explored ; and
upon his return to Mexico to lay the result of his mission
4 The situation of these lakes is not known at the present day ; but
the riyer is probably the Canadian forl^ of the Arkansas..
d
278 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
before the head of his order, he wrote an account of the
country, giving the location of the various mines of
precious metals, with such general infonnation as would-
be of service to those who might succeed him.
In the year 1629, by order of the reverend father friar
Francisco de Apodaca, the "commissary of all the
provinces and consecrated vessels of New Spain," one
friar Francisco de Velasoo examined the journal of Sri-
maron, and caused the same to be made public, in order
to stimulate other religious men to undertake missions
into the country to convert the natives from idolatry.
The notice of Velasco, giving publicity to this journal, is
dated at the convent of San Francisco, city of Mexico,
August the 18th, 1629.6
1 1 have not been able to find Salmeron's JoumaL
JHE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. .279
CHAPTER XXXVI.
THE INDIANS BECOME DISCONTENTED UNDER SPANISH RULE,
AND MAKE SEVERAL ATTEMPTS AT REBELLION.
As has been already stated, when the Christians first
enftred New Mexico to establish permanent settlements,
the Indians received them with kindness and extended to
them the rights of savage hospitality. They famished
them the means of living until their fields should bring
forth fruit, and assisted them in erecting dwellings to
shelter them from cold and storm. The simple-minded
natives were of an amiable disposition and averse to war;
and were disposed to live on terms of good-will with the
strangers who had made their homes in their country.
In a few years, however, the Spaniards began to as-
sume the prerogative of masters, and under the rule of
tyranny which naturally followed, all harmony and good-
feeling between the races were at an end. It had ever
been the poUcy of Spain, in all her American conquests,
to change the religion as well as the civil institutions of
those whom she conquered. In accordance with this
rule of action, the Spanish settlers of New Mexico sooyi
.required the Jndians to give up the religious &ith of their
380 THE CONQUEST OP NSW MEXICX).'
fatliers, to which tliey were strongly attached, and em^
brace Catholicism. To eflFect this purpose with more
facility, churches were built and priests established in
most of the pueblos ; reh'gious services were celebrated
according to the forms of the Catholic church, and the
Indians were compelled to adopt a mode of worship
which they neither understood not sympathized with.
In a short time they saw all their ancient rites prohibited;
their estufasi were closed ; their altars removed, and their
idols destroyed. Their favorite dance the Cctchi7ia<i
which made up part of their religious worship, was in-
terdicted ; and in fine they saw themselves compelled to
kneel at the white man's shrine, to worship his God, and
l)y their sweat and toil to support a swarm of priesta^
established in all their villages. The Indians were
naturally attached to the religion of their race, in wMbh
they had been reared and which their fathers had
believed in from time immemorial, audit was a severe
trial for them to give it up. This was a compliance
cruel in the extreme, but the strong arm of Spanish
power obliged them to submit; and not unfrequently
the lash was applied to* make them more devout. In
addition to this, when the Spaniards turned their atten-
tion to mining, the Indians were compelled to work in
1 The cstufa still retains its importance in the political and religious
organization of the Pueblo Indians. Each village contains one, which
is used both as a counciVchamber and a place of worship, where they
practice such of their heathen rites as still exist among them. It is
built partly under ground, and is considered a holy place. In it the
Indians hold all their deliberations on public affairs, and transact the
t^rdinary municipal business of the village. It is said to be their cus-
tom when they return from a successful war expedition, to repair to
the estufay where they strip themselves of their clothing and dance
and otherwise celebrate then: success; and that, upon some occasions »,
they remain there two or three days before visiting their familie&
THE CONQUEST OF NEW »LEXICO, 28i
the mines, where, year after year, they dragged out a
life more miserable than death itself. From these causes
the natives became bitterly hostile to the Christians ; and
as years rolled away with renewed and incre^ed hard-
ships, their hearts were steeled against all desire of
reconciliation. From this time friendship between tho
races was at an end, and they became open or secret
enemies.
Under these circumstances we are not surprised that
the Indians wore the Spanish yoke with uneasiness and
discontent, and longed to throw it off. They now begaa
to look upon the Spaniards as intruders in the country,
and considered it their duty to expel them. In secret
they still worshipped the Gods of their fathers, and
neither the teachings of the priests, nor the severe
punishments inflicted upon them, could compel them to
relinquish their ancient rites. Whenever they were
known to indulge in their heathen ceremonies, even in
the privacy of the estufa, they were severely punished ;
but this had only the effect to incense them still more,
and increase their hatred^ of the Spaniards.
The Indians now resolved to rid themselves of their
harsh task-masters, and to effect this object a general
combination of all the pueblos was agreed upon. They
began to manifest open discontent, and defy the Spanish
power. They made several attempts at rebellion before
success crowned their efforts, in every instance being
either betrayed by one of their own number, or immedi-
ately overpowered^ after they had taken up arms. The
first attempt of the kind, of which we have any record,
was about the year 164Q, while General Arguello was tha
governor and captain-general of tho province. The
immediate cause of this outbreak was the whipping, im^*
2S3 THE CONQUEST OF l^W ICEXIGO.
prisoning and hanging of forty Indians, becanse thej
wonid not relinquish their heathen worship and become
devout Catholics. They flew to arms but were soon
overpowered. During the same administration the Jemez
and the Apache Indians combined in a conspiracy, but
the effort was futile, as they succeeded in killing only one
&^>aniard, named Di^o Martinez Naranjo. The governor
caused twenty-nine of the conspirators to be arrested and
imprisoned.
A second rebellion was put on foot in the year 1650,
during tlie administration of General Concha. It was
planned by the pueblos of the Teguas nation, namely :
Ysleta, Alameda, San Felipe, Cochitei and Jemez ; and
it was the intention of the Indians to drive every Span-
iard, and parficularly the priests, from the country whom
they did not massacre. In this instance the Apachesa
also became their allies. The time agreed upon for the
outbreak to take place was the Thursday m'ght of Passion-
Week, when the Christians would be generally assembled
in the churches engaged in religious exercises, and being
luiprepared for defence the Indians were to rush in and
massacre them. Fortunately the conspiracy was dis-
covered before the time arrived to carry it into effect,
and was prevented. A party of Indians had been sent
t Ysleta, San Felipe and Cochite are situated in the valley of the Del
Norto, the two former South of Santa F<^, the latter about due West,
and within sight of the town Pena Blanca. Alameda was situated
near Albuquerque, and has long since passed aWay. San Felipe is a
few miles South of Pefia Blanca, and almost in sight of it. On a high
blutr mesa near this pueblo, and overlooking the river, is the ruin of
Hu old pneblo, which has not been occupied within the memoxy of the
prtvHnit generation.
a A wandering tribe, consisting of several bands, and occupying va-
rlouH parts of New Mexico. They live in lodges and subsist by the
^chtuH) and stealing.
THOE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICa 288
out to steal horses to aid them in the enterprise, and the
Spaniards suspecting some- mischief, dispatched captain
Alonzo Baca in pm^uit. He succeeded in arresting them
with the animals in their possession, when they made a
full confession of their plan of operations. They informed
him that the horses had been delivered to them by the
Christian Indians of Sandia and Alameda ; and that all
the pueblos had united with the Apaches, in a conspiracy
to kill every Spaniard in the country. Baca lost no time
in commimicating this information to the alcalde of
Alameda, who gavQ immediate notice of what he had
heard, to the governor. General Concha took prompt
action in the matter. He ordered an investigation to be
held forthwith, which resulted in the discovery of all the
plans of the enemy, by which the rebellion was crushed
and the ring-leaders secured. Many Indians were arrested
and imprisoned, of whom nine were hung, and a number
sold into slavery for the term of ten years. These
energetic measures overawed the rebels, and for the
present they remained quiet.
For some time the two races lived in apparent friend-
ship with each other, and nothing more was heard of
rebellion, but the Indians had not relinquished the hope
of driving the Spaniards from the country. For a few
years undisturbed quiet reigned throughout the province,
and the Indians bore their grievances in silence and
sadness. During the administration of General Villanueva
the Indians of the pueblo of Piros conspired with the
Apaches, and fled from their village and took refuge
^vitli the latter in the Magdalena mountains. From this
rendezvous they sallied forth with arms in their hands
and commenced the work of death. They killed five
Spaniards before they could be overpowered, one of
xrv-i ^"Tas- *n u\.-:iu:e :i i r^ei^bormg village, who waa
HIT !fr^i \v ^ Cinicfiti Li'ilam named Tambalita. Thia
*^ii^ ii^r .ixnr :r ±je ^7:117 done when the conspiracy
t:ss^ .ris^tii i2.d tiie leaders secured. Six of them were
":ur:^. .uii -^azj Cuiers isipriioned and sold into slavery^
.wui- :\: ::L:«:r sc:r«r^dt:."^Il^ that existed with the Indians
.; Nv^ 5Ux:cv> W5is that ot witchcraft, and about thi*
::.Li :i;e S:x.c:iirds caused several of the inhabitants of
S:: AvU ro \? burnt for this imaginary offence. 4
A >u.r: rliue afVexward another rebellion was put on
::v: '\h:v'>. rvsulted as disastrously as before. The head
.u:-.! :'r«.':i: of :h:s luoveuient was Estevan Clemente, the
^v»tr:Lor ot the S.ilt Lake pueblos, an Indian of much
. ;:;:t:KO, luid to whom his brethren paid great deference.
IV .:< v.oi:spirHcy \vas general tliroughout the country, and
.0-: :i white mau was to bo spared to tell the tale of
'\,vO. Clemeute directed the Indians to steal the horses
I 'lio Spanuu\U and conceal them in the mountains, so
..v; *^'Uui liiivv no means-of escape should they attempt
' '10 :iinc tlxovl upon for the outbreak was the
■•.L.>^^:i\ Mii;iit of P;u>j>ion-AVeek as before ; but mean-
» ". 'c !io \\iioic plan of operations was discovered and
c \ vViiioa uip^vvl in the bud. Clemente was arrested
K. .i;* v^iioJi hU followers abandoned the enterprise
....^io 'A'i**us with the Spaniards. There were found
iio oiilvt^ of this Indian many idols and other
». %
\\.
• kV\
w -x •
. iiv "UKKSi* luUiiiu* ot' New Mexico still believe in witchcraft. In
.:n v^ * .: ^.^ ^ > x> i> ih%> luvUaus of the pueblo of Nambe' put two of their
.» .. ..^k\* a» -iirtUx ior ihU imaginary offence, being accused of eat-
.^ , ^1 i5v' mk' slJiidivu of the village. The offenders were tried
•v. \v uv . ^»iw MHiv* Ui*trict Court at Santa Fe, for murdef, and
., .^... V. V \v.*swHf 1 vN>aii.l uot be clearly proved in which of two ad-
... >. IV «. IK 'l^lhii^ twk place. The author conducted the case
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 285
urticlesin readiness to resume their he^en worship had
the conspiracy been successful.
In the year 1675, and while general Juan Franjeisco
Frecenio was governor and captiain-general of the province,
the Indians of the Teguas nation were accused of having
bewitched friar Anares Duran, superior of the convent of
the pueblo of San Yldefonso, his brother, sister-in-law,
and an Indiad interpreter. Upon information being laid
before the proper authorities, upward of forty of the In-
dians were arrested and imprisoned. A military tribunal,
composed of Francisco Javier, civil and military secretary
of the governor, as judge conliscator and executioner ;
Louis de Quintana, associate judge, and sergeant-major
Diego Lopez, interpreter, was organized for their ex-
amination. Upon being arraigned the Indians pleaded
guilty, when forty-three were sentenced to be whipped
and sold into slavery, and four to be hanged. Of the
four sentenced to suffer death, one was hung in Nambe,
another in the pueblo of San Felipe, a third in Jemez,
and the fourth hung himself.
This proceeding increased the hostihty of the Indians
toward the Spaniards, and those of the Teguas nation
formed a conspiracy to put the governor to death. For
a time they were troublesome, but no outbreak occurred
nor was there any open resistance to the Spanish au-
thority. While the Indians under sentence remained in
confinement, seventy warriors of this nation, under the
command of Pope, a distinguished San Juan Indian,
repaired t#the quarters of the governor early one morn-
ing, and demanded the release of their brethren. They
entered the house and filled two of the rooms, and laid
before him eggs, chickens, tobacco, beans and peltries, as
e. ransom for the prisoners. The governor was alarmed
286 THE CKDKQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
at the resolute fi^nt the Indians wore, bat exhibited no
sign of fear, rf reply to their demand, he told them
that he would release those in confinement if they would
abandon their heathen customs, when they quietly retired.
Thus the Indians, for a period of nearly half a century,
and during the administration of foprteen governors,
made ineffectual attempts lo free themselves from the
yoke of the Spaniards. The latter were ke{)t in a state of
constant alarm and fear, and the most unceasing vigilance
was required on their part to prevent themselves being
expelled the country. These repeated failures, however,
did not dampen the ardor of the Indians for rebellion, nor
relax their efforts to be free. From time to time they
renewed the attempt, and each succeeding effort brought
to the work increased wisdom and cunning, and expe-
rience purchased by defeat. At length the oppression of
the Spaniards reached such a pitch that the Indians were
determined to bear it no longer ; forbearance had ceased
to be a virtue, and they resolved to make a united and
mighty effort to rid themselves of their oppressors forever.
Tills led to the revolution of 1680 which resulted in the
expulsion of the Spaniards from the coimtry, when the
Indians maintained their independence for upward of ten
years in spite of all the force the government could send
against them.
THE C(MfQU£ST OF NEW MEXICO, 28T
CHAPTER XXXVII.
THE INDIANS RISE IN EEBELUON AGAINST THE SPANISH
AUTHORITIES. .
After the defeat of their contemplated rebellion in the
time of Governor Concha, the Indians had repeatedly
discussed the formation of new Conspiracies in their pri-
vate assemblies, which some of the pueblos advocated and
others opposed. The first attempt, to unite all the
pueblos in a common league against the Spaniards, was
made by the Taos Indians. Their method of communi-
cating intelligence to their brethren was simple but
efiective. They obtained two deer-skins upon which
they made drawings representing the manner of the
proposed conspiracy, and the object of it. These they
sent by trusty hands to all the Christian pueblos, with an
invitation to join in the enterprise. Messengers were
even sent to the distant villages of Moqui, but they
refused to unite with the others, for which reason the
project was postponed.
The second effort of the kind was put on foot in the
year 1680, by the same Pope, who is mentioned in the
last chapter. He was a man of decided ability, and
M
288 . THE CONQUEST OF NEW ilEXICO.
exercised a controling influence over his untutored
brethren. He traversed tlie country in all directions,
and, with an eloquent tongue, pictured to the Indians the
wrongs they were suffering, and aroused them to a desire
to throw off their yoke. He told them that their Great
Father and chief of all the pueblos, he who had been
their father since the flood, had commissioned him to .
order his countrymen to rebel against the Spaniards and
drive them from the land, so that they could live as their
forefathers had done, free and independent To wield a
greater influence with them, he made them believe that
this undertaking was the result of supernatural agencies, •
and that he iield intercourse with the devil, who was
lending all his aid to the work. He said, thjjj; one day
while down in the estufa at Taos, there appeared untD
him three figures of Indians who M^ere always present
there. They were named Caidit, Tilim and Tlesime,
who sent forth fire from every extremity of their body ;
and were messengers fromlhe infernal regions ; that they
tionversed with liim, advising him what course he should
take to unite all the Indians in a common league against
the Spaniards. That they directed him to make a rope
of the palm-leaf, and tie in it a number of kots to repre-
sent the number of days before the rebellion was to take
place ; that lie must send this rope to all the pueblos in
the kingdom, when each one should signify its approval
of, and union with, the conspiracy by untying one of the
knots. Pope, as he had been directed, caused the pahn-
ioaf rope to be carried from pueblo to pueblo, by the
fleetest young men, with an invitation to all to join in
the enterprise, and threatening with death those who re-
fused. Absqlute secrecy was enjoined upon all. The
Tope was carried to -every pueblo but that of Piros, which,
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 289
*<or some unexplained cause, was not invited to participate
in the rebellion. In this simple manner notice was given
4ill over the province of the proposed rebellion, and the
time it was to take place.
Pope was not alone in his endeavors to arouse liis
countrymen to a sense of their wrongs and persuade them
-to drive the Spaniards from the country. He was the
leading spirit in the work, but he had some active and
.zealous co-laborers. These were Catite, a half-breed
Queres Indian, Tacu of San Juan,i Jaca of the Taos
pueblo, and one from San Yldefonso,* called Francisco.
Some of these men had cause of personal revenge ; and
all burned with a desire to rid themselves of the system
of tyranny imder which they had been groaning for near
a century. They had been whipped and scourged be-
cause they would not bow down and worship the unknown
God of the Spaniard, and been compelled to dig the
precious metals from the bowels of the earth to satisfy the
avarice of their tyrants ; and they thirsted for vengeance.
Every tiling was conducted with the most profound
secrecy, and no means spared to prevent their plans
becoming known to the Spaniards. A constant watch
was kept upon those who w^ere thought likely to divnlgc
the plot, and not a woman was let into the contidence of
the conspirators. Pope's own son-in-law, Nicholas Bua,
governor of the pueblo of San Juan, fell under his suspi-
<;ion, and, for fear he might give information to the enemy,
lie put him to death by his own hands. The Indian--
1 It is said that Uie two pueblos of San Juan and Pozos remained
faithful to the Spanish, for which the former was afterward styled San
Juan de los CabaUcros, or the gentlemanly San Juaners.
2 The pueblos of San Juan and San Yldefonso are situated in ihe
uT&Ucy of the Del Norte, a few. miles North of Santa Fc.
19
J
290 THE COXQUEST OF KEW fiEXfCa
lield Pope in great dread because of their belief that he
lield latercourse with the evil spirit, and they attached
more importance to what he said than that spoken by all
the other leaders.
The time fixed upon for the rebellion to break out
was the 10th of August, and the poor, oppressed Indians
looked forward to its arrival as tha period that was to
deliver their necks from the yoke of the Spaniards. They
had newly bent their bows and tipped their arrows afresh
to draw Christian blood, and they awaited with impatience
for the day of vengeance to come. In spite of all their
precaution, however, treachery lurked in their own ranks.
Two days before the time fixed upon, two Indians ef the
pueblo of Tezuque went down to Santa Fe and divulged
the conspiracy to the Spanish governor. They were
parties to it, but betrayed their country and their cause
to the enemy. The Indians were immediately informed
that their plans had been made known to the Spaniards,
and, fearing that delay might endanger the whole enter-
prise,they resolved to take up arms tbrthwdth. That night
tlie pueblos nearest the capital commenced an indiscrim-
inate slaughter of all Christians who fell into their hands,
sparing neither priests, women nor cliildren, except a few
of the handsomest maidens, whom the warriors reserved
for wives.
The rebellion, burst upon the Spanish authorities
l)eibre they were prepared to meet it, and they were in
dismay when informed that the Indians were advancing
toward the capital. The most vigorous measures were
taken to roll back the tide of rebellion tliat was setting
in upon them from aU parts of the country. Governor
Otcrmin directed that the Spaniards in the South should
take refuge in the pueblo of Isleta, under the command of
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 291
»
tiie lieutenant-governor, and there fortify themselves;
while those in the North were ordered to repair to Santa
•Fe. The settlers obeyed the snmmons with alacrity, and
leaving their homes hastened toward the places of ren-
dezvous ; many reached them in safely, but a large number
were overtaken on the way by the Indians and put to
death without mercy. The capital, meanwhile, was put
in the best possible state of defence. The suburbs were
abandoned and* the inhabitants withdrew to the central
part of the town. The streets entering into the plaza
were strongly barricaded; the government buildings were
converted into fortifications, and jwrns distributed fimong
the citizens.
Thus situated, the little garrison awaited, with much
apprehension, the approach and attack of the savages.
Information reached them daily that they were advancing
toward the town, and they were in hourly expectation of
seeing them make their appearance. Two Spanish sol-
diers arrived from Taos on the evening of the 10th instant,
having passed through the rebels with difficulty, who
brought information to the governor that the Taos pueblo
was in arms, and on the march for the capital. They
also reported that the Spaniards at La Canada were well
fortified and able to defend themselves. The governor
sent out a detachment of soldiers in that direction to
reconnoitre the enemy, with orders to bring in the citizens
who remained at La Cafiada. In the meantime, however,
the Indians had attacked that place, massacred the inhab-
itants, destroyed the town and driven off the stock, and
on the 12th the troops returned with the intelligence.
The Indiaqs were now gradually drawing near Santa Fe,
and the alarm of the inhabitants and the garrison in-
creased daily. They had avowed the massacre of the
292 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
Spaniards in the several pueblos, and thi'eatened the re^
with the same fate, expressing a determination to exter-
minate all who were m the country. ,
Two friendly Indians were dispatched in the direction
of the Galisteo, to gain intelligence of the enemy in that
quarter. They had been absent but a few hours, when
they returned with the information that about five hun-
dred warriors of the Tagnos nation were marching toward
Santa Fe, and were not more than a league distant. The
^pies had entered their camp, and understanding their
language had been kble to learn something of their plan
of opetations, as well as to note the disposition they
manifested. They were incensed in a high degree against
the Spaniards, and were confident of success. They
declared that the God of the Christian was dead, but that
their God, the sun, never died. They were only waiting
to be joined by the Teguas and Apaches to carry into
effect their war of extermination.
The forces of the savages followed close upon the steps
of the two spies, and the following morning they were
seen approaching the town in large numbers from the
South. They halted in the suburbs, and took possession
of some deserted houses to await the an*ival of their allies
from the North, before making an attack. Governor
Otermin was fully sensible of the danger that menaced
him and his little garrison, and determined to arrest it,
if possible. He desired to hold a parley with the rebel
chiefs and induce them to withdraw their forces before
the aiTival of the Northern Indians ; and for this purptBc
he sent out a deputation to meet them in conference. But
instead of manifesting any wdllingness to come to terms,
they exhibited a strong determination for war. They
iF»formed the Spanish officers that they had brought with
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 293
them two crosses, one painfed red which signified war,
aAd the other white which indicated peace, and they might
take their choice between the two ; but if they selected
the one which indicated peace, it could only be upon
condition of an immediate evacuation of the country.
The governor made every possible effort to conciliate tlie
rebels, and induce them quietly to retmn to their homes.
He offered to pardon all their crimes and receive them
jigain into the favor of the government if they would lay
down their arms and become good Christians and loyal
subjects ; but they treated these overtures with scorn and
refused to listen to any terms of peace. For nearly a
century they had toiled and labored under the iron rulij
of their Spanish task-masters, and now they saw a gleam
of happier times ; a day of deliverance and retribution
was near at hand, and they could not give up the hope
of retaliation and again place themselves in bondage*
The conference ended, and the Indians awaited the arrival
of their confederates.
M
294 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTEB XXXVIII.
THE INDIANS BESIEGE SANTA F^, AND COMPEL THE SPAN-
lARDS TO EVACUATE THE TOWN.
GovEBNOR Otermin haying failed to conciliate the
Indians, now determined to attack them, hoping to defeat
them before the arrival of their confederates frcmi the
North. For this pm^pose the garrison made a sortie to
didodge them from the suburbs. The savages received
them ^vith great bravery, and handled them so roughly
that the governor was obliged to turn out in person with
Jill tlio disposable force to save them from defeat. The
battle was continued all day, being maintained with equal
oourage on both sides. The Spaniards had a few men
killed and wounded, but tlie loss of the Indians was very
^reat. Toward evening, and before the action was ended,
the Teguas and other nations were seen approaching the
tiuvu from the Nortli, when the Spaniards were obUged
to retire within their fortifications and reUnquish the ad-
vantages they had gained during the day. The enemy
iMicaniix)d dose under the walls of the town and prepared
to invest it
^THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 295
The Indians closely besieged Santa Fe,i and took
•every precaution to confine the Spaniards within their
earthen walls. Their numbers increased daily by tlie ar-
rival of warriors from surrounding pueblos, and they
showed a determination to starve out the unfortunate
garrison. The siege had now lasted nine days, and the
enemy exhibited no disposition to relax the investment of
the town. The condition of the garrison was becoming
desperate in the extreme. The Indians had turned off the
stream that supplied them with water, and the horses and
I Santa Fi, or, as it is sometimes written, Santa F€ de^San FranciscQ,
the city of the Holy Faith of Saint Francis, is the capital, of the terri-
tory of New Mexico, and has been the seat of government of that
country almost from the time the Spaniards firet settled it. It is in
latitude 35 degrees, 41 minutes North, and lOG degrees West longitude
from Greenwich, and has an elevation of more than seven thousand
feet above the level of the sea. It is situated at the western base of the
^eat Rocky chain of mountains, in a pleasant valley, and on both sides
of a little river of the same name that empties into the Rio del Norte
about twenty miles to the South-west. History is silent as to the time
Santa Fe was first settled by the Spaniards, but it was no doubt soon
after they arrived in New Mexico. It was the capital long before 1680,
and the seat of the civil and military power of the Spaniards. The
city occupies nearly the.site of several Indian pueblos, and here was
established the power of their kingdoms ; but they have long since
fallen to ruins, and aU that remains of them are the pieces of pottery
to be found on the surrounding hills and down the valley, and parts of
two of their old houses on the road leading to San Miguel. A portion
of the old palace is still standing, a quaint old building, the witness of
stirring events long before William Penn founded Pennsylvania. Santa
Fc is a mud-built city, the houses being constructed of adobes from
turret to foundation stone. The streets are narrow and unpaved. In
the centre of the city is a large public square, or plaza, of late years
planted with trees and enclosed with a board fence ; and fronting it
are the leading mercantile and business houses. It contains but few
public buildings. It is the centre of an extensive and profitable busi-
ness with Eastern cities. The populatioa is about five thousand. .The
.<limate is delight^L
i
296 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO;
other animals were d3dng of thirst ; provisions were be-
coming scarce, and starvation began to stare them in tht»
face. All hope of succor, imder present circrnnstances,
was at an end, and tlie only alternative left the garrison
was to starve for want of supplies, or to make a sortie
and cut their way tlirough the enemy. The latter course
was resolved upon and they made the necessary prepara-
tions for it during the night of the ninth day of the siege.
The next morning, at sunrise, they sallied out of their works
and made a des^Kirate assault upon the savages. In spite
of greatly superior numbers, Otermin succeeded in cut-
ting his way through the Indians and driving them from
their position. Three hundred of the enemy were slain^
and forty-seven made prisoners, besides a large amount of
j^roperty recaptured. The captives were examined as
to the nature of the conspiracy, after which they were
executed. The Spaniards lost Or few soldiers killed and
wounded, the governor being numbered among the latter.
The Indians now raised the siege, and, about three thou-
sand strong, retired to the mountains a little distance from
the town.
Otermin now called a council of war to determine what
course to pursue in the emergency. Although the popu-
lation of Santa Fe was over one thousand souls, not more
than an hundred able bodied men could be mustered
to oppose the swarm of savages that surrounded them.
They were fatigued by fighting and constant watching
by day and by night, and the supply of provisions was
about exhausted. In view of this condition gf things,
the council resolved that it was ad\isable to evaouate ti\&
tovni and leave it to its fate. This course determined
upon, they made immediate preparations to carry it into
'ittect. They completed their arrangements during the
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 297
night of the 20th of August, and early the next morning
they evacuated the town and took up the line of march
for El Paso del Norte. The inhabitants accompanied
the troops on foot and carried their own baggage, as
there were not enough animals left to carry the sick and
wounded.
The Indians watched the movements of the Spaniards
from their camps, but did not attempt to interrupt or
molest them, and when they had retreated some distance
they marched in pursuit. The fugitives continued their
retreat with all possible speed to Alamillo, where they
halted to rest. At this place the Indians came up with
them and made demonstrations of attack. Here the
Spaniards were reinforcgd by forty men under the com-
mand of adjutant Pedro Leyva, who had heard of their
distressed condition and marched to their rehef. The
Indians now gave up the pursuit and retraced their steps
toward Santa Fe. A council of war was called by Oterr
miu, when it was decided to continue the march to
Salienta there to await a supply of provisions, and they
accordingly again put themselves in route. When they
reached the pueblo of Isleta they learned that the Span-r
iards who had assembled at that place had retreatecT to
the South a few days before. As they marched down
the valley of the Del Norte they found all the pueblos
deserted, the ranches laid waste, and the Christians either
killed or driven away. Tliey were nearly in a starving
condition, and suflfered greatly for provisions as the
Indians had destroyed or removed everything that could
afford them relief.
In a few days the whole detachment became so much
reduced and broken down that it was unable to proceed
without assistance, and an express was dispatched to the
298 THE GONQimST OF NEW HEXIOO.
«
lieutenaEnt-govemor for supplies. He sent them a smaB
quantity of provisions, and loaned them a few carts to
transport the baggage and disabled. Before the Spani-
ards marched from Alamillo an express was dispatched
to father Ayeta, at El Paso, for a supply of com. He set
out from that place with four wagon loads, but in crossing
the river, which was high, one of the wagons swamped
and the reverend father came near being drowned. The
balance oT the com reached the troops which enabled
them to continue the march. They reached Salienta
the latter end of September, having overtaken the ad-
vanced party. Here another council of war was held
to consider the propriety of returning to New Mexico,
when it was determined to ren^ain at some convenient
place near where they then were until the viceroy could
be heard from. They selected San Lorenzo, about twelve
leagues above El Paso, for the place of encampment,
because both wood and water were near at hand.
The fugitive Spaniards passed the winter at San Lo-
renzo, and suffered very much. They built rude huts
raised on four forks, with thatched roofs, and the women,
•barefooted, mixed the mud and plastered the walls. Most
of *the material was brought on the backs of the men,
the governor and priests assisting in this arduous labor.
Father Ayeta supplied them with ten beeves and as
many fanegas of corn, daily, but some of the time they
^were destitute of provisions, and were obliged to live on
herbs, wild fruit, mesquit-beans and mescal. Many left
San Lorenzo and went to Casas Grandes, Viscayaand
Sonora, in search of provisions and quarters. The
governor of Parral iesued a circular calling upon the
inhabitants to send them supplies, but few only were
received. To add to their troubles, the surrounding
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 299
Indians were hostile, and they were in constant fear of
an attack ; and they were also threatened by the Indicgis
of New Mexico. Upon two occasions Otermin marched
against the Firos nation and chastised them severely for
their depredations.
Upon relinquishing the pursuit of tjie retreating Span-
iards the Indians returned to Santa Fe, which they
entered and took possession of. They immediately
commenced the work of pillage and destruction. The
churches and convent were fired and consumed with
their contents, except the provisions, which they saved ;
and while the fire was raging the Indians danced around
the burning piles with the wildest demonstrations of
delight, crying aloud in the midst of their savage orgies,
that "God the Father and Mary the Mother of the Span-
iards were dead," and that tlieir God alone lived. They
dressed themselves in the vestments of the priests and
rode around the town on horseback yelling and whooping
with joy. They established the four cardinal points of
the compass for their visible church; and erected stone
enclosures in the plaza around which they danced the
cachina^ and made offerings of floui^, feathers, the seed
of the meguey plant, corn, tobacco, and other articles to
propitiate their heathen deities. The children were
enjoined to observe these rites in future. After these
ceremonies had been concluded they repaired to the little
river that flows by the town, in whose limpid waters they
bathed and washed their bodies with soap- weed, « in order
to cleanse themselves of Christian baptism administered
to them by the Spanish priests. The cliiefs ordered that
the names of Jesus and Mary shojild not be mentioned
in the pueblos; that all should drop baptismal names,
s Arnold mentioned before.
300 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
and put away the wives who had been given them in.
marriage, and take for partners any other women whom
they might fancy. The estufas were directed to be
opened in place of the churches destroyed, and the
cachina dance was re-established with all its forms and
ceremonies.
The number of Christians who fell in the rebellion
was over one hundred, Spaniards and civilized Indians,
and including men, women, children, and suckling babes;
of whom eighteen were priests. The loss of the savages
was much greater. At the siege of Santa Fe alone more
than four hundred were killed and a large number
wounded, besides the loss sustained at other places.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW. MEXICO. 301
CHAPTER XXXIX.
WHAT TOOK PLACE AFTER THE SPANIARDS WERE DRIVEN
FROM THE COUNTRY.
The Spaniards having been driven from the country,
the leac^ers of the rebellion took measures to unite all the
Indians in conunon league against their return. They
even made overtures to those of Sonora ; and agreed to
intermarry and live upon friendly terms with the Apaches,
upon conditions that they would assist them in their future
struggles with the Spaniards.
Pope made a tour thi'oughout the province to see that
the Indians ^ere in a proper state of defence to resist any
attempt of the Christians to reconquer them. He sent
messengers in advance to all the pueblos to warn the
people of his coming, and to notify them to be in readi-
ness to receive him. He was accompanied by Jaca, Louis
Cupavo and Alonzo Catite, and whithersoever he went
the savages received him with almost regal honors, and
paid him the most devout submission. He ordered the
churches and convents to be burned, and the pictures and
other articles used in Christian worship to be destroyed,
acd •the religion of their fathers to be everywhere
302 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
re-established. The Indians were forbidden to speak the
Spanish iangnage, but compelled to converse in their
mother tongue. They were prohibitedfplanting any but
their ancient seeds, beans and com, and were ordered to
throw away all the seeds and grains given them by the
Spaniards. They were directed to open new-lands and
increase their fields, and Pope assured them that since
the Spaniai;^s had been driven away they could enjoy
the fruits of their own labor, and live free and indepen-
dent as their forefathers had done. Upon the condition
of comjfliance with his demands, he promised them the
blessings of good crops and health. He told them that
the God of the Spaniards was made of rotten wood and
was not good for anything, but that the God whom they
worshipped was very powerful. The Indians were made
to believe that these commands eminated from the three
figures \Yhose extremities gave forth fire and smoke, and
tliat obedience to them was necessary in order to return
to their ancient customs. All who refused to comply
were immediately put to death.
When Pope entered Cia he rode a black mule, wore
the Indian costume, and had a large bull's horn fastened
upon liis head. He reached the pueblo early in the morn-
ing and was received with the honors paid to the gover-
nor and father-custodian. According to custom he threw
corn meal upon the people and assured them that it was
an emblem of happiness. He ordered the images to be
taken from the church and broken, and divided the vest-
ments between Cnpavo, Catite and other captains, after
taking the lion's share himself. He then made the
inhabitants a speech, in substance aa follows: That in
consequence of having driven the Spaniards away he had
come to accompany them in the chase ; they would *kill
THE CONQUEST 6F KETT ^tEXlCO. 303
many deer, rabbits, and all other animals ; tKey would
have good crops of corn, pumpkins, and large bolls of
cotton ; that they need not fear the Spaniards as he had
thrown up entrenchments on the three roads, and built
strong walls tha^ reached from the earth to the heavens,
and if they should enter by any other road he would
surround them with darkness, and take them without
arma and put them to death.
Having made this speech. Pope took his seat at the
table attended by Alonzo Catite, Louis Cupavo and a
number of others. They drank .wine from the sacred
vessels and toasted him as " Your Worship," to which he
made appropriate responses. The handsomest women of
tlie pueblo were then brought in the room when he
selected the most comely, and gave the others to hi&
captains. During his trip through the country he caused
many persons to beput to death, and conmiitted numerous
«
other outrages.
The Indians wreaked their vengeance upon the poor
priests who fell into their hands with terrible cruelty,
and but few escaped. They looked upon them as the
cause of nearly all their sufferings, and therefore made
them the first objects of their revenge. The fate of the
old priest of Jemez, friar Jesus Morador, was cruel in the
extreme. After the prior and the first alcalde had left
tlie pueblo the Indians went to his cell in the night,
wjiere he was soundly sleeping ignorant of the rebellion.
The first iotimation he had of danger was the crowd of
infuriated savages rushing into his room. They quickly
made him prisoner and stripped him naked; then mounted
him upon the back of a hog, and with lighted torches and
fiendish yells paraded him around the church and through
the village, beating him with sticks and heaping curses
J
S04 THE CONQUEST OP NETT MEXICO.
upon his head. They next compelled liim to get down
Rpon his hands and knees, when they mounted upon his
back and lashed and spurred him through the pueblo imtil
exhausted nature gave way, and he fell dead under the
operation. When Ufe was extinct tliey Jlirew his body
• outside the pueblo to be devoured by wild beasts.
Tliree priests were stationed at Acoma, named Cristo-
val Figeroa, Albino Maldonado, and Juan Mora, whose
fete was nearly as cruel as that of the priest of Jemez.
The Indians stripped them naked, when they tied them
together ^vith a hair rope and paraded them through the
. pueblo in triumph, making a great noise and covering
them with abuse. Figeroa, satisfied that tlicy intended
to put himself and companions to death, told them to
glut tlieir vengeance upon them, but tliat in three years
they would consume each otlier in wai*s. This excited
the fury of the Indians, who immediately fell upon them
with clubs and stones and killed them, when their bodies
were thrown into a deep cave on the North side of the
pueblo.
AAlien the news of the rebellion reached Zuni the
Indians flew to arms and commenced a massacre of all
the Spaniards who fell into their hands. Here were also
stationed three priests, Lorenzo Analiza, Juan do Jesus
Espinosa, and Sebastian" Calsada. The savages entered
their cells and dragged them forth to execution. Seeing
a servant of Analiza standing near, they directed him to
put them to death, and threatened to kill him if he re-
fused. He plead earnestly for their lives, but the Indiaji?
were deaf to all entreaties. They were then stripped
und stoned, and afterward tied upon the ylazix and shot
l>y Analiza's servant. Tlieir bodies were buried in the
7iUage church. The Indians .being now maddened witli
THE CONQUEST OP'NEW ^MEXICO. 305
'Tage, and their revenge being unsatisfied they started for
the distant pueblos of Moqui* Here were stationed two
missionaries, padre Juan de Vallada and friar Jesus de
Lombarde. They were also dragged from their cells in
a cruel and barbarous manner, then tied together and
driven through the streets with shouts of scorn and
derision, and afterward stoned to death. Their dead
bodies were thrown outside the pueblo, as food for the
beasts of the field and birds of the air.
The Procurador of the province left Acoma to proceed
to Zuui while the massacre was taking place, and was
followed by some Indians. The latt^ had sent word to
the Zuuians that he was oij his way to their pueblo, and
as he approached they sallied out to meet him. When
he saw them coming toward him he was convinced they
thirsted for his blood, and that there was no chance of
escaping them. He dismounted from his mule, knelt
down upon the ground with his hands clasped in prayer
and eyes turned toward heaven, in which position he
remaiiied until they came up and put him to death.
They left his body where it fell. In this manner the
priests stationed in the diflerent pueblos were killed, and
mostly by their own flocks, for whose spiritual and tem-
poral good they had been laboring for years.
The ancient records relate, among . other marvelous
things that took place during the rebellion, a wonderful
account of four influential Indians of the pueblo of Cia.
They were implicitly obeyed and much respected by their
fellow villagers and had the credit of performing miracles.
It is stated that one of them coidd make it rain whenever
there was a necessity for the earth to be refreshed with
showers from heaven ; a second had the power to create
^ rabbits, wolves, and all other animals ; the third couki
20
306 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO^
swallow arrows and swords, while the fourth swallowect
rattlesnakes which passed througli him alive without
doing him any injury. The supposed gift of supernatural
power was the cause of the great influence they exercised
over their brethren. These four men were afterward
captured by the Spaniards and executed in camp by order
of Don Pedro Renero de Posada.
After the revolutionary chiefs had concluded their jour-
ney through the provhice they returned to their respective
pueblos. Upon the arrival of Catite at Santo Domingo
lie caused preparations to be made for the celebration of
the cachina dance. It is related that the idols were
vbrought out and the Indians assembled waiting for the
ceremonies to begin, when Catite burst with a report hke
the sound of a gun, and was immediately carried off by
tlie devil. Louis Cupavo was afterward disposed of in the
same manner. Pope had been intrusted with the supreme
<iommand for a long time, when the Indians limited his
power because of tlie numerous outrages he had" com-
mitted, lie was deposed at one time, and th(\ chief
jiutliority was conferred upon Cupavo, but he soon became
dissatisfied and Pope was reinstated.
The Indians had now driven the Spaniards from the
(•ountry and acliieved their independence. They abol-
islied all the social and religious institutions introduced
by tlie Christians, and again relapsed into the darkness
• and superstition of barbarism.
^HE CONQITEST OP NEW MEXICO. 307
CHAPTER XL.
♦GOVERNOR OTERMIN MARCHES FOR THE RE-CONQUEST Ot'
NEW MEXICO.
At the close of the thirty-eighth chapter we left
Governor Otermin, with the troops and colonists of New
Mexico, encamped at San Lorenzo. He remained there
several months awaiting ordere to undertake a re-conquest
of the country ; but it was not until the month of Sep*
tember, of the following year, 1681, that he received
instructions from the earl of Paredes to fit out an expe-
dition for that purpose. He immediately began to equip
his forces, but this was found to be a task of no ordinary
magnitude. It was with great difficulty he could procure
either provisions, ammunition or transportation, and to
complete his outfit he was obliged to ask assistance of the
Franciscan friars at El Paso. They supplied him with
two thousand fanegas of com, two thousand beef-cattle,
besides anmiunition, wagons to transport the baggage and
rations, and other articles the soldiers stood in need of.
There was equal difficulty in arming and equipping the
expedition. The old armor had become almost worthless
i
•308 VBB CO^'QUEST OF KEW MEXICX).
from long usage, and for want of better material hemantr-
factured new armor of ox-hides. There was great scarcit j^
of arms, and some of those he was able to procure were
quite useless. The inhabitants of Santa Fe, byruing
with a desire to revenge themselves upon the Indians for
expelling them from their homes, determined to accom-
pany the expedition, and they enrolled themselves for
that purpose. On the 18th of September they addressed
^i petition to Otermin requesting that their families might
be permitted to remain in the garrison at San Lorenzo,
and be suppUed with provisions during their absence
with the army. They set forth that the nearest point at
which corn could be procured was at the Casas Grandes,
eighty leagues distant, where only two persons planted,
and that not more than two fanegas could be had there.
The prayer of the petitioners was granted.
The ex|Dedition was organized in accordance ^vith the
custom of the Spaniards, and, in addition to the troops
and ordinary army followers, a number of priests accom-
panied it in order to christianize the Indians in case the
country should l)e conqnered. Otermin was tlie general-
iurchief of the little army and Francisco Javier civil and
military secretary. The force consisted of botli cavalrj^
and infantry, with a body of friendly Indians. The num-
ber of men is not given, bnt he marclied wntli nine hundred
and seventy-five horses. The stores and subsistence were
conveyed in wagons drawn by oxen, and on pack mules.
'i'he arrangements being completed the general unfurled
tlio royal banner on the morning of November 5th ; and
amid the sound of trumpets and the shouts of the citizens
who liad assembled to witness their departure the little
army took up its march for New Mexico. They crossed
•to the East side of the Del Norte opposite the town of
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 309
El Paso,i and directed their course to the North along the
bank of that river. The troops marched in good order,
the different divisions keeping in sight of each other, and
about sunset reached a point called Estero Largo in the
vicinity of some large salt marshes. Here they encamped
for the night. From their camp they could see large
smokes rising in different directions, proceeding from
signal fires of the Indians who were watching their move-
ments. They passed a quiet night, and, resuming the
march the next morning, continued on to Robledo, forty
leagues further, which was accomplished without opposi-
tion from the enemy. This point is at the entrance upon
an extensive barren region of country known as IHl Jor-
nadrt del Ifuerto^t the journey of death, where for the ^
distance of ninety miles water is not to be found except
1 A Mexican town, in the state of Chihaahua, situated on the West
bank of the Del Norte, a short distance below our boundary line. It
lies in a fertile valley, and is a place of considerable trade. It was
founded by the Spaniards at an early day.
» This is a stretch of barren country, in the southern part of New
Mexico, the only vegetation being a short dry grass and a few tall
weeds. It stretches from Fray Cristoval on the North to Dofia Ana on
the South, nearly an hundred miles. In the whole distance there is
no running water, and the only reliance is upon what collects in holes
when it rains. El Jornada is properly table land, for it is considerably
elevated above me general level at its two termini, and in shape not
unlike a canoe. Its width varies from five to thirty miles. It is
bounded on each side by a range of mountains, that on the West shut-
ting off the approach to the river. The Rio del Nort^ here makes a
long turn to the West whil ethe road across the desert runs nearly North
and South. It has ever been the dread of travelers, and many an one has
entered upon it never to be heard of again. It was formerly roamed
over by the Mescalaro Apache Indians, who, in iome instances, cut off
entire trains. In the winter season it is visited by terrific storms of
wind and snow, and men and animals are sometimes frozen to death
while attempting to cross it. It has been ^amed the *' Journey of
Death," because of the number of persons killed while crossing It.
310 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
what collects in holes after a rain. Before the troops
entered upon the Jornada some soldiers were sent aliead
to search for water, but were only able to find a limited
supply in holes at a place called Perrilla. Otermin now
made a forced march of two days and one night to Za
Cruz de Onasa within seven leagues of Fray Cristoval,
the northern terminus of the desert. From this place he
sent forward all the soldiers, except a small camp guard,
with the animals to the river. The next day they were
brought back to camp to bring up the wagons and packs,
and about sunset the same afternoon the army, with the
trains, was encamped on the bank of the Del Norte. The
troops were paraded and the priests offered up solemn
thanks to God for the safe passage of the desert.
The next day the march was continued up the river
and at night they pitched the camp at CoQtadero. Here
some trails of the enemy, both horse and foot, were seen,
and the general ordered a squadron of forty soldiers and
some Indians to be detailed the next morning to make a
reconnoissance of the surrounding country ; and particu-
larly to examine the village of Cenecu,3 which was styled
the first pueblo of the kingdom of New Mexico. They
left camp at an early hour, being accompanied by Oter-
min in person, several other officers and ^ some of the
priests. The pueblo of Cenecu was situated upon the
"West bank of the river, which was here crossed by ford-
ing. As they approached they saw several traces of the
enemy, but upon entering tlie village it was found to have
l»cen abandoned. It presented the appearance of having
been attacked by the Indians arid sacked. The church
and convent were* in ruins. The clappers had been taken
from the bells in the church and cemeterv ; and tho
3 A few miles Korth of Pray Cristoval, and i^ now in ruina..
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 311
'Crosses erected in the cemetery and upon the plaza had
been burnt. In the vestry the head and crown of a
crucifix, and some "holy stones" were found lying upon
the ground, having been desecrated by the " Apostate
Apaclies." A small brass cannon, used for the defence
of the church, had been removed and thrown into the
cemetery. The reverend father ordered the crosses fomid
in the houses, the head and crown of the crucifix and all
wooden ornaments of the altar to be collected ancl burnt,
and the consecrated . stones thrown into tlie river, to
prevent them falling into the hands of the Indians. Tho
bells were taken from the steeples and the cannon from
the cemetery and placed in the wagons when tlie pueblo
was set on fire and entirely consumed. The party re-
K'rossed the river the same night and joined the main body
of the army at Contadero.
The next day, the 28th of November, the whole com-
mand marched for the ruins of San Pascual which was
passed, and the camp i:)itclied six leagues beyond. Many
oigns of the enemy were seen, with traces of women and
children, the trails conaing from the interior pueblos.
Six abandoned stock-farms were passed, all of which had
been pillaged. That night Otermin made arrangements
for the march of the army on the following day, and
afterward detailed a party of twenty Spaniards and some
Indians to accompany him upon a reconnoissance of the
i^urrounding country, and on a visit to tlie pueblo of our
lady of Socorro. The troops continued up the river the
next morning while the general and escort crossed over
on their way to Socorro.*
This village stood upon a bluff bank about half a mile
' 4 This pueblo was situated near the present town of Socorro, in the
county of the same name on the West hank of (be Del Nort^
312 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO-
from the river, and had a beautiful and commandiirg--
sitnation. Upon entering the town it was found to have
been abandoned by the inhabitants, and afterward pillaged
by the Indians* The church and convent were burnt and
the clappers removed from the bells. The images, which
had been concealed in a hole in the church at the time of
the rebellion, had been removed and mutilated or de-
stroyed, some being burnt to charcoal and others broken
into pieces. Two human skeletons were found in the
cloister of the convent. The plaza was barricaded by an
adobe wall and palisade, and pieces of broken images and
crosses were scattered over it. The houses had been
sacked. In a field near by were found the heads and
bones of two dead bodies and some articles of clothing.
Tlie pueblo was set on fire and destroyed. Before he
re-crossed the river Otermin, with an escort of twelve sol-
diers, visited a warm spring situated about a league from
the village at the foot of the mountains.s He rejoined the
army the same afternoon. Many of the broken images
and other articles belonging to the church were taken to
the Spanish camp and burnt under the direction of the
priests.
The following day tlie army marched to Las Vueltas del
SocoiTO where it encamped. The road here was found
to be very bad, and the soldiers were obliged to repair it
a The warm spring which Otermin visited in 1G81, is pointed out
near the town of Socorro, and there can bo no question of its identity.
I visited it in the spring of 1854, and bathed in its limpid waters. They
gush out from fissures in the rocks at the base of a mountain ridge, and
after flowing a few yards fall into a pool about a foot and a half deep,
and ten o? fifteen feet in diameter. The temperature is a little warmer
than that of new milk, and pleasant to the person. It is said to pos-
sess medicinal qualities of a character highly beneficial to persons*
attllctcd TCith rheiunalio diseases.
THE. CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICa 313
before the wagons could get along. The only accident
was the upsetting of one wagon. Passing only one night
at this point, the Spaniards marched the next day to
Acomillo, passing through the pueblo of Agua Nueva.
The former village was situated on an open space near
the river, but had beea aibandoned by the inhabitants, and
was partly in ruins. The general completed the work
of destruction. They encamped near the pueblo and
spent an unpleasant night in a severe rain storm.
Continuing the march up the river, over a road very
difficult for wagons, the army reached Sebollita on the
4th of December. Otermin rode in advance to examine
thQ pueblo. He found it deserted and nearly destroyed,
tlie inhabitants, through fear of the Apaches, having
joined the revolutionists in the interior of the country.
Some of the timbers of the church had been used by the
Indians to build an estufa for the worship of idols. Near
the pueblo were several deep holes in which the enemy
had concealed corn, pumpkins and earthen pots. They
were covered with clay made, up into an oval shape on
which was %ured the face of an Indian and the body of
a toad. In the pueblo were found a great many dried
herbs, pulverized, two pieces of human flesh, feathers, and
several other articles used in their idolatrous worship.
Some of these things the Indians esteemed very highly,
and believed tliat by offering them to their Gods their
cora would be preserved.
314 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
CHAPTER XLI.
TllL ARMY REACHES THE PUEBLO OF ISLETA, AVHICH IS TAKEX
AFTER SLIGHT RESISTANCE.
The army marched from SeboUita on the 5th of
December to the Barrancas, where it encamped. From
this place Otermin, with an escort of sixty men, went in
advance the next day as far as the pneblo of Isleta,i He
had sent spies into the mountains to look for smoke or
soHiC other sign that the pueblo was inhabited, who
returned and informed him that they had seen smoke
i.-j-i:inf2: from the chimneys. He arrived within siirht of
the pueblo early in the morning, and immediately formed
his little command to make an attack. He divided it
iiito four divisions, so as to make the assault from as
many points; when, sounding the charge, the Spaniards
rushed to the attack shouting in a loud voice, as they
advanced, praises " to the most holy sacrament." The
1 The pueblo of SeboUita was situated on the East bank of the Del
Norte, about twenty miles above Sorocco, and the Barrancas, near the
present village of Los Lentes, both of which are now in ruins. Isleta,
fitill in existence, is on the West bank tf)f the river, about fifteen miles
South of Albuquerque, and contains not more than three hundred
Indians.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 315
Indians were on the alert, and when thej saw the Span-
iards approaching they raised their war-cry and flew to
arms. They made but a feeble resistance. Seeing the
plaza and quarters already in the possession of the soldiers
before they had time to form for their defence, and also
being assured by the general that they would be put to
death if they did not surrender, they laid down tlieir
arms and submitted.
Otermin, being in possession of the village, made an
examination to see tlie amount of damage that had been
done to it. He found the church and convent burnt, the
crosses thrown down, and the body of the church had
been converted into a corral in which a herd of cattle
was confined. He caused the whole population, men,
women and children, to be assembled upon the plaza,
whom he reprimanded in severe terms. They denied
being guilty of the destruction of the buildings, but laid
it to the charge of the leaders of the rebellion, who had
come down with the Taos, Picoris and Teguas Indians
and burnt the church and everything else pertaining to
Christian worship, and ordered the inhabitants to return
to their heathen rites. The Indians were directed to
deliver up everything belonging to the citizens or the
church; and their dwellings were also searched that
nothing might remain concealed. The articles found
concealed were the box in which the consecrated host
was kept, a belt worn by the priest, five small bells used
in saying mass, four candlesticks, three large bells,
(buried in the church), one missal and two other books,
three horses, a copper kettle, a brass mortar, and other
articles not enumerated. The property of the church
was delivered to father Ayeta, and that of the citizens
to the respective owners. The general ordered crosses
316 THE CONQUEST OF NEW BfEXICO.
to be erected upon the plaza and in the honses, ancf
directed the Indians to wear small ones about the neck.
The priests returned thanks for the successful termination
of the fight
Before Isleta was taken two Indians made their escapf,
who were supposed to have been sent to notify the other
pueblos of the approach of the Spaniards, and advise the
inhabitants to fly. Upon being informed of this, Otermin
dispatched two Sandia runners to the pueblos up the river
to order the Indians, in his name, to remain in their
houses, come to terms, and receive the gospel, or he
would subdue them at the point of the bayonet. During
the attack father Ayeta remained in the rear with the
army, but as soon as he heard tlie village had fallen he
set out for it. As he approached it he was met by the
general and a large procession of men, women and chil-
dren who had come out to receive him. They escorted
him in amid songs of praise, the reverend father himself
singing aloud, "Praise be the most holy sacrament and
the purity of our Lady, the Virgin Mary, conceived
without a stain of sin;" to which the Indians responded,
"Forever." Arrived in the pueblo the inhabitants em-
braced him, after which the Ave Maria was sounded
upon the trumpet, which the Indians repeated three
times in a loud voice, and then quietly retired to their
houses.
At dawn the next morning religious exercises were
held upon the plaza, attended by the governor, captain,
and all the inhabitants of the pueblo. A portable altar,
carried with the^ array, was erected in the middle of the
square, and surrounded by the " most serene Virgin Mary,
San Francisco and San Antonio." Father Ayeta preached
to the Indians through an interpxeter. He admonished
THE C0NQU5:ST OF KEW MEXICO. 317
Jthein to tarn from the patli of apostacy, and again enter
the fold of the church. After the eeniion he gave them
•absolution for past offences in sight of God, and received
them again' into communion. Many children were bap-
tised, the first one receiving the name of Charles, in honor
of the kiog of Spain, and for whom Otermin stood
sponsor. These exercises having been concluded the
general ordered th« royal flag to be raised, which was
unfurled amid shouts of "Long Uve Don Carlos the
Second I" from the soldiery, and loud vivas from the
surrounding Indians. Three rounds of musketry were
then tired, and the trumpets of the army pealed forth
their martial strains in honor of the occasion. The
church-bells, after being purified of the desecration
heaped upon them by the apostate Indians, were rung
in loud and merry peals, when vespers were solemnized,
which closed the ceremonies of the day. In the mean-
time the army and the wagons had come up, and the
whole force was encamped at the pueblo.
The following day was the anniversary of the "Pure
conception of our Lady," when religious exercises were
again held. In the evening an altar was erected on the
plaza and the Indians assembled around it, when High
Mass was celebrated and father Ayeta preached a second
sermon. These concluded, Otermin made an address to
the inhabitants, in which he pointed out the great power
of his master, the king, and explained to them the obe-
dience that was due to him for all the blessinojs he hud
conferred upon them, and the more particularly because
of the care he had of their souls. lie pardoned all in the
name of his royal majesty, and the poor Indians appeared
.pleased with the clemency extended to them.
The same day an Indian, who was charged with being
318 THE COKQCEST OF KEW MtXICD.
a sorcerer and wizzard, and bad come from the paebloS
above to teach siiperEtition and idolatry to. tliose of the
South, was made prisoner. In order to obtain sufficient
evidence to arraign liim, Juan Dominguez de ilendoza, the
lieutenant-general of cavalry, was dispatched ivith seventy
l>icked men and a troop of Indians to make reconnoissance
of tlic pueblos up the river. He was instructed by Oter-
3«in as to tlie course ho should talte until the latter
resumed the march and rejoined him. He was directed
to visit tlie three pueblos of Alameda, Puara and Sandia,
(jf the Tegnas nation, and demand whctlier they intended
to submit to the king and church, or make resistance.
The Indian runners previously sent to these villages had
not yet returned, and it was not known whether the
inhabitants remained at homo or liad deserted to the
rebels.
The army still remained encamped at Isleta. The
general tooli this opportunity to collect a sup]>ly of com,
113 the amount on hand was being rapidly consumed.
Each house was required to furnish one sack, and tlio
whole quantity collected, when shelled, amounted to only
lirtceu fiinegas, a part of whicli was ground for the soldiers.
That year iiad been a season of great scarcity and very
little corn had been raised North of that jilace. A great
dronght prevailed in the country, and, notwithanding the
Avitches hail performed all sorts of incantations to propi-
tiate their gods and induce them to send down rain, not
n drop had fallen for a long time. The failure of the
crop was given as a reason why many of the jjueblos had
been abandoned. The suffering at some of the Northern
pueblos was so great tliat the Indians of the Tanos, Teguas
and Qucres natioi:s had combined with the pueblos of
.Vcoma and Jemez to attack and destroy Isleta in order
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO- 3111
to get the com in store there. When Oterniin arrived
only SIX days were wanting of the time when tliese North-
ern Indians were to have made the attack. His advent
was considered by the inhabitants as so ordered by (lod
to save them and their pueblo from destruction.
A soldier arrived at the camp on the night of the 9th
with dispatches from Mendoza^but they contained nothing
of interest. He brought a few articles belonging to the
church which had been captured from the Indians up the
river, consisting of " a small brass crucifix, an image of our
Lady, a chalice and patena, and the bottom of a silver
lamp without chains." Upon liis request, the crucifi.^
was presented to Otermin, by father Ayeta, as a precious
relic.
The next day the army intended to resume the marclu
The camp was raised and the wagons loaded preparatory
to starting, but a storm of rain, snow and wind set in
with such violence that the general was obliged to post-
pone the march and re-encamp. The same evening an
Indian of the Teguas nation brought information to
Otermin that the inhabitants of the pueblos of Sandia,
Alameda and Puara were in the mountains perishing witli
cold and hunger, and desired permission to return to their
villages. The messenger was treated with kindnes?^, and
<lirected to return and tell the chiefs of these pueblos to
come down and have a talk, and that until some arrange-
ment could be made they must do the best they could.
On the night of the 11th instructions were sent to Men-
doza not to molest these Indians, but treat them well,
and to receive and disarm all who should come in and
give themselves up.
-320 THE COKQUEST OP KEW MEXICO*
CHAPTER XLII.
THE SPANIARDS CONTINUE TUEIR ^lARCH UP THE RIVEH^
AND THE CONDITION IN WUICU THE PUEBLOS WERE
FOUND.
The Spaniards resumed the mareli on the morning of
the 11th. After proceeding about a league and a half
the axle-tree and hounds of the cart which carried the
portable altar broke, and they were obliged to encamp to
repair damages. In the night a furious storm of rain
and sleet came on which continued until the next day,
iuid as the troops were badly sheltered they suiSfered
Hcverel3% They were benumbed and chilled by the
cold, and were not in a condition to continue tlie inarch.
Some of the men vrere hardly able to leave the camp-
fires. Duriner the day the cold increased and the storm
raged with greater fury; snow began to fall and the
neiirhboriu": mountains were covered with it. The
animals were so much broken down by exposure to the
storm and cold that they were not able to proceed. Under
these circumstances Otermin determined to remain in
camp until the storm should abate in order to give the
•wearied men and animals an opportunity to recruit.
TIBffi COKQUEST OF KEW MBXICO. 321
*
While encamped at this place, the general received
letters from Mendoza by the hands of two Indian runners,
which gave an account of his march up the river. On
arriving at the pueblo of Sandia he found it abandoned,
but discovered many articles used in their idolatrous
worship which the inhabitants had left behind in their
flight. Proceeding up the river he reached Alameda on
the 9th, which he also found deserted except by an old
woman who was blind and too feeble to make her escape.
The woman, although a Teguas by birth, had been raised
in a Christian family and spoke Spanish fluently. Upon
being asked why the Indians had abandoned the village,
she replied that it was because of the idolatrous worship
they practiced, and the acts of treachery they had com-
mitted, and for fear the Spaniards would punish them if
they should fall into their hands. They had fled two
days before the arrival of Mendoza. He also found a
man suspended in one of the houses who had hung him-
self for some unknown cause. The old woman was left
in the pueblo with a supply of provisions for her support.
She was instru^^ted to inform her people when they
should return, that unless they made peace and acknowl-
edged the God of the Spaniards, not one stone of their
pueblo would be left upon another, and that they would
be all destroyed.
On the hills near Puara the Indians made signals with
smoke, and a horseman appeared and hailed the Span-
iards, but upon being approached he fled toward Sandia,
and was not seen again. They entered Puara which they
also found abandoned They discovered in it several
articles used in the church service, and a considerable
quantity of corn, beans and salt. Near by the pueblo
stood a cart loaded with wood, from which the Indians
SI
M
322 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO-
had taken the oxen and fled upon the first intimation of
Mendoza's approach. He now returned to Alameda.
Here he found other articles of church property which had
been secreted at the time of the rebellion, besides a
further supply of beans, com and wild turkeys. In this
neighborhood the meadows were yet green, and the com
fields filled with fodder, and wood was abundant upon the
opposite side of the river. From this point Mendoza
wrote Otermin and advised that he should establish a
camp, between this pueblo and Puara, to allow the animale
time to recruit upon the fine pasture that was to be had
there, and recommended that a pai*ty of men should be
sent forward to secure the fodder then in the fields. This
letter concludes in the following manner, wliich exliibits the
estimation in which the priesthood was held in those
times: "The reverend preacher, father Lagosa is, in
every particular, acting like an angel to my reverend
missionary fray Francisco Ayeta whose hand I kiss and
repeat my supplication in the name of father San Antonio
to commend me to God."
Otermin moved from liis last camp on the 13th, to join
ilendoza. The day was exceedingly cold, with a strong
wind and severe hail storm prevailing. Ruin and deso-
lation marked the line of march ; the farms had been hiid
wast€ and the buildings destroyed. The grain had been
taken from the fields but the fodder was left standing.
The march was conducted with great care ; scouts were
thrown out in advance, and every other necessary prccau-
tton taken to prevent a surprise. One night a party of
Indians made an attack upon the camp and attempted to
run off tlie animals, W'hich, had they succeeded, would
have left the Spaniards almost at the mercy of the
enemy. Some soldiers and friendly Indians sallied out
tHE CONQUEST OF N£W MEXICO. 323
Jn defence of the animak, and succeeded in repulsing the
assailants.
While the troops were in march the general took a
small escort and rode in advance to Alameda. He saw
no Indians on the road, but found the buildifigs destroyed
and the farms laid waste. He expected to find some of
the inhabitants waiting here to hold a talk with him, but
none had come down from the mountains whither they
had fled upon hearing of the approach of the Spaniards.
He had sent them word to meet him at this place, but
fear kept them away. The pueblo was searched, and in
it were found many articles used in their idolatrous wor-
ship, such as a figure of the devil, herbs and feathers.
An estufa had also been erected. These things were all
destroyed by order of Otermin and father Ayeta. A
considerable quantity of corn and beans Was found, and
what the animals did not consume was burnt. The old
blind woman was still there, not being able to join her
people, and the body of the dead man was hanging as
Mendoza had left it. The pueblo was set on fire and
completely destroyed. The army did not reach Alameda
until late at night, and as there was no shelter for the
troops they were obliged to bivouac in the open air.
They had marched part of the day through a rain storm,
and were drenched to the skin and shivering with cold.
The Spaniards remained encamped at this place three
days, during which time they suffered a good deal from
the inclemency of the weather. The second night a
severe storm came on, and the following morning the face
of the whole country was covered with snow. The storm
Still continued ^vith great violence, and the weather was
cold, and the snow deep. The general was greatly afflicted
with sore eyes and hardly in a condition to march, but he
A
324 I«E CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICa
determined to proceed, sa lie stood in fear of a surprise ff
he remained here. He was also apprehensive that the
river would freeze over, in wliich case it could only be
crossed at great risk.
Under these circumstances the march was resumed on
the 16th, in a storm. They crossed to the East bank <rf
the river with some difficulty, as there was no ford at this
place, but they got over with no other mishap than one
oi' the wagons and the cart with the altar miring down.
The whole command being safely across, the general, with
a squadron of cavalry, marched in advance as far as the
pueblo of Puara, about a league distant, which was found
abandoned. Many trails werq seen leading from the
mountains, supposed to have been made by the Indians
who had come down for com* The beans and corn
found in the pueblo were collected and consumed to pre-
vent them faUing into the hands of the enemy. This
occupied the greater part of the day, and at evening
Otermin returned down the river and joined the main
body of the army.
The storm had now abated and the weather was clear
again. The army being encamped only two leagues from
Sandiii, the general took an escort of twenty soldiers and
some friendly Indians and mai'ched in advance to that
place. When the Indians heard of his approach they set
lire to the pueblo and fled, but he arrived so soon after-
ward that the lire had not spread beyond the church and
chapel. The Indians liad destroyed or injured everything
connected with Christian worship ; the church bells had
been broken into several pieces, and the images of the
saints disfigured. The church ornaments had been con-
cealed in the houses. Two estufas had been erected in
<the pueblo, in \vhich were found the articles used in the
THE CONQUEST OP KEW MEXICO. 325
eelebration of their heathen rites. The soldiers collected
everytliiuff belonging to the church and as much com as
they could carry away, when they fired the houses which
were entirely consumed. The day was thus spent in the
work of destruction^ and at night Otermin again returned
to the main body of the troops at their place of en-
campment.
The troops having undergone great fatigue of late, and
both men and animals being much broken down, the
general remained in camp a few days ta give them time
to recruit. Fresh meat was issued, and other necessary
means taken to place them in the most serviceable condi-
tion for a further advance into the enemy's country. In
the meantime a squadron of cavalry was dispatched to
scour the surrounding country, with instructions to bring
in some of the Indians dead or alive. While Otermin
remained at this place Mendoza returned to camp, bring-
ing in three Indians and two half-breeds, prisoners. The
former had been captured, but the latter came down from
the mountains and voluntarily surrendered themselves.
The half-breeds said they had been impressed during the
rebellion and compelled to join the rebels. They reported
a large number of Indians in the mountains composed of
all the nations in the province, among whom were the
leading warriors of the pueblo of Cochiti, active men in
the rebellion, and tliat the pueblos were deserted.
Otermin desiring to gain information as to the cause of
the rebellion the previous year, now proceeded to organize
a tribunal for the examination of the prisoners. He pre-
sided as the examining court, assisted by the reverend
father Ayeta, " commissioner of the holy order, attorney-
general of both the canon and civil laws." Two soldiers,
named Juan Lucero de Godoy and Juan Ruiz de Casares*
326 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICOw
who understood the Indian tongue, were sworn as inter-
preters. The prisoners were then brought before the
tribunal; but as they were heathens and could not be
sworn until they had been first absolved, the rites of
absolution were administered, when they took the oath
and were examined in due form. As the result of this
examination has been properly noticed in that part of
the volume which treats of the breaking out of the
rebellion, there is no necessity of my repeating it here.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 327
CHAPTER XLIII.
^lENDOZA MAKES A RECONNOISSANCE UP THE RIVER TO
COCHITI, AND WHAT TOOK PLACE THERE; THE ARMY
RETURNS TO EL PASO,
We will now leave the main body of the Spaniards
•encamped near Sandia, and follow Mendoza in hie
march up the river. It will be borne in mind that he
was ordered by Otermin, soon after the captftre of Isleta,
to take a proper escort and make a reconnoissance of the
pueblos further to the North. From Sandia he sent
back runners with information that he had reached the
pueblo of Puara, but no particular account of his expedi-
tion was received until he returned and reported it in
person.
He took up the march from the camp of Otermin
about vespers and proceeded that day to his own farm,
three leagues below Alameda, where he encamped. He
remained there a few hours to give his men time to warm
and refresh themselves, when he resumed the march for
Alameda, which he entered the next morning about dawn.
The condition in which the pueblo was found has already
been mentioned in the last chapter. Thence he continued
to Puara. As he drew near the pueblo smoke was seen
issuing fi'om the cliimneys, a sure sign that it was inhab-
328 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
ited, bat before he could prevent it the inhabitants hajtf
set fire to the houses and abandoned it. Several articles
belonging to the church were found here, and some,
things used by the Indians in their worship, among
which was a mask in the shape of the devil. From this
place he marched to Sandia, which was also found aban-
doned. The church and convent were both in ruins.
The chapel of San Antonio was in good condition, the
Indians having apparently preserved it to use in cele-
brating their heathen rites. Three cells of the convent
had not been injured, one of which had been converted
into a blacksmith shop. The only person in the pueblo
was an old blind man, who was duly confessed and
absolved by one of the priests.
Mendoza continued his march further up the river to
San Felipe, which was also abandoned, the inhabitants,
having gon% to Cochiti. The roof was oif the church
and the convent demolished. He found several articles
6f church property concealed in the houses, such as an
incensory, the box for the consecrated wafers, and pieces
of broken crosses ; besides many things belonging to the
idolatrous worship of the Indians. In the middle of the
plaza were piles of stones, around which they had wor-
shipped. The church-bell was found lying upon the river
bank with a hole broken in it. Thence he marched
to Santo Domingo,! where he likewise found the church
and convent in ruins. Near the convent was a large
pile of stones where the Indians made offerings to the
devil, and celebrated other rites of idolatry. The houses
were searched, and in them were found considerable
1 This pueblo is situated upon the bank of the Del Nort^, a few miles
above San Felipe, and differs in no essential particular from the othex?
pueblos, described. .
THE CON<}UBST OF NEW MEXICO. 329.
property belonging to the Spaniards. In the houses
of Catite and Zepatero were discovered the writing-desks
of the priests, and other articles of church property.
He next marched to the pueblo of Cochiti, a few
leagues higher up the river. He passed several pieces
of broken crosses and two large copper kettles upon tho
road. On arriving in the vicinity of the pueblo he sent
a party of soldiers forward to reconnoitre, which returned
in a short time and reported the village deserted. la
the meantime the Indians made their appearance upon a
hill near by, and challenged the Spaniards to combat;
but, as it was then nearly dark, Mendoza declined en-
gaging with them. He now marched his command up to
the pueblo, where he found an abundance of provisions
and secure quarters for both men and animals. Fearing
an attack in the night, a strong guard was stationed
around the village, the horses were kept saddled, and the
men forbidden to leave the main plaSa.
Early the next morning Mendoza made the proper
disposition of his forces to give battle to the enemy.
Before leaving the pueblo they were drawn up in front
of the priest, who absolved and blessed them, and ad-
monished them to cleanse tlieir hearts of sin before
engaging in deadly strife. The Indians, meanwhile, had
assembled about a league from the pueblo upon a hill
where they had thrown up a slight breastwork. The
Spaniards advanced toward them, and when they drew
nigh the enemy raised their war-cry and made prepara-
tions to begin the attack. " To avoid the shedding of blood
Mendoza stepped forward and sounded a parley. He told
them that the king, tlieir master^ had pardoned them for
past oflfences. Catite now approached and inquired of
Mendoza wLy the Spaniards had come there.; to which.
330 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
he replied that they had come in search of him and other
Indians in order to save their sonls. The chief admitted
that he had done much harm, but declined to make peace.
The priest next besought the Indians to turn from their
apostacy and sabmit to the will of the church. While this
proceeding was going on, the war-cry was again sounded,
but Catite commanded his followers to be silent, and they
obeyed. After a good deal of time spent in parleying, the
Indians promised to make peace and return to the church,
when the oflScers and chiefs embraced each other in ap-
parent friendship.
That night the Indians received large reinforcements
from various quarters, and they now numbered about one
thousand warriors, of whom more than a hundred were
mounted. The next morning they approached the Span-
iard^ formed in a half circle, with the intention of
surrounding them. They advanced shouting their war-
cry with every indication of making an attack. Mendoza
made proper disposition to receive them, and was upon
tlie point of beginning the fight, when Antonio Guerra,
through an interpreter, sounded a parley in the Queres
language and stopped the shedding of blood. A brother
of Catite, a war-chief among the rebels, now came forward
and announced that the Indians were prepared for peace.
The priest exhorted them to lay down their arms and
return to their duty to the king and the church and
become good Christians and peaceful citizens. To this
Catite responded in person, and asked in the name of
"God, the holy Mary and all the saints," that peace might
be granted them; which was done accordingly. The
treaty, on the part of the Indians, was ratified by the
chief kissing the foot of the priest, and shedding tears,
when peace was announced as concluded. The Indians
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 331
assembled upon the occasion belonged, principally, to the
Teguas, Tanos, and Queres nations.
Catite asked that a day and a half might be granted
him to bring in the Indians of the pueblos of Cochiti,
Santo Domingo, and San Felipe, promising to return at
the end of that time. He said the .Indians had nothing
to fear in returning, as they had not caused the rebellion,
which was the work of the Spaniards. The other chiefs
also requested permission to inform their respective
pueblos of the treaty that had been made. Time and
permission were accordingly given, when the Indians
took their departttre, except one chief, and two casiques,
one of the Teguas nation and the other of the pueblo of
Cia, who had been selected to remain with Mendoza.
The next day Mendoza sent a friendly Indian, named
Tano, to notify the six nations to come in and arrange
the terms of a permanent peace. He carried a letter to
the cacicfae of Cia, and was also charged to cause crosses
to be erected in the houses of the people of that nation,
and along the road, in place of those torn down. It was
now time for the return of Catite and the other chiefs,
but as they did not appear Mendoza was well convinced
tiiat their professions of peace were feigned and not reaL
When the Indians made terms with the Spaniards it was
snowing hard, and their bow-strings were wet and un-
serviceable, and they were quite in the power of the
soldiers; and their submission was only a ruse to gain
time in order to extricate themselves. Mendoza remained
at Cochiti three days longer, to afford the Indians ample
time to fulfil their promise in case they were disposed to
do so. In the meantime an Indian from the pueblo of
Cia, named Pupiste, came to the Spanish camp with a
cross around bis neck, ^s the representative of that pueblo
332 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO^
and Santa Ana, and reported the people of these two*
villages as willing to submit and make peace. About the-
same time a Teguas Indian was sent to the pueblos of
Sandia, Puara and Alameda, with directions to invite the
people of his nation to appear at the camp of Otermin at
the same time the other Indians were to present them-
selves.
Mendoza, now satisfied that the hostile chiefs did not
intend to return, took up the march from Cochiti to rejoin
Otermin. The first day he encamped near the pueblo of
San Fehpe. In the night two Indian spies came into
camp, who, upon being made prisonere and questioned,
confessed the object of their visit. They informed
• Mendoza that the main body of the IndiaYis had followed
him for the purpose of making an attack and running oS
his animals, and that they were then in San Felipe
waiting for an opportunity to put their plan into execu-
tion. One of the spies had formerly been a servant of
Francisco Javier, who said that his friendship for the
Spaniards induced hira to make the confession. The-
Indians were under the command of one Louis of Picoris
who had invited Catite to assist him. Upon receiving
this information, Mendoza determined to anticipate the
Indians and make an attack upon them in San Felipe ;
but upon laying the matter before a council of war, the
oflicers decided against it, and they resolved only to stand
upon the defensive. The enemy made no attack and the
night passed away in quietness in the Spanish camp. The
next morning the march was resumed, and in due season
the lieutenant-general rejoined Otermin j^fter an absence
of eleven days.
We took our leave of the general and the main body
of the army at the close of the kst chapter^while in camp
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXiCa 38S
;J08t below the pueblo of Sandia. He remained there from
the 16th to the 22d of December, occupied, principally, in
investigating the cause of the rebellion, but meanwhile
he gained other important information. The first In-
dian examined was a native of Tezuque, named Juan,
who made known a plan the Indians had formed to cut
off the detachment of MendoEa, and which they were only
prevented carrying into effect by the watchfulness of the
Spaniards. The attack was to have been made the same
night this Indian came in and surrendered himself, and
being thus put on their guard they remained under arms
aU night The plan had been arranged by Catite, and
was as follows : The young women of the pueblo of La
Cienegiai were to wash and dress themselves in their most
comely attire, and go to the Spanish camp. While the
soldiers were seduced from their duty, and in dalliance
with the Indian maidens, the Teguas and Picoriss warriors
were to drive off the animals, and those of the Queres
and other pueblos were to attack the camp and put the
Spaniards to death. The excuse the girls were to give
for entering the camp, was, that they came to bring dinner
to the soldiers. Catite himself was to go to the camp
and hold a talk -with the Spaniards, and when he should
give the war-cry his confederates were to rush to the
attack. The arrangement was made, in council when the
Indians first heard of the approach of Mendoza, and in all
probability the timely warning of Juan, the Tezuque
Indian, saved them from destruction. Another prisoner
s Sometimes spelled Cieneguilla.
3 Situated in Taos county, a few miles East of the Del Nort^, among
the mountains. It is a little village, and the inhabitants have inter-
married with the Jicarilla Apaches. The population is small and
bears a bad reputation.
.^ » ■»*if
:l N',:"est of xett jiexico.
-. "l.v I:::::iii srirls wash and dre53
■ ■--: ::. :irA tliev were only deterred
^' I :■->".: liiiip by seeing a party of
"-tt::::: '..:\d changed his camp. Tlie
-. . -.5' ::-.:;r'i exiH>scd to the cold, and
^r-. ..: . :e?.l in ronsequence. Pasture
^: :.:.::rcly failed, and the soldier?
. ■'.:: .? '.v.'^'J a league at gi-eat risk of
. ".V. ::;-.!is. For these reasons lie
.. '../.v-ijrula of Louis de Carravajal
. ../ *.\ :;nd a much more favoral)lc
-. :• r.cd :i council of war to deter-
['Ursued, which assemlded at
. 1. •. - ." vr. Each officer was requested
-^ : writinir, aud there was *rreat
V ::;e were in favor of advanciug
. -^ ailvised an innnediate retreat.
- v-.inniended that the army fall
-, lU wliich had asked for protec-r
- -v^uosted to take a seat in the
V ■., bur gave his opim'on at sonic
• m::s received with great con-
^ ■;,-.: tlie expedition should he
.i:./: the army return to San
>^ ^ :1;:U the Indians were not
..-. r*..l tlie force was too small t(»
■,v: it was near mid-winter and
• .v^-; that the men from lonir
. ■.. -..^ do duty, and the horses and
v. !: broken down to proceetl.
::< irv: instance, to fall back upon
V
THE CONQUEST OP KEW MEXICO. 335
Isleta. The inarch of the troops was hastened by the
arrival of a messenger from that place with information
that a party of fifty mounted Indians, headed by Louis
Tupata, had appeared before the pueblo and threatened
to burn it unless abandoned by the inhabitants. The
general immediately sent sergeant-major Louis Granillo
with twenty soldiers to protect the place until his arrival,
and the same day lie followed with the army. He marched
Avith great caution, scouring the country with scouts as
he advanced.
Upon his arrival at Isleta jOtermin determined to con-
tinue on to El Paso, and he remained at the pueblo only
long enotigli to recruit the men and animals, collect pro-
visions and make other necessary preparations for the
march. In examining into the condition of the animals
it appeared that of the whole number of nine hundred and
seventy-five horses, with which he had left San Lorenzo
in November, eight hundred and fifty were still alive, of
which only one hundred and thirty-six were fit for service.
When the Spaniards had ttl-st entered Isleta it contained
a population of more than five hundred, but at the time
of their return there were but three hundred and eighty-
five of all ages, the remainder having joined the rebels
and returned to their idolatrous worship. The inhabit-
ants remaining determined to accompany the army; and
after they had taken out their goods, and provisions for
the march, the pueblo was set on fire and burnt, with
over a thousand fanegas* of corn and a large quantity of
beans. The troops left Isleta on the 2d of January,
1682, and arrived at El Paso on the 11th of February,
having lost nearly one-fourth of the animals upon the
march. •
-'"'■• - -J
4 About twenty-two kundred bushels*
M
338 IBECXJNQUEST OP NEW MEXICO
CHAPTER XLIV.i
DON DJEGO DE VAKGAS SUCCEEDS OTERMIN AND MARCHES
FOK THE EE-CON QUEST OF NEW ^lEXICO ; HIS EXPEDI-
TION TO TAOS.
Sea'ERAL years elapsed, after the failure of Otermin to
subdue the rebellious inhabitants and to re-conquer New
1 1 found among the old archives, in the secretary's office, at Santa
Fc, evidence that an effort was made, after the failure of Otermin, and
before Vargas, to re-conquer New ^lexico. An expedition was in-
trusted to one Domingo Jironza PetrS de Cruzate, who was appointed
captain-general of the province. lie must have entered the country
at two different periods, from the records in my possession. In 1688
the viceroy of New Spain, Don Gaspar de Suniga, count of Monterey,
sent Cruzate into New Mexico in command of an expedition, and
among others he was accompanied by Don Renero de Pasada, anc*
Juan de Ofiate, a brave soldier. Oftate took with him seventy Fran-
ciscan friars, among whom was one Marcos de Niza, a native of the
province. The latter said he had made a visit to Zufii, called the
IJuffalo province, during the reign of Philip II. At the first arrival of
himself and people in New Mexico, the inhabitants were much sur-
prised, being astonished at seeing white men, and at first believcil
them to be Gods, and reported them as such. After the surprise had
worn ofl*, a cruel war broke out, the governor and most of the priests
being killed, a few only escaping to the pueblo of El Paso. Among
those who escaped was a Franciscan friar, who went to Mexico and
carried with him an imacre of our Lady of Macana, which was. pre-
served for a long time in the convent of that city.
5?HE tX)NQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 387
i!Mexico, before another attempt of the kind was mad«.
Meanwhile the Indians remained in undisturbed posses-
sion of the country, and were fast relapsing into their
barbarous manners and customs. The vice-regal gov-
ernment of Mexico now determined to send another
expedition into the coimtry, and in 1692 the count
<jralvas, the viceroy, by and with the advice and consent of
Cruzate was in New Mexico as early as the 2Gth of November, lG8r>,
at which time he was in the pueblo of San Antonio of Sinolu, [svp-
I)08ed to be the same as Cenecu,] on a visit to the civilized Indians.
Upon this occasion the Indians were assembled in the plaza, where he
held a talk with them, and among other things he communicated to
them the following as the orders of the king, their master : *^ That they
should respect and venerate th« churches, and attend Mass punctually
every Sunday and feast day ; that the governors, captains and fisculs
should pay particular attention in seeing that no person failed to do so,
and not to permit idolatrous danoes and other abases in >the pueblos ;
to see that all married men are faithful to their wives, and to prevent
them living separately as they are accustomed to do ; and for the pre-
servation of health they should sleep in the second btory, and all the
men, women and children should keep on their necks their crosses and
rosaries, and all should have crosses .placed over the doors of their
houses. Every head of a famUy should keep ten hens and one chicken
cock of Castile, and if possible should raise turkeys for the support of
their families. They should treat the 'ministers of the gospel with love
and friendship, and observe the greatest respect toward them; and
whenever they meet them they should kiss the hem of their habit with
submission and veneration. The children of both sexes should be
made to say their prayers every pight in their houses before retiring to
rest. All the natives able to bear arms shall keep their bows in good
order, and have ready, at least, ten arrows each to defend themselves
with, and also to offend the enemy ; and none shall dare use the arms
of the Spaniards, for the reason that they are prohibited from usinu:
them by royal ordinances."
I have only been able to obtain a fragment of the journal of Cruzate,
and cannot learn from it the result of his expedition ; but conclude he
failed to reduce the Indians to subjection, as this work was afterward
intrusted to Vargas. The records at Santa Fe state that he was
•captain-general m the years 1684, 1G85, 1C88 and lG8a.
22
338 THE CONQUEST OF NEW ICEXICO.
the royal andience, appointed Don Diego de Vargas Zapats
Lujan to the command, with the rank of governor and
captain-general. He immediately entered upon the dis-
charge of his new duties. Relinquishing the pleasures
and pursuits of liome, he set out for El Paso del Norti,
the place at which he was to organize his command,
where he arrived some time in the summer of the same
year. All the available troops at this jwst were placed
at his disposal, and every other assistance was rendered
him. His force consisted of two hundred mounted Span-
iards, and less than half that number of friendly Indians;
with which he took up the lino of march for the North
on the 31st of August. He was accompanied by sev^eral
priests, who were charged Vitli the re-conversion of
those who had fallen from the true faith. He appears to
have been impressed with the inadequacy of the force
given him for the re-conquest of the country, and before
he marched from El Paso he wrote the viceroy for a
reinlbrcemeiit of fifty soldiers, who were to be sent for-
ward by the lieutenant-governor, in charge of an officer
who remained behind for that purpose.
\^u-gas was sensible of the difficulties and dangers to
be encountered with the small force under his command.
In a letter written to the viceroy, on the eve of marching,
lie says : " 1 determined to risk life and all in the attempt,
and prepared rather to be considered rash, to being looked
upon as a man of too much caution, thereby exposing my
reputation to remarks." lie and his little band of gal-
lant followers pursued their hazardous march up the
valley of the Del Norte, through a country swarming
with a numerous and incensed enemy. We have no
record of the march until they arrived in the vicinity of
Santa Fe, on the 12th of September.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 339
The Indians had received notice of tlie march of the
Spaniards, and, from time to time, their runners reported
their progress. When they came within striking distance
of Santa Fe, and it was known that that was to be the
point of attack, the inhabitants of the surrounding pueblos
turned out to assist their brethren to repel the assault.
The Indians were seen coming in great numbers across the
different mesas and down the sides of the mountain into
the valley. Vargas now determined, if possible, to pre-
vent these reinforcements uniting with the garrison of the
town ; for which purpose he sent nearly all his force
against the former, retaining only a suflScient number to
hold the latter in check in case* they should make a sortie
against him. The enemy, however, effected a junction
of their forces in spite of the pains taken to prevent it ;
and the movement, intended to compass the defeat of the
Indians, well nigh led to the destruction of the Spaniards.
The enemy, seeing the Spanish forces thus divided, sallied
out to the attack with their united strength, on the IStli
of September, at four o'clock in the morning. The action
lasted nearly all day, and it was not until three o'clock in
the afternoon that the Indians began to give way. Both
sides fought with great determination and bravery, and
the Indians exhibited the most bitter hatred of the
Christians. In the midst of the fight they taunted them
with having run away from them before, but said they
would not escape this time. Vargas greatly distinguished
himself in the action, and when the occasion required he
would ride far ahead of his troops to reconnoitre the
enemy and the country. The Spaniards marched into
4md took possession of the town the same evening, and
the troops, wearied with their arduous march and the
fatigue of battle, found comfortable quarters for a season
IM ^2r .-'jyviCEST OF 5ZV XEXTOT.
: 2Tr ico.'ie Lwi^ilTngs- ji thu enemT. The nmubel' of
;r ^le«i. Old -Trmmit^i ii? n.i:z ziven, but from the lengtli
. **-::itr u:t urrioa jkiteiL and rLe braverj' with which the
-2u:iii!& :oii:rir* ^e jl>»=& :n.usZ have been heaw.
'•V'lii -iie niil :i Sinna Fe the pueblos in the vicinity,
•vfi're 'Ji 3ani'?er. ziauie ?iibniL»ion, and were visited and
"akta p«:*5tieaei<3CL •:■:" in the namtr of the king of Spain. As
vai :iie enstom iz. rhc^e davs with Spanisli conquerors^
ill .ver tiie w..>rli as 54»a as the pueblos had been
rr-UiT-it to military subjngaj^on, they were delivered over
"0 'i^.t I'ioii* -eal of the priests for the purpose of heiffg
>-.::v*': t.^ si'irtrjal v>bedience. There were baptised, be-
^ .-t^ I'A .>il irvz who had l>een bom and lived during
V. -^xVA :-:, seven huudre^l and sixty-nine persons^ all of
. 'V r- , ^^ re nxvlved into the bosom of the church.
• >-i,v. Ssatai Ke Varjpis wrote the viceroy an account
.^w ::*,v:v.re of the toi^Ti, and reduction of the neiffh-
» • u '"-^-5^ Frv^ru this letter we are informed of the
. - ;* r:i:v.!I:es and soMiors ne<:*essarv to hold the
. > ndl as i:;e diniculty to be anticipateil in
^ ■ :c Iv.v:-a::> to a condition of peace. lie says :
»1m- :o ::oM rhese pri.>vinces it is necessarj' to
^ar!'«s<>r.s ::i them, and to attempt to send less
iviMviiwl tlimilios and a liundred soldiers, would
^»«N* •»- a cnvin ot' salt into the sea. This
..I 'v *iavi y^.HUUing with one hundred families
:; :»'l l^w^» del Kio del Xorte, and lift v soldiers in
.^, ...-.<* ,kiui wV.ioh may l>e added to the number
.\K^ii^uv\N a.nd the Royal Junta may procure.
.-.s liu'v can never be reduced, for it would be
.,.^,v . o coiixerc the Jews without the inquisition,
^;i.vx* riic bidians to leave their country and
. ..vUi/' He recommended that blacksmiths,
'^•^
V-
■■. V
«\ X
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 341
carpenters and miners should be sent from the jails of
Qneretero, Zacatecas and Rosario, and that the families
should come from Paso del Norte, as being the best
adapted to the country. He further states that he was
then preparing to march against some of tlie adjoining
provinces, and that he would induce them to embrace
" Our Holy Faith," or raze their villages to the ground,
and, as he terms it, " thus punish their obstinacy." After
these people shall have been reduced, he says that he will
declare war upon the Queres and Jemez nations and then
make a visit into the country of the Zuiii and Moqui
Indians to see how they stand affected toward the
Spaniards.
Having established order in Santa Fc and the sur-
roimding pueblos, Vargas made preparations to subdue
some of the more distant villages, in accordance with the
plan he had marked out. The Indians of the Taos
pueblo, who dwelt in a beautiful and fertile valley some
seventy-five miles to tlie North, continued to be very
hostile toward their brethren who were disposed to'
acknowledge the authority of the Spaniards,- and Vargas
had been requested by the Tanos, Teguas and some of
the Picoris Indians, to exterminate tliem. Ho marched
for that pueblo on the 5th of October, leaving a sufficient
garrison in Santa Fe to defend the town in his absence.
He reached San Juan the same afternoon, eight leagues
distant, and on his approach to the village he was met by
a large body of warriors under the command of Don Lo-
renzo, their war-captain. The Spaniards were formed in
line in martial array, with the royal ensign flying, and the
Indians were received with the usual military honors.
He explained to them that the object of his coming was
to re-establish the authority of his master, the king of
342 THE CONQUEST OF NEW HEXICO.
Spain, and that he was accompanied by priests who wonid
absolve them of the great sin they had committed in
abandoning the Catholic religion. They were ordered to
erect crosses in the pueblos as emblems of submissioii*
During the day father Francisco Correra baptised eighty-
six persons of all ages and both sexes, the captain-general
standing godfather for a daughter of Captain Lorenzo^
and several other children. The Indians made professions
of peace, and appeared entirely friendly.
The next morning the Spaniards resumed the march
in a storm of rain and snow. They encamped that night
at the foot of the mountailis, which they crossed the next
day without accident, and descended into the valley of
Taos. The march was conducted with great caution to
prevent their approach being discovered by the enemy^
but when fairly down in the valley they advanced rapidly,
the governor leading them in a gallop. When within
about four leagues of the pueblo they halted and made
the necessary arrangements for the attack. It was ordered
that the squadron of El Paso should surround one of the
two large buildings of which the pueblo consisted, while
the balance of the forces, with the exception of the reserve
under the command of the general in person, whicli was-
te act as the emergency might require, surrounded the
other. This disposition having been made, father Corvera
administered absolution to the command, when they again
took up the line of march. Upon reaching the pueble
they assaulted the two buildings which they secured, with
the entrenchments and all the defences, but found them
deserted, and not an enemy was to be seen.»
1 The pueblo of Taos is situated in the valley of the Del Nort^, about
seventy five miles to the North of Santa F(^, and is the best sample
extant of the ancient villages. It consists of two large adobe boildinga^
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO, 343
Looking toward the East smoke was setn ascending
amoDg the mountaiiis, which was supposed to proceed
from the Indian encampment. The general dispatched
Louis, a Picoria Lidian, with his brother and people to
ascertain the cause of the smoke, intending to follow him-
self, with the troops, as soon as the animals came up and
he could obtain a change of horses. In the course of an
hour, one of the scouts returned with information that the
smoke was caused by the Taos Indians, who were en-
camped in the gorge of the mountains, and had sentinels
posted, upon some of the highest peaks. 'Upon receiving
this intelligence Vargas immediately marched for the
mountains without waiting for the fresh horses. As he
approached one of the rebels came forward and hailed
him in Spanish, and in reply as to whom he was, he said
he was called the Spaniard. The governor held a parley
with him, and reproved him because he and his people
had deserted their villages and fled to the mountains.
The Indian was directed to communicate with his brethren
in the name of the captain-general, and was instructed to
t)etween three and four hundred feet in length, and about an hundred
and fifty wide at the base, situated upon opposite sides of a small creek.
They are five or six stories high, each story receding from the one
telow it, and thus forming a terraced structure from top to bottom.
!Each story is divided into numerous little compartments, the outer
tiers of rooms being fighted by small windows in the sides, while those
in the interior of the building are dark, and are principally used for
store-rooms. The only means of entrance is through a trapdoor in
the roofi and you ascend, from story to story, by ladders upon the
outside, which are drawn up at night, and the population sleep secure
from attack from without. In these two buildings there live some
•eight hundred persons as one large family. A little way removed is
the eatufay built partly under ground, and which is used both as a
council-chamber and a place where they practice such of their heathen
rites as still exist among them. It is esteemed a consecrated place,
And revered as such.
:^m
344 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
give assurante that he was authorized by the king or
Spain to pardon them it* they would come down and
return to their pueblo. He ako bade him say that the
Holy Virgin was upon the flag, and the reverend father
who was with them would bring them back again to
Christianity. He returned with these peaceful messages
to the rebel camp, and that his \yords might have more
efiect, a rosary was suspended around his neck.
Shortly after this messenger had left, six other Indians
approached around a point of the mountain. As they
drew near they laid down their arms in token of peace,
when Vargas dismounted and embraced and gave them
liis hand. They appejired rejoiced with this friendly
salutation. Two of their number were dispatched to<
liring down their people ; and they had not been absent
a great wliile, when a large number of Indians were seen
approaching with the eliief, Francisco Pacheco, at their
head. Vargas received them kindly, and explained to
them the object of his visit. He desired them to return
to tlieir houses and live peaceably, promising that they
should not be molested by j;he soldiers ; and accordingly
most of them proceeded to tlie pueblo, a few only remain-
ing in the mountains to take care of their property. The
difficulty, between the inhabitants of Taos and the Teguas,
Tanos and Picoris Indians was also amicably adjusted,
and they embraced cadi other, and expressed great
pleasure at being friends again. Tow^ard evening the
remainder of the Indians, with the women and children,
came down to the })ueblo, and saluted the Spaniards-
by shouting in a loud voice, "Blessed be the Almighty!"
The next morning the troops and Indians were assembled
i n the plaza, when Vargas explained to them more fully
the reason of his coming among them, and impressed
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 345'
upon them the duty of obedience to the king and priests.
They were absolved of the sin of apostacy, and ninety-sLx,
of all ages and both sexes, were baptised and received"
mto the church. The same afternoon two of the young
men of the Taos pueblo returned from the province of
Zniii with information of a conspiracy among the Moquis,
Jemez, Queres, Pecos, Faraon Apaches and the Coninas
Indians, against the Spaniards. They had attended a
large council of these Indians on the road, and were
made acquainted with their plans. The rebels were to
waylay the Spaniards, in large numbers, as they were
marching through the country, run off their animals, and,
if possible, put the soldiers to death ; and they were col-
lecting their provisions and making other necessary
arrangements to carry their plans into execution. This
news was communicated to Vargas by a Taos chief named
Pedro Pacheo, and he immediately determined to make
an expedition into the coimtry of the conspirators and
chastise them. He informed the Indians present of his
intention, and invited the young men, who could come
well armed and mounted, to accompany him, telling them
that those whom he was about to make war upon were
as much their enemies as they were of the Spaniards.
Many agreed to join the expedition, and pledged them«
selves to meet him at Santa Fe in eight days from that
time, properly prepared.
Vargas left Taos to return to Santa Fe on the 9th of
October, and that night reached camp Miranda. The
next day he marched to the pueblo of Picoris, where the
inhabitants gave him a friendly welcome. From this
place he dispatched two runners to Pecos to notify the
inhabitants of that pueblo to meet him in Santa Fe.
They carried with them, as emblems of their peaceful
346 ' THE CONQUEST OF NEW KEXIOO.
mission, two wooden crosses more than a vara* long, and
a tliird painted on white paper. He reached El Embudo,
at the South base of the mountain, on the 11th, where
he encamped for the night. He rested at San Yldefonso
on the 12th, and reached Santa Fe on the following day.
The expedition was entirely successful, and Vargas re-
turned to his capital without the loss of a man.
3 A Spanish measore of thirty-Uuee and one-third inches in length.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 347
CHAPTER XLV.
VARGAS MARCHES TO SUBDUE THE PUEBLOS OF PECOS, CIA
AND JEMEZ.
The Northern Indians being now in a state of peace,
Vargas had leisure to turn his attention to those who still
manifested hostility. These were the Queres, Pecos and
Jemez Indians. Upon his return to Santa Fe, from
Taos, he remained in the capital no longer than was
necessary to make preparations for the proposed cam-
paign. He had recently received reinforcements from
Parral which would enable him to operate with more
vigor against the enemy. He decided to march iX> the
pueblo of Pecos in the first instance, and after having
chastised that village, if it should be found necessary he
would proceed against those West of the Del Norte.
In the unsettled state of the country, he deemed it
advisable to appoint some suitable person to govern the
conquered pueblos in his absence, and to this important
duty he called a Picoris Indian named Don Louis. The
cliiefs being assembled, the oath of office was duly admin-
istered to the newly appointed governor upon a cross,
when a staff was delivered to him, with instructions how to
govern his actions in any case of emergency. Before he
348 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICa
marched Vargas dispafched two squadrons of moanted
men, two pieces of artillery, the pack animals, with the
friendly Indians and captives, to Santo Domingo to await
his return from Pecos.
Having completed the necessary arrangements for the
campaign, he took up the line of march for Pecos, with
the balance of the troops, on the 17 th of October, accom-
panied by two priests, fathers Corvero and Barros. The
war-captain and governor of the Santa Fe pueblos had
intended accompanying him, but on account of the un-
favorable state.of the weather they were obliged to remain
at home to take care of their crops. Vargas directed his
march across the mountains to the East, and about two
o'clock of the same afternoon he entered Pecos, i The
1 Pecos was situated twenty-five miles South of East from Santa Fc,
on a small tributary of tlie river of the same name. In the time of
Vargas it contained a population of about fifteen hundred, but now is
entirely in ruins. A few years ago the remnant of the Pecos Indians
left their pueblo and joined the people of Jemez who speak the same
language. There houses and lands were given them.
Many curious tales are related of the superstitious customs of the
Pueblos, among which is the following told of the Pecos Indians. It
is said that Montezuma kindled a sacred fire in the estufa of that pueblo
and commanded that it should be kept burning until he came back to
deliver them from the Spaniards. He was expected to appear with the
rising sun, and every morning the Indians ascended to the house tops
and strained their eyes looking to the East for the appearance of their
deliverer and king. The task of watching the sacred fire was assigned
to the warriors, who served, by turns, for a period of two days and two
nights without eating or drinking, and some say that they remained
upon duty until death or exhaustion relieved them. The remains of
those who died from the eflect of watching are said to have been car-
ried to the den of a great serpent, which appears to have lived upon
such delicacies. The tradition, that the sacred fire was kept burning
until the village was abandoned, is generally believed by both Indians
and Mexicans ; but their great deliverer never came, and when the fire
went out, from what cause is not known, the survivors of Pecos found
new homes West of the Rio Grande.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 349
Indians having heard of his coming, awaited his arrival*
They had erected a large cross, and arches, at the en*
trance to the pueblo, where they received him, singing
the Alabadoi in full chorus. The troops were conducted
to the main plaza and afterward to the quarters prepared
for them. The whole population rendered their submis-
sion, after which they were absolved of past offences,
and two hundred and forty-eight baptised, the captain-
general standing godfather for a child of the sexton. The
next morning he held a talk with the Indians, and at their
request he appointed a governor, alcalde, and war-captain
for the pueblo, who were duly qualified and entered upon
the discharge of their duties.
That evening Vargas marched for Santo Domingo.
He struck across the mountains to the South-west, and
ttbout nine o'clock at night reached the Galisteo in a
storm of rain and hail. Here he encamped. This pueblo
was found in ruins and deserted. The next day, being
Sunday, Mass was celebrated, and afterward the troops
resumed the march. In three leagues they arrived
at the pueblo of San Marcos, also deserted and in ruins
except the church and convent. They halted here a
short time, when the march was continued to Santo
Domingo eight leagues further, where they arrived in
good order and found tlie cavalry and artillery sent for-
ward from Santa Fe. Here Vargas met the messenger
whom he had sent, some time previous, to Antonio Mala-
cate, the Queres cliief, with crosses and a rosary, to
request him to come in and have a talk. The chief had
left his pueblo and taken up his residence at Santa Ana,
and was then too sick to cbme in ; but he had sent his
2 A hymn sung ia praise of the sacrament when it is pat in the
tabernacle.
350 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
singer to announce his illness and say that his people
awaited the arrival of the Spaniards, whom they woTild be
glad to see. The messenger was furnished with a new
supply of crosses and rosaries and sent to the Queres
Indians which had deserted their pueblos, and were at that
time on the other side of the mountains, with an invita-
tion to the chiefs to come in and hold a parley. He
returned the same afternoon, bringing with him some of
the head men, whom Vargas received with great friend-
ship. He held a council with them, after which they •
were dismissed to their people, with instructions to prepare
their villages for the arrival of the soldiers. They departed
well pleased, with crosses and rosaries suspended aroimd
their necks as evidence of peace.
The Spaniards marched from Santo Domingo on the
21st of October. In consequence of the road to La
Cienguilla being very bad, he sent the artillery, pro-
visions, captives and friendly Indians to the deserted farm
of Cristoval de Anava, there to await his arrival. Vargas
marched direct to Cochiti, where he crossed the Del Norte,
and continued in a North-west course toward the moun-
tains. In three loiigues he reached a pass where he found
a large cross erected by the Queres nation, and a short
distance beyond the Indians were assembled in great
numbers, with arches built of foliage. They received the
Spaniards as friends, saluting them as they advanced,
and chanting the Alabado. Vargas dismounted, when he
was escorteil to the pueblo, which he entered and took
possession of in tlie name of the king of Spain. Tlie
priests then proceeded to the duty of absolution and
baptism, and one hundred and three persons, adults and
children, were received into the church. The general
stood godfather for a son of one of the principal chiefe,
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 351
•
who was named Carlos, in honor of the sovereign. At
this place there were assembled the inhabitants of the
pueblos of Cochiti, San Marcos and San Felipe, who had
deserted their villages through fear of the Teguas, Tanos
and Picoris Indians. They were assured that they should
not be molested if they would return to their homes,
which they promised to do. The same evening he
marched to within a short distance of Cochiti, where he
pitched his camp.
The next morning Vargas proceeded to the farm of
Anaya, where he joined the troops he had sent forward
with the provisions and captives. Here the Spaniards
were again divided. Vargas, with the main body, continued
the march for Cia and Jemez, while the artillery, supplies,
tired animals and prisoners \vere dispatched to the farm
and pueblo of Mejia, at which place the officer in com-
mand was ordered to await the return of the general.
That afternoon, Vargas, with five squadrons of mounted
men, and fifty friendly Indians, marched for Cia, near
which they encamped the same night. The pueblo had
been destroyed a few years before by Cruzate, but it had
not been rebuilt. The troops entered it the next morning.
It was situated upon the mesa of Cerro Colorado, and the
only approach to it was up the side of the plateau by a
steep and rocky road. The only tiling of value found
there was the bell of the convent which was ordered to
be buried. The Indians had built a new village near the
ruins of the old one. When they saw the Spaniards
approach they came forth to meet and bid them welcome,
carrying crosses in their hands, and the chiefs marching
at their head. In this manner they escorted Vargas and
his troops to the plaza, where arches and crosses were
erected, and good quai'ters provided them. He caused
. •
352 THE (X)NQUEST OP ^EW MEXICO
the inhabitants to be assembled, when he explained to
them the object of his' visit and the manner in which he
intended to punish all the rebellious Indians. This con-
cluded, the usual ceremonies of taking possession, baptism
and absolution, took place. Among other things the
general advised them to return to the old pueblo and
rebuild it, and he gave them a few axes to aid them in
the work. The interview closed by the Indians per-
ibrming their favorite dance, after which Vargas appointed
the requisite officers of the pueblo and instructed them in
their duties.
A'argas marched from Cia the same day for the old
pueblo of Jemez, three leagues distant. lie arrived there
without hindrance, but finding it abandoned he continued
on to the new pueblo situated upon a high mesa, and
about three leagues beyond the old one. The ascent to
the top of the mesa was up a rough and difficult road.
The Indians had watched the approaeli of the Spaniards
and made preparations to resist them. A'argas commenced
the ascent, and as he neared the top he was met by ovor
three hundred well-armed warriors, nearly the same num-
ber being held in reserve. They advanced with ever}'
appearance of hostility. Tliey sounded their war-cry and
rushed among the Spaniards and friendly Indians brand-
ishing their weapons and throwing dirt in their eyes.
A'argas sounded a parley to know what was the meaning
of their strange conduct, when they informed him such
was their mode of manifesting their pleasure at seeing
him and his troops ; but suspecting treachery he was on
his ffuard and watched them closelv. lie ascended the
mesa on horseback. When he approached within about
an hundred yards of the spot where the governor and
<jhiefs and manv of the old men were assembled, witli
"THE CONQUEST OP ' NEW llEXICO. S^
•TTosses in their hands, they all knelt down, lie diri-
rnonnted to salute them, when they chanted the Alabado,
embracing each other, and conducted him to the pueblo.
This pueblo was quite extensive and well fortified. It
(contained two plazas with four large buildings around
each, and was defended by a redoubt and wall, with only
one entrance to the first plaza, which communicated with
the second by a small <]rate. The Indians crowded into
the pliiz.i in large numbers with their arms in their hands,
and immediately commenced the war dance. Seeing this
-demonstration, Varc^as became alarm cid for his safetv, but
wisely kept his fears to himself, in the meantime counsel-
ing in his own mind how to defend himself in case of an
attack. He peripitted them to continue the dance soma
time, when he ordered them to bring in the women and
children, whicli they complied with. lie now directed
them to lay down their arms, which they also did, and
immediately after he assembled them in couiicil. lie
explained to them that he came to chastise those who
continued in rebellion and apostacy ; that all the Indians
were the subjects of his master, the king of Spain, and
the land his property ; and that if they did not remain
peaceable and forsake their heathen customs, he would
])unish them severely. The priests then entered upon
the discharge of their holy duties, and baptised and
absolved the whole population. Vargas and the priests
were then invited into an inner room of one of the build-
ings where a good entertainment was provided them, but
they partook of the feast in constant fear of treachery.
AVhile at Jemez, a deputation of Apache Indians came
to see Vargas and made many professions of peace. He
refused to hear them, but promised to return in one year
•and listen to what thev had to sav, comraandino^ them, to
.23
i
334 THE CONQUEST OF »EW MEXICO.
live at peace with the Spaniards, in the meantime. Th^
interview was now closed, and all the Indians were directed
to return to their respective pueblos. That afternoon
Vargas descended the mesa and pitched his camp in front
of the old pueblo, directing the Indians to bring him pro-
visions to that place the next morning, but they only
furnished him with a few sheep and a little pinole. He
resumed the march that day, and at night encamped at
the ruined pueblo of Santa Ana. The following day he
rejoined the remainder of his forces at the deserted tarm
of Mejiar
THE CONQtTEST OP NEW MEXICO. 35i
CHAPTER XLVI.
f HE ARMY NOW MARCHES FOR THE TROVIXCES OF ZUSl AND
MOQUI.
Since Vargas had entered New Mexico for its re-
xK)nquest, he had reduced to complete subjection seventeen
provinces, while the priests who accompanied him
baptised upward of one thousand five hundred and seventy
persons. The provinces yet remaining in a hostile atti-
tude were those of ZuM and Moqur, the latter being
about an hundred leagues West of Santa Ana. For the
reduction of these he made immediate preparations.
Before taking up the line of march he made disposition
of all his superfluous forces, so that they would not encum-
ber his movements. The citizens and friendly Indians, wlio
had accompanied him to this point, were sent to El Paso
del Norte with an escort, pack animals and wagons being
provided for the transportation of themselves, families
and pro\asions. Among those who were sent to El Paso
were the following prisoners, to be kept in charge by the
lieutenant-governor until their fate should bo decided by
the king. The list, as hei*e published, is a copy of the
original record, and was handed to the oflicer in command
of the escort, viz^
■i
366 THE COKQUEST OF NEW MEXICa
" 1. Captain Roque Madrid conducts Patrona Casadaf
with Cristoval her grandson, citizens and residents of
Sonora, with five sons and two daughters.
" 2. Jose Dominguez takes his sister, Juana Dominguezy
with four daughters and one son.
" 3. Juan Olguin takes two daughters of Jose Nevares, -
a soldier at Jeniez.
" 4. Francisco Marques takes aunt Luzia, wife of Pedro
ilarques, resident of the Casus (Jrandes, with a daugliter
grown.
" 5. Francisco Almazar takes a muhitto woman, called
Maria, with three daughters and one {?ou.
" 6. Uicgo Garcia, soldier, takes a woman called Juana,
with three childrcn."i
The escort having left for El Paso, Vargas took up tlic
line of march for Ziifii on the afternoon of the 30th of
October. Ilis force consisted of ciGrhtv-nine soldiers, rank
and file, and thirty Indian runners, these being all the
troops at his command for the conquest of two powerful
provinces. The same day he marched to Isleta where he
encamped for the night. lie found this j)ueblo abandoned
and in ruins, except the walls of the church and convent,
v/hicli were in a good state of preservation. The follow-
ing day he reached the river l^lerco, which he found
hwollen and of difficult passage, lie was obliged to cross
the camp equipage and provisions by hand ; and he
]>itched his camp that night near the bank of the stream.
Pursuing his march across a barren country, in a course
a little South of AVest, on the 3d of November he cnme
within view of the pcfiol of Acoma, and saw^ smoke ai'ising
from the camp fires of the Queres enemy. Vargas now
1 Although these persons seem to have been prisoners, the journat
of Vargas is silent as lo the nature of their offence*
.^
• THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 857
mounted a fresh horse, and, riding forward with a small
escort to reconnoitre, he found the Indians assembled in .
considerable numbers upon two rocky eminences. When
^vithin gunshot of the one on the right, the Spam'ards
charged the enemy, crying in a loud voice as they
rushed toward them, "blessed be the Virgin Mary."
The Indians made no hostile demonstration, but as. the
soldiers approached they responded to their cry by
shouting "forever." Vargas, seeing that the enemy
exhibited signs of peace, sounded a parley, and through
the medium of an interpreter explained the reason of
his presence among them with an armed force. He told
them that he came to punish those who still remained
in arms against tlieir king, but to pardon all who would
acknowledge their guilt and surrender. As evidence of
his pacific intention, he showed them an imago and a
cross. A friendly Indian was now sent up to the mount
to hold an interview with the enemy. He told them
of the manner in wliich the pueblos had been treated who
had already laid down their arms, and called two warriors
of the Zufii and Moqui village to witness tlie truth of
what he said. The priests joined their assurances with
those of the friendly Indians ii4 testimony of the peaceful
intention of the Spaniards. The Indians at last professed
to be satisfied, and directed Vargas to march his command
to the opposite side of the hill where he would be able to
make the ascent.
The Spaniards reached the summit by traversing a
narrow and difficult pathway. The Indians, however,
refused to come forward to meet them, but instead with-
drew within their entrenchments, the entrance to which
they stopped up with stones, and declined to hold any
further intercourse with them. This strange conduct and
358 THE CONQUEST OP NEW IHEXICOv
«ipparent hostility greatly provoked Vargas. The mes=-
sengers sent up to liold the parley, being still in the
enemy's camp, demanded to be set free, but tBe Indi-
ans refused to let them go. After a little delay a half-
breed went up to the entrenchments and talked witb the
Indians, but what he said produced no effect upon them.
They refused, positively, to entertain any proposition
imtil after they had held their grand council. They told
Vargas that the Apaches were watching an opportunity
to attack his camp, and begged him to be upon his guard.
The Spaniards, being unable to accompHsh anything,,
withdrew into the plain below and encarfiped.
Early the next morning the half-breed Zuni Indian was
dispatched to the Queres camp upon the mount with a
cross and a message in writing. He was again directed to
assure the Indians tliat the Spaniards had come into their
country for no other purpose than from a desire to bring
them back to Christianity^ and that the priests who ac-
companied the expedition would baptise and pardon them.
He returned about ten o'clock with the answer of the
Indians. He had given the cros&to one who understood
Spanish, and who read the letter to the others, who-
listened to it attentively. . They kissed the cross, and
expressed uneasiness because they were alone and unpro-
tected, having no other friends than the Nabajo Apaches,
whom they promised to inform of the situation of things.
They desired that Varjras should continue his march ta
Zufii, and when he returned, they promised to be prepared
to hold a talk with him.
]3eing now convinced that he could not open negotia-
tions with the enemy at this time, Vargas concluded to
resume his march to the West. Before he set out he
made search for a convenient watering place at which
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 359
I
to establish his camp upon his return, but was unable
to find a more favorable location than the one ho then
occupied. Seeing that the Indians watched him closely
from their entrenchments, and perceiving, as he thought,
some signs oT their coming to terras, he made a last effort
in that behalf. For this purpose he returned within
speaking distance of their position, accompanied only by
a few soldiers, and requested a parley. The principal
chief, wlio spoke Spanish, came forward and invited
him to ascend the mount, which he did. When they
had come together, the chief said that he had been ad-
vised not to treat with him, upon the ground that it was
feared he desired to got them into his power under the
cloak of Christianity, and would afterward hang and shoot
(hem. The captain-general assured him that this was
false, and after some time he succeeded in making the
Indians believe in the sincerity of his professions, when
they laid down their arms and submitted. To seal the
treaty Vargas and Mateo, the chief, embraced, and the
latter erected a cross in the middle of the pueblo. The
priests now entered upon the discharge of theii* functions,
and absolved the whole population, kneeling, and after-
ward baptised eighty-seven persons. This pueblo was
quite extensive,! with two plazas and three immense rows
of buildings. The church was large and in good repair,
with walls a vara and a half thick, some of which had
been loop-holed. Having accomj)lished the object in
s'iew Vargas returned to camp, where he offered up
thanks for the capture of the pueblo without loss of blood.
s The old manuscript journal of Vargas states that this pueblo was
''^ the size of a long horse race," (Tamaiia de una carrera larga de ca-
ballo), but as neither the size nor length of a horse race of that day has
come down to us, we are unable to determine how large it was.
i
360 THE CONQUEST OP NEW HEXIOQ^
The Spaniards resumed the march for Zuui on Wedste^^
day, tlie 5th of November, and the same evening en-
camped at a spring a few miles beyond. The third day
they marched within twenty-five leagues of their destina-
tion, when a messenger was sent forward to the pueblo
to announce their approach, and forbid the inhabitants
leaving. He bore with him a cross and a rosary as evi-
dence of the peaceful and friendly indention of the
Spaniards. That night the command was compelled to
encamp without water, as there was none to be had
nearer than the iloro, twelve leagues beyond. They
encamped there the following day, and found an abund-
ant supply. They marched the next day through a
heavy sform to the small spring of Zuhi. During the
afternoon ten mounted Indians, and two on foot, came to
the camp and informed Vargas, that in consequence of
his friendly letter the old men of the pueblo had sent
them out to welcome him, and to say that they were well
pleased at his coming. They brought a present of a sheep,
and some tortillas and watermelons. Thcv remained
in camp that night. Thence the Spaniards marched fivo
leagues, and encamped in the vicinity of Zufii prepara-
tory to entering it the next day. In the night the
Apaches3 attacked the guard in charge of the animals,
and in consequence of the darkness succeeded in running
off seventeen head of cattle. Vargas was unable to send
a party in pursuit of the thieves because of the bad
condition of his horses; but he determined to make a
campaign against them as soon as possible.
lie took possession of the pueblo the next day. The
road up the penol or mount upon which it was situated'
was so steep and difficult of ascent, that he was obUged.
-isSupppsed to have been the same tribe now. called MogplloneSi..
THE C0I7QUEST OF NEW HSXICa 361
to dismoant and ascend on foot.4 When he entered he
found a large number of the inhabitants waiting to
receive him. He chanted the Alabado, when the Indians
approached and embraced him, and proclaimed their
friendship. The pueblo consisted of three sets of quar-
ters. The inhabitants being assembled he explained to
them the object of his visit ; that the king, his master,
was also their master ; that they and the whole country
belonged to him ; and that in his name he took possession
of the pueblo, as he had done of all the others. They
were then absolved, and two hundred and ninety-four
were baptised. He ordered a large cross to be put up in
the plaza. The principal chief then invited Vargas into
his house, and upon entering it he found a small altar
erected and two large tallow candles burning thereon.
Upon removing some pieces of church ornament he dis-
covered two brass images of Christ, fifty-six inches in
length, attached to which were crosses of wood ; another*
image of Clirist, crucified, fastened to a wooden cross,
with San Francisco Capuchino at his feet ; a painting ot"
Saint John the Baptist, on canvas, three-quarters of a
yard long ; a silver custodia inlaid with gold, and other
articles ; besides a number of books on Christianity, among
which was one on confession, in the Mexican and Spanish
languages. The books and sacred Ornaments were deliv-
ered to Vargas, who promised to return them to the holy
father at El Paso. He and the priests, upon invitation,
dined with the head men of the pueblo, and were enter-^
tained in the most hospitable manner. They were much.
4 The situation of ZaUi, and the steepness of the road that led up to
it, with the difficulty of its ascent, agree with what Castafieda says
about the entrance to Cibola when Coronada was there in 1511. It is
addUional testimony in favor of the identity of these places.
M
362 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
pleased with their reception and entertainment, not having
seen anything e<|aal to it among the Indians of New
Jlexico. The exercises of the day being concluded, Var-
gas returned to the Spanish camp about sunset.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 363
CHAPTER XLVII.
THE MOQUI INDIANS BEING PACIFIED VARGAS RETURNS TO
EL PASO WITH HIS ARMY.
While the Spaniards were encamped at Zuni, a Mo-
qui Indian brought information to Vargas that that
pueblo had become alarmed at his approach and fled
to the mountains with their families and stock. Their
alarm was caused by the Nabajoi Apaches, who had been
to the villages and told the inhabitants not to believe a
word that Vargas had written them from Jemez, nor to
accept the cross, as his only object was to get them in his
power and then destroy them. The Indians beheving
this would be the case had sought safety in flight. To
assure them of his peaceable intentions the governor
wrote them a second letter, wliieh he dispatched by the
runner who brought the information ; in which he stated
that he had already pardoned them for their participation
in the rebellion, and requested them to return to their
villages and await his arrival. He also sent them another
cross.
I A tribe Blill living in New Mexico, West of the Del Nort^ river, and
known as the Nabajo Indians.
364 THE COiSQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
On tlie 13th of November a deputation of eight or ten
Saline Apaches,* headed by a chief, came to the Spanisli
camp with many professions of friendship. Vargas em-
braced them and extended his hand in token of peace. Ho
told them that he woidd be their friend so long as they be-
haved themselves well and remained at peace ; but that if
they were really desirous of being friendly with the Span-
iards they must make war upon the Faraon Apaches and
bring buck the cattle the latter had stolen from him. He
then acciLscd them of being the thieves, and having run oft'
liis cattle, which they denied, and said their only object
in coming to his camp was to make peace, and notify him
that he could pass through their country in safety^ He
wanted them to be baptised as evidence of their friendsliip,
which they declined, when he closed the interview, and
giving them a little tobacco, sent them out of camp.
Vargas now made his arrangements to continue the
march to the IMoqui villages. He had two objects iu
view in going into that country; one, in order to explore
the mountain where it was said red ochre abounded, and
the other, and more important, for the purpose of reducing
the Indians to subjection. He had reported the abund-
ance of quicksilver said to be found in that country, and
he also was desirous of j)roving the truth of this to the
viceroy. lie sent all the disabled soldiers and worn out
horses to El Pa,so under a guard of twenty-five men in
command of captain llafael Teves Jiron, and he caused
the cattle and other stock, not necessary for the expedition,
to be placed in a secure place under a guard at Zufii, until
he should return.
He left this pueblo with sixty-4:hree soldiers -and two
priests, on the loth of November, and encamped that
1 Supposed to have been the same as the present Mescalero Apaches*
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 365
night in the middle of the timber, bix leagues beyond.
On the fifth day, while on the march, two Indians, named
Salbador and Sebastian, from Agnatubi, came to him to
inquire when he would arrive at the pueblo. The father
of one of them was on the look-out the day before, and
waited until sunset, but as the Spaniards did not make
their appearance, he returned. Vargas received them
with kindness, and put a rosary upon their necks. About
four o'clock the same afternoon, four otlier Indians, well
mounted and armed, met him two leatjjues from the villairc
and bade him and the soldiers welcome. Thev accom-
panied him about a league and then returned to their
pueblo. When he arrived near the mesa, upon which the
village was situated, he was mot by seven or eight hun-
dred Indians, some mounted and others on foot, and
armed with arqucbuases, and bows and arrows, and singing
their war songs. They surrounded the Spaniards ; and
the manuscript journal of Vargjus states that they en-
deavored to provoke him into a ii;>:ht bv askinir him
*' diabolical questions." lie assured them that he had coine
upon a peaceful mission^ having been sent by the king to
pardon them for the part they had taken in the rc])ellion,
and that he had brought with him an image of the IIolv
Virgin, and the royal standard. He then directed tlie
chief, Miguel, to dismount and order his people to do the
same and lay down their arms. The chief did as he was
required, and in a short time the Indians wcyq pacified
and order restored.
This village w^as found to be well fortified, and the en-
trance to it was so narrow that but one person could pass
in at a time. Vargas caused the soldiers to dismount,
when, with the royal-flag flying, and himself at their head,
they entered on foot and took possession in the name of
J
3G6 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
the king. He compelled the rndians to receive the Holy
Virgin on their knees, and repeat the act of possession,
Tlie two interpreters, Miguel and Francisco, were then
directed to tell them that the friars would absolve and
baptise them the next morning ; until which time they
must return to their homes, and that if they remained quiet
they would not be molested. Miguel invited Vargas to
go to liis house and partake of refreshments, which he
declined to do, as he was not willing to separate himself
from liis soldiers, but he requested the interpreter to bring
to him what he had prepared* I le retired for a short time
and returned with a supply of provisions for the whole
command. The Indians requested the general to remain
in the pueblo that night. This he declined as he preferred
encamping outside, and having obtained a good location,
he pitched his camp.
The next morning the ceremonies of absolution and
baptism were peformed. Vargas and the priests entered
tlie pueblo with an escort of fifty men, well mounted and
armed, who were cautioned to be upon their guard during
the religious exercises. In the first place the Indians
were ordered to erect a large (tross upon the plaza, which
being done, they were asseml)led around it, when one
hundred and twenty-two were baptised, and a great num-
ber were absolved of their sins. Vargas stood sponsor
for a son and daughter of Miguel. These ceremonies
having been concluded, the general appointed a governor
for the pueblo. His choice, for this position, fell upon
Miguel, to whom he caused the proper oath to be admin-
istered, gave him the necessary instructions, and com-
manded the people to obey him. He now dined with
the new governor, after which he returned to camp.
The next afternoon Miguel came to the camp and
A
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 367
related what took place among the Indians when they
heard the Spaniards were marching into the province.
He said that he had read the letter he received from
Vargas to the Indians of Agiiatubi and sent word of
its contents to the pneblos of Gualpi, Jongopabi, Mon-
sonabi and Oraybi, and that the inhabitants of all the
villages assembled on a Sunday and held a council, the
leading man being one named Antonio, of Gualpi. When
informed that Vargas had left at Zufii the principal part
of his forces, they resolved to kill him and his whole
command. The chief Antonio was the leader of all the
hostility ; he it was wlio caused all the disturbance in the
province, and induced the Indians to arm themselves
upon the ai'rival of the Spaniards. They determined not
to permit any of them to enter their pueblos. The new
governor, according to his own account, stood up man-
fully in defence of the Spaniards and opposed the hostile
intentions of the Indians ; he told his countrymen that
Vargas and his troops had come a long distance upon a
mission of peace, mainly to pardon them for the oftences
they had committed in the late rebellion ; that they were
good Christians, and himself and the inhabitants of his
pueblo would receive and treat them well. The Indiana
commenced collecting together, the ne;^t day after tlie
council, to put their plans into execution. He said they
were much enraged against him for the part he had taken
in the reception of Vargas and his troops, and threatened
to put him to death as soon as the Spaniards should
leave the province.
The relation of Miguel did not cause any alarm to
Vargas, and he determined to carry out his intention of
visiting the other pueblos. He accordingly marched for
Gualpi, the nearest village, with forty-five soldiers, well
68 TraE COKQUEST OF KEW MEXICO
moimted, leaving the balance of hifi animals at Aqnatobi,
with a guard of fifteen men. The soldiers marched in
fours, and were ordered to have their arms always ready,
but not to fire witliout (Ji'ders. In three leagues they
reached the mesa upon which the pueblo was situated ;
and as soon as the Indians saw them approaching the^'
ballied out in great numbers, some mounted, and others
on foot, and armed witli various kinds of weapons.
A'ar^as directed the lialf-brced, Antonio, to ask the Indians
to lav down their arms and come and meet him ; which
those of the pueblo of Gnalpi immediately complied with,
but the others refused. One-half the command then
entered the pueblo, while the remainder kept guard
outside. Vargas then went through the same ceremony of
• explaining the object of his visit, and taking formal pos-
session of the village, as I have before narrated. He
caused a cross to be erected on the plaza, and commanded
the Indians to repeat the four .prayers every morning,
and to build a church and convent. The priests thcii
absolved and baptised eighty-one persons, old and young.
Tlic doors of the houses v.ere on the top. Vargas
entered the house of captain Antonio and took some
refreshments, after which he retired from the pueblo.
The Spanijirds next marched to Jlonsonabi, otherwise
culled liuenavcntura — Ventura, situated upon a high
mesa tlirce leagues distant. As soon as he took up the
march for this pueblo, all the Indians who were at Aqua-
tubi belonging to it, left the latter village and returned
to their own homes. The entrance to ^Alonsonabi was more
diliicnlt than that to all the other pueblos. Here Vargas
met the Indian named Pedro, whom ho had dispatched
to the Moqui country, from Jemez, with a cross as evi-
^dence of his peaceful mission. He was standing i^pon
^THE CONQUEST OP ITEW MEXICO. 369
'the plaza with the cross in his hand, in company with the
two captains, Joseph and Sebastian. He caused the
Indians to lay down their arms, bring their families to
the square and erect a cross, when he took possession of
the pueblo,*after which the priests baptised and absolved
the whole population.
Leaving Monsonabi, the Spaniards marclied to the
pueblo of San Bernardo de Jongopabi, a league .distant,
situated upon a mesa still higher than that of Buenaven-
tura. A munber of unarmed Indians were met at the
entrance to the village, many of whom had their women
and children with them. Vargas ordered a large cross to
he erected in the square, when the usual ceremonies of
taking possession, absolution and baptism were performed,
after which he returned to his former camp near Agua-
tubi. From the latter place he had marched twelve or
fourteen leagues without water, and manjr of his horses
were broken down for the want of it^ He seems not to
liave visited Oraybi.
Having completed the pacification of the province Yar-
i;as next tnmed liis- attention to the red-ochre mines, the
diiscovery of which was one of the objects of the expedi-
tion. They were said to be situated in the Red Mountain,
(Cierro Colorado,) and in order to obtain informatiori
about them, he examined one Pedro, a Zufii Indian, who
had twice visited them. He had been a servant of friar
Joseph de Espleta, a missionary among the iloquis. Ho
said they were ten days' travel from Agnatubi in«i high and
steep mountain, difficult of access ; that it required a day
or two to go up and get the ochre out of the earth, havin<^
to descend into a deep hole, and that it was necessary
to remain in the mountain all night without water. Tlu*
•road from the Moqui pueblos was a difficult one to travel.
24
370 THE CONQUEST OF NEW BIEXICa*
«*ind water was only found at long intervals, tlie first?
watering place being ten leagues distant from Aguatubi,.
A river lay in the route, the banks of which were so
steep that horses could not be taken down them, but
must be left on the East side.a It w-as neces^rj^ to pa^s
through the country of the Cominas, who were repre-'
fi3nted as a very strong and warlike nation. Upon being
asked the size of the vein, the Indian answered that it
was " about jis large as a watermelon,"* and very solid,
and sometimes changed its color. The Indians used this
earth to ])aint themselves and also for the preservation
of tlieir skin, which kept it smooth and soft, and obliter-
ated marks of the small-pox. After learning tlie distance
to the ochre mine, and the difficulties to be encountered
in reaching it, Vargas concluded to give up the expedi-
tion and return to the pueblo of Zufii*
It was his intention to return to Zufii by the way of
Oravbi, but because of the great scarcitv of water on the
road and at that pueblo, and of the broken-down condition
of the animab, he determined to proceed direct to the
former place. He took up the line of march on the 24tli
of November, and the same evening encamped at a water-
ing ])lace called ilagdelena. The second day a number
of liis animali* gave out, and he was obliged to leave them
behind on the road, A messenger from the grazing cajn]>
at Aloma met liim with information that the Apaclies
liad stolen three liead of horses, and threatened thc^
destruction of tlie troops stationed there as guard, which
induced him to push forward as rapidly as possible. He
left camp on the evening of the 26th, about nine o'clock,
:'. This river is the same as the Rio Colorado, which formed Vim
Western boundary of New Mexico as originally established by Congress.
Por comparacion de una grandia."
***
THE CON'^'TIST OF NEW MEXICO. 371
•with twenty-six of his best horsemen, for the relief of
Aloma, and by making forced marches he arrived there
about the same hour the next evening. His command,
with the horses and n-'iles, arrived the next day, when
lie moved his camp near the pefiol of Zufii.
Having now fully accomplished the object for which
lie had entered New Mexico, the pacification of the
Indian provinces, Vargas resolved to march for El Paso,
and made immediate arrangements to set out. He met
with an Indian who promised to conduct him by a new
and shorter route to the pueblo of Cenecu (near the
present Socorro), and along which there was an abund-
ance of wood and water. Tlie name of this guide was
Cabezon, (Big-head,) and he and his two companions,
named Bermejo and Alonzo, were each to receive a horse
for his service besides his provisions. He commenced
tJie march on the 30th of November, by the way of tlic
Ojita de Zuni, where he was overtaken by an Indian
runner, with information that the Apaches intended to
attack him that night. He ordered his men to sleep
upon their arms, and be. ready at any moment to resist
the enemy. Here he was joined by two soldiers left in
the pueblo of Aloma; who were accompanied by their
two sisters, wlio had been made prisoners in the rebellion,
and lived among the Indians since that time.
The Spaniards encamped at the Moro on the night of
the 1st of December. Their course was now changed to tho.
Soutli, and lay through an unknown and barren country
roamed over by bands of hostile Indians. Tliey broke
up camp the next morning in a heavy storm of snow and
rain. After marching a league they came in sight of the
Black ilountains, and the guide pointed out Long Rock,
near which the Red Apaches lived and planted corn*
372 tTHE CONQUEST OF J^£t7 tt£XICOt
Sere flowed a fine stream of watlr. At the base of the
moantams the road changed to the Soath-east, and passed
over a country of volcanic formation, and very rough.
In a march of four leagues they entered . a mountainous
region and encamped* During the night, in spite of the
vigilance of the guard, the Apaches succeeded in stealing
fourteen horses, and lanced one which died the next
morning- The camp was entirely surrounded by them,
and the presence of the sentinels alone prevented them
from making an attack.
The Spaniards continued the march in the same direc-
tion. In the distance of two leagues they left the
mountains and struck upon a prairie which they crossed,
and then came among hills of volcanic formation, which
they traversed for more than a league, when they entered
an extensive valley bounded by hills covered with the
royal pine, and thence descended into another valley,
where they encamped for the night. The next day they
continued their march down this valley, wliich tliey
found well wooded and covered witli fine pasture, in a
storm of rain. IIa\nng traversed the valley several
leagues, they crossed a rolling prairie and entered upon
an extensive plain, on which they encamped without
water. They continued their march in the same direc-
tion until the 9th of December, when they reached the
ruined pueblo of Socorro. The next day they proceeded
down the West bank of the Del Norte, and, making easy
mai'ches, reached El Paso the 20th of the month, witliout
further detention. During the expedition Vargas had
recaptured seventy-fom* Spanish women and children,
who had been made captive in the rebellion, and the
priests had baptised two thousand two himdi'cd and four-
teen Indians, who had renounced their idolatrous worship*
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 373
CHAPTER XLVIII.
SECOND EXPEDITION OF VARGAS INTO NEW MEXICO, AND
HIS ^LVRCH TO SANTA A
The Spanish government in Mexico determined, the
following year, to send anotlier expedition into New
Mexico, to be accompanied by emigrants, for the purpose
of establishing permanent settlements, and effecting a
more complete conquest of the country and subjugation
of the Indians. This was, likewise, intrusted to the com-
mand of Vargas, who received the necessary instructions
to fit out the expedition, and funds to provide for the
wants of the settlers on the marcha The whole com-
mand, including every description of persons, numbered
1 On the 24th of November, 1692, by virtne of an order of the count
of Galyes, and the ministers of the Royal Junta, at Mexico, there was
paid to Vargas the sum of $12,638.50, and on another order from the
same officer, there were paid to him on the 8th of April, 1693, $29, 783.62,
in all $42,461.12, for the purpose of recruiting settlers for the Presidio
of Santa F4, and for their support for one year. Of this whole amount
of forty-two thousand dollars and upward, it is alleged that Vargas
only expended seyen thousand for the use of the emigrants; the
remainder probably being spent for his private purposes.
374 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
fifteen hundred, with over three thousand horses and
mules. To each famUy there was given a sum of money,
amounting to from ten to forty dollars, to purchase neces-
saries on the way. The emigrants were placed under
the immediate control of captain Juan Paes Hurtado.
Vargas took up the line of march from El Paso on the
11th day of October, 1693, and followed his former
eom'se up the valley of the Del Norte. The suflferings
of the famihes w^re very great. Each person was allowed
one pound of flour and a Httle beef per day until tliey
arrived at a place called Louis Lopez, when the provisions
gave out, after which their condition was wretched. They
were compelled fo sell their arms and horses, and every
thing else they could dispose of to the Indians, for food.
Thirty persons perished from hunger and exposure alone.
The march was so much retarded by the wagons carrying
*
the effects of the emigrants, that Vargas was obliged to
leave them behind to come up at leisure, while he pushed
on ^\ath the troops.
I have not been able to obtain a complete record of
his march up the valley, and therefore am not acquainted
with his operations until after he arrived at the pueblo of
Isleta. The valley of the Rio del Norte is narrow in its
widest part, and lies on both sides of the river, extending
from the stream back to the barren hills which follow its
course. In many parts it is sandy and desert-like, and
the march of troops, and the transportation of supplies is
necessarily a laborious and tedious operation. Up the
valley the Spaniards piursued their toilsome way, meeting
all the incidents and dangers to be encountered in a march
through an enemy's country.
'When Vargas reached the pueblo of Isleta, less than
a hundred miles South of Santa Fe^ he encamped his
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 375
forces for a time, in order to prepare for a further advaneo
into the interior. He sent a runner to the village of Cia,
to obtain information of the condition of the country and
such other news as might be useful to him in his future
operations. Upon his return he reported that the Indians
of Santa Fe had held a council and resolved to resist hi^
iidvance, and had provided a large number of lances "and
arrows. Their plan was to make an attack upon tlK>
troops and animals at the same time, hoping by dividing
the attention of the Spaniards, to meet with success.
The Pueblo Indians invited the Apache tribes to join
,them, and the latter had expressed their willingness to
do so. There was great scarcity of provisions in the
<'Ountry, on account of the damage done to the crops
by grasshoppers. Much divisimi and dissension pre
vailed among tlie inhabitants of Cia, some being in favor
of war, while others were as anxious for peace. Thi«
information put Vargas upon his guard, and he moved
and acted with extreme caution.
Having made tlie necessary disposition of his forces to
•resist an attack upon the march, he movfed from Isleta
with his command and proceeded to a farm within fifteen
leagues of Santa Fe. where he arrived on the 12th day
of November. He halted here in order to reconnoitre
the surrounding country; and as the position was a favor-
tible one for that purpose, he thi'ew up some slight works
as a defence. The next day, with an escort of fifty
-soldiers, he marched up the valley to the pueblo of San
Felipe. Upon his approach the Indians formed in two
lines, with a large cross between them, and when he
icntered the village they received him friendly. He
told them he had again brought priests with him, and
diat they must say Mass according to the form of iho
376 THE CONQUEST OF NEW HEXIOO.
Spaniards. They expressed themselves satisfied witl^
this, and offered refreshments to him and the whole of
his command. Here he met some of the chiefs of
Cochiti, whom he told he intended to visit their pueblo,
and directed them to return and talk with their people,
and come and see him again the next day.
From this place Vargas sent captain Cristobal with
eleven head of cattle to the pueblos up the river to trade
with the Indians for corn and other grain. Four leagues
from camp he met an old woman who told him that the
Indians were assembled for the purpose of destroying the
whole command about seven leagues from Santa Fe-
They had sent two fleet young men to Cochiti to ask the
assistance of the inhabitants of that pueblo, but the latter
being divided in opinion had not yet decided upon the
course to take^ This information was inamediately com-
municated to Vargas, who ordered the troops he had letlt
behmd to join him. Shortly afterward he was informed^
that because two nations had refused to join this combi-
nation against the Spaniards, tlie Indians had returned to
their pueblos, but that they were determined to resi.st
any attempt t* enter Santa Fe.
The command was united on the 19th. Tlie same day
V'argas took a squadron of sixty well-armed men and pro-
ceeded to the mesas overlooking the valley of the river,
where he found assembled Indians of the pueblos of Santa
Ana, Cia, and Cochiti, who appeared to be friendly
disposed, and, as the old manuscript expresses it, " obe-
dient to the Divine and human Majesty.'^ A few of the
children were baptised at the request of the Indians ; and
after obtaining some provisions he and his command
returned to camp.
The Spaniards now resumed the march for Santa Fe^
THE. CONQUEST OF WEW MEXICO. oZ7
They arrived at Santo Domingo the let of December,
and found that pueblo deserted. Here Vargas met and
liad a talk with the governors of Tezuque, San Lazaro,
and San Yldefonsb. Don Louis, the leading man of all
these pueblos, appearing much dejected in the council,
was asked the cause of it. He replied that' when the
Spaniards left the country, the year before, the governor's
interpreter told him they would return some feast day,
and order all the chiefs and principal men engaged in the
rebellion to be put to death ; and that the idea of such a
thing taking place caused him trouble. Vargas quieted
the fears of tlie chief, but, at the same time, told him
this second attempt to conspire for the destruction of his
forces merited tlie severest punishment, even to the ex-
termination of their whole kingdom. He then sent Don
Louis on a mission to the Indians of Santa Fe and San
Lazaro, with instructions to inform them that he had
brought with* him the images of Jesus and the Holy
Mother, and a cross, and that he would not break the
promise of pardon he had made them the year before ;
and that these holy things were much better than their
cstufas. He promised the Indians that when liis inter-
preter, Pedro de Tapia, should return he would cause
liim to be shot for deceiving them. Don Louis took with
liim a few goods to trade with the Indians for provisions,
and was accompanied by four soldiers as a guard. He
returned to the Spanish camp on the fourth day wdth a
good supply of corn, in addition to twelve mule loads
sent him by the inhabitants of Santa Fe, as a present.
Vargas marched from Santo Domingo on the 11th of
December in a violent snow storm, and the same evening
encamped on the mesa at the farm of Roque Madrid,,
witlna two leagues of Santa Fe. He was visited that
3 78 THE CONQUEST OF NEW KEXICO.
evening by a depntation of Indians from the town, headed
by the governor and accompanied by the chief of Tezuque.
They manifested great friendship, and, as evidence of
their good feehng, they brouglit the Spaniards a supply
of tortillas. J They informed him that the report put iu
circulation by the interpreter had caused great commotion
among them, and given mucli alarm ; but that the old
men and women had denied its truth, saying that Vargas
Avas their father, and would not injure them.
He remained encamped at this place until the 16th,
when he resumed the march for Santa Fe. With his
troops formed in martial array, and mounted and accom-
panied by the ayuntamiento,3 with the same colors flying
that had waved over Don Juan de Onate, the first
conqueror, when he had entered the place, he marched
into the town And took possession of it. The population
assembled upon the plaza to receive him, the men being
drawn up on one side, and the women •on tlie other.
AVlien the priests, who wore in rear of the troops,
npproiiched the plaza, they commenced chanting liymns
and repeating prayers. The soldiers were formed in
open ranks to allow them to pass through, and when
tliey arrived upon the srjuare they knelt down before a
cross the Indians had erected, celebrated the Te Deum,
and chanted the Litany. Vargas now delivered a dis-
course to the Indians, in which he exphiined to them the
object of his second visit to Santa Yc ; all that he said
being confirmed l)y the friars. The town was in about
tlie same condition as when he had left it the vear before,
the works and entrenchments being still in good order.
The ceremonies having been concluded, the troops were
2 Thin cakes made of corn meal.
t Town council.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 379
inarched to a hill a short distance out of town, where
the Indians had prepared accommodations for them.*
The soldiers and emigrants remained encamped upon
tliis hill until the 25th of the month. The weather had
set in very cold in the meantime, and there was great
suffering in the camp, many of the troops and colonists
dying from hunger and exposure. Vargas called uj^ou
tlio Indians for one hundred bags of corn, which they
furnished ; but when afterward required to furnish two
lumdred more, tliey refused to supply it, and declared
tlieir willingness to fight sooner than give it up. They
had been allowed to remain in actual possession of tlie
town up to this time; but the weather had now become
so severe, that the priests petitioned the general to be
allowed to occupy their houses. Tlie corporation also
begged for permission to take possession of the public
buildings, then occupied by the Tanos Indians, requesting
that the latter should be sent to tlieu* pueblos on the
Galisteo.
In the meantime there were various rumors of a con-
spiracy among the Indians, and the Spaniards became
more guarded in their movements. As a matter of pre-
caution Vargas permitted the town council to occupy the
palace, but declined acting upon the petition of the priests
until the return of the men who had been sent to the
mountains to cut timber for the repair of the church of
San Miguel. They retur^aed in a few days, withont
timber, alleging that the weather was too cold for them
to bring it in. He now determined to take possession of
the public buildings, and ordered the Tanos Indians to
vacate them immediately and return to their pueblos.
■
4 Supposed to be the hill on the left hand side of the Taos road,
about three hundred yards from the plaza.
380 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO^
Upon rcceiviDg this order they appeared excited and dis^
satisfied, but said nothing; they asked permission to
remain in the bmldings nntil the next day, which was
granted them. Their condnct npon the occasion created
suspicion in the mind of Vargas that they desired the
delay, in order to accomplish some hostile purpose, which
liad the effect of putting himself and followers more upou
their guard.
?rHE CONQUEST 0^ iJEW MEXICO* 38l
CHAPTER XLIX.
THE INDIANS DEFEND SANTA FK, BUT IT IS TAKEN BY THK
SPANIARDS".
During tlie day and night of the 24th of December, the
Indians counciled among themselves and resolved to op-
pose the entrance of the Spaniards into Santa Fe, and
made preparations for that purpose. In the evening a
soldier, wlio understood their language, was in town and
overheard them talking upon this subject. lie returned
to camp about ten o'clock, and reported to Vargas what
he had heard, and the movements that were going on.
The latter immediately assembled the troops under arms,
collected the cattle, and made every preparation to attack
the enemy at daylight.
As soon as it was light enough the* next morning to
see, he marched the troops to the assault of the entrench-
ments, which he found manned by the Indians, who
saluted them as they advanced, with shouts of defiance
When the noise and confusion had subsided so that lie
could be heard, he sounded a parley, and asked for a
conference with them, being anxious to reduce them to
peace without bloodshed. He persuaded them to lay
382 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
down their arms, which they refused, but said they would
like to hold a council to determine what to do. Vargas
was not willing to allow them much time, for be was well
convinced they were awaiting reinforcements from the
Jeniez, Nabajo Apaches, and Taos Indians, but never-
theless he granted them until that afternoon to come to
terms. In tlie meantime he drew off his troops and
btntioned them as near the town as practicable ; while he
took the precaution to send the governor of the Pecos
pueblo for his warriors to reinforce him and assist in the
reduction of the ])lticc. The enemy failing to return an
imswcr to A'argas's proposition in th© afternoon, as agreed
upon, the Spanish forces were kept under arms all
niglit close to the entrenchments. The Indians spent the
night in scenes of revelry and rejoicing. They made the
town resound with tlieir war-cries and songs, and per-
formed their various dances with all the pomp attending
sucli ceremonies ; mingling their festivities with the most
insulting lani::uagc and shouts of derision to tlie Spaniards.
,Vt early dawn the next morning, Vargas commanded liis
troops to Htaiul to their arms preparatory to an assault
upon tlie works. The priests absolved anew tlie whole
coinniand, and (fhanted the Alabado. When the Indians
saw the Spaniards in battle array and witnessed the
religious exercises, they raised tlieir war-cry and discharged
a shower of arrows from the port holes, and threw stpnes
with slings from the entrenchments. The action was now
fairly commenced.
A'argas divided his troops into two divisions, one being
ordered to mount and attack the only door which com-
municated with the works, while the other was directed
to carry the entrenchments. They rushed to the assault
amid a shower of missiles, shouting the old Spanish war-
THE CONQUEST OF KEW MEXICO. 383
' cry of Santiago. The first division approached the door
and tried to cut it down, but finding it too solid to bo
thus disposed of, they set it on fire and burnt it down,
when they entered and took possession of a house that
communicated with the principal estnfa. . To reach the
plaza it \va8 yet necessary to scale the walls, which was
liazardous and could only be accomplished with con-
siderable loss ; ])ut Vargas, knowing there w-as a large
reinforcement close at hand, determined to lose no time
in the attempt, and, if possible, secure the plaza before
assistance could arrive for the garrison* He immediately
set to work making scaling ladders, and providing beams
to assist in climbing the walls ; but while thus engaged
the reinforcements for the enemy were seen approaching.
When the Indians saw their countrymen coming to their
assistance, they renewed their war-cries and made a more
fnrious resistance than before. From the first assault, a
severe and constant fire had been kept up on both sides,
to which the Indians now added boiling water which tliey
discharged upon those who were trying to undermine
their works. ^ •
Vargas now made disposition to resist this new force
and prevent it joining the garrison. For this purpose he
detailed five squadrons of cavalry, wliich were ordered to
attack and disperse them before they should reach the
town. The cavalry charged and drove them back with
the loss of five men, but they soon rallied and came mucli
nearer than before. The Spaniards now attacked them
a second time, with the loss of four w-arriors, when they
dispersed and did not again return to the charge. The
battle had now continued all day and neither party had
gained any important advantage over the other, and, as
evening drew nigh, they mutually ceased figliting.
384 tHE CONQUEST OF VPEW MEXICO
When it grew dark Vargas stationed a strong guard
around the town, commanding all the approaches, so as
to prevent the enemy leaving, or reinforcements entering
\vitliont his knowledge. One squadron garrisoned an
'cstufa which had been taken during the day. During the
night the Indians permitted some of the soldiers, with
whom they were acquainted, to enter their entrencliments,
but no attempt was made to harm them, although they
were completely in their power. The Indians had
become much disheartened because their reinforcements
had been repulsed and their chief badly wounded.
Both parties slept upon their arms, but the night passed
away without further conflict.
The contest had proved disastrous to the Indians, who
had lost heavily in killed and wounded. They were now
well convinced that it would be useless to contend lonjjer
against the Spaniards, and therefore suffered Vargas to
take possession of their entrenchments without opposition
tlic next mornini;. He iharchcd in with colors flyiuij^
and music soundinix, drove the enemv from their works,
and took ' formul po^i^ession in tiiio name of the king of
8[»tiin. He caused the royal banner to be hoisted upon
the higliest point of the entrenchments, and erected a
cross over the door. The town was now searched. In
jnany of the houses warriors were found concealed, sonic
of thcni wounded, who were first absolved by the priests
and then executed by a party under the command ot"
lv0(iue Madrid, the adjutant of the general. Four hun-
dred women and children were captured, wlio were
distributed among the Spanish families, professedly for
the purpose of converting them to christianty, but in
fact to reduce them to slavery. The property of those
^executed w^as confiscated, amomr which wore two thou-
TniE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 3S5
sand fanegas of corn, besides a large 'quantity of beans,
wheat and other articles of food. The grain was placed
Tinder a gnard to prevent it being destroyed, and it was
afterward furnished to the garrison and citizens. The
whole number of Indians killed in the capture of Santa
Fe was one Inmdred 'and sixty, including the seventy
who were executed after it was taken. Two men were
found hanging in the houses, one of whom was the
governor, whom the Indians had hung that morning after
the town had fallen.
Althougli Santa Fe was in the possession of the
^Spaniards, the Indians by no means gave up tlie contest,
but commenced a system of harassing operations whicli
they continued during the jwinter. In truth the victory
was a fruitless one, for although Vargas and his com-
mand were safe behind tlie defences of the town, thev
were beset by the Indians the moment they ventured into
the country. They made frequent attacks upon the
grazing camps and stole a number of the animals. The
settlers and soldiers were both badly armed, and many
of their guns had already been broken and rendered
worthless in their conflicts with the enemy. The Indians
took advantage of this condition of things, and their attacks
were so often repeated and so violent that Vargas became
alarmed for the safety of the garrison. In these con-
flicts a few soldiers were killed and wounded, but the
loss of the enemy was greater; several of them were
taken prisoners, who, after being absolved, were invariably
shot. To add to other misfortunes the provisions and
ammunition began to fail. A fresh supply was expected
isoon after the capture of the town, J)ut the wagons not
arriving at the appointed time, Vargas sent a party of
soldiers to Parral, in Durango, to fetch them. Tlic
25
386 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
winter passed away in unceasing conflicts between tlpc
contending parties. When spring opened, and the
weather would permit operations in the field, the general
made preparations to march against the Indians to punish
them for their hostility, and likewise to endeavor to re-
cover the stolen animals. *
He marched from Santa Fe upon this expedition in the
beginning of March, 1G94, at the head of twenty soldiers.
It began to snow the morning he started, and the storm
continued with great violence tor three days. He came
up witli the Indians on the third day on the mesai
beyond the pueblo of San Yldefonso, but the storm wa|
feo severe that he could not engage them. In the after*
noon he captured seventy head of horses. Toward evening
lie retired to the pueblo with his troops, where they took
up their quarters for the night, and threw up some slight
defences to protect themselves and animals in case of
attack. The weather was so inclement thev were obliged
to remain shut up in the village for three days, during
which time the eneniv constantly annoved them.
When tlie storm had ceased Vargas again took the,
field in pursuit of the Indians, who fled to their strong-
liold upon the mesa. He followed them thither and
reconnoitred their position, which he found to be strong,
and could not be taken without much difficulty ; but
notwithstanding the peril that must attend the enterprise,
lie ordered it to be attacked. The Indians received him
with a shower of arrows and stones, and defended their
camp with great hravery. The Spaniards soon possessed
themselves of a small hill near their trenches and wall, and
I This is a short stretch of tabic land that lies on the east bank of
the Del Norte, near the pueblo of.San Yldefonso, and was a place
of great resort for the Northern Indians.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 387
would have gained the works but for a deep riivinc that
intervened and arrest^tl tlicir progress. 1'lie action con-
tinued until late in the afternoon, when Vargas was com-
pelled to withdraw liis troops, with the loss of two meu
wounded. The enemy had fifteen killed and womided.
The next day he sent his woiuided, witli an account of
the action, to Santa Fe.
Vargas now changed his plan of operations. Leaving
a small guard in charge of his animals, he inarched with
the main body of his troops to the opposite side of the
Del Norte, where they would ]>e in a position to give
greater annoyance to the enemy, and at the same time
would be more secure from attack themselves. He
remained in camp here a few days, when tlie cold became
so intense that he found it necessary to change his posi-
tion for the safety of Ids men. He now ordered a second
attack upon the mesa. He divided liis command into
two parties, and caused tlie attack to be made at as many
points at the same time. The soldiers, eager for tlie
fray, rushed to the assault, shouting their favorite war-cry.
The ascent up the mesa slope to the Avorks of the enemy
was very steep, and the savages received them with
shouts of defiance and hurled down upon them a storm
of arrows and stones, which for a time checked their
advance. Vargas encouraged his men to renewed exer-
tions, both by word and example, but it was impossible
to overcome the resistance of the enemy, and the troops
were obliged to retire with the loss of m'ne men, wounded.
The loss of the Indians was eight or ten men killed and
several wounded. The wounded Spaniards were imme-
diately sent down to Santa Fe, together with a consider-
able quantity of supplies obtidned from the neighboring
pueblos. The Indians, knowing that part of the Spanish
.■]88 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
force bad been detacbed as escort, and supposing Vargai^
to be too- wcjik to resist tbem, determined to surprise and
overcome bim in tbe nigbt. The Spaniards, wbo were
informed of tlieir intention, were on tl!b alert and had
tbe camp and animals l)otb well guarded. Some-
time before morning tbe Indians ruslied to tbe attack in
great numbers, and seemed determined to carry all before
tbem ; but tbe soldiers met tbem witb sucb determination
and courage tbey were compelled to retire to tlie mesa
witb tlie loss of two killed, and several wounded. Being
unsuccessfid in tins attack, tbey made no furtbcr attempt
tbat nigbt.
Vargas, seeing tbere was no bope of defeating tbe
Indians in battle, on account of tbeir greatly superior
numbers — tbey being about five bundrcd strong, wbile
be bad not more tlian fifty effective men — determined, if
possible, to bring tbem to terms in some otber manner.
For tbis puii)ose be cut off tbe supply ^of water tbey
obtxiined from tbe river, a league from tbeir camp, wbich
put tbem to inconvenience, but did not bavc tlic desired
effect. lie maintained tliis condition of tilings until tbe
19tb of Marcb, wben, seeing tbat tbe enemy still beld out
witbout any indication of coming to terms, tvbilc bis own
men were sick from exposure, and tbeir ammunition
nearly exbausted, be was obliged to return to Santa Fe.
During tliis campaign more tban tbirty of tbe enemy
were killed, and a large number womuled. Vargas
destroyed or consumed all tbe provisions found in four
pueblos, and captured one bundred and luurtecn borses
and mvlofc?.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 389
CHAPTER L.
VARGAS MARCHES TO COCHITI, AND AFTERWARD MEEm
THE INDIANS ON THE MESA OF SAN YLDEFONSO.
Immediately upon his arrival at Santa Fe, Vargas,
dispatched an express to meet the party in charge of the
ammunition that was on its way up from below, with
orders to hasten their march. About this time a deputa-
tion arrived from the pueblos of Cia and Santa ^Vna, with
information that the enemy threatened-the destruction of
their villages, and asked for assistance to ward off the
blow. With this request the general was not able to
comply, for he had lately been informed that the enemy
threatened an attack upon Santa Fe, and the whole of
his force would be required for its defence. The attack,
however, was not made. Vargas was now convinced
that as long as the hostile Indians were in arms it would
be impossible for him to afford adequate jjrotection to the
citizens and friendly Indians, and therefore he concluded
to take the field again'fet them witli all his disposable force,
and compel them to sue for peace if it were possible.
He now marched for the camp of tlie enemy with a
considerable body of Spanish soldiers and some Indian
allies. Arrived there without accident, he halted his
390 THE CX)KQrEST OF 2^EW MEXICO.
forces at the foot of the mesa and made his disposition
for the attack. He divided his command into three
divisions, And at the word thev assaulted the works iipou
as many sides simultaneously. The conflict was long
and obstinate, but at last the Spaniards succeeded in
gaining the mesa, when the enemy broke and fled in
every direction. Seven Indians were killed and a large
number wounded, and thirteen men and over three hun-
dred women and children were made prisoners. Among
the spoils of war which fell into the hands of the victors
were nine hundred head of sheep and over seventy horses
and mules. The sheep and some other property were
turned over to the friendlv Indians, and the branded
mules and horses were given up to their owners. The
thirteen warriors who were taken Vere shot. The next
dav an Indian came down from the mountains in search
of the women and children, and as security against injurj*
from the trooj>&, he carried a large cross in his hand.
When brought into the presence of Vargas and ques-
tioned, he s;iiJ the Teguas and Tanos Indians had induced
his peonle to go to war, and that the latter were not to
blame. lie wiis told that all the pueblos would be destroyed
unless the inhabitants returned and lived in them. lie
was directed to inform his pe<.>ple, when he should return
to them, that they must bring in the principal men of the
rebellion, and come back to their villages and live like
Christians. Ai\ Indian named Zope was a leading man
in the present disturbance.
The following dav another warrior came into tlie
Spuuish camp, and reported that all his people were
weeping at the loss of their families; that they had
already made Zepe and five other leading men prisoners,
and were only waiting to capture a few more when %ey
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 391
would bring tliem in. The fourth day after the fight
Vargas sent a pack train and the wounded down to Santa
Fe, under an escort. He established a grazing camp
three leagues off, where he placed a guard, and the
babnce of his men, only thirty-six in number, occupied
the pueblo the Indians had built upon the mesa. The
enemy seeing the Spaniards in this weakened condition,
and thinking they might be easily overcome, made
an attack upon them. It was so sudden and unex-
pected that they gained the mesa and had possession of
all the outlets of the streets of the pue!blo before their
approach even was known. It was a complete surprise,
and Vargas found himself surrounded by the foe. The
Indians continued the assault for some time, but the
Spaniards rallying and defending themselves with great
bravery, some of the captives being put to death, and
the enemy seeing they could not gain possession of the
place, drew off and retired to the mountains. During
the combat one hundred and fifty of the prisoners effected
their escape and joined the enemy. The general suc-
ceeded in holding the mesa until the 24th, when he was
reinforced by the guard which had been in charge of the
grazing camp on the west side of the river. In crossing
the river corporal Almazan, one of the best soldiers of the
little army, was drowned, a loss which caused great grief
to Vargas.
At this tune Vargas received information from the
officer in command at Santa Fe, that the town had been
attacked by a very large body of Indians, which deter-
mined him to return immediately to that place to give
assistance to the garrison. H# loaded his wagons with
grain, set fire to the pueblo, and took up his march with
the ju-isoners. That night he encamped at the old pueblo
392 THE CONQUEST OF XEW ILEXICa
of San Yldefonso, where he liberated the relatives of the-
friendly Indians taken in the fight. Here he gave the
command of the troops to captain Boqiii Madrid^ and set
out for Santa Fe, with a few soldiers as an escort, where
lie arrived the next day, the 2otli, at three o'clock in
the afternoon. He received the most flattering reception
from the clei^, the citizens and soldiers. The enemy
had retired before his arrival^ and the inhabitants were
relieved of tlieir fears. Captain iLxdrid, with the re-
mainder of the troops and tlie train, arrived there on the
27th, without ntolestation from the Indians.
Tliere was now a short interval of peace, for the first
time since the second entrance of Yar^ras into the countrv.
At\er everything had been properly arranged, the
prisoners disposed of, and the animals sent to secure
grazing ground, he turned his attention to peaceful pur-
suits of equally pressing importance. As sprmg was
about to open, seed-time claimed his attention, and he
made the necessary preparations for putting in the crops.
T-.and3 around Santa Fe were assigned to the soldiers for
j)lanting purposes, and a guard was detailed to protect
those who worked in the fields. He also visited Tezuque,
three leagues distant, to ascertain v;hether the inliabit-
jiuts were putting in their crops ; but he found the pueblo
deserted, and no indication that the Indians had been
there for some time. He saw no fresh trails of the enemy
in that neighborhood.
In the early part of April Vargas visited the pueblo
of Cocliiti, in the valley of the Del ^Xortc for the purpose
of settling the inhabitants of that, and the villages of
Santo Domingo, San Feipe, and other neighboring ones,
in their old pueblos ; and also to procure a supply of corn
for the use of the garrison and citizens of Santa Fe.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 393^
^VTiil© at CocLiti he received a letter from friar Francisco
Forfan, .dated Los Patos, sixteen days' joiurney below El
Paso, April the 3d. The reverend father, who was on
his way, from Mexico to Santa Fe, with several families
of emigrants, complained hc*ivily of the severe hardsliips
he enconntered. He says, among other things: "I have
lost over one hnndred and fifty mules ; some have been
stolen, some strayed, and others have died ; and the
wagons are so heavy that it requires two pair of mules
for the empty ones." Tlio poor friar attributed all his
mishaps on the road to the " devil with many legions, by
Divine permission, in punishment of my sins." In speak-
ing of the scarcity of provisions at El P;vso he states that
corn was not to be had there, and says that the fathers
wrote him, that if they dined they did not sup, and if
they supped they did not dine. These arc but few of
the severe trials these selt-denying men were compelled
to underoro in settlin;^ Xev/ ilexico, and convertin;]? the
heathen to Christianity. *
On the morning of the ISth of April an Indian of the
pueblo of San ilarcos visited Vargas at Cochiti, with a
cross in his hand, and told him that his peoi)le were
anxious to re-inhabit %ieir pueblo, if they were permitted
to do 80. He was directed to return and tell them tliev
might re-occupy it upon condition that they v.'ould bring
in Zepe and all the other principal men of the rebellion,
tied. The next day two other Indians came to him
with information that nearly all the principal men had
been captured, and were then tied, and they were only
waiting to catch a few others they were then in pursuit
of, when they would bring them all in. Presents were
distributed among them, and they departed well pleased.
In the absence of Vargas, they had had more stirring
394 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
times at Santa Fe. The Indians appeared before it in
force on the 19th, and commenced an attack about nine
o'clock in the morning. Some were mounted and others
on foot. The garrison was weak, but defended itself
with determined bravery. . ^he troops marched out under
the command of Louis Granillo, the commandant, to
meet the enemy, and after a fight of three hours suc-
ceeded in beating them oflF. They pursued them in
their retreat as far as Tezuque, but being poorly mounted,
while the Indians had good animals, they were unable to
overtake them. The Spaniards sustained the loss of one
man killed, a friendly Indian named Bernardino, and had
fifteen horses run oft* from the Cieni^a.i The enemv also
stole the stock of Eusobia do A'argas. Granillo sent word
of the attack to the ircncral the same dav, and besoufrht
t
Jiim not to be alarmed for the safety of the town.
In the meantime Vargas remained at the pueblo of
Cochiti. On the 20th the war-captain of S:in Felipe
'came in and informed him that they had captured nine
of tlie leaders of the rebellion, including the chief Zepe,
and. asked that the prisoners belonging to his pueblo
should be liberated. This he dechned to do until the
caj^tives were delivered to him, allJb:ing that the Indians
had deceived him once, and he would not trust them
airain. The war-captain tried various means to accom-
plish his object, but failed. He went away promising
faithfully to bring in and deliver up the captive chiefs.
About two o'clock in the afternoon of the next dav a
•
largo body of Indians made an attack upon Cochiti. At
the time there were but thirty-six soldiers in the village,
the remainder having been sent out with the animals to
graze, and as an escort for the train that went to Santa
* ■— .■ I ■■■ _ I --.^i ■» — ■ ■ ■ ■!■»■■■ -^ ■ ■ 1 ^T^— ^^
1 Meadows near Uie town.
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 395
Fe, loaded with corni The troops were entirely off their
guard, and had not their armor on when the attack was
made, and the prisoners were engaged ia shelling corn.
They flew to arms at the first alarm, and fought the
Indians man to man, and after a desperate struggle suc-
ceeded in beating them off, but owing to their small
number they were unable to pursue them. More than half
the prisoners made ilieir escape during the fight. Vargas*
immediately called in thetroops from the grazing camp,
and took the necessary measures to resist a second attack.
The horses were placed in the plaza, with a strong guard
over them, and twenty were ordered to be kept saddled
all night, to be ready to mount in case of a sudden
assault. Loop-holes were cut in the houses in which- the
soldiers were quartered, to' enable them to defend them-
selves with more security. The enemy, however, did not
renew the attack.
Vargas now held a council with the principal captains
of the pueblos of San Felipe, Santa Ana and Cia, and
afterward liberated the prisoners belonging to these vil-
lages, lie furnished them with a small escort to protect
them* on their way home, and also a guard while planting
their coni, cotton, and other crops. They took their
departure much pleased with the treatment they had re-
ceived. Having accomplished the object of his visit to this
place, Vargas left Cochiti on the 22d, for Santa Fe, where
he arrived the, same afternoon. The train, with corn,
came in soon after his arrival. Upon his return he com-
pleted tlie distribution of the lands abandoned by the
Indians among the citizens and soldiers, which he super-
intended in person.
The war-captain of the pueblo of Pecos, accompanied
396 THE CONQUEST QF NEW MEXICO;
by a deputation of eight Farreom Apaches, from the-
plains, made him a visit on the 2d of May. After hold-
ing a talk with them he gave them chocolate served upon,
a silver plate. He asked them if there was any of that
kind of metal in their country, and told them if there was-
lie would like them to bring it to him, " as it was very
good for sore eyes and disease of the heart" They
replied there was plenty of it at the foot of a small hill,,
where it was found in large rocks ; that it was very.hard,
and they had no means of brewing it ; but if he wonld
give them an ax they would bring some of it to him. He
asked them many questions about tlieir country, particn-^
larly tlie distance from it to the country of the Tejas,
which they said was six or seven days' journey to the first
viUages. He next inquired if there were any Spaniards
in that country, to which they replied there had been
some there ; l)ut as they, the Indians, had not been there
for some years, they could not tell whether they were
there at that time. Vargas thought this information of
importance, as he believed the Spaniards spoken of be-
longed to the expeditions which counts Monclova and
(lalvcs, when viceroys, had sent into that country. Tlic
Indians said there were many watering places and a
number of largo rivffrs on the road, large herds of buf-
taloes, and an abundance of fruit in the summer season.
On l)ein;x asked the distance from their countrv to that of
tlie Quivira, they said it wtis from twenty-five to thirty
days' journey ; tliat they knew that country well, as they
went there for captives to buy horses with. Tlie general
then made them a present of an ax, and told them to re-
turn by roasting-ear time to meet him at P^os, w^hen he
would give them permission to trade with the Spaniards
2 Probably the same as the Faraon Apaches*
THE COXQUEST OF NEW ^rEXlCO. 3J)7
lind Pueblo Indians, They left well pleased, saying they
would return at the time appointed.*
The Indians made another attack upon Santa Fe, and
nttempted to run oil* the animals, on the 25th of May, but
the cattle hcin<x scattered amoni): the hills, and the cjuard
making a stout resistance, they did not succeed. None
were killed on cither sidb, but a Taos Indian was made
prisoner. The garrison was kept under arms, on the
plaza, until seven o'clock in the evening, when the guard
and animals arriving in safety, they were dismissed. No
further hostile demonstration was made. ' The prisoner,
upon being questioned, informed Vargas tliat the ten
pueblos of the Teguas and Tanos, the three pueblos of
Taos, with the Indians of Jemcz, Picoris, and a few of
the Queres nation from the mesa of Cochiti, had risen in
arms and were assembled ready to commence hostilities.
Upon receipt of this information Vargas resolved to
anticipate the attack of the rebels, and the same evening
lie left Santa Fe with his disposable force for the mesa
of San Yldefonso, where they were assembled. IIo
arrived there about four o'clock in tlic morning, and
made immediate dispositions to attack their camp. He
stationed his troops at different points of the mesa, and
sent his horses ovCr the river so they would be secure
from capture. In malving a reconnoissance of the enemy's
position he succeeded in capturing one of their principal
chiefs, a boy twelve or fourteen years of age, and several
horses. The charge l)eing now sounded, the troops rushed
to the attack. The Indians met them half way up the
slope, when a long and severe struggle took place for the
]>ossession of the mesa, which resulted in Vargas being
c>bliged to retire, leaving the eiu iny in possession of the
lie! J 'Vhr [mliau ^.K^^ wn.^. uue killed and one wounded,
M
398 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
the latter bcinpf carried to the Spanish camp where liia
wounds were dressed, 'and twenty-eight head of animals
captured. The troops retired a short distance, to draw
the Indians down from the mesa so they could meet tlieui
upon more equal grounds. They pursued tlie retiring
Spaniards into the bottom, where a second light took
place, in which the latter were completely victorious.
The loss of the enemy was one killed and one wounded,
that of the soldiers not being mentioned. The same
night the general returned to Santa Fc with the animals
he had captured, and delivered them to their respective
owners.
Vargas remained but one day at Santa Fe, w^hen he
returned again to the mesa of San Yldefonso, for the
purpose of driving the Indians entirely from it, as he had
left many there atler the last light. He hoped to be able
to draw them down Jigain upon level ground where he
could engage them to better advantage. He arrived
within three leagues of their position about two o'clock in
the morning, whence he could see their camp fires burning
brightly. He continued his march to a creek near by,
. where he halted and threw out spies to reconnoitre their
camp. They returned about nine o'clock, and reported
that the Indians were still upon the mesa, and from the
stir and bustle in their camp they must have discovered
the approach of the troops. Vargas determinedto attack
them without further delay. He divided his force into
tliree divisions and marched them to the river, hopmg
to be able to capture a straggling Indian from whom ho
could obtain information. He saw two of the enemy a
little way off, but both of them were killed while attempt-
ing to escape. Here the Spaniards halted and break-
fasted. He now made a careful reconnoissauce of the sur-
THE CONQUEST OF iJEW MEXICO. 390
rounding country, and succeeded in capturing a Tanos
Indian. The prisoner gave information that a large
number of the Taos, Picoris, Jemez, and other Indians
had left the mesa and returned to their respective pueblos
to plant their crops ; and that those who remained liad
planted hi the vaUey of the Del Norte. As the Indians had
generally returned to their villages, and seemed disposed
to plant, Vargas deemed it most prudent not to molest
them. They had been a good deal harassed since hostil-
ities commenced, and had lost many men, and ho
judged they would be more likely to come in and make
terms if allowed to put in their crops in peace. He
therefore returned with the troops to Santa Fe, to give?
them rest after the hard service they had performed, a.s
also to aflford proper protection to the town in case it
should be again attacked by the enemy.
i
•400 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO
CHAPTER LI.
TUK nrDIAXS A(;AIN become IIOSTiLE, AND VAKGAS MAKCHE8
ACiMNST THE TAOS PUEBLO&
•
After the return of Vargas from the mesa of San
Yldcfonso to Santa Fe, as narrated at the close of the
last chapter, there was again a short interval of peace.
Tlie Indians were engaged in planting, while the Span-
iards also prepared their lields and put in their crops,
and recruited themselves •t*ter the severe service of the
past winter and spring. About tin's time a considerable
reinlbrccment of settlers arrived from El Paso, who were
quartered and supported in the town until lands could be
assii^ned them and they were in a condition to raise
crops and support themselves. The wagons, witli a
supply of ammunition and provisions, did not reach
Santa Fe until late in June.
The Indians having finished planting, resumed hostil-
ities. On the 14th of June a party from Jemez made an
attack upon Cia and Santa Ana, two friendly pueblos,
and ran olf their stock. The inhabitants sent word of it
■
to Vargas, and asked for protection. He dispatclied ten
mounted men to assist in their defence, but when the
soldiers reached the Del Norte thev found it so mucl.i
THE CONQUEST OF ^EW MEXICO. 40l
•swollen by the melting snow and rains, tliat they were
unable to cross. The river continued liigli for several days,
and on tlie 30th it was still impassable. In tlie mean
while, however, the Teguas and other Indians, on the east
side of the river, having committed depredations Vargas
determined to march against them. He left Santa Fe,
with his disposable force, in the direction of tlic mesa ol
Sau Yldefonso, and the same day he came within sight
of a party of fourteen of the enemy, to whom he gavi
chase. He succeeded in killing eleven, while tlie re-
mainder made their escape to the mesa. In the evening lie
encamped upon the bank of the Del Norte. The Indian-
he was pursuing had been joined by those of the pueblo-;
of Taos and Picoris; and he was satisfied, from the traiL
and other signs, that the enemy were around him on
• all sides. Leaving his camp he marched directly t<'
Picorfs to chastise the inhabitants of that village, in cast-
they should be hostile. Upon entering the pueblo li;-
found it deserted. lie caused a cross to be erected <n?
the plaza, when he retired some little distance and eii-
. camped; thus giving evidence to the Indians that ho di<!
not interfd to injure them. During the night the tire-
of the enemy were seen burning along the base of'th.
mountains in many directions, but his camp was not di.--
turbed.
The next mornincc he resunie<l the march lV)r Tao:
His route lay through a country very rough and dilKcul*
of travel, and the Indians made several hostile dcmo^:
strations, but did not attack Jiim. lie pursued his cour.--
without opposition, and entered the pue])lo on the ai'tei
noon of the 3d of July. He found all the houses deserted,
but in most of them crosses had been erected as a prote*^-
,tion from pillage. Fearing an ambuscade, he took tlu»
26
402 THE CONQUEST OP NEW K^XtCO.
necessary precaution against it. Supposing the ln^
clians had fled to a very deep gorge, in a neighboring
mountain, he marched thither to explore it. On his way
he was met by a party of friendly Apaches from thf
plains, who informed liim that the Taos Indians had lei't
their pueblo that morning, and sought safety in a mountaii^
ravine called the funnel. They liad requested the Apache:^
to go and meet thfe Spaniards, telling them they would
not be harmed. Vargas continued his march, and as ht-
drew near their place of refuge he discovered their caju}^
at the entrance of the gorge. Some of the Indians niadt-
their appearance, whom he invited to come and hohl n
ctouncil, pledging himself not to injure them. The chief,
Pachcco, responded and came out to him, but he could
not be persuaded to retm*n with his people to the puebk».
Seeing the eflfort fail, the governor of Pecos requested
permission to remain all night with the rebels in order to
liavc H talk and endeavor to persuade them to return U
their village. Tlic Indians, with their arms in tliciv
!i:iiuls, were now seen descending the momitain in great
'UHiihers, and Vargas fearing they might do some injurv
ti) the governor, should he remain among them, endeav-
ored to dissuade him from stajnng; but persisting in
his request permission was at length given liim. It
u'as now late in the day, and Vargas returned to his
coinniand, w-hich had halted and encamped a short dis-
tance in the rear. Upon bidding adieu to Pacheco la
t( Id him he would expect to see him at camp the nex;
morning, but the chief made no response.
Some time in the night after the troops had retired to
rest, a confused noise was heard in the direction of the
enemy, and in the course of an hour four or five rebel In-
dians came in and inlbrmed Vargas that the governor of
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 403
Pecos had sent for his warriors to assist them in fighting
the Spaniards. This he did not believe, and was incensed
at the deception they wished to practice. He told the mes-
sengers to inform the Taos Indians that if they were not
in their pueblo by one o'clock the next day he would
destroy it, with its contents, and if tliey» should do the
least injury to the governor of Pecos nothing could save
them from his wrath. He further directed them to
release him immediately if they had him prisoner. There
was no further alarm during the night. The Indian?
not coming down from the mountain and occupying
the pueblo by the 'time fixed by the general, he gave
his soldiers orders to sack it, which was accordingly
done. They found in it a considerable quantity of corn,
which was shelled and put into sacks for the use of tln^
troops. Some of the Indians came down to get corn for
their families, and Vargas allowed them to carry a part
of it away for this purpose. On the night of the 5th n
great number of fires were seen blazing around, and tlie
general thought the enemy meditated an attack, but none
was made. He now prepared to return to Santa Fe.
The friendly Indians advised him that his only chance to
carry the com with him was to march through the Utah
country, as the roads were so bad on the other routes that
he would not be able to get along with the packs. He
followed their advice, and took the course they pointed
out.
He left camp at two o'clock the next morning, choosing
this hour as the one when the enemy would be less likely
to observe his movements. "When he had marched about
a league the Indians made signal fires, which were an-
swered by others on the mountains, along the base of
which he was marching. Six or seven leagues furtlier on
I
•
404 THE CONQUEST 'OF NEW MEXICO.
'lie came to a creek, on tlie bank of which there was aSi *
Indian ambuscade about an hundred strong. Some at-
tached his advance, while others attempted to capture
the packs, but they were repulsed on all sides, with the
loss of five killed and Several wounded. A warrior, badly
wounded, was made prisoner, who stated that the whole
of the enemy were on the road waiting for the Spaniards,
and that the chief, Pacheeo, had thirty spies watching
their movements. They were seen to leave camp, and
•the fires were kindled to give notice to the Indians.
Having obtained this information from their prisoner, he
was absolved and then shot.
A'argas marched through a mountainous and well-
timbered region, and at six o'clock the same afternoon,
reached the Colorado, the first stream of the Utah
country. He caused a number of fires to be built to in-
vite the Indians to his camp, but none came. He
continued his route, and on the 9th reached the Del
Xorte, down which he marched about three leagues to a
■point where the river divides and forms an island. The
next day he crossed the river and marched four leagues
to a beautiful vallev filled with buflaloes which furnished
ft/
food tor the Utahs. These Indij\ns allowed no other
people than the Spaniards, with whom they traded, to
enter their country. They had expelled the neighboring
tribes which caused a long and bloody war. When he
leached this point his provisions were exhausted, and the
troops had to subsist upon corn, which they parched ;
lie halted here for the day, to allow time for the Utahs to
come in, and also to afiord the soldiers an opportunity to
procure a supply of fresh meat. He sent gut a hunting
^)arty of eighty men in pursuit of buffalo, but they only
-iiucceeded in kiUing fifteen, and a few large deer. They
HHE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO*
405
saw immense herds, but when they were fired at, they
ran away with such swiftness that but few could be over-
taken. That night they had a grand feast in camp and
made the mountains resound with their merriment. The-
next day Vargas, with an hundred men, went out
Jiunting, but they were not able to kill as many as the
first party, and only brought in ten J|)uflaloes and a few
deer. He caused the meat to bo cut up and packed to
be ready to move early in the morning.
Abou£ daylight, as the Spaniards were preparing to
march, the camp was attacked on all sides by about three
hundred Indians. They sounded their war-cry and
discharged a shower of arrows. As they were supposed
to bo Utahs, the soldiers had orders to act only on tluj
defensive, as Vargas did not desire to come to blows with
tliat powerful tribe ; but five of his men being already
wounded and the Indians still continuing their fire, he
ordered a general attack, in which eight Spaniards were
killed. The guard being now mounted, charged the
enemy ; and meanwliile the remainder of the soldiers hud
time to mount and come to their support. The Indians
immediately commenced a retreat. A river was near tlu;
camp, which they were obliged to cross, and as it was
dimcult of passage, and they carried their killed and
wounded with them, they met with considerable loss in
crossing. They succeeded, however, in getting over,
and when they had reached the opposite side they hoisted
a deer-skin in token of peace, and cried, in the language
of their country, A7ic/ie^ Paviche^ the first meaning
" brother," and the second " friend." From this signal
they were recognized to bo Utalis, and were imdted to
come to the Si)anish camp, where they wxre kindly
received.
406 THE CONQUEST OF NEW KEXICO.
Upon being asked why they had made the at^u^ upon
the Spaniards, they gave the following reason in excuse*
They said the Indians aronnd Santa Fe had often invaded
their country dressed and armed like Spaniards, and
under this guise had done them a great deal of harm.
They had come upon the camp in the night and were not
able to distinguish yhether or not they were Spaniards,
jmd therefore they made the attack. They expressed a
desire to live upon friendly terms with the Spaniards, and
as evidence of this had called them brothers and friends.
They had suffered some loss in the action ; and among
the killed was a brother of one of their captains, but they
manifested no regret at his death. Vargas gave the
captain of the Utahs a horse and some other articles, at
which he was much pleased. In return he invited tlie
general to go to his camp, telling liim he had a good deal
of peltry, and would like to trade. This invitation was
declined, but the chief was invited to bring his skins
down to Santa Fe, where he could barter to better ad-
vantage. The Indians tlien left the Spanish camp well
fciatistied with their treatment.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO, 407
CHAPTER LIL
AN" EXPEDITION MARaiES AGAINST JEMEZ, WITH THE
BESULT; CONCLUSION.
Resuming the inarch after the skirmish with the Utah
Indians, the Spaniai-ds in two days reached the Ojo
Caliente river without opposition ; and in two days more
they passed the boundary of the Utah country. The
general moved with great caution along this part of his
route, being appreliensive the Indians might attack him
in retaUation for those killed in the late action, but he
was not molested. He passed on the way an abandoned
pueblo wliich he supposed to be that of San Gabriel, the
same at which Don Juan de Oilate had encamped and
named. It was situated six leagues from the junction of
the river Zamai with the Del Norte. Continuing down
the western bank of the latter river to a point just above
the pueblo of San Juan, he crossed over to the eastern
side and encamped. As soon as his presence was known,
the rebel Indians of that vicinity kindled signal fires on
the mesa to give information of his approach to those of
San Yldefonso. He broke up his camp the next morning,
-and putting the main body of his troops en route for
.T Tbaaame as the river Chama.
408 THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO.
Santa Fe by the direct road, he proceeded with a gnard*
of forty men to reconnoitre the mesa. On approaching
it he found a large number of Indians assembled there,
who received him with their war-cry and shouts of defi-
ance, and being strongly posted they tried to draw him
into a fight. This he declined because of the small num-
ber of Iiis force and his being encumbered with his pack-
mules, lie continued his march to rejoin the main body
across a rough and rocky country to the pueblo of
Pojuaque, being pursued by the enemy, who made many
vienionstrations of attack. The trooi)s encamped thafc
night at the pueblo of Tezuque, while Vargas marched
to Santa Fe, where he arrived at three o'clock the same
afternoon, the 14th of July. He had been absent seven-
teen davs, and durinjir the time had marched one hundred
and twenty leagues.
IJv this time the Del Norte havin^r fallen so as to be
fordable witliout danger, Vargas determined to march
!iito the Quercs nation, to protect them from the threat-
ened attack of the Jenicz Indians. Another motive
svliich induced liim'to make a campaign thither, was to
<)btain a supply of corn for Santa Fe. lie left the capital
with a force of one hundred and twentv mounted men,
but did not inform liis oflicers of the object of the expedi-
tion until he arrived at the pueblo of La Ciencguilla.::
Thence he proceeded to Santo Domingo, where he left it
small force under the command of his lieutenant-ojeneral.
At this place he received, information, by an Indian ex-
press, that on the day before the Jemez and Apache
2 The exact situation of this pueblo is not known at the present day,
but it was somewhere between Santa Fd and Santo Domingo. Some
ruins are found in the cailon of the river of Santa Fe, and these ma^
be the rcmainaof La Cieaeguia, as it is sometimes spelled..
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MiSXICO. 4C9
5ndians had made an attack upon the pueblo of Cia and
killed four of the inhabitants. He ininiediatelv sent tlic
express back with word tliat he was on his march witli
relief. lie crossed the Del Norte i!i sight of the mesa of
San Felipe, and marched direct for Cia. lie had not
])roceeded far when he was met bv captain Burtolome de
Ojeda, a friendly Indian, who thanked hhn in the name
of his people f(.)r the assistance he was about to render tlio
friendly pueblos. Vargas dispatched Ojeda ba<:k to Cia
;ind directed him to tell the inhabitants that he would
march to Jcmcz, in the first instiince, to chastise these
Indians, and that they must be ready to accompany him
];v the time he should arrive at tlieir vil!a<]:e. . *
He reached the pueblo of Santa Ana, on Friday, tho
23d of July, and entered Cia the same afternoon at sun-
set. Tlie inhabitants awaited his cominci: with 'iTcat
anxiety, and welcomed him as their deliverer. He re-
sumed the march for Jemez, without delay, accompanied
by a number of Indian allies ; having arranged his plan ot*
attack upon that village with the governor and caciqiiO
of Cia before he started. The Indians of Santa Ana and
Cia, witli twenty-live soldiers, were to make the attacl:
on the side next the cultivated fields, and on the road
that led to the Teguas nation, while tlie balance of the
furce, under the command of Vargas in person, was to
assault the opposite side of the town. Upon reaching the
pueblo he found the Indians had abandoned it, and gone
upon the hill, near by. They had moved everything up,
even to the timber of their houses, intending to build a
new village there. The Spaniards reached the foot of
the hill about sunrise, when Vargas ordered his division
of the forces to dismount preparatory to making the ascent,
at the same time directing the command of Eusebio Var-
410 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
gas to go ronnd to the opposite side and make the ascent
there. The Indians discovered their approach, but by
reason of the assault being made at two points, at the
same time, their attention and force were divided, and
they were not able to make so good a defence as they
might have made under other circumstances.
The Indians, however, offered a determined resistance.
They discharged a shower of arrows, and also rolled down
large stones upon the assailants. After a spirited contest,
captain xVntonio Georje succeeded in possessing himsell'
of one of the entrances to the works, when the Indians
retreated, some throwing themselves headlong from the
top of the hill. The troops pursued the enemy, but
owing to the roughness of the country they could not be
overtaken. As soon as the soldiers had taken possession
of the peiiol, or hill, they entrenched themselves and
prepared for defence. In the meantime several of the
Indians who had been driven from the hill had manned
their liouses and again opened a lire upon the Spaniards.
The houses were lired, and four warriors and one woman
were burned to death ; fifty-five were left dead upon the
field, and ^two made prisoners who were afterward shot.
The whole number which fell before the place was taken
was eighty-four, and three hundred and seventy women
and children were captiu*ed. Eusebio Vargas killed
fifteen with his own hands. There were taken from the
enemy one hundred and seventy-six head of sheep, of
which number one hundred head were given to the gov-
ernor of Cia for the use of his i)coi)le, and the balance
were divided among the soldiers. The four horses cap-
tured were given to the ofiicers. Among the spoils
was a large quantity of corn, which was first taken to the
old pueblo and shelled, and was afterward sent to
THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXICO. 411
Santa Fe, a present supply for the troops. The prison-,
ers, under a guard of forty soldiers and eighty friendly
Indians, were marched to the old pueblo, and a guard of
twelve men and a corporal was left in command of the
penol. In his report to tlie viceroy Vargas says : " This
action having been fought the day before Santiago day,
I believe that that glorious apostle and patron interceded
in our behalf, and wliich was the cause of our signal
success."
Vargas remained encamped at the pueblo several days,
in which time he collected and sent three liundrcd fanegas
of shelled com to the inhabitants of Santa Fe. On the
evening of the eighth day the guard on the penol cap-
tured an old Indian, who was conveyed to headquarters
and interrogated. Upon being asked where his people
were, he replied that they were scattered over the coun-
try ; but the response not suiting Vargas, he ordered him
to be absolved and then shot. Tlie next day another spy
was brought in, who, ui)on being questioned, said that he
belonged to the Queres nation, and knew where the
Indians had concealed their corn ; ho was placed in con-
finement to be of future use. When the friendly Indians
who had convoyed the corn to Santa Fe returned, they
informed Vargas that this prisoner was a war-chief of the
enemy, an^ had been sent to Acoma and Zufii to per-
suade these Indians to declare war against the Spaniards.
Vargas was anxious to obtain the remains of friar Juan
de%esus, who was killed during the rebellion, but had
fiome difficulty in finding his burial place. An old man and
woman professed to know the place where he had been
buried, and Vargas accompanied them to the old pueblo
to have them point it out. They designated a spot near
the estufa, and upon examination being made bones were
•*12 THE CONQUEST OF NEW MEXieO;
discovered, wliich, frdtai their size, were declared to. have
belonged to the deceased priest. A portion of his clothr
ing was found in the grave; and a piece of an arrow,
about six inches long, was sticking in the back-bone.
The remains were disinterred which, after proper religions
ceremony had been performed, were taken to camp.
Vargas marched from Jemez on the 8th of August, the
guard on the pcfiol first setting fire to tlie houses and
joining the main body in the pueblo below. lie ai'rived
at Santa Fc on tlie 24th,3 without meeting the least op-
position from the Indians. The next day after liis arrival
the remains of father Jesus, which tliey had brought
from Jeme2, were interred in the parish church with
appropriate religious services. They were placed in
a coffin lined with yellow damask, together with a certi-
ficate setting forth the circumstances of their discovery, a
duplicate of which was forwarded to the custodian in
3Iexico. Priest Jesus had been killed on the second dav
of the rebellion, and it was just fourteen years from his
death to his burial at Santa Fe. On the loth two Jemez
Indians came in with proposals of peace, who said they
luul been sent by the governor and the whole nation to
ask for peace, and the restoration of their wives and chil-
dren. A treaty was made with them, and again the
i^onqucror and the conquered were on friendly terms
with cacli other.
Peace being now restored, the two races for a time
maintained amicable relations, and no further disturt^ee
3 There must be an error in the day of the month when Vsu-gas
arrived at Santa Fe from Jemez, as the distance between these points
is only a little more than fif^y miles, and the troops, being all mounted,
shoulc^ have marched it in two or three days. They probably arrived
there on the 10th, and buried the remains of the priest on the 11th:.
The old MSS. give no further information on this point.
THE CONQUEST OP NEW ^USXICO. 413
took place until 1696, When a partial rebellion ^broke out.
In that year the Indians took advantage of a famine, that
prevailed to an alarming extent, to rise in arms. This
famine is noted in the annals of New Mexico, and Vargas
himsell* is charged with being the cause of it. The year
before, priest Antonio Farfan brought to the country seven
hundred fanegas of corn intended for the support of the
garrison and citizens of Santa Fc. It was delivered to
Vargas who, instead of appropriating it to its legitimate
object, made use of it for his private purposes. He issued
n little to the citizens, as a special favor, giving them a
lljfttefnl, each, at a time. Tliere was corn enough to last
^ir- months, had it all been distributed, but tlic general
retained so much for his own use that the balance did not
last more than one month. The consequence was, that
a severe famine took place the following year. The
people suffered terribly. They were reduced to such
want that they ate all the dogs, cats, horses, mules, and
l)ull-hides they could lay their hands on, and idso boiled
and roasted all the herbs they could collect ; and the
dried bones of horses and mules were picked up m\d
boiled for fioup. After they had consumed all the filth
they could find they went to the mountains and roamed
about for food like wild animals. Many persons, l)oth
citizens and soldiers, to save their lives liired tliem-
selves and their \rives to the Indians to lu'ing wood and
water and grind corn. During the famine over two hun-
dred persons died of starvation and from eating filthy and
unwholesome food. Four of the citizens deserted chirino-
this trying time and made their way to El Pjiso, from
which place they were brought back* by Juan Paes Hur-
tado, the commanding oflicer at that place. A'arsas
caused them to be hung, and even denied them the last
414 THE COXQUEST OF NEW MEXICO.
consolation of religion. Their wives and children were
left in a most destitute condition.
The Indians, beholding the distre^ed and weakened
condition of the Spaniards, considered it a favorable mo-
ment to take up arms, and accordingly, in the month of
June, 1696, they broke out in rebellion. The conspiracy
extended among fourteen pueblos. Thej' put to deatli
thiity-four Spaniards and five priests — many of the fornier
having been driven among tliem to find subsistence — and
burnt the churches and desecrated the sacred vessels.
Durinc: the rebellion "more than two thousand Indians
perished in the mountains, while as many more deser^
tlieir \'illages and joined the ^\^ld tribes, leaving tne
country in many parts neai'ly depopulated.
In the year 1695 the coi^poration of Santa Fe, and the
regiment in garrison there, presented charges to the
Wceroy against Vargas, for pecnilation. He was accused
of using the public money for his private purj)oses, instead
of expending it for the benefit of the citizens, for whicli
o])ject tlie government had appropriated it. In their
] etition they set forth immerous sums of money tliat lie had
(h'iuvn from the public treasury at divers times to pnr-
cliase corn and other provisions, and horses and mules
\oY the settlers, and thev charti-ed him with sellincr the
animals and putting the money into his own pocket. He
was also accused of having drawn drafts and received
money for expenses never incurred. For these causes he
was removed from oflice in 1697, and Don Pedro Eodri-
i]!:uez Cubero was appointed in his place. How long Cubero
remained in oflice the records do not inform us ; neither
have I been able to find anv account of his admhiistration.
In 1 703, however, Vargas was again sent into New lllexico,
as' the military commandant of the province, which woiiid
THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO. 415
lead UB to infer that he had been acquitted of the charges
made against him eight years before, and once more
enjoyed the confidence of the viceroy. The Spanish
conquest of New Mexico may be said to have been com-
pleted at this period, and the power of the Indian nations
completely broken. The authority of the Spaniards was
acknowledged in all the pueblos, and both civil and ec-
clesiastical jurisdiction was extended over them.*
4 The Pueblo Indians of New ^Mexico, once so numerous and power-
ful, at the present day inhabit twenty-six villages situated principally
in the valley of the Del Nort<5, and the whole population does not ex-
ceed ten thousand. Anciently they composed four distinct nations,
speaking as many languages, namely, the Piros, Teguas, Queres, and
Taguos or Tanos, but the villages of the latter have gone to nrins and
the population passed away ; or if any of thorn remain, they have
become incorporated with other pueblos. They still live in little com-
munities, distinct from the Mexican population, and are governed by
their owa local customs and laws. Each village is distinct from the
others, and, there is no common bond of union between them. Their
officers are a governor, a justice of the peace, or alcalde, styled
caciqtie, & fiscal, or constable, to execute the laws, and a "council
of wise men." These are the civil officers, and in addition there is a
** war-captain," who attends to military affairs. They have been made
to embrace Christianity and worship ^according to the forms of the
Roman Catholic church, priests being stationed in many of the vil-
lages. They are a quiet and orderly people, and form a meritorious
class of the population of the territory. They are industrious and
frugal, and live in harmony with each other and the surrounding 3Iex-
icau population. A few hundred acres of land belong to each pueblo
■which, for purposes of cultivation, is pjirceled out to the respective
families. They raise grains, vegetables and fruits, manufacture some
wine, and possess considerable flocks and herds. They cultivate by
means of irrigation. They have retained, in a great measure, their
aboriginal costume, and dress either in skins, or woolen goods of their
own manufacture. Their food is simple and wholesome, consisting
mainly of beans, peppers and com-meal, which are prepared in a
manner peculiar to these people. They are ignorant and superstitious,
but brave ; and instead of increasing hi numbers appear to be gradually
decreasing.
i
41B THE CONQUEST OP NEW MEXICO
It is the belief of maoy persons that the Pueblo IndiaDs of New Mexicc
were reclaimed from a wild state and were settled in villages by the
Spaniards, an error it is hardly necessary to combat after the proof to
the contrary to be found in this volume. This race is identical with
the one the Spaniards found in New Mexico on their first exploration
of the country— in manners, customs, mode of living, &c., and dif-
fers but little from the aboriginies of Mexico proper. Early after the
conquest, the Spanish government became sensible of the wisdom of a
policy that w^ould conciliate a people so numerous and so powerful a^'
the native inhabitants of 3Iexico ; and accordingly, in \o2o, the em-
I)eror Charles V. authorized the viceroys and governors to grant a
certain quantity of hind to each village. In 1533 the mountains, pas-
tures, and waters were made common to both Spaniards and IudiaD>.
The dfcree of Philip II., dated June, 15S7, confirmed, to the various
pueblos, or villages, eleven hundred varas Sfiuare of land, which was
hllcrward increased to a league square. Some of the decrees state that
the Indians were not to have any higher title in the land than the rii^bt
of posscEsion ; and the ordnance of Philip IV., of March IGlh, 1(142, pn.«
vides that the lands, which the Pueblo Indians have in any manner
improved by their industry, shall be reserved to them, but that they
shall neither have power to sell nor alienate the same. The decree oi
the Royal Audience of Mexico, of February 1^3, 1781, confirmatory oi
that of Philip III., of October 20lh, l.V.)3, prohibits the Pueblo Indian?
selling, renting, leasing, or in any other manner disposing of their
lands to each other or to third parties, without the consent ot ^-uivi
Koyal Audience. Thtse authorities prove two facts— if tliero were in-
other evidence on these points— fii^st, that the Spaniard^^ iound tiu-
Indians already settled in villages, and confirmed land to llieni to cnu-
ciliate them ; and second, that said grantb of land were held by ri«hi
cf possession only, the fee-simple remaining in the crown of Snaiu.
from which it passed to the government of Jlexico, and subscciueutiy
to the United States, by the treaty of Guadalupe Hidalgo.
If space permitted, it would be inK're.sting to inquire the I'roba*;!^.
origin of the Pueblo Indians and whence they came. There arc lw<.
tlieories on this subject — one, that they are of Aztec origin, and lii(
ctlicr, that they are the remains of a Toltec colony. According i»
tradition, when the Aztecs peopled Nev/ Mexico they came from th»
"^Corth or North-west, and only reached their new homes in the valley
of Anahuac after a peiiod of an hundred and fifty years— haltin-j
from time to time, and building villages and cultivating the eardj.
C:istafieda was of opinion that the Pueblo Indians came from thi-
^T>orth-west. If this were the case some of the migrating Aztecs must
TllK CUNQVKST OF NEW MEXICO. 417
have remained in Now Mexico and not moved on with tlie main body.
Tliere is a tradition among them, that they are the people of Monte-
zuma. The survivors dt the Pecos pueblo believed that he would
return to deliver them from the Spaniards down to the time they be-
came extinct — while the Qod of Laguna is called by his name. All
the pueblos keep up the estvja, because it is said to have been instituted
by Montezuma. A Jemcz Indian told lieutenant Simpson that God
and the sun were one and the same. Baron'Humboldt contended that
tlie Aztec language differed essentially from that of the Pueblo Indians,
and Castaneda declared that the latter were unknown* to the inhab-
itants of Mexico until Yaca and his companions brought information
of them. The late Albert Gallatin believed them to be of Toltec origin.
Notwithstanding there are many facts in opposition to the theory
that the Pueblo Indians and the Aztecs belong to the same race, the
similitude between their manners and customs, and their mode of
building and living would argue an identity ; and if, upon carefhl in-
vestigation their language shall be found substantially the same, the
evidence on the subject would appear quite conclusive.
27
A.PPEIsrDIX
420
APPEXDIX.
3g3SS||.9
1 ^J ^A' I ° 8
,ao »- c JO'S s>
Kg.saSjs'So
to _ '3 «
CB
Cm 08 ^ " S3
S ®.2 o q> c^
o
00
8 fcH
q s o c 0^
^ OS « CD •- « -^
cJ C3 5«. t) Jt -^
•:= " ^ c: o sj X ;=:
:^ a* ., *- c o'^
§•3
OS t^^
<D
s^
a
o
.S 5iq^
a 3
Ci 09
c c 2^ MS ::*
2 3 t^' e- ^^ •
c ** S tf ^ . CLo «
•r.
UQ
C"? © o ft^j^S
1:3 o S g c3 o g
o !>.*" c >» c <u a «
e .— -S fc- « ^ fl c "^
00 o " rr?
o O •^
no ►- o
•S ©"^ o
- ©t £
• S 2 ^
H
. *-
; O
a « ^
1 « QC
Bh
s ^^ ^
o z^ ^
. bk
.0
1
1 "^
1
• ••••,•»■
o *♦• »5 I-:
^■^ «^ sA *n
S •'• '-C X «
>i 2 H ^ —
•
■'3
1
:|i
»n o © o £ o
•&
' T*'«» •• «•
c;^ © p ON
•
1 :
'■i ;
' < •
'S
: o
O ® • Tj ■ M
« .
a •
o -
'^3
: o
; es
<^ "S ^ ^
o g - o
fi ^ a s
j o ceo
13 .9 C C ^ O
^:o__ _ '^ZO
1 1
^ 1 1 l-ei
1 «
1 ' i
1 1
t- =:5 ?*- 5 -
' 1
: 5^
» o CO c; w - - 3
1
: d
ii ^ 2 .SS = ^
1
1 s
;| E = £p8
1 ^ ' .
w ! :
•
■ U
:^
• 2 s
O © J3 K
> ^ ► c •- C O
b ■
1 r"
oe
' o .
• ■■X
• u
• o
o c
: V) 1-
1 g^cSg'^6®
^^ ^ r\ ^ * ^ C O O ■
goQj.isocoS-
1 *
li
xoowo^<;^p
^-
f)
r:
-t
»•:
• A
t^
QC
^«
O © C ^
Ari*KNDIX.
421
IS
fi
<
CO
o
H ,0
I
r?!
O
r- 5 !r ::
-f ,*J r: t- — »;7 — '
^ .— ^ -' r" .r" I!^
•
^1
•*: TC '^ ^>
i-i /. ^
e — '»; —
•^ *^ ^^ ■'•
i'rJ^ •'to
S5 ' ir L; i X — —
^4 I ^* ^* ^* J'^ • 2"^ •'^
I ri -*• t'- r; -^ ii X Til
i^ ti I- I- I- I- 1^ j
38
M
u
'- -a ^ ^# ^
P
N tr C 3 3
.S S »''E To?
o c 3 if '/: S
c ►- c s ^ 3
I. J «^ <-• «M ». *"
t^— t ,— '^ ■^ _r
5: c: .= ^ i^
^ O fe fl3 O o d
>»^ o^ cja —
^ t> «-• •- —
C/ ~ ^ 'ri kvT O
*-"^ "* c a o
38
O
a
«s
ki
o
a
>
Si "^ - •" —
P ^ ^ T. ^
s"? ? ? 5
.S tL ? < —
^ ^ W) O ^ t^ 'S
• -■- ^ .,00
«A a*^ ^^ ^4 ^ -
— >'= S c^ -
^ ~ i s
>»Ph 'a ;^ w
^ ?; 's* ri s_.
S r z^" c S o
J ^ Q 5 a ^ 3
::; "w 003 g8 U 03
C
C
c
5?5
o a
§«
h-l >
^» •-*
•" ^' 1. ft
, ti N ^ .:C
I ~ - s J is
'^-zs 2 ii o
o
IS c
c c f
c: T, —
- fl ^
K
... ,a
— tr t<
• • • • •
O ^ "M Tt -t-
-::-/:
."^ 'Z S '
? ^ c
TO =
5 ^ fc^ .
*-" c ^
1*1 ■-? «i^
• • •
»^ o I"
to- -
t -^ 5
cS --I ^
»-. "" ^
^ O
fill
d M w
«j «« Vi
- *- "J d
C -n ^- -
^"E^ to
r3
d
a
U
c
d
f-4
i:^ d
I- 53
^^^ d LZ d t--^
df -"^
3^ S J2 X-i
'-sQdSti •Sd£l>«-^
o S ?, 5 « * ,c ti> >» w
d t- ;:-
«- — .d
^ ^ =8
^ — »*%♦-»
2 *? i^ 5
> 5 r J
ti C ^^
d d.;_ O
•-* S —. 2j
t; w —
^•^ - d :^ -:
— «^ ^ "^ ^
«- — '/.— X
>< ^ I- :* "-'
1^ iS* CO ;-i C
d
.2 a 52 5^^:; 33 g C. o 5
•• "d 2 ..•' 53 -
- - d >. ^'•
o
^ -r t-i
dX/
o <M
^ c
2d .'3 .3-3 .go
ao
422
APPENDIX.
re
p:
H
H
H
C
00
p
^
^■»
.« .
► o
c r;
P*
• ••
»«?t
oc n
ci-
««
•
. •«•<•
c.
•^
•k
A
• •>
^n
c^ n
«, o
r*" r**
« 1 •■
_ •.
» •
^ * nr-i
C4p
Cl 'O
:■: X C5 CI — c >-.
C: .rr^jr ^»P
•» •» •
CI -f »*: — — c 3c c- -^ »-
I — — — CI C'l.CC c^ cc -t- -*•
||«. l^ |« 1^ !«. I. »^ !«. 1^ I-
hi*
— Jj
•^
•r; -«
'^
'^
_ S^
iim
■/•o
^»
■r ij
— < •<
• •*
>■, L.
•Mrf
"*^ "j
<".
' '^ 1^
-;
• >— r ^"^
/.
, _ /»^
D >> >
a* •— • .^ ^» 5 ^-
. ■ .^ r, .^ ,^ p-*. ^" r»» ^^ ^_
X n -r — CI ?■: -r »- *c t-
I— -- CJ 71 ?) CI 71 71 71 71
2 -'S"^
fc-rs r* H *5 i3 rt
t4
^ <H j3 C ,-,
^.S ^ i CJ
•o a
a o
► o
2 ©
c
fcr o
a ►
t: to
'C o
B OQ
c a
II
OQ to
' a
<M ee
C u^
go
> a
08 Q)
5
'a
2^1
.OB <H
c o
5 fe c
OS V
73 S
§^
C C
B
SOD
c: ^ 08
a i-i 5- oj
* O O 'S •
fc c c <*- ^
*> ^' £ c £
7^ .rz "■ OS .»«
'^ ::< -:3 . If!
c •" t; t»
C5 ^ C
-5 6
?s
•• ft ■
1'
• ST
'•a
>- o
08
fc-i .
fees
si
oe bo
a
o3
ci3
c
o o
g2
PC
M &)
2*3
Vf-3
■a
o
a
&
a
3
a
08
c^
*^t2
•=»- a c
ci ^
Ii5
o;
00 *«
SC •art
I
"^ •* ^'\ ^
06^
55 23
(J ^— CO
^ .^ cc c3
o
s
o
^ o
- § cO
CI ► £c^
^3 t C S
5 c g •;:
o^ o
= ^t.= r r 5
7 fi c o
-• = s C*
a
s
*-► _ x-" *1>
— E Ti
'" •"* '^1 Wm
5 ^ — 35
o O w
^ c'^ S
^ — . «» o
ia>4 -^ •=
. c c ^ O
M
^»* S^^
C. — • 71 C
« 1^ y. ?
I- Cj fc- 53
'^ " •
C »^ S CI
Ni» ^ *-» "~
- c y 2
c SI'S ^
u
s
Oi
c ^ =
.S c P
;* w oc
X c ir "^ t •*
^-^ ^ S c^
C «-• 35 C X P
■** O 1^ C; *^ gg
'o tc-, tt^'2
o S »P c o S
, S c — .S; »^ p
'c: r^ <»- « ^ s
2 .2§-?
AI'PKSDIX.
423
to
•^
•
a.-".
»-
P
•«
%
S3
00-
Ho
H -
p
t- ri P
»5
H
1
o
_-«-*
-"'i.
Pi-
^ «• *k
« c; Ci S
CO
Sr^
■4 X <M
« »C i^ o
>^;.
I
?J it C'l C. X ?5
5© •- ao X c: c
CI
X —
«S b- C.
» • -
P S
it
<
-a
a
o
.5
as
O
»«
a
a
o
e
O
O
N
— Ci L: c X -f L-^
;o L* 5* X X Ci O
l^ b- l« t^ lo X
X —
a5 X
X
;2 X
X X
%1
o
C w w
I
**^ ^ ^
r3
p
o
a
o
O
as
« to
as
.9 a
>
d
HI
p^
OpLH »
ill
• • •
00 —
C^ 50 W
09
03
P
<
'O
09
.s
p
pq
p
es
g3
.P
O
a
8"
o
s
p
o
JS OS
I
f-4
O
^-H P ^
P J_S •"*
a*^ a» _
P P C^v 6 Sb!
o o
p p
09 09
P P
i
Z3 OS
rt? o *
<1~
a^ r.
CI e^ "H*
C3 M n
• « * « •
11% ^ to X Ci
90 09 so GO C^
C> r* eS
► ;5 5
§•- .
n 5j p
p ^
^ ^ ■^
^ 2 P
o c *^
•-» tf v.
w c
C! =* t*,
o go :?
2i /- ^
P ;r'*^
C «
iS5
05 1^ O
*::: ^ =
O -1 c
■P ^ .t:
c c —
'•— '^ ;?■
o p.?
a
§.:
O 2; ^
i> C ."^
• I
p «
.- ^
o a
-pcp
•" CI
X
o
o S 08
P w a;-
09 iJ •£
c a «
Sop
M -: o
- S»-'
b ^^ S
s o C
o u o
■gal
o be
^'Ji >
pt: o
V fe «*
a o ^
4) S d
is
^ u
"I "lis
p « w ^^
- •"* ^ s;
'•^ »i» 50
P J^c^i
on'-* "-*
o
^•Si'^
O P
O O
p !^ as
c a rs*©
o g -• * «
■' s to "^
i-*.^ ^p £ o
P <^ w 2 p ^^
P
Q.
, .ja g 2 p
C ^ 'SS O *^ w
O ot! — .2 « O
^' T** w -r -r „•
-I .S "^ c* 50 n
J: .8 » ii s
C = iiSiftitSzi 2"
ilaillJSiilJ
it %=is & =
If iif,; I . Ii
li:-il!ilpy.^il
Ifl,ias|£flay5ii'
Is^lUiiliMlli
Ari'KXDIX,
42.>
H
E
H
O
i.
C
&
i^
I
— "^ O ;o '^
^ ^ ^ ^ «t«
00 OO 00 00 QO
ia
I
c
g!
o
e
bo
P
® -a rf
^'5 3
o 2
II
09 I
-
• ■■ ■ <
I SI
Sin
• • • • •
>o c£ r<. CO Ci
1* o 1* lO >5
28
- 2y.-
^"^ ^^ w^
«-« *»
* o g
f? o 5
t)0;=: P
CSr— O
a P
" P
S cT -r
es •Xt <n
Ci O ♦i
S
s
O QO
CD 1-^
bo'=*^
p hi
>ri o
P
►
g
P
o
Cm
o
o
08
O
M
. P«
c
03
00
- o^
CO °o
O O 09 S
a CD
1-3 'w I* O "» -Si
»^ ».*: j-t xi ^^ c8
1 IM D E X .
A.
Apalachc, town of, captured, liG.
AuU', Spaniards arrive at, 21).
Ai'my, the, marches inland, 215 ;
raised to conquer Cibol?i, 142;
reviewed by the viceroy, 14 i;
enters Culiacan, 149 ; Arellano
to command, l.'»0 ; marches Irom
Culiacan, 150; resumes march
for Cibola, 158 ; arrives at Cibo-
la, 159 ; marches for Ti5:uex,
1H3; goes into quarters, 184;
reaches Tiguex, 1J»5 ; encamps
at great ravine, 200; continues
its march on the plains, 212; re-
mains encamped at valky, 217;
returns to Tiguex, 22:5 ; how
guided, 223 ; winters at Tij^ex,
227 ; makes preparations to re-
turn to Quivira, 228 ; ordered to
return to Mexico, 230; leaves
Tiguex for New Spain, 231 ; ar-
rives at Culiacan, 233 ; sickness
in, 232.
Alaniz and Ovieda left on an
island, 50.
Avavares, 70.
Arbadaos, 7(1.
Alcaraz, Diego de, lUU.
Acus, 122.
Apacus, 128.
Alarcon, Pedro, sails for Nativi-
dad, 143.
Acaxas, 14G.
Attack of Indians reported, 101.
Alvarado marches for Cicuy «.•, 1 77 ;
reaches Tiguex, 179.
Acuco, town of, 177 ; hostile, 178 ;
I situation of, 181.
Acha, the village of, 189.
Aleman, Juan, 193.
Aguascalientes, the province of,
1 2'M
Arellano starts to search for Co-
ronado, 220.
Acochis, country of, 22G.
Accident to Coronado, 228.
Arms of Indians on Rio del Norte,
Art X * '•
Amies, province of, 252.
Acoma, town of, 252 ; situation of,
252, fate of priests at, 304 ; Var-
gas arrives at, 359.
Acomillo, 313.
Ave Maria sounded upon the
trumpet at Isleta, 310.
Alameda, 318.
Aguatubi, Vjirgas arrives at, 305 ;
situation of, 305.
Apaches, deputation of, wait on
Vargas, 353 ; Nabajo, alarm
Zuni Indians, 303 ; Saline, visit
Spanish camp, 304 ; steal Var-
gas's horses, 372 ; invited to join
rueblo Indians, 375 ; Farreon,
visit Vargas, 390.
Absolution at Aguatubi, 300.
AFsault of Santa Fc, 382.
Almazan, corporal, drowned, 391.
B.
Barrameda, San Lucar de, the fleet
sails from, 1 7.
Boats, Nar>'uez resolves to build, S2.
J
428
INDEX.
I5oat of Vaca, cast on shore, 41.
** Bad-Thing," account of, 7.'>.
Bell of copner given to Dorantes,
in).
Blankets of cotton, 100.
Beautiful country, lOS.
Bisifotes, J 70 ; restored to liberty,
201.
Butfaloes, first discovered, 180 ;
immense herds of, 2()G ; fright-
ened at Spaniards, 208; mcatoi,
how prepared by Indians, 219 ;
t::reat numbers ot, 2G0.
Braba, village of, 22r>.
* "Neatsleaihcr," boots and shoes
made of, 217.
Bodies of friars found by Espejo,
241).
Battle between Indians, 274.
Baca, Alouzo, 2>:J.
Bua, Nicholas, killed by Popii, 25^9.
Blind woman at Alameda, ^21.
J Jeans and corn burnt, 321.
Black mountains, 371.
C.
Cape Santa Cruz, the licet arrives
at, v.).
Caravallo, licet placed in command
of, 22.
Castillo, captain, accompanies Va-
ca to search for the sea, 30.
Cacic[Uo made prisoner, 3(1.
Crew of Vara's boat becomes in-
sensible, to.
Charmcos, Vaca remains with, .">7.
Children killed at birth, (;.'>.
Casiillo esea])es inland, i'>~K
Cattle montionod, (17.
Camoues kill Pefialoso and Tellez,
(.'onilition of all the Indians, 7<J.
Country, the ai>pearance of, 88.
(.'astillo searches for inhabitants,
tiG.
Cow nation, 07.
Chacan fruit, 1>S.
Certilieate given to Vaca and com-
panions, J 07.
Coniposlella, Vaca arrives at, 10'.);
army tu uiL-emble at, 1 l.l.
Culiacan, army reaches, III;
province of, 1 4 '>.
Cortez, Heman, returns to Mexico,
112.
Cibola, 110; army marches for. 111;
account of, by Stephen, 120; ad-
ditional information of, 122 ; how
houses built in, 127; Niza ar-
rives in sight of, 137 ; army
raised for conquest of, 142 ; Co-
ronado approaches, 1 54 ; as seen
by Coronado, 1 '>'* ; attacked and
taken, l.">r»; situation of, 107.
Coronado, Francisco Vasquez, go-
vernor of New Spain, 112; re-
pairs to Culiacan, 113; Niza
relates his adventures, to, 141 ;
appointed captain-general, 142;
starts in advance for Cibola, 1 "lO ;
enters the great desert, 154 ;
comes within sight of Cibola,
1 .')."> ; makes peace with Cibola,
1(V.); sends runners to other na-
tions, 170; messenger from Al-
varada to, arrives, 180;. visits
Tutahaco on his way to Tiguex,
ISO ; arrives at Tiguex, 181 ; his
interview with the *' Turk," 182 ;
goes to Cicuyc in advance of
army, IDS; prepares to start for
(^uivira, 212 ; arrives there, 213;
kills the **Turk," 217; alarm
felt for, 220 ; rejoins army, 220 ;
occnpied himself dunng winter,
how, 227 : meets with an acci-
dent, 22S ; soldiers petition him
to return to Mexico, 221) ; orders
army to return, 230; reaches
the city of Mexico, 233 ; falls in-
to disgrace, 23:5.
Crosses to bo sent back by Stephen,
118.
('o\v-hidcs given to Xiza, 123.
Crosses set up, 121.
'* Casconados," 1 2.">.
Cattle and sheep driven along with
army, HI.
Chiametla, army halts at, 1 17.
Chichiliicale, 131 ; how named,
100.
California, gulf of, expedition to,
1 00.
INDEX.
420
Cascade, the, I7r>.
Combat wirh Tiguex IiuVmns, lOt.
Cdia, the village of, 202 ; the prov-
ince of, 221.
Council of war, 212; 221).
Cicuye, deputation from, 17G; Al-
varado marches for, 177; town
of, 171); situation of, IDS; vil-
lages in province of, 2CK) ; army
arrives at, 201 ; river of, 20r>.
Cona, 211; army reaches river of,
on return, 22:J : ascend river of,
224 ; tight at, by Arellano, 22«>.
Cardenas, Lopez de, sent to Ti-
guex, 180; besieges a village,
101; massacres pris()nei*s, li)2;
assaulted by Indians, l!)i; con-
duct of, at riguex, VM) ; returns
to Spain, 227 ; finds Indians at
Suya in revolt, 230.
Conchos Indians, 211.
Cross, the mystery of, taught the
Indians by the friars, 2t2.
Children blessed by friars, 21-t.
Cicique, commtiiids of, how exe-
cuted, 24S.
Cunames, province of, 2.")l.
Christian Indians found at Zuni,
by Espejo, 2r>:j.
Corn meal sprinkled under the
horses' feet, 2."'>().
Chapels dedicated to the devil, 248.
Cotton bolls given to Espijo, 249.
Cannibal lakes, 27ti.
Chichimeca troops, 200.
Colonists organize settlement, 200.
Cadaudachos, river of, 277.
Cochina dance prohibited, 280.
Concha, general, 282.
Clemente, Estevan, 2S4.
Caidit, 288.
Calite, 280 ; his fate, ao(j; brother
of, :330.
Conspiracy, by Jemcz and Apache
Indians, 2S2 , discovered, 28;} ;
in time of Villanueva, 2s:i ;
crushed, 2s4 ; by Estevan Cle-
mentc, 28 1 ; cause of rebellion,
280.
Cupavo, Louis, how disposed of,
:;oo.
Casas Graudes, 008.
Cenccu, destiniction of, 311.
Children baptised, .'517.
('ause of rebellion investigated, 333.-
Corvera, Francisco, baptised Indi-
ans at San Juan, 312.
Cia, what took place at, 353.
Ciiizens and prisoners sent to El
Paso by Vargas, 3.">r>.
Church ornaments discovered, 3CI.
Conduct of ]Moqui Indians when
Vareras approaches, 367.
Cabeson, 371.
Cia, dissention among inhabitants
of, 375.
Cristobal, captain, sent to trade
with Indians for com, 370.
Cochiti, the pueblo of, 320; at-
tacked by Indians, 304.
Caliente, the Ojo, 407.
Cicncguilla, La, 408.
Cubero, Don Pedro Rodriquez,4 14.
D.
Don Pedro, killed bj' an Indian, 28.
Dorantcs, Andres, accompanies
Vaca to search for the sea, 30.
Distance marched, 33.
Direction of route, 80.
Dress of women, 101.
Dias, Melchor, visits Vaca,108; re-
turns with Sandoval to Cbiamet-
la, 147; commands new settle-
ment, l.">7; searches for coast,
iiVJ; death of, 102.
Death of Tejos Indian, 112.
Desert, Niza arrives at, 110.
Dogs Uansport Indian baggage,
200.
Distance marched on the pluns,
218.
Devil, the, oratories erected for,
24S.
Deerskins sent to all the pueblos,
287.
Desert passed, 310.
Don Louis appointed governor of
Santa Fc puebloes, 347 ; alarmed
at threats of Indians, 377 ; goes
on a mission to Santa Fe, 377.
** Diabolical (Juestions" asked by
Indians, 305.
r
4.*;0 iNi>i:x.
E. I Kixtd liJibilalioiis, 87.
IVuit or the country, DJ.
Enrr'unu-z, Alonzo, LiikIs on an ' Friars, Iho, relusc to reliira with
island, I'O. • ,' suklicrs, -:»(> ; estabUsb them-
Embiircalion, order of, :u. i sdvcs at Puara, 2:J7 ; killed by
E<quivcl,aud companions, fiile of, Indians, I'.JT ; namesof, who ac-
Gk compauinl Ofi'Ue, 267.
Estevanioo escapes inland, <;.'. ; re- : Fl.-h tjivcn by Indians to Spaniards
turns wilh lndlan^^, 11/.. | locMt, i}.'».
Emeralds given to Vac a, lOo. i Fore sts orpoi>lar and wahiut trees.
Expedition to (Cibola abandoned, -U),
112. ' Flemish miners, 272 ; their machi-
Expedition to coast returns, 121. i nery described by settlers, 272.
El r^uevo Ki'^ho do .San Francis- Fir>t mii<sion establLshed, 277.
CO, i:js. ; IV.ty Cri^toval, 310.
Espcjo, Antonio de, oJlVrs to res- F.itficr Ayct a preached to Indians,
cue the iViari?, 2::'.> ; marches' :i!7.
lor New Mexico, 210; s?e:id.s Frc.-h meat issued to trooi>a, iJ25.
messeniiers to l*u.i:iliv< s, 212; Fores ot* Vargas united, H7t».
goes up to Indians in the moun- iM^fan, Francisco, friar, oi)3.
tains, 2i:J ; welctmied by thfMn, Famine, iijreat, 413.
21 1 ; comes to ten towns on llio ; Foifan, Antonio, -113.
del Norti', 2t7: enters the Trju:i<;
nation, and linds the b(*(H'-s of G.
the friars, 211); cuiiliiiics his
journey, 2."i() ; ri'nc'iis Acoma. CIov. rnor, the, woundcil, 30.
252 ; arrives at Z'lfii, or Cibola, ; Greek accompanies Indians for
253 ; hears of a country rich . water, ;>7.
in precious metals, 2:.:J ; starts , (In-sil river from the North, 93.
West from Zuni, 2'.:. ; eoiiciiliili's (i(»ld, traces (ff, lOG.
the Indiaiis by ]>nv!ir.ts. 2.")(; ; (I nzir.an, g)vernor, receives Vaca,
marches W eslw:ird ffoiii Z.i'jTua- b-'.*; ci. 'Ionizes Culiacan, 112;
to, 2.'»7 ; re:icli'S miius, l':,s : thrown into prisuu, 112.
returns to Znfii, 2:>s ; hjavL-sZuiU (.real deLHM-t, 120.
lor the Norlh-cast, 2.M) : arrives (J.ilh'^^u rtlurns to Mexico, \o7.
amon^ Tiinns luui ms, 2i'.0; ro- Cln-at i liver, the, 17;); expedition
turns to Mc'xiro, 2'".:). to, 174.
Encansaqvu', thv\ 27:*.. </(///u.s' f^';)r/7)«(Z«, 187.
Expedition toNcu- Mi'xieo project (Jr.ipe.N simiiiir to llie Muscat, dis-
ed by the king but is abaijdoned, ', covired, 22;i.
27<>. , (.;:.. z.d potfery, 22.-;.
El Teguayo, 277. G.iIlL':r(;s, Juan, meet with rein-
KlJoruada del ^luerla, :;ii:). li;rc.'UK'nt>, 2;;2.
('.'.'::.>uo, the putblo of, 23il.
F. (Ir.ipes, 2.")^.
' Gt>v( rjiiir i'recenio waited upon by
Ileet arrives at San D^'^mi-ii^o, 18:1 drii^iraiion of Indians, 285.
men desert from, is : two vi-sj^t-K ' CJ:iiTisi)]i, condition of, 21»5.
of, wrecked, ID: sails f;»r i'iori- Gucrra, Antonio, sounds a parley,
da, !!); to Ibllow eo:' ;t (.f, 22. o-">.
Fatal sickness amon,i^ Indians, 18. Gua][)i, ]);iLijlo of, entered by Var-
Figueroa, 7<). ' gas, ;)i;s.
Fiour of 31ez<iuinuez, 81. ■ Gcoij«', Antonio, 110.
ixr)i:x.
4:U
n.
hares killed by Indians, how, l>2.
Heavy rains detain SpauiariU, lot.
Houses of Cibola, l'J7.
Hemes, 188.
Haxa, village of, 2(>5.
Hail storm, iMO.
Houses, description of, 217.
Horses, how treated by Indians,
240.
Hubates, province of, 2.V.).
Humana ent<»rs New Mexico, 2<'»0 :
killed by .Indians.
High Mass celebrated, JUT.
Hurtado, Juan Pacs, 4 1 :'>.
I.
Indians, the, desert their Luis, bat
return, 20 ; four arc captured,
21 ; two hundred encountered,
23 ; a chief visits Spaniards, 24 ;
attack Vaca at Analaclic, 2«> ;
kill Don Pedro, 28 ;* attack Kar-
vaez while crossing a lake, 28 ;
"they kill Avellaneda, 2li ; desert
Aute', 29 ; follow Nar\'aez to j-^ea,
88 ; give provisions to Span-
iards, 4;j ; take Spaniards to their
huts, 4G; fatal sickness breaks
out among, 48 ; manners and
customs of, 51 : names of tribes,
f*'); abuse Spaniards, 04; their
strategy in war, 80 ; astonished
at sight of Spaniards, S."* ; killed
hares, how, 92 ; sickness among,
05 ; furnish food to Alcaraz, 107;
provide for Niza. 120 ; kill Ste-
phen, 135 ; kill Samaniego, 1 47:
of great stature, and their cus-
toms, 100; plot of, to massacre
Dias and party, 101 : badly treat-
ed by Spaniards, 190: attack
Spaniards, 191; massacred, 192;
refuse to treat, 193 ; assault 0:ir-
denas, 194; deputation of, ar-
rives from Cibola, 203 ; pleased
at restoration of IMgotes, 204 ;
of the plains, 219; kill friar Ma-
ria, 237 ; kill Ruiz, 238 ; num-
ber of, converted and baptised,
238 ; attack Espejo, 243 ; Luma-
Indians—
nc>3, have a faint idea of God,
2tl; give Sp:mi:irds large fish
to cat, 2I5; their treutriient of
liorscF, 219; tied to the moun-
tains from Esptjo, 2t9; idols
wor.sliippcd by, 2."i(»; warn Es-
pejo not to approach their towns,
2.")(; ; how they dress, 259 ; kind-
ness of, to Oft ate, 209 ; two boys
taken to Spain, 27(> ; number of
baptised, 277 : their treatment
by Spaniards, 279 ; become dis-
r.'ont.endcd, 281 ; sent to steal
horst'S of Spaniards, i:S3 ; accus-
ed of l);nvil(:hing fiinr I)uran,285;
how Intelligence communicated
among, 287 ; three figures of,
28S ; (^omnience to slaughter the
Sp.miard.s 290; refuse proposi-
tions of Otermin, 293 ; besiege
Santa Fu, 295 ; retire to the
mountains, 290; watch the Span-
iards evacuate, 297 : conduct of,
at Santa Ft\ 299 ; number killed,
DOO ; abolished the Christian re-
ligion, 30(; ; traces of, 311 ; offer
resistance at Islet a, 315 ; perish-
ing in the mountains, 319 ; attack
Oiermin's camp, 322 ; set fire to
Sandia, 324 ; threaten to attack
Mendoza, 330; motives for mak-
ing peaco, 331 ; unite to defend
Santa Fc', 339; difficulty be-
tween, settled by Vargas, 344;
welcome Vargas to Cia, 351 ;
receive the Spaniards at Jemez,
how, .•»52 ; flee from Moqui pu-
eblos, :i03 ; of Gualpi lay down
their arms, 308 ; scarcity of pro-
visions among, 375; refuse to
furnish com to •Spaniards, 370 ;
resolve to defend Santa Fe, 381;
surrender Santa Fv, 384; killed
at Santa Fc, 385 ; defeat Vargas
at San Yldefonso, 388 ; deputa-
tion of, from Cia and Santa Ana,
visits Vargas, 389; surjirise Var-
gas, 391 ; attack Santa Fe', but
are driven off, 394; ready to
commence hostilities, 397 ; again
hostile, 400 ; Rebel, visit Vargas^
402 ; make signal fires, 403.
432 iNPr.x.
Meeting l>etwecn Vaca and Do-
rantes. <>0.
Island, Vaca'& boat cast upon, 4 1 .
Indications of other S[)auiarda
seen, 105. ' 3Turtane Indians, 05.
India figs, 158. ! Maliaconics, 7(>.
Indian woman escapes, 221. i Manners and customs of Indians,
Intelligence communicated, how, 78.
288. I Mczquiquez, Hour of, 84.
Instructions of PoiW to Indians, Maize discovered, 1)8.
302. I Mexico, Vaca departs for, 1 00.
Isleta, Otermin falls bnck upon, ' Marala, 122.
335 ; village of, burnt, :V.\:> ; Var- 1 March of army, I4G.
gas finds it in ruins, :>5G. I Maldonado searches for gulf of Ca-
Interval of peace, 302. lifomia, 15(».
Melons, how preserved, 164.
J. . Messeuger sent to Corouado, 180.
Jaca, 280. Maldonado, Don Rodrigo, starts to
Jemez, fate of priest, at, 3(« ; situ- explore C^uivira, 200.
ationof, 352 ; pueliloof, burned, : Missionaries left at Tiguex, 231 ;
410; treaty made with, 412. | their fate; 3Iaria, Santa, Juan
Javier, Francisco, 308.
Jiron, captain Rafael Teyes, 3G4.
Jongopabi, the pueblo of, 3G9.
de, 235 ; returns to New Spain,
237.
J^Iexican Indians remain at Cibola,
Jesus, friar Juan de, remains of, 232.
found, 412. Mines of gold and silver found by
L.
Espojo, 241.
Macanas, the, 248.
Mines reached by Espejo, 258.
La Baya de los Caballos, 34. ^ March of Ofiate, 2G8.
Lisbon, Vaca arrives at, 100. Metals found in New Mexico^ 271.
** Little beasts," 126. ' Missions establibhed, 276.
Los Corazones, town of, 1 56. ' Morador, friar Jesus, cruel fate of.
Letters trom Alarcon found, 1 60. j 303.
Loss of Indians at Tiguex, lOG. | Mendoza sent on reconnoissance,
Lopez, Diego, sent to search for 318; arrived at Alameda, 321 ;
llaxa; 207 ; gets lost, 207 ; Fran-
adviscs Otermin to establish a
Cisco, 235 ; killed by Indians, camp at Puara, 322 ; brings in
237. prisoners, 325 ; marches to San
Lakes, Salt, 223. Felipe and Santo Domingo, :i2S;
Lumanos, the province of, 212. Indians threaten to attack him.
Latitude taken, 251. j .'>3l ; invites Indians to come in
Leiva killed by Humana, 2C1 and arrange peace, 331 ; rejoins
La Caiiada attacked and destroyed, Otermin, :;32.
291. Mateo, a chief, embraces Vargas,
Louis of Picoris, 342. 350.
List of ptisoners sent to El Paso, Miguel appointed governor of
356. I Aguatubi, 3(;g ; Monsonabi, pu-
Lands assigned to soldiers, 392. ' eblo of, 308 ; march of, to El
Paso, 372.
M. Madrid, Koque, farm of, 377 ; exe-
cutes prisoners, 381 ; commands
Malhado, island of, 50. troops, o!>2.
Medicine, Spaniards practice, 5:5. I
INDEX.
433
N.
Narvaez sails from Barramccla, 1 7 ;
arrives at San Domingo, 18 ;
winters with the llect at Trini-
dail, 11) ; sails for Florida, 19 ;
lands ui)on the coast, 20; march-
es into the interior, 23; takes
Apalache, 20 ; arrives at Auto,
2[) I retm*ns to the coast, 31 ; re-
solves to build boats to escape
by sea, 32 : visits hut of cacique,
y(> ; asks Indians for water, 37^*
consults with Vaca, 40 ; his fate,
. G3.
Nail of horse shoe discovered, 10-1.
New Mexico, earliest inlbrmation
of, 110; climate of, 2(>0 ; first
pueblo of, 310; metals found in,
271.
Niza, Marcos de, starts for Cibola,
113; how treated by Indians,
IIG; hears of large cities, 117;
sent parties to sea-coast, 118 ;
leaves Vacupa, 1 22 ; hears more
of Cibola, 122; visited by lord of a
village, 1 25 ; arrives at great des-
ert, 12C; receives messages from
Stephen, 130 ; enters the great
desert, 131 ; hears of Stephen's
death, 131 ; greatly alarmed,
13G ; arrives in sight of Cibola,
and its situation, 137 ; takes pos-
session, 138 ; returns toward
New Galicia, 131); arrives at
Compostella, 140 ; taken to
Mexico, 141 ; relates his adven-
tures to viceroy, 142 ; returns to
Mexico, 157.
Nacapan, provmco of, 158.
Naranjo, Diego Martinez, killed,
282.
O.
Ovieda, Lope do, ascends a tree,
42 ; reconnoitres the island, 43 ;
hia fate, 59.
Other Spaniards heard of, 104.
Oxitipar, the valley of, 110.
Oronato left behind, 1 io.
Officers for the army appointed,
143 ; sent out to collect provi-
sions, 224.
29
Officer, an, assaults an Indian wo-
mau, 190.
Qbando, Francisco de, captured
and killed by Indians, 196.
Order of Franciscans alarmed about
friars, 239.
, Oratories erected for the de^ 248.
Ofiate, Juan de, proposes to plant
colonies in New Mexico, 203;
the remuneration demanded,
205; his petition granted, 200;
marches from the city of Mexi-
co, 207 ; enters New Mexico and
forms a settlement, 208 ; his ac-
count of the Indians, 270 ; sets
out for Quivira, 273 ; takes In-
dian-boys to Mexico, 275.
Otcrmin, governor, prepares to re-
sist Indians, 290 ; fortifies Santa
Fe, 291 ; parleys with rebels,
29^ ; attacks and drives Indians
from their works, 290 ; retreats
to San Lorenzo, 298 ; ordered to
re-conquer New Mexico, 307 ;
continues the march, 308; re-
connoitres the country and visits
Socorro, 311 ; goes in advance
to Isleta, 314 ; sends two runners
up the river, 310 ; pardons Indi-
ans, 317 ; marches to join Men-
doza, 322 ; bums Alameda, 323;
marches in advance to Sandia,
324; organizes tribunal to ex-
amine prisoners, 325; calls coun-
cil of war, 334 ; marches for El
Paso, 335.
P.
Pcilalosa placed in ambush, 30;
joined by Vaca, 40 ; killed, 09.
Panuco, what happened to party
in search of, 03.
Pantoja killed by Soto Mayor, 04.
Pillage, custom of, 87 ; ceases, 92.
People of fixed habitations, 90.
Powder of straw, 100.
Pintados, 121.
Populous valley, 127.
Pacasas, the, 110.
Plot of Indians, how discovcrcti
101.
Poisoned arrows, 103.
434
INDEX.
Petallan, province of, I Cui.
Pitihaya, wine of, M'A,
Peace made with Cibola, 109.
Padilla, Juan de, 171.
Peace, how made by Indians, 1 78.
Pobaros, Francisco de, killed, r.^G.
Prediction of mathematician, 220.
Paara, pueblo of, reached by lluiz,
235; the village of, 818; burnt
by Indians, 028.
Passaguate Indians, 241.
Peralto, Don Pedro de, 272.
Plums, 273.
Plans of Indians discovered, 283.
Pope waits on governor Frccenio,
285; rouses up the Indians to
rebellion, 288 ; advised by super-
natural Indians, 288; kills hLs
son-in-law, 280 ; makes a tour
of the province, 301 ; enters Cia,
how, 802 ; his speech, 303.
Palm-leaf rope, 288.
Priests at Sioqui stoned to death,
305.
Procurador, the, put to death, 305.
Paredes, the earl of, 307.
Provisions, scarcity of, 318.
Peace concluded with Indians, 330.
Pupiste, a Cia Indian, 331 .
Plan to cut ofTlilendoza, 333.
I^ieblos of Santa Fe submit, 310.
Pacheo, Pedro, a Taos chief, 345.
Puerco, the river of, $50.
Paso del Norte, El, Spaniards re-
treat to, 335; prisoners, &c.,
sent to, 355 ; disabled soldiers
sent to, 304 : Vargas arrives at,
• from Zuni, 372.
Pecos, Vargas marches for, 318;
how received at, 349 ; governor
of, sends for his warriors, 382.
Palace at Santa Fe occupied by
town council, 379.
Priests absolve Vargas's army, 382.
Prisoners taken at Santa Fo, 384.
Provisions begin to fall, .•)85.
Property captured at San Yldefon-
so, 390.
Prisoners liberated, 395.
Picons visited by Vargas, 401 .
Pacheco, 402.
Peace between Spaniards and In-
dians, 412.
Q-
Queveno Indians, 59,
Que vara, Don Die^o de, 197.
Quirix, province of, 200.
Querechos, the, 205.
Qaivira, Sopete's account ofi 208 ;
Coron ado arrives at, 214 : village
and province of, 215 ; visited by
Portuguese, monk and nc^ro,
and their fate, 215 and 21G.
Quirix, province of, 221.
Queres Indians visited by Espcjo,
251 ; receive Vargas, 350.
Quivira Indians carry- off prisoners,
274.
R.
Resume practice of medicine, 71 .
River Petutan, 106.
Reflections of Coronado, 154.
Rio Vermejo, 154.
Rogues, valley of the, 103.
River of Tizon, descent to, 174.
River of Cicuye frozen, 203 ;
bridged, 205; Bihka into the
ground, 225.
Reinforcements arrive, 227.
Revolt at Suya, 228.
Ruiz, Augustin, 23 i ; receives per-
mission to enter New Mexico as
amissionar\% 235; arrives among
theTegiiasiudians, 235; reaches
Galisteo, 230; removes to the
pueblo of Santiago, 238 ; killed
by Indians, 238.
Rio del Norte, Esi>ejo travels along
the, 213.
River of Oxen, 200.
River, the Chama, 208.
Rebellion, llrst attempt of Indians
at, 281 ; cause of; 282 ; second
attempt at, 282 ; third attempt
at, 28 1 ; first attempt to unite all
the pueblos in, 287 ; cause ofi
28<> ; time of, fixed, 290 ; plan
of, betrayed, 290 ; cause of, in-
vestigated, 338 ; attempt at, in
1090, 344.
Red ochre mountain, 304.
Red ochre mines, the, 309.
Rumored conspiracy among Indi-
ans, 379.
INDEX.
435
8.
Ban Domingo, the fleet arrives at,
18.
Subsist, how, while building boats,
33.
San Miguel, strait of, 35.
Spanish settlements of Panuco,
men sent in search of, 48.
Survivors of expedition, 04.
Sickness among Indians, i>5.
Spaniards, the, embark, 34 ; land
on an island and are attacked by
Indians, 36 ; re-embark, 37 ; vis-
ited by Indians in canoes, 38 ;
condition of, 45 ; taken to Indi-
an huts, 40 ; escape by sea cut
off, 47; practice medicine, 53;
number of, alive, 5G ; cross to
mainland, 5G; attempt to escape,
6G; treatment of^ by Indians,
C4 ; survivors of, united, G9 ;
spend the winter with Avavares,
70; cure the sick, 71; wonder-
ful success as physicians, 74 ;
well treated by all the tribes, 7G;
occupation among Indians, 77 ;
arrive at a village of huts, 78 ;
cross a large and rapid river, 85 ;
cross a motlntain range, DO ;
presents of pearls and antimony
^iven to, 90; Indians stand in
lear of, 93 ; travel toward setting
sun, 94 ; arrive among people of
fixed habitations, 9G ; travel up
a great river, 99 ; bless infants,
101 ; teach Indians about God,
102 ; detamed by rain, 1Q4 ; find
towns deserted, 105 ; believe ac-
comit of Tejos Indian, 111; car-
£y off Indians, 116 ; repulsed at
Tiguex, 195 ; besiege Tiguex,
195 ; march from Cicuye, 204 ;
enter a mountainous country,
205 ; reach the great plams, 206 ;
kill many buffaloes, 218 ; receive
presents from Indians, 245 ; con-
tinue the march along great fiver
to the North, 246 ; precious met-
als exhibited to, by the Indians,
252 ; how welcomed by Indians,
256 ; prepare to leave Zuiii, 259;
search for the precious metals,
Spaniards—
271 ; treatment of Indians, 279;
make sortie against Indians,
204; resolve to evacuate Santa
Fc, 296 ; retreat to San Lorenzo,
298 ; encounter severe storm,
323 ; crossed the Rio del Norte',
324 ; bum Sandia, 325 ; attacked
by Indians, 339 ; assault pueblo
of Taos, 342 ; Indians try to pro-
voke, 365 ; march to Jongopabi,
369 ; encamp at the Moro, 371 ;
encamp on a hill outside of San-
ta Fo, 379 ; put Indians to rout,
395 ; engaged in planting, 400.
Seven Cities, the country of the,
110; how reached, 111 ; further
information of, 1 13 ; ^Niza takes
possession of, 138.
Stephen sent in advance, 118 ;
hears of Cibola, 119; sends mes-
sengers to Niza, 130 ; meUiod of
travel, 133 ; sends messengers
to Cibola, 133 ; how received at
Cibola, 134; is put to death, 135.
Shields of cow hides, 121.
Strange beasts, 129.
Strength of army, 144.
Sarmaniego, Lope de, killed by
Indians, 147.
Saaveard governs New Galecia,
150.
Snowstorm, 159.
Savage, how disposed of, 161.
Sonora, province of, 163.
Suya, valley of, 164; town of,
sacked by Indians, 231.
Soldiers in want of clothing, 189 ;
skins distributed among, 209 ;
lost on plains, 218 ; opposed to
returning to Mexico, 229 ; revolt
at Suya, 230 ; one devoured by
sharks, 233 ; desert Ruiz, 236 j
arrive at home, 239 ; return to
New Biscay, 259; desert tho^
colonists, 2(>9. ^
Saldibar, Don Juan de, 197.
Stone balls, 200.
Silos, village of, 200.
Saint Bartholomew, tlie valley of,
235 ; Espejo arrives in, 260.
Sanches escapes, 261 ; settlement
ofOnate, 268.
I -I'
i 1 1* I
in:'!:.';.
t..liii!,iiiti, 111. II, ■,, ; III'. i..»;rn;il, "I'nwiioC L«.3 ('ofuzoiics foUDvltJi
I,,'"''-
!t|i|ii Ml itiM.il :r rill 1 "■, "■ ■. , 'I'mII Illilr^Tl, ITiT.
I'll III I \ I i>|.iii.-i (I. ■ ;. Tjji-.ic (ii'.'h's Wtv.U'} in hoiis'os, HU.
i'liiiii i ■' . ifiii.' .1. ■ >i : ii !'i !■ :iM '\\i .i\ rni, rxpuntifn to, 171 ; nr-
ini'.ii It. ■■' •■".'.!. i .'. I. I'll! »m1, rive ill M::lit 4^1', 1 7:.' ; ttiUcn, 17:i.
■■»!. I \ -.1 J! Ill il. '.I, . i.il»i 11 pi^s Ti/ ui, ii\i r ol", I 7 .'>.
II ■■ h'tift I.\ I'll! .1, ..■.:». i:ili;ili 'r;i;;l1j:n'.\ Inwn o!*, ISO.
: 1: r.j A, tinvn dl", I 7;» ; ilcscriptioii
ilml I l.<M.'\\ { »:« Ti:v'i, ;■.'
I »'.. M I<\ \ I i'-. . . ■■» ; i;:i.i '.:■.:
Ii \\'\\ I ,1 .I*. .• : ^ . lM.l';i:v; i»:', rp
pi» ■' I'j'.r. i.it^l . . . .' . t.iki ;; \ \
\ 11 -.1 ..".'. ■• >\.\ • IM'I .. <.. ,'. I'V
t.«\\ ■! t i«!M'i .*. ' . \ :i'. . . . ,jN
■ .i: ; ■
IS w.-
• . t
■ « ■
• ■ » .'.Ik'
I ■ ' •
:-x I .:,
ji.
I ..
\
\ . .
\'\\ I:-.': i'On!ributit>n Icviuil ciu,
l>'.»: Sj^^.^Tiriuls mriroh lor, !'.».'»;
l;.'\ ■\ l:'.'. : r.iio «)f iiUi:il»i-
t.'.v.-.-. 1:7: army in:ir».I:os Irom,
. • -i ■ ■!*,> ■» I
• .
: ;.rTlVi> "SI' i 111
v^.-i—i.
. *
iNni:x.
437
Vaca—
sea, 24; enters Apalachc, 20;
cUscovers a cape, US; his boat
only one in sight, 31) ; boat
wrecked, 41 ; wrecked third
time, 44; meets with crew of
Dorantes and Castillo's boat, 4(> ;
winters with Indians, 4S; too
fiick to attempt escape, oG ; lile
among Indians, r>8; starts to
escape, 59; slave to ^Marianes,
Gl ; escapes with Dorantes, Cas-
tillo and Estevanico, (JO ; lost in
the wood, 71 ; elFects a great
cure, 73 ; joined by Ciistillo and
Dorantes, 7G ; cures a wounded
man, *.)l ; shows his displeasure,
IH ; is given emeralds, 100 ; be-
comes alarmed, 1(K"> ; overtakes
ibur horsemen, lOG; arrives at
San MigUL'l, 101) ; Maldonado
comes to Indians visited by, 20l>.
Viceroy, ofticers for army api)oint-
ed by, 143; arrives at Compos-
tella, 14 1 ; accompanied army,
145.
Village given up to pillage, 198.
Vapor baths, 225.
Vaca and companions heard of,
244.
Velenzuela, looks for a harbor, 24.
Village surprised by Indians, 89.
Vegetables, how cooked, 99.
Vacupa, 118.
Victorio, Antonio, accident to, 151.
Volcanic region, 1 G2.
Valladolid, the province of, 221.
Velasco, friar, 273.
Vargas appointed to re-conquer
New Mexicd, 338; takes Santa
Fo, 339; letter of, to viceroy,
340; marches for Taos, 341 ;
iinds it abandoned, 342; marched
for the mountains, 344; persuades
the Indians of Taos to submit,
344 ; hears of a new conspiracy,
345 ; returns to Santa Fe, 345 ;
appoints a governor for the San-
ta Fe' pueblos, 347 ; sends a force
to Santo Domingo, and marches
for Pecos, 348 ; marches for
Santo Domingo, 349 ; meets the
(JuvTcs Indians, 350; marches
Vargas—
for Cia, 351 ; arrives at Jcmez,
:J52 ; at Cia, 353 ; marches for
Zuni 35G ; his negotiations at
Acoma, 357; takes possession
of Zufii, 3G0; leaves Zuni for
M()(iui, 3G4 ; arrives at Aguatu-
bi, ;w>5 ; stands sponsor, 3G(; ;
enters pueblo of Gualpi, 3G8 ;
mcetij his runner, Pedro, 3G8 ;
leaves Jong()i)abi to return to
Zuni, 370 ; marches for El Paso,
371 ; mar<:hes a second time for
New Mexico, 374; arrives at
Isleta, 374 ; halts within fifteen
miles of Santa Fe, 375 ; march
of, for Santa Fu resumed, 37G ;
ciuiets the fears of Don Louis,
377 ; encamps on tarm of Koguo
Jiladrid, :J77 ; visited by deputa-
tion of Indians, 378 ; enters San-
ta Fe, 378 ; assaults Santa Fe,
382 ; sends soldiers to Parral,
:i85; marches to mesa of San
Yldefonso, 38G; obliged to re-
turn to Santa Fe', 388 ; marches
again for the mesa, 389 ; defeats
Indians, 390 ; surprised, 391 ;
marches to Cochiti, 393 ; attack-
ed by Indians, 394 ; defeats them,
395 ; returns to Santa Fc, 395 ;
visited by Farreon Apaches,
39G ; again visits San Yldefonso,
393 ; marches to Taos, 401 j In-
dian ambuscade, 404 ; attacked
by the Utah Indians, 405; ar-
rives at Santa Fe, 408 ; marches
for the Queres nation, 408 ; cap-
tures Jemez, 410 ; returns to
Santa Fe, 412; charged with
peculation, 414; removed from
office, 414; re-oppointed, 414.
Vargas, Eusebio, 410.
W.
Water, supply of, taken in, 39.
Women carry water, 89.
Wild sheep, 158.
WarlUrc between Spaniards and
people of Tiguex, 189.
Women and children leave Tiguex
dming siege, 190.
438
INDEX.
Wound bv poisoned arrow, 233.
Witchcraft, 284, 285.
Wonderful account of four Cia In-
dian b, 305.
Water scarce, 310.
Warm spring, 312.
X.
Xagua, the licet winters at, 10.
Ximera, village of, 200.
Xabe, Indian named, given to Ck)-
ronado, 2U4 ; mortilied that his
predictions did not come true,
;i2G.
Y.
I Yeguase Indians, account of^ G5.
I Ynqueyunque, the province of^
221.
Zeburos accompanies Vaca, 108.
Zaguato, village of, 257.
Zuni, situation of, 1G7; fate of
priests at, 304.
Zepe, 3!)0.
I Zama, 407.
\
N
I.
I
1
\ \
I
THE BORROWER WILL BE CHARGED
AN OVERDUE FEE IF THIS BOOK IS
NOT RETURNED TO THE LIBRARY ON
OR BEFORE THE LAST DATE STAMPED
BELOW. NON-RECEIPT OF OVERDUE
NOTICES DOES NOT EXEMPT THE
BORROWER FROM OVERDUE FEES.
Harvard College Widener Library
Cambridge, MA 021 38 (61 7) 495-241 3
vvioENen
It
//57